O X F O 2 0 1 4 R D I B D I P L O M A P R O G R A M M E E D I T I O N B U S IN E S S M A N A GE M E N T C O U R S E C O M PA N I O N Loykie Lominé Mar tin Muchena Rober t A. Pierce p334: iStock; 3 p355: Great Clarendon Street, Oxford, OX2 6DP, United University Press is a department of the University © University Frederic It furthers the University’s objective of excellence scholarship, Oxford a the © is UK and Oxford and registered in certain University education trade mark other Press of by publishing Oxford moral rights of the Press in The countries The have been published in p366: Mesut Neema/Sygma/Corbis, Six authors p347: University iStock; Press; p364: Dogan/Shutterstock; (b) © Corbis; p376: p374: Oxford Red Marbles and Oxford University Press and to the Association the ve publisher reprint of the are Chartered fundamental grateful copyright to material Certiled principles from the following for listed: Accountants Code of Ethics and (ACCA) Conduct asserted ( January, First Oxford Press by permission 2014 authors bikeriderlondon/ worldwide. University for The p357: Press; p340: Mintzer/Shutterstock; in Artwork research, Jason of University Oxford. pick/Shutterstock; p344: Manufactus.com; Oxford Kingdom (a) Oxford p338: Shutterstock; 2011), www.accaglobal.com. 2014 Acorn Systems for case study on Coca-Cola Turkey Icecek, from www.acornsys.com. All rights stored any in reserved. a retrieval means, University under Press, terms the or the as agreed above part of system, without organization. of No or prior Enquiries be the publication transmitted, permission expressly with should this appropriate concerning sent to the in in permitted may any by law, reproduced, form writing of by or by licence mass or the Anand’ Times scope of Press, at the address must impose not this circulate same this Data Library Cataloguing on in Ratna Group, Ltd to (BCCL) for different Bhushan, copyright 6 © ‘Pepsico segments June 2011, BCCL of targeting consumers: Economic 2011. All Times, Rights Reserved. Education in any any other form and you must acquirer by Publication A International 1991, this Strategy British Co, cater for ‘The Power Interest Model’, original above. work condition & will Oxford model You by India Pearson University Coleman marketing, Manu rights outside Department, Bennett, Oxford reprographics reproduction Rights be L Mendelow Conference version (5e, on from Prentice published in Information G Hall, Johnson the Proceedings Systems, & K of the Cambridge Scholes: Second MA, Exploring Corporate 1999). Data UNDP available for Financial Summary Services to from the ‘Vodafone Poor in and Rural Safaricom: Kenya’ by Extending Winifred 978-0-19-839281-1 N Karugu National 1 3 5 7 9 10 8 6 4 and Triza Mwendwa, Development growinginclusivemarkets.org. Paper used in the production of this book is a natural, made from wood grown in sustainable manufacturing process conforms to the of we the country of in Great Britain Acknowledgements The to publishers use their Cover: MJ would p5: UIG/Getty Shutterstock; iStock; p34: Images; p72: p10: p52: p162: Yamashita/Corbis; Bloomberg/Getty (a) © Alex Titov © Maria (a) © Michele Rodach, © p301: p241: © Mike (b) p174: Craddock p311: M. Neil © © © / U. Julian Cienpies (b) p173: p198: p180: p182: David © Vitaly Becker/ Ozmen/Shutterstock; passionates/Corbis, p222: © Yuri (b) p250: © Danny iStock; Images; Images, Bloomberg/Getty Design / Alamy; (b) Arcurs/Tetra Iraidka/Shutterstock; p300: Bocman1973/Shutterstock; Michael Eales/Alamy; Bloomberg/Getty Richard iStock; Hanson/National Society/Corbis; food p270: © Hutchings/Reuters; Baumgarten/Getty Alamy; (b) (b) p101: Mazzzur/ Mukoya/Reuters, Michael Unal Ken p94: p159: Farrin/JAI/Corbis, p253: (a) Shaff/Shutterstock; iStock; iStock; Curioso/Shutterstock; p267: p23: Epperson/ iStock; Leynse/Corbis, News/Corbis; (a) iStock; Greg p74: Thomas Geographic p210: p247: Crebbin/Shutterstock, p329: (a) p169: C/Shutterstock; Samantha p69: p122: Johannes/the Eve/Splash eans/Shutterstock; Annette permissions razihusin/Shutterstock; tab62/Shutterstock; James Images; Images; Lehman/Corbis; Gil for ChristineGonsalves/ Sidelnikova/Shutterstock; Images/Corbis; p252: © Society/Corbis; Stringer/Getty p215: p97: p165: Rossow/National & following p19: p41: Images; Robinson/JAI/Corbis, Geographic Krista (a) p1: iStock; Imaginechina/Corbis; Shutterstock; S. the iStock; iStock; AFP/Getty aerogondo2/Shutterstock; © thank Prototype/Shutterstock Wolter/Shutterstock; p111: to photographs: Shutterstock; p45: like All rights have holders made before every effort publication to United www. p318: p256: (b) p281: Images; (a) jo Kuhlmann/www.qdrum.co.za; p332: reserved. trace this all cases. If notied, the publisher will origin. omissions Printed at has and not contact been all possible environmental in regulations 2007 forests. copyright The © published recyclable Although product copyright Programme, 2 Tupungato/Shutterstock; at the earliest opportunity. rectify any errors or Cours book dnition The IB Diploma resource throughout course help is Programme materials of their study students expected designed two-year in a gain from course to an books support Diploma particular the The IB Learner Prole of subject. an IB The They of aim of all a will better and what learner subject while that illustrates reect the presenting the purpose philosophy and and content in and encourage a deep aims approach of the of by providing making understanding connections opportunities for to of wider critical books mirror in the terms IB of a issues use of a wide and of Diploma of the range of resources, learner Programme knowledge, action, IB service the core prole essay, issues book materials required a variety and and and and of be so the indeed, and reading suggestions for conjunction students encouraged resources. further in to of draw the theory creativity, are given how to in with IB for each extend natural to curiosity. conduct research and actively snow enjoy independence learning and in this will be sustained throughout their love lives. that They have explore local and concepts, global ideas, signicance. doing, they acquire understanding in-depth across a knowledge broad and and balanced of disciplines. Thinkers: thinking They skills exercise critically approach complex ethical initiative and in applying creatively problems, to and recognize make decisions. other Communicators: are conclusions Suggestions their necessary IB and used below. international and (CAS). can ten the reasoned, Each the through approach; requirements, extended skills Knowledgeable: viewing whole-course develop the They learning range mindedness, described create of and thinking. philosophy They acquire develop the person to aim each In curriculum as this work The IB. and The develop world. the of subject peaceful develop who a learning. IB to attributes, inquiry They is to people Diploma They way programmes minded more programme Inquirers: Programme IB internationally Programme understanding study are students from additional ideas more of book research are and They information than one language communication. willingly in understand condently and They in work collaboration with a and and express creatively variety of effectively in modes and others. provided. Principled: In addition, and the guidance requirements They are being course on the and specic on distinctive companions course academic and provide advice assessment honesty authoritative protocol. with for a the action act sense dignity communities. own without They strong of the They and the with of integrity fairness, individual, take and justice groups responsibility consequences honesty, and for that respect and their accompany them. prescriptive. Open-minded: their own They cultures understand and personal and appreciate histories, and are IB mission statement open The International Baccalaureate aims to knowledgeable and caring the perspectives, young help to create a better and more other through intercultural traditions individuals to and seeking communities. and evaluating They a are range of peaceful points world and people accustomed who values develop of inquiring, to understanding of view, and are willing to grow from the and experience. respect. Caring: To this end the organization works with respect governments and international organizations challenging programmes of and rigorous have act to programmes world to a personal make encourage students across and to learners their who active, compassionate understand differences, can compassion and feelings of and others. a commitment positive to service, to the difference and lives also that be other and people, the of environment. the Risk-takers: become empathy, needs assessment. others These the international to education show towards to They develop They schools, They approach unfamiliar situations lifelong and uncertainty and have with courage and forethought, with the independence of spirit to explore right. new roles, articulate ideas, in and strategies. defending their They are brave and beliefs. iii Balanced: They intellectual, understand physical and the importance emotional of ballance What constitutes malpractice? to Malpractice achieve personal well-being for themselves is behaviour that results in, or may and result in, you or any student gaining an unfair others. advantage Reective: to their They own give learning thoughtful and consideration experience. They in Malpractice to assess and understand their strengths in order to support their learning or includes is work assessment plagiarism and component. collusion. dened of as the another representation person as your of own. the The and following personal more and ideas limitations or are Plagiarism able one are some of the ways to avoid plagiarism: development. ● words one’s and ideas of arguments another must be person to support acknowledged A note on academic honesty ● It is of vital importance to acknowledge passages be appropriately credit the owners of that are quoted verbatim must and enclosed within quotation marks and information acknowledged when that information is used in your work. ● After have of all, property work, and owners it ideas rights. must original of be ideas acknowledged. To (intellectual have based with on the Therefore, an authentic your work all property) Internet piece be individual of others oral, own completed language used or for and referred assessment expression. to, whether must Where in the use in the of the or paraphrase, such sources sources way of of all you acknowledge other and and works of people is that through you the have use original be used (placed (placed provided another at at the the bottom end when you document, information provided do to that is need part of denitions part of the of a page) a do in provide ‘body not of a document) quote or or use accepted involves into that of summarize and as forms works to nd how for knowledge’. be the of compulsory iv of artist is allowing a part must dened not music, arts of be as the categories art) in use That as formal work. one of (e.g. is, Other that they are list of your own work lm and dance, a where work takes the place, the acknowledged. supporting malpractice by or the books, providing viewer of A Extended includes: your work by to be copied another work ‘Formal’ several you use magazines, resources, full work bibliography Essay. Cds information your can is for and/or forms gives results of you of or submitted student different diploma malpractice an unfair another assessment requirements. unauthorized misconduct a CAS or Examples material during record. include advantage student. the usually that internet-based and the This resources information. in your This assessment duplicating taking a presentation. reader same are You information footnoted include used articles, a they the knowledge. should separating newspaper graphs, be are document. footnote to should you you different if visual of student. falsifying that data, must paraphrase closely another a need assumed Bibliographies means material or room, resources maps, programs, similar whether or components not and bibliographies. ● from must of for to art, arts creative ● endnotes the be another Footnotes books photographs, audio-visual Collusion footnotes as on media acknowledged. that ideas sites direct must How do I acknowledge the work of others? the way computer theatre The web electronic are ● appropriately same illustrations, acknowledged quotation other your sources form treated messages, any written ● or email and journals fully assignments, CD-Roms, an into an any action affects the include, examination examination and Contents Ui 1: Busiss orizio d Ui 4: mrki viro 4.1 The 4.2 Marketing 1.1 Introduction of to business management organizations 1 1.2 Types 1.3 Organizational 1.4 Stakeholders 55 1.5 External 61 37 environment of marketing planning introduction 18 objectives role 4.3 Sales 4.4 Market 4.5 The Growth and evolution 1.7 Organizational the forecasting (including four (HL Ps) 263 only) 274 research four Ps promotion, 1.6 to 247 281 (product, price, place) 293 65 4.6 planning tools (HL only) The extended (HL only) marketing mix of seven Ps 80 320 4.7 International 4.8 E-commerce marketing (HL only) Ui 2: Hu rsourc 2.1 Functions human and evolution resource 326 of management 94 Ui 5: Oprios 2.2 Organizational 2.3 Leadership 2.4 Motivation 2.5 structure and 117 management 5.1 The 5.2 Production 5.3 Lean (corporate) 5.4 Location only) Employer (HL 5.5 Production 5.6 Research 5.7 Crisis operations management 339 methods production and 346 quality management culture (HL 2.6 of 135 Organizational (HL role 127 only) 353 147 and employee 365 relations only) 155 planning and (HL only) development management and (HL 374 only) 384 contingency Ui 3: Fic d ccous planning 3.1 Sources of 3.2 Costs 3.3 Break-even 3.4 Final 3.5 Protability 3.6 Efciency 3.7 Cash 3.8 Investment 3.9 Budgets and nance External HL only) 397 liquidity analysis ratio (HL Assessment 406 191 Index ratio Assessment 179 Internal and 392 174 analysis (some only) 161 revenues accounts (HL analysis only) ow 413 207 216 224 appraisal (HL only) (some HL only) 233 240 v Introduction This book is a companion Management Diploma is a in to caring and of “develop young more an IB peaceful exciting who of Business all Management of that knowledgeable to create through Throughout Baccalaureate education help world and students Business inquiring, people understanding for International Programme. component seeks the a and the two intercultural class of your or some IB Diploma all diverse you to Management range of develop Course business a robust you will of of modern business activity, allowing of as the needed to manage businesses in structure programme Standard of in and our the book is Subject Higher of for your the but you and to – the you as part have also identify suggest forward These concepts and integrate which take assessment. course we boxes’ concepts to simply can are be should in just applied keep from the very beginning. Sud workpois well as activities encourage you to reect on the you’ve learned and apply new skills. Many successfully. closely Guide Level the is content, ‘concept thoughts of mind encourage The to aimed this core what skills our the activities part have a These principles as of extra links and we Programme study organizations, understanding some areas them Business book, Sometimes, discussion research respect.” years the additional better this concepts. included to During six based and material. on covers As can the both well be which a you great you to do your own opportunity could use in to research, nd new which case studies assessment. as ex prcic covering all the syllabus content, this book aims Throughout to capture the spirit of the IB learner prole exam-style page iii), allowing you to make links to your to TOK, and to the wider world. book, you will nd the following assessment. studies, about the and Diploma concepts essential Business Many of encouraging solutions included are Programme nd help you exam and prepare these follow for on you to think from critically features: Cox s d cocps Contexts you’ll to Throughout case the book, questions other your subjects, the (see features and of the to real-world dedicated internal chapters problems. on the We’ve also examination assessment. Management thory of kowld course. By considering concepts and contexts, as We’ve well as content (lots of ‘c’s!), you should develop holistic understanding of encourage and its place in the are the case studies the other and examples will encounter throughout your course - of book, in other resources, and in your By looking real-world at context these for examples, the ideas you and learn and evaluate about. You are encouraged examples, hope and to think the issues they Subject Guide underpin of identied the six content in key the Business the activities societies, and and the them this book authors, is as useful well as to you being in your experts are truly in international, IB and to used. reect It is this not in the expected examples that this and case book only resource. The business world will is ever- the more concepts and the more research you do, course. studies you nd, and the more questions you are: ask, ● change ● culture ● ethics ● globalization ● innovation ● strategy We vi group, with and Management, tried your case They its raise. has all between that The changing which in concerned carefully be The book analyse studies about the common will have these in In principles Business you TOK in studies. nd to more! own We research. subjects is individuals relationships this links nd that attitudes you of to world. Management Contexts lots you business with management included a and wide-reaching, the more wish you assessment! you the will best get of out luck of in this your course. studies and o r g a n i z at i o n 1 e n v i r o n m e n t tnemnorivne a n d 1.1 An introduction to business management By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ Explain the role of businesses in combining human, physical and nancial resources to create goods and ser vices ➔ Understand the main business functions and their roles (human resources, nance and accounts, marketing, and operations) ➔ Dene primary, secondary, ter tiary and quaternary sectors ➔ Outline the nature of business activity in each sector and the impact of sectoral change on business activity ➔ Explain the role of entrepreneurship (and entrepreneur) and intrapreneurship (and intrapreneur) in overall business activity ➔ Identify reasons for star ting up a business or an enterprise ➔ Outline common steps in the process of star ting up a business or an enterprise ➔ Examine problems that a new business or enterprise may face ➔ Outline the elements of a business plan th l f b A business aims organizations ● producing ● creating ● providing Some that its activities distinct. (sometimes doing wanted Many “a so or focus desired referred either or one and wants following raw of individuals or activities: materials activity. Other may a convert even output. to by as a from this “added organizations olives will the value”) earth for to the most under that olives are oil for generally adds and satisfying is is them to value rewarded what is needed. would business sale related processes what or activities. several inputs people many olive business for satisfying grow multiple into and the (sales) may in cluster activities fashion, that operate engage resources revenue recognition nonetheless the in inputs In gaining business business engage business A businesses Sometimes gaining activities business” on olives label. sometimes by the extracting transistors. grows the needs of service. Regardless, generate for a own or or the any product businesses farm under meet crops a manufacture A to through not consider principles. All 1 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 B u s i n e s s 1 B u s i n e s s many tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 organizations sense must religious charities, a basics and provide food for other and our organizations, need Business Figure have human, organizations business. – people o r g a n i z at i o n types Needs or want activity can wants Other be in are and etc. that all nancial such shelter – as they in the clubs and live are we many for our services are resources. synagogues, to provide provide sense summarized and mosques, different: businesses clubs, and physical, (churches, clothing charities, e n v i r o n m e n t organizations and water, needs. of a n d in all a certain need the businesses wants. or Thus, etc.), Religious products that businesses. ow chart shown in 1.1.1. human goods physical production nancial services enterprise Resource inputs Processes to add value Product outputs Figure 1.1.1. Summary of business activity The ● resource Human the inputs – the product automated Others ● and land Internet ● ● or – the business. become a It the – is the the least to types of and, as of laundry often and the with of input or of social including services, and the a cash to Even computer. and see other important the business. which cutting-edge Enterprise, everyday brick and person. sets. machinery, service. crucially will thriving media. or one skill materials, make highly only different “entrepreneurship”, high-tech if to forms of service. but the required even even space quantity ideally, – product ofce and people businesses, input product idea of quantity some tangible telephones, business, and make the follows: All human quality make business referred institutional 2 right to to require connotation computers, all the service. quality required as quantity individuals, functioning sometimes has right the and require many required Enterprise categorized quality still businesses – be provide ones, space Financial money right require Physical can other for elements Enterprise today is often businesses: though, exists (lawn-mowing manufacturing, etc.) in services, ● processes Capital intensive machinery land rich the of ● or in a resource and operation other inputs, intensive also or (an Goods home. such – these They as be are might or Services – them these examination, are a service: products for and the a or with land or Sometimes qualities unique deal the (land features), due to the or scale example). proportion land or of labour machinery. low-skilled as that other an we and for provides the or relative Labour- workers but primary extracted a can in take sector, from the the secondary not physically car. buyer delivery physically the made example, the can in items items iPad international to to special for of labour. great produced include include, consumers M A N A G E M E N T follows: products such retailers a large fairly as items intangible the B U S I N E S S employees. might They cost factory, use products are home. or equipment involve include sector, proportion especially relation categorized they (manufacturing) in tangible agricultural environment, take processes skilled large simply automobile may a proprietary specialized especially can use have T O forms: inputs, machinery highly outputs many other may operations involve Product ● to Labour-intensive to ● the take processes relative machinery land the can I N T R O D U C T I O N tnemnorivne Production A N does a of service karate a of class, package. having a medical Retail an sales array of purchase. B fc All businesses, from the same lines, ● human ● marketing ● nance ● operations by small resources and start-ups function – what to is huge to be conglomerates, done. There are are four organized key on functions: (HR) accounts HR management or production HR Finance Business Marketing and organization accounts Finance Business and Marketing organization accounts Operations Operations A small business A large business Figure 1.1.2. Business functions in a small business and a large business 3 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 1 1 B u s i n e s s or tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 The only o r g a n i z at i o n difference owners of themselves managers a and to between smaller do a larger the the business jobs two can e n v i r o n m e n t types have business same a n d to of deal afford organized in business with to is these hire that the owner functions specialized separate departments. The role of business depar tments In larger doing are so set businesses help out the these managers business achieve will its focus overall on their function objectives. Some and in examples below. Table 1.1.1. Business functions Function Role HR Ensuring to make people that the are suitably accomplish must these recruit dismiss appropriate product goals, and people ser vice rewarded people, them, or the train for HR them, determine are and employed that doing the so. To depar tment at times appropriate compensation. Finance and accounts Ensuring that appropriate funds are made available to make the product or service. To accomplish this goal, the nance and accounts depar tment must forecast requirements, keep accurate records, procure nancial resources from various providers, and ensure proper payment for goods and services acquired to operate the business. Marketing Ensuring that the business oers a product or ser vice that is desired by a sucient number of people or businesses for protable operations. To accomplish this goal, the marketing depar tment must use appropriate strategies to promote, price, package, and distribute the product or ser vice. Operations management or Ensuring production in order that the quality. that to in ways or ser vice is this quantity appropriate the of the used and desired the f low methods good are ser vice operations depar tment and competitive produce or goal, production the t o d a y ’s to or processes product accomplish control determine and, the product To management must appropriate make of world, or of stock , production, look ser vice for more efficiently. All these functions department as 4 a result are interdependent. determines of changes in that a product consumer For example, needs taste, the to be if the made operations marketing differently management production degree. That department and type must of with character businesses and that the may (produce other each of the then growth HR goods on a or even processes, at least resources, may business, can survival, to the would B U S I N E S S M A N A G E M E N T some which inuence which is a which control of the If in the may places a over the nance number have market might to and all to be geared to very become its diversify requirements is the Initially, accounts, marketplace, plan new business modications time. nance production business departments. signicant or HR, established example, services), change with management business For business and redesign the interdependence Once require in its nancial T O function. focus change. four could The operations end. priorities which the redesign require working typically marketing, toward of must may procure. people coordinated The function redesign I N T R O D U C T I O N tnemnorivne or A N on successful, a different priority, business departments. The strength aligned or the service good and or a for the service, particular functions market and are non-nancially)? they can hand, more must can of four respond large name it Small to the at? upon business Are in have the right often the even a successfully a people appropriately have an they good On the wider dominating become the (nancially advantage resources, business when desired producing marketplace. greater businesses, how producing rewarded businesses changes However, Large depends people generally recognition. vigilant. Is aims those quickly businesses remain business are. in that other reach, a and market complacent, fail. yduts esaC Kk For most of the 20th century, Kodak dominated the US photographic lm market. However, because of the introduction of digital photography (the technology for which Kodak itself actually developed), the business began to see sales of its photographic lm decline. By the late 1990s, the company was star ting to struggle nancially. The last year in which the company made a prot was 2007 and in 2012 Kodak led for bankruptcy. Since then, the company has made several attempts to revitalize the business through redirection of operations and sale of assets. Although the business emerged from bankruptcy in September 2013, its health prospects for the future are uncer tain. Kodak’s early camaras made home photography possible for many people. The company continues to dominate the market throughout much of the 20th century. 5 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 1 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t Business tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 sc f b cy local activity takes community, Traditionally, sectors, as in a place economists set out in in a country, have Table number or even of different within grouped the business areas: global activity in the community. into different 1.1.2. Table 1.1.2. Sectors of business activity All raw materials are acquired in the primary sector. This can be by extraction, mining, farming, shing, hunting, or even trapping. Today, because of the scarce nature of many Primary resources in the primary sector or because of the potential to damage fragile environments, governments closely monitor activities in the primary sector. In the secondary sector raw materials are processed, usually by manufacturing. Goods Goods from the secondary sector can take many forms, such as consumer durables, non-durable consumer goods, and capital goods. For most of the 19th and 20th centuries, much Secondary secondary sector production occurred in what are referred to today as “developed countries”. Since the 1970s, however, manufacturers in developed countries have been facing increasing competition from manufacturing rms located in “developing nations” and “emerging markets”. All services are provided in the ter tiary sector, sometimes using manufactured products. These services can be nancial, leisure, healthcare, education, transpor t, security, and many others. As manufacturing (the secondary sector) has shifted to developing countries, the Ter tiary ter tiary sector has grown in impor tance in developed countries. Services such as banking, insurance, transpor tation, retail and wholesale, and consultancy have become especially impor tant. Services This sector, a subgroup of the ter tiary sector, provides ser vices that are especially focused on knowledge. Generally speaking, various types of e-ser vices and those involving IT, Quaternary the media, and web-based ser vices are considered quaternary. This sector is typical of “post-industrial” economies and, thus, many businesses in the developed world engage in quaternary activities. These sectors production is the raw steps types glass, materials and of The online 6 this type of information. is turn sector). also and This type of and on by is to also the For to parts turn plastic into the (secondary assembly line (tertiary after-sale in the read service to sector) service tertiary but (oil sector. magazine or Sometimes in other companies quaternary make (tertiary records. for-prot the to example, make government, by in made consumers they and the production manufacturers shipped cars, produced business an provide repairs), features be as of processed parts cars typically provided is must materials are the purchase to chain automobile used cars sell A marketed. sector) into then major automobile free is rubber, The which information referred automobile are consumers about information cases sell before reports that even is that that (primary parts dealers and sectors good manufacturers dealerships, what (metals, sector) (secondary in production. different material automobile tune-ups, Sometimes, of consumer extracted Automobile changes, this are linked chain the (secondary automobile sector). or a raw etc.) automobiles to into automobile sector). typically through materials many and are chain sector. that A N I N T R O D U C T I O N T O B U S I N E S S M A N A G E M E N T tnemnorivne Student workpoint 1.1 Be a thinker Think of some production everyday chain. ● a cherry ● a skateboard ● a cellphone. What pie primary, involved in products you you use and imagine their purchase secondary, the that Consider: tertiary, production, and quaternary distribution, and business marketing of are these products? As businesses this is merging for the when (the other times, in have or operations activity the as in business a lumber company this process is purchases called another forward organic the crops organic Horizontal market and Lowering Ensuring ● explicit ● and supply in market – has various activity, grocery occurs, the new involved internal to in in or a businesses by If chain, harvest a or growth. the business, store the other production earlier its own When the a trees, business process farm the such is producing restaurant that sells farm. to increase economies transactions costs. – if These the market of scale. terms of regulation – if share and Vertical – integration treat such the strategies as is exibility price to backward and controls, (or stage as price. taxes, or integration. successful in is “downstream” availability, through integration businesses eliminated. quantity, stages greater pricing can between are vertical stage various power business use of of were acquiring of example, intended of or integration. retail on chain or same reasons: upstream customer a advantage costs government the can usually transaction the open is another produced varied regulation Increasing costs), for reliable preferred Avoiding is take transaction have “upstream”), a might by reserves For the share. through forest less one Sometimes acquiring integration chain vertical or merged entered enters business more market the businesses. a when that integration. meats to or or stage or purchasing meats occurs earlier business and two in backwards integration typically ● and power an in “vertically” stages acquired vertical food integration ● called grow later to horizontal the increased businesses earlier merge When of other refers engaged airlines another. will acquire which business two beginning of often combination acquisition) involved they growth, another purchases business At with example, stores grow, “horizontal” setting increase its its (that is, prices market if to it lowers others power. 1 ● Eliminating or weakening the market power of other businesses. 1 Carlton, Dennis W., and Perlo, Jerey M. 2005, Modern Industrial Organization, 4th ed. Addison-Wesley, Boston, MA 7 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 1 1 B u s i n e s s Not tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Common to always prots, than as these does it can savings. sometimes and all o r g a n i z at i o n a purposes vertical (or introduce Also, the business downstream is a n d the stages at aim horizontal) of of integrate another becoming integration proportionally protability will e n v i r o n m e n t greater to protable. greater complexity integration vertically more lead can only to (costs) change divest over time: upstream time. backwards vertical primary horizontal horizontal integration secondary tertiary forwards vertical quaternary Figure 1.1.3. Business sectors and types of integration Sectoral change The size of each sector of the economy may change because, just as TOK discussion individuals or Economists businesses usually grow measure and the develop, size of so each too sector will in countries. terms of the Are business sectors “timeless”? number of people employed by the industries in that sector. The Have they always existed, or traditional pattern is set out in Figure 1.1.4. are they specic to cer tain Closely related termed “social complex whereas skilled sector are raw ability tandem: as (for and typists. 8 of see are – not, however, while are workers to with the thrive. the and that Thus, historic periods? more Thus, few quaternary managers want more economies technologies have relatively (producers and is, workers, businesses information. social sector businesses possible and a scholars and of have developed advance improve; as in social develop. linear. word about some often for technologies computerized some low-skilled people develops, and what advanced often of advanced knowledgeable Thus, is economies technologies (which contexts skilled social economy example other emerge use are more numbers highly improve, The extraction consumers make the (individuals make on and Developments economies social large typically technologies area and both to economies needed material workers relies changing technologies”. the information) the to Technological processors) operating occupations occupations perceived as and word its related processors) obsolete, become “high innovation skill”). such as in one workers can typewriters obsolete, new ones Businesses that can anticipate or adapt A N to I N T R O D U C T I O N the changing T O B U S I N E S S environment M A N A G E M E N T can Less developed well, even in industries that are perceived as “in decline”. In general, (low income) economies developed both done in economies Canada and remarkably Australia. economies German have well: Another of the have is has a strong and a two in primary Canada as sector and one of quaternary of strong the primary Germany: retained engineering from two farming example it away however, organic world, businesses high-quality moved Australia, its wine the In sector. have primary production most secondary developed ter tiary However, long-standing secondary sector. industries quaterary strengths: sector. Developing The process of shifting from one proportional weighting of sectors in an (middle income) economies economy primary can to a produce sector to an require fewer occur and may other as require of will mostly physical well. As be (as skills economy the as economy may one tertiary will not be to the short secondary damage are the primary secondary supply. ter tiary another. needed goods). on example) Secondary in to for quaternary tangible environmental be sector or based sector, resources. that from for shifts an secondary human these services against as diverted in from the specialist resources an on such based intangible protections (shifting based resources, too, economy production weighting economy on resources, Finally, can an strains businesses Financial the different sector quaterary sectors as much Other sector, often will in strains legislation weak, Developed (high income) economies and primary manufacturing rms in developing countries often do more damage to the secondary environment than manufacturing in developed economies. ter tiary quaterary Entrepreneurship and intrapreneurship Both as entrepreneurs they provide opportunities. to the for the by impetus of a large their intrapreneurs, as well). business start-up, risk of ventures. either for for failure They a typically which and employers Both are work). both and likelihood types or new usually entrepreneurs product of for a to products develop the vital business and self-employed they (which against new are innovative are organizations of the for business benet balance intrapreneurs Entrepreneurs start-up employed the and new (or activity business were Intrepreneurs products benet or people whole success who new for want central are services them, intrapreneurs of Figure 1.1.4. Size of sectors the must new to create a business. Key terms Innovation is central to what entrepreneurs and intrapreneurs do. This Entrepreneur 2 typically comes in one of three forms : an individual who demonstrates ● market reading: observing customers and competitors and then enterprise and initiative in order making small changes to existing products to make a prot. ● need to seeking: determine communicating their with current and potential customers Intrapreneur needs an individual employed by ● technology driving: investing in research and development and a large organization who following opportunities offered by technological capabilities. demonstrates entrepreneurial Sometimes people imagine that “innovation” always involves new thinking in the development of technologies (computers, telephones, electronics, etc.), but need-seeking new products or services innovation often need for exists occurs simply otherwise because ordinary someone products or understands services. For that a example, in 2 Rober t M. Price, “Infusing Innovation into Corporate Culture,” Organizational Dynamics (2007), vol. 36, issue 3, pages 320-328. 9 tnemnorivne do dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 1 1 B u s i n e s s in tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 the United the last services. and the States 30 Although in the entrepreneurs Other social are in the business home some all of have workforce or workers most of in have homeowning for lawn occurred demand providing social has these in and the been equipment met services. changes patterns garden by an Some successfully built industry. prompted increased in demand the these this e n v i r o n m e n t changes the mostly understood emerged: and innovations businesses changes a n d increased involved, who protable changes have number large, new social years processes increase women o r g a n i z at i o n other in the the dog-walking the day, the industries. United States, business. family pet As Now often the for example, that has percentage fewer nine or of one women ten hours Professional dog-walkers have alone in the house. Some businesses go to the homes in which both partners made the most of changes to work and, for a fee, take the family pet on a 30-minute walk in the middle families’ working habits of the day. Dog-walking services are now common in many US cities. r f p b People start business for many reasons, as summarized in Table 1.1.3. Table 1.1.3. Reasons to star t up a business Working for someone else means that you do not get to keep all the rewards yourself. Although some criticize this aspect of capitalism, one central element is that those who put their capital at risk (the Rewards business owners) get the rewards, whereas those who do not put their capital at risk (employees) receive wages or salaries that are typically less than the return on capital is to the owners. Many millionaires own “boring” small businesses. Working for yourself means that you are your own boss and not following someone else’s rules. Individuals with an entrepreneurial spirit sometimes feel constrained by bosses, policies, and Independence procedures in large organizations. Star ting your own business means that you can set and change the policies and procedures as you see t. Sometimes businesses are star ted by individuals whose positions were made redundant or who could Necessity not nd work . The necessity of having an income led them to star ting a small business. Some people just want to see whether they can “make it” themselves. Star ting a small business typically requires one person to perform all functions of the business (HR, marketing, accounts and nance, and Challenge operations management or production). Over time, if the business is a success, the business owner then has to learn new skills as his or her role changes to accommodate a larger and more complex operation. Many interesting businesses are set up by people with a passion for something who want to just keep doing what they enjoy doing. The business producing Hawaiian Tropic suntan lotion was begun by a Interest high-school chemistry teacher who liked spending time at the beach. Many specialty shops – guitar stores, lamp stores, ballet clothing stores, rare books stores, and many others – allow their owners to work in an area for which they have a passion. Businesses may see or nd an untapped opportunity in order to achieve “rst mover advantage”. Sometimes businesses, large or small, stumble into opportunities for which they were not looking. The idea Finding a gap of Post-its®, one of the most successful products of the 3-M Corporation and which revolutionized interoce communications, was stumbled across by accident by Dr Spender Silver, a scientist working at 3-M. If you really believe in something, you may want to sell the idea to others. Yoga studios, for example, Sharing an are typically owned by people who themselves do yoga and want to spread the idea that yoga idea enhances quality of life. Marketing the idea helps their business, but often the original motivation to open a yoga studio is to spread the idea. 10 A N I N T R O D U C T I O N T O B U S I N E S S M A N A G E M E N T th pc f p b 15 time it takes minutes common in to all ● the ● planning. The business more it is idea refers sophisticated, – service-driven, or business Then the or the for that or market- to must to 4 might weeks in vary, for example, Argentina. Two from features are start-ups: the basic, fundamental such as means convince of others the should associated with by that activity sense plan up a business business the or must the the service, the business entrepreneur starting of product new carefully The needs some the the that house-cleaning the in that whether product-driven, a manufacturing. determined which Regardless risks business up example is, entrepreneur many a to idea something market-driven purchasing. register successful business whether to Singapore tnemnorivne The will do, something idea market or can be product – entrepreneur service is or basic have a business is worth or sophisticated, basic in business order to idea. reduce business. 4 Establishing 1 Organizing 2 Researching 3 Planning 5 Raising the 6 Testing the nance market legal the basics the market the business requirements Figure 1.1.5. Steps for star t-ups 1. Organizing must be based? be its a 2. the address How legal basics . several will business suppliers, potential Rening the the to concept determine the market. case, are United a to idea feasible, the is very they for be business a gap its in or failure as elude she the business in 50 Is to will there feasible research. outline, – itself easy. and research from Were others that However, precise are Once the market so surveys, between going What structure? obvious. be business services? do While new business distinguish would a business business? broad should rates. many are the market in market detection example, the government will the is operational make that, business high name through he starting Where to and determined determine, that States, will customers, successful have difcult short-lived how Rarely starting businesses What infrastructure has is entrepreneur questions: entrepreneur business entrepreneur business the structure? sufcient The basic rates small failure 80 per new of and failure so rates cent in the in in the the 3 rst In four years Europe, Thus, then will once do will target the operation; and he or market? business research the she Can 25 developed basic market target, How of another to per idea is conduct new in the failure the must market fail precise answer research? business test its rst rates determined, determine entrepreneur the cent economy, the year are Who high. business market some alone. also basic will concept? must segment be it questions: the What will 3 http://www.statisticbrain.com/star tup-failure-by-industry/ 11 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 1 1 B u s i n e s s its “unique selling a n d proposition e n v i r o n m e n t (USP)”? How will the business Student workpoint communicate with the market? 1.2 tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 be o r g a n i z at i o n Let’s the of consider grocery the the example business. basic The necessities of of the idea is entrepreneur very human who attractive. wants After all, to enter food is one existence. However, market may too competitors, Be a thinker research Choose may be very revealing. A market have many one following a segment of the grocery market (high volume, low cost, for be saturated. Market research might reveal that a the businesses: example) ● may of or small local delicatessen and niche café market there (such is a gap as for in the organic products market. Thus, or specialized researching the meats) is market where has rened ● the it basic to a business idea signicantly (a more grocery precise store) idea: a and narrowed speciality and grocery rened store new either organic products and/or specialized Planning the business. Once the concept has been narrowed, should write a business plan, a travelling hairdresser which is a beautician the ● entrepreneur of drink meats. and 3. energy that ● offers manufacturer document after-school sports that club addresses begin. all The business owners of plan to business will some the well as must entity business – can the be tax only be in paid, taxes, such as unemployment 5. Raising the rened, a business started from protable than the the for the can in – often take investor or its business legal – to can (even include taxes that insurance. has get the sustain the requirements must of who, the not must government, idea if In pass requirements been requirements it of must investigate would payroll types that and/or must as businesses country. the lender and host licences These in legally Other medical years procedures a from until cash or the business has practices, all not even legal plan have the business operations business may be is greater condence business. external met, to Who the in will business, groups plan business. between write the organization entities taxes of money business auditing the and nance of These sorts basic is business pensions the legal specic the business operate legal business). are the how in business steps them. countries, laws benets, the of a new the business operational operate. country. beginning, Any the various written, the – the (which the have can its most trader of that address Work lending starting the The potential of elements businesses and In (banks, nanciers, All below. especially people indicates Finally, Once raise and accounts the or to operations composition inuence with they also plan which prots). and example sickness then from sole employees’ support accounting prepare 12 to prots, of nance. must it can must detailed specic trying operator costly. but and business and a for before and requirements income if accordance inspections as obligations. the The the practices, businesses extensive of investors is are before institutions entrepreneur that even from countries certain tax corporations, established many plan requirements. laws planned stakeholders, capital. most and labour registered, separate be its determine be issues have business, For be nancial condence, legal that and the to business multiple through operate. Establishing of the need provide requires potential countries of serve may think provide that business that business foreseen will the business can issues elements plan companies) 4. the bullet down at points to for create your Divide you least for the and ve each step verify start-up other that investors capital, Most it the investment the they may means of – are Some may required. who selling all person business, business. accurate? or be that entrepreneurs control to they monies. start so will a – be Then, come When partial up some shares Who is I N T R O D U C T I O N a of but the the the some of the lenders? of do capital must provides the not will M A N A G E M E N T attract or equity business. want be capital What B U S I N E S S entrepreneur, someone owner business the business from T O tnemnorivne will A N in to the may kind of lose form be of loans terms will want? Table 1.1.4. Possible problems for a star t-up Problems a new business may face Organization Market research Business plan Legal ● The location of the business is inappropriate. ● The name does not register. ● The structure does not work . ● Supplies are unreliable. ● The research was poor. ● The target market wasn’t appropriate. ● The test was too optimistic. ● Channels of communication were weak . ● The business plan did not convince. ● Goals were too vague or contradictory. ● Labour laws were not addressed. ● Registration was too dicult. ● Tax obligations were not addressed. ● The accounts were not kept properly – cash ow, in requirements Finance par ticular, was a problem. The market 6. Testing How “pilot”) of the will the be? respond types and of that of the suggest The launch failed. ● The pilot was inconclusive. ● Success was limited – the product failed to inspire. In to by the – nal the types of reactions restaurants, changing the The idea will business in for well a launch on will only a – enough the or by the way. respond is to rm Other quickly changing market of (a success and slow often received chance for capital-intensive and recipes, business. scale expensive can testing the criteria limited changing reasonable of small especially example of a the extremely purpose be the begin What is menu, has is business, launch business. the stage business reaction? initial market business that The Will some the business easily, aspects ● consumer manufacturing, can Raising medium-term to long-term nance was dicult. occur? test pilot Raising star t-up capital was too dicult. ● market. that to ● other verify consumers to success. 13 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 1 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t Even tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Pbl w b y fc when probability they did basic all of these before or poor-quality to investors operate, of these Even if of from is or a plan, the the and New were certainly and strained successfully. cause it sales and to high had upon or of in insufcient unconvincing properly did what problems satised, insufcient not develops Sometimes the Other right cannot have funds to materialize. All failure skills. often Therefore results failure In the capital not strong times control less would a anticipate business which not had accurately start-up executives can fail. generally a poor a fail. idea with always a to have because based were marketplace. labour cannot or still the recruit operating control may was and so business business business business businesses managers business’s a good weakens, the still do were planning unsuccessful in the requirements cause a often services and/or business businesses economy business was start-ups fail opened: or research, recognition competitors between has that ever legal kept can to followed, products launch inability competitors. the its market start-up name business poorly the are Businesses lenders, problems because of or were business lack the organization, accounts steps failure. other the rely brings be things of it its upon out present many cases reactions actions to from stems if if problems the outside a fail. th l f b pl A business plan objectives. asking The is a the It where plan the applies detailed heads. targets A for to business required out plan of be from the period, and of the regularly all measured what and its of against several clearly achieve business stated years, objectives to such and should necessary, the organization, business priorities over if its operations needed and, elements the meet long-term resources reviewed the in will day-to-day potentially short-term analysis be organization back heading individuals the is is delivering will in the specic an key Success set a should Responsibility how stepping business to with It allocated out statement business objectives. be sets involves as be. and of these updated. plan will department performance plan. usually combined with detailed budgets to nance the activities. th pp f b pl A 14 business plan the is drawn ● support ● attract ● support strategic ● identify resource ● provide a ● work new as a launch funds focus of up a from to: new organization banks, grant needs measure development of business business providers, planning for or success. or idea venture capitalists business want of to new years with be have some low If condent business in a may experience. they failure sectors risk business needs is going, and A good of to – is it is plan will To may lend paid high will – has to get be of back only it ideas, funds up persuade that going original to be very failure. of are banks prove how business plenty banks I N T R O D U C T I O N with to 80 want a its there. cent signicant other use to Since it knows it they risk rst two businesses money, words, M A N A G E M E N T lack the the those homework, In often over to lend B U S I N E S S businesses, interest. lend to they new per to bank done but to T O tnemnorivne Entrepreneurs A N a where needs stakeholders. a it plan. For Student workpoint 1.3 potential detailing investors, how the it will provide business will a use basis a for bank assessment loan or of risk investment. by For Be a communicator employees, it will identify specic objectives and goals and provide a Using focus for action and a source of motivation. For suppliers, analysis in the business plan may identify whether there are likely to be the from a commercial relationship with the the will local provide Businesses a clear plan” community the that plan. which groups basis such have This can as for is pressure become often be the and assessing in the groups, successful the presented style to government of will a the have to in usually investors bank the role document potential or access organization’s you on discussed page 12, a business plan and present business. it For business workpoint long-term create advantages the of business the or the other the rest of the class. plan community. started called to off with “Business interested manager. th l f b pl There are six elements ● the ● business ● HR ● nance ● marketing ● operations. Each set business in a aims business and plan: objectives organization element out idea, of has Table a specic focus and should address key questions, as 1.1.5. 15 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 1 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t Element tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Table 1.1.5. The key questions for a business plan For this element Key questions to address are: the focus is on: Star ting the setting out the What is the core idea and what are the objectives of the business? How will the business – the business idea in product work? Does it have a unique selling point (USP)? How will the product idea the right context be developed? Why should it succeed? Business how the business Where will the business be located? What structure will it have? What type of business organization will be organized will it be? Who will make what decisions? How will the owner or owners share out the prots? Are there any legal requirements necessary to start up the business? HR Finance Marketing Operations how the business Who will have what responsibilities and what rewards should they expect? What will will be staed be the HR plan? What type of contract will be used? how the business Where and how will the entrepreneur source the start-up capital and at what cost? This will be nanced unit should include projected budgets, income statements, and cash-ow forecasts how best to What market research has been done? Has a sales forecast been made? Is the market the product to be targeted at a particular segment of the market or will it be mass product marketed? What will the promotional mix be? How will the product be distributed? how the product How will production be organized? How many units will the business produce? will be made How long will production take? Is there likely to be a lead time? What is the supply chain likely to be? r chckl ✓ Businesses produce ✓ Human the resources raw make There ✓ the ✓ the ✓ four tertiary ✓ the quaternary An intrapreneur products A new both The or are business resources to to carry out the buildings, include the aims of machinery money needed to business involves activity: the acquisition processing raw of raw materials, materials. usually where provides individual make an most a service services who businesses that focus demonstrates sit on knowledge enterprise and prot. individual employed by thinking a in large the organization development of services for many researching might a resources, its face nance, raising and plan Steps market, challenges control business reasons. the requirements, within of is an started legal elements of entrepreneurial include: things human 16 is new business nancial include resources involves sector to demonstrates establishing ✓ is order who Businesses needed resources generally sector entrepreneur in people sectors sector the An and product ✓ a ✓ a physical service. sector secondary create the Financial or main primary initiative ✓ are Physical product are human, services. materials. the to ✓ and organization. and ✓ combine goods nance at each external are: the marketing involved planning starting new testing stage. factors idea, and and in the the These beyond business operations market. can its up business, be control. organization, A N I N T R O D U C T I O N T O B U S I N E S S M A N A G E M E N T Pcc q ® and Tata Coffee tnemnorivne Starbucks ® Starbucks is a multinational coffee shop chain based in the United States ® (US). Starbucks is in discussions with Tata Coffee, an Indian company, ® about opening The Indian into India. Tata Coffee Starbucks government grows and coffee limits sells its shops the own in entry the of coffee. fast-growing Indian foreign-owned It is owned by retail Tata market. chains Group, the ® largest Indian considering seven business forming years, the a two conglomerate*. strategic Starbucks alliance companies have or a done and joint Tata venture. business with Coffee For are the each past other. ® Starbucks coffee has shops Forming a purchased in Europe strategic coffee and from the alliance or US), a various suppliers including joint venture from with in Tata Tata India (for its Coffee Coffee will ® allow Starbucks to enter the Indian market. Additional advantages for ® Starbucks include: ® Starbucks ● could nationwide open hotel coffee shops inside hotels of the Tata Group’s chain ® Tata ● the Coffee Over has Group numerous has the long past increased choice, would retail been popular decade, of to 1 that in however, young over allowing chains signicantly, appeal population consider as is India consumption coffee with to open coffee shops in owns. southern new Indians billion) it Starbucks but of shop coffee chains disposable developing not fast in in the with income. (with a the north. north more India growth (with rate its of ® 8% of its GDP this year). Starbucks has carried out research and found ® that the global brand name “ Starbucks ” is already well-known in India, ® although there are no Starbucks coffee shops there yet. ® The competition dominates shop the chain, in India market. is An intense. Italian Café Coffee company Day owns , an the Indian other big company, coffee Barista™ [Source: adapted from “Starbucks to broaden dealings in India”, International Herald Tribune, 14 January 2011] a) Dene the b) Explain term the multinational importance of company. branding for the decision [2 marks] [4 marks] of ® Starbucks c) Explain to one enter PEST the Indian factor that market. may inuence the decision ® of IB, * Starbucks Nov. to enter the Indian market. [2 marks] 2012 conglomerate: a company that is made up of a number of dierent companies and business that is typically in diversied elds and, often, dierent sectors of the economy 17 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 1 tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 1.2 Types of business organi zation By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ Distinguish between the private and the public sectors ➔ Outline the main features of the following types of for-prot (commercial) organizations: ● sole traders ● par tnerships ● companies/corporations Outline the main features of the following types of for-prot social ➔ enterprises: ● cooperatives ● micronance providers ● public-private par tnerships (PPP) Outline the main features of the following types of non-prot social ➔ enterprises: ● non-governmental organizations (NGOs) ● charities m f f p-b (ccl) Prot-making businesses existence, the but ● sole ● partnerships ● companies ● for-prot or social micro-nancers ■ public–private common the to feature generate following partnerships of revenues, business 18 in a all prot. types the of legal organization and following: of (PPPs). these The types prots a of business business is that receives one can be of their shown formula: Prots Total many are enterprises ■ is in corporations cooperatives aims come common traders ■ The by most often = total called specied revenues “sales”, period of are time. all total the Total costs income costs are received all the by costs the incurred that and business expenses formula The in are suggests, difference the same measured but for between period is now them of time. actually the simple can be The more way that complex form is expressed O F B U S I N E S S O R G A N I Z A T I O N revenue than this simple tnemnorivne by T Y P E S enough. as shown in Figure 1.2.1. equity sole trader turnover cooperative par tnership company assets employees Figure 1.2.1. Revenue, expenses, and prots in dierent types of organization sl Most people budget and choose to a is fullls many seeing a The ● the main The the in the a features sole decisions, business trader form of reasons of a sole and runs but sole decisions and have No distinction to traders ultimate the those just include a the business. responsibility sole their trader own boss, creating their Sole the often dream. following: to make for limited they quickly, living a proprietor), a being empowered themselves sole Being respond or with constraints, called business: business including begin organize. a community, people, the these to start wanting trader owns Facing business the typically (sometimes people and serving trader other sole market product, employ the of own organization. as simplest gap own their simple operate which their starting traders make may some of management business. Monique owns and runs her own ● legal trader. the The debts lawsuit). ● The that from of the institutions ● The a high or sole limited may is business customer. be Sole other sole or or from nance, family, reluctant rate close that of to get can the banks, their sole for to as café business - she is a sole trader all the the a sole of a money personal loan traders personal other trader sole liability”. from such and the outcome refers come because the liable Regardless, savings nancial money because businesses. customer. the as is and “unlimited sources, bank. lend thus, nance It other either to the to use. business (such have friends, start-up allows traders a and, Here, for from the claims traders limited. trader friends failure or business available because business small has between the words, usually and have limited the is is business business family typically of the trader other nance the savings are of In sole exists sole know A trader their sole to trader interact customers is usually with on an each individual 19 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 2 1 B u s i n e s s which larger tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 basis, ● The the allows sole time, trader sole the business tax has money or sole in for of the the a sole the complete ● exibility privacy, ● minimal ● close The have a more personalized service than to do consensus of the the and being sole a business. a a In Sole easy from sole the traders lease) and general, and country trader traders Sole have is usually traders to to simpler make devote time all to decisions. sole trader, vary as not prot sole as of anyone privacy. le. for (such Most to much well, relatively laws organizations. out as statements. of operating ll nances how contract degree therefore advantages know nancial generally and to building to their Sometimes, nancial see accountability. declare Although legal and limited to want high is starting from a to quick. belong control in trader as Other no is legal that all prots distinction advantages of operating as over terms of all the important working hours, decisions products and services, and operations sole legal ties Sole to owner as success into paperwork and to to of enthusiasm, falter. a include: ● ● which need of and have purposes. business and greatest changes enter themselves trader not tax may types business separates for general legal discussion from – other less decisions One e n v i r o n m e n t provide privacy do traders the inexpensive country, or lessors Registering have to authorities, made lenders however, has traders borrow than them a n d businesses. except ● o r g a n i z at i o n traders generally not need to divulge information formalities customers, businesses and do health traders also which can operating of the have sole as give sole traders other a competitive traders depends themselves. disadvantages, advantage. on Any which of the drive, these include can the following: ● Competing daunting ● There trader and ● ● ● will her on for There is 20 lack businesses death – all by yourself the limited the made. seek will be for with advice in business scope the business. unlimited to ineffectiveness often continuity running there potential decisions, of day-to-day mistakes and the opportunity be time Generally, cash established stress all be may burden ● be makes owner’s There or may limited There the against can be a challenge. the limited from event itself may expansion time to the sole make them others. of a not as because serious accident or continue. the owner spends all his business. limited The operations liability of capital, focus will than the on which be may more looking owner for any on to also create having the a sufcient future. faults, debts, or the majority business Sometimes, a decent of sole living complexities niche to in enough to surviving up or an traders not often support be within to to on a see growth, the chief rst stay the goal few to too risks of a years which Sole great. of and allows growth them are too to the sole prots many O R G A N I Z A T I O N dies. often When Their trader: or about) traders B U S I N E S S typically retires worry expand. sole of trader (and scale. need are businesses sole small, larger no or the manage challenges the small when want have and the remain end operating market may fail traders to and of the expand, sole comes O F have a not great. sole make many traders are tnemnorivne The T Y P E S want large Just traders give existence. Php An alternative business is associates type formed or people popular with doctors, lawyers, The ● main each ● The all the No legal Most to partner who is business or ● they The bring of no a law commercial role vary. of and but the run they business, number the partners business and of the than and debts legally partnership’s the and can debts other be even called if a business. for capital which person. a of one unlimited, partners. some as than tecÚically partnership’s more (their a sole to usually to trader start Also, willing up provide is the means banks partnership in partners” , investment Otherwise, the more and other nance considered to a more as a partnership a sole and could the however, than This in which a means that partnership) sleeping and partner business. the trader. product situation professionals rm law, own own more is liability the “sleeping prot. expertise, partnerships example, be operated can the the one trader, nance the service different business as 2–20 business, only usually sole may other varied are as rms. trader. some of of of by partners available the are such people also of following: who other Partners between contribute by the partners , percentage more Partnerships consultancy employ unlimited small a of all cent into” to sole business more the a share performs ● “buy than provide a a per provided partners expect have 100 type friends, qualications, include managed have for This are ownership. difcult exists liable partners if and number more institutions than Some are only to partnership stable is usually All than nancial the the may they skills. business decisions. partnerships for owns business. capital owned Often business by Partners partnership. related even percentage Partners pay Finance or a related with jointly distinction obligations. ● is a of people. or people management agreement partners, upon made with that partnership Although increases. ● a is more similar together. business getting of are partner person. with or accountants, features business make business two professional Decisions the of by have international such is as or or often lawyers the doctors. specializing civil in in a partners offerings true or offer different service especially lawyers law, can Often, of case For criminal law, law. 21 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 2 1 B u s i n e s s Partnerships than tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 ● o r g a n i z at i o n a legally do. it is the It sole required Having a typically trader. a legally includes responsibilities ■ nancing ■ division ■ liabilities ■ procedures a major of deed for of a Partners Usually, get Partnerships in general, are partnerships business sense the rights and their rights and not often because duties of of the of than sole Drawing business If some traders up but one a and deed will of help the determining percentage advantages different that the skills are expect are the partner’s provided a allocated. active In partners considered partnership’s prots are prot. allocated to ownership. compared production each has may partners partners”, drawings equally. to partner person other the prots according that the “sleeping or the out then than determined, efcient all paid business. with their bring of and to sole traders: qualities, through the partnerships specialization and labour. partners generally ● Partnerships Partnerships can are bring more in have end also perceived have help partner legally other the salaries to likelihood decreases. stable share and nance, is the continuity. registering prots certain partnerships Each of of and partners more of allocated of know expertise to a business than one can. necessarily 22 out accountability term. purpose often the necessarily prot more Partners of the have partners down long are according ● is not the division they ● the amount for have person slow partnerships partners often As good sets partnership, typically ownership after partners In partnership, makes that of partnerships circumstances. between agreed-upon expenses ● in do the likelihood proportion addition, Then, are will substantial greater may within prots percentage ● of degree countries about: partnership, higher organization the most deed document changing disagreement partnership As a greater prots Partnerships have ● up a in partnership information ■ a draw of binding responsibilities ● have Although e n v i r o n m e n t partners. With ● to deed a n d if more partnership, a have for one stability and lower risk, when others continuity as are the ill or on business holiday. will not dies. all liability, of the exception partner or of greater nance. disadvantages: unlimited The to more chance partner certain responsible partner. to emergencies one have has access or which means businesses to certain this debts liability partners are is that or each partner actions when, declared in of the any deed “limited limited Although partners specied in Compared ● the to partnerships nancial from An ● deed individual Prots ● Partners and have or to may access Limited does rely but as to nance not on shared disagree, according operate less maximizing to be that have partner has vary liability to also country, limited B U S I N E S S in O R G A N I Z A T I O N general, control (both partnership). businesses institutions. business laws limited of usually expanding ● the have O F tnemnorivne partners”. T Y P E S often in and control partners. the worst case of and a making goodwill the (corporations), banks prevent for complete work among which can from opportunities have the companies loans other business prots. over the others. could break up the partnership. In summary, partnerships organizations. sole traders more of a of a As and because chance chance of are multiple of safer of the surviving expanding than partners if can greater traders inherent changing the sole typically market conditions are but raise also more stability, more complex nance than partnerships conditions and have have more right. Cp cp Perhaps the most (corporation may have in the important North type America) following – Incorporated LLC – Limited PLC – Private or PTE – Private Limited LTD – Limited Company Public Limited SA – Sociedades can after is the company recognize its Anónima (United a company as it logo: States) Company Company Company Sociedad you (USA/Canada) Liability – business abbreviations INC SA of and (UK) (UK) (various) (Latin Anônimas America (Brazil, except Brazil and Mexico); Portugal) This business in the USA has registered itself as a corporation SpA AB – – Bhd Società Aktiebolag – GIE per – Berhad Azioni (Finland, (Malaysia, Groupement GmbH – (Italy) Sweden) Brunei) d’Intérêt Gesellschaft mit Economique beschraenkter (France) Haftung (Austria, Germany, Switzerland) Other countries is used, is a that can other A this joint types business process and the type stock be – have of or means company. company and the This abbreviations. same type (corporation) of to thing: that business is distinguish Whichever the the it business only from one the business. can the a designations designation limited called of other become business liability of the a company and the by owners company is a simple of the distinct but very business from the powerful are legally liability of separated those who 23 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 2 1 B u s i n e s s it. Another owners, tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 own (shares The each of handle stock the laws prots (past or Shareholders of determined company by €600,000, of shares the each and is business the or a not in case the of shares, group of for of a If person own of shares of person to that the to the can, rare With 100 per friends to of For the of dividends. at the is example, pay total by the were a number 100,000, of 20,000 if dividends €6.00 of the for issued €120,000. the do shares. and obey unless dividend of must dividends gure a can – who partnerships, portion divided owned part a The partnerships, it and stock. be right. dividends of theory very own or shares workers and form as receive a in company. members of will percentage is multiple of own and or decides would only it all the receive company a in person majority has activities prots If its traders pay and in traders proportion would lower shares one the one it form community: sole to outstanding. the sole business the the business the (€600,000) companies, family in shareholders a of like decide their stock that own the Unlike their in existence Just €1,000,000 and owns the of and shareholders large legal of typically, company. shareholders owned. decisions uncommon small the payout share they of from of issued who very majority to individual unless shareholder weight a case, the manage taxes. proportion person individual the has to proportion prot each the a total stock outstanding that prots their the of share Often, a of owner pay company, a – in that, company responsibilities present) makes of shares) e n v i r o n m e n t is the shareholders) receive the of operations. and the called a n d company company land keep (also a executives certain the of fraction equity the has of discretion a day-to-day companies owners – or employs company the feature owning business company a o r g a n i z at i o n business. not In still practice, have a therefore, for one cent own the sometimes deciding control person smaller When control to companies, of the shares 100per cent it. In own it or of all is for the shares. Regardless, three 1. shareholders The price company in of is The The the same amount number once every comes of they well. of too a for hold investing In may theory company should stock issues of of in the the sole portion money dividends three in with a shares part are in is increase (though based total value company because has are a in not upon of its should or company value if always its in the true prots. shares. increase not paid quarter want in that – are and liability, As Therefore, in value at partners in in a small paid new small. invest dividend in With – the income that company. is owning one of stock partnership, way on or regularly individuals regular any dividends. relatively often which of as depends With are particular benets responsible or the prots receives owns. dividends they and or company shareholder limited not the shareholder ownership features of often months, proprietors company each each companies, share important Unlike 24 so shareholder most a value established company The share(s) shares company large, in rewarded rate. companies, 3. the increase, individual the the performing practice), prots 2. are ways: for the in a single company. shareholders the company’s If the investment goes into to do have not a The 2. to cost The the to the price the value of too (typically) poorly The “owners” the stock. say An of have 1 who the approximately Typically, the existence rather other ● than The ● as shares with a active the the business Companies does to the the the in theory declines, does in of not that be need so or the have are able to money equipment rarely shares mean decisions and 100 never pay to and pay investment of that is the an about (GE) individual the in company thus require would, such have an as a business. the outstanding shares (and become business thus giving or partners, a company: being a source a to shares of practically GE. 1 To per cent investment limited is company have the company the existence the of the of of a owners, liability. because separate as There generally legal shareholders are also recognition that stability major rm, can for a business, especially requirements. apart business a nance capital increases in it to also Corporation would initially working die, if successful. good death executive nance, a legal shareholders businesses, ● a of been follows: above, if hand value not issued giant monies rst). dollars. want trader a are) billion status is in of in owning as is of value. may company personally, growing has all 000 any paid Companies on the fraction Electric be prot dividends investment of or shares. companies say If their liability value 1 is company liquidation is in a O R G A N I Z A T I O N shareholders receive point growing stock rm 625 the choose company company at of becoming has a a investor business sole enhanced Being or a for in executives them business Selling one the from reasons the ● of only 405 say $2.5 the General cent businesses owners in meaningful 10 no per more many of will prots. cash rapidly for in reasons. measurement own 2012, issues to debts decrease its lose if euros the company individual sufcient pay a noted upon to are fall in event party all may As many result, shares had not have or any of for that a individual even in often States speaking, own rise has value (to As owning end United not hold well. of B U S I N E S S shareholders’ the last investing based funds entire the shareholder At may is the millions The in can example, companies, business; they choose need growth upon company, the may capital). dividends. based will a For owing other debts. are of of share(s) shareholders more. (however, performing Businesses the working those assets company company support As a Businesses dividends. of and shareholders not the no (bankruptcy) any the all but banks, shareholders of then investment of the doing pay the sale is to. 3. to their company The fails, company, individuals, company, from the receivership dollars limited 1. business in O F tnemnorivne debts. T Y P E S of from the its continues. In shareholder, cause business, owners. some if the If case that as a a shareholder of small person disruption. is also an Nevertheless, continue. typically especially have loans, improved from chances nancial of gaining institutions further and governments. 25 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 2 1 B u s i n e s s business. tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Achieving company Up questions o r g a n i z at i o n until exist status the about is point the a n d often that a a survival e n v i r o n m e n t turning business of the point in the becomes business a and evolution company, its of a some continuity and growth. As with any company becoming a major a a owner company, all When either a ● public only people company the offer major nancial $16 billion the has no bought The ● main The its of little not liable is company 26 a the as the and and hire a could even becomes executives (as of thus original business owner can choose as sole to to trader or become In have to buys to worth company own in include but provides the shares do normally low, the around amount based FTSE, the or it 20. of in the has one Facebook rst sale the to of acquired of some the Street, possibility lose to of Tokyo, Wall investors in (and then shares privacy. see their business example, Apple itself Microsoft 1997. following: run but day-to-day are up does For a limited Frankfurt, Further, the not nance, – the potential shares. associates. company York, it is the maintained. (IPO), everyone. of it example, public, and that privately: private public”) opens offering” their a limits exchange for allow in limited New public goes be example, 2012, public to is company generally going London, Going open is company family, company stock for of the friends, public a in permitted control a – company into the business. otherwise running of employed the the to Their shareholders business. make all Instead, the decisions. and for limited and a may forms country, online; capital. managers business liability and of shares management are or who input professional it shares company place “initial a two sell limited become such shareholders have The of the more “the million features purchase ● to is become over US$150 business company, such to private companies control a shareholders NIKKEI. sums which become advantage investors occurs, When business to full investor. only owners public When limited accounts, a centres from public. Public a can allows used the large an country Singapore, NASDAQ, securing to or but in the shareholders) between of decides shares Shanghai the from typically its to becoming available this company. original as multiple when over choice take company. company varies have To company number business phrase the the the organization: difference known result, nance If limited real Although a limited limited (the merely of the The reorganizes types business, will control in owners be a However, some decisions. now these private As new of disadvantages. business capital. loses business of private its may ● The of a and involvement major partner) to company, personal make organization advantages infusion business lose legal has the any to of owners the their debts of are (shareholders) divisible. the investment shareholders owners are in separate are The business. the The company legal divisible, shareholders entities. the shareholders’ because As owners the can the business change. person shares ● The owning for any legal thus business the and to this have appropriate country For of company the titles nancial IPO. nance represents the are to company ● A the time – areas details the To to drawn up (which of this the sell these and varies document the legally a company owners of registered in name the with from documents): activities of are form owners), of memorandum records the will the provide business key company and being basic record the required. – this regulated and the is a of of document internally. the species It will, executives responsibilities etc.) and they is that the its the of how for the (chief rights held to a must of high are its the of the example, company executive and The explain with ofcer, responsibilities any the initial capital receives to the price future shares degree to of of information management of paid (or only, more at to their are from the unless The time to shareholders held in the capital. investment being the losses) accountability. so of business. gains raise entities, condition offering the shareholders separate provide understand and cost) it and additional company company shares (or sells available. injection shares, initial and the can sells benet company that generally one-time the issues company owners the ofcer, business Thereafter, price decide O R G A N I Z A T I O N shareholder. Greater Once and from external organization chief the names objectives association their shares the the be can record. agency the association initially will initial each ● on capital Articles ■ do and of public documents example, information share as of company many of government characteristics created. the separation two country, Memorandum ■ and matters achieve must in B U S I N E S S whatsoever. existence recorded (and shares reason O F tnemnorivne A T Y P E S and so so Key terms accountable. Sole trader Information on a company is generally provided by: a person who owns and runs published, ■ audited company reports annually and, in some their own business and who countries, unaudited quarterly reports has complete control over ■ an annual general ■ an extraordinary meeting general (AGM) meeting open to (EGM) if all decisions shareholders called by the Par tnership shareholders. a business owned and ● Compared to companies have continuity. continues has no other greater When to a impact of business stability shareholder operate. direct forms The on death the and dies of a organizations, or a higher sells shares, shareholder company. All that controlled by two or chance or the the happens of more people who share company sale is of that shares responsibility and decision making one Company partial A of owner company the can and of business theoretically The company, began example been the shareholders. construction CE of an Kong o by exceptionally in Belgium replaced last oldest operations operating is for ever company Gumi, building old since by another because in the which a is is world was Buddhist company it partial independent is a founded temple. Stella owner. Japanese in 578 which established for a specic purpose and registered Another Artois, a business organization has according to local or national legislation 1366. 27 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 2 1 B u s i n e s s ● tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Advantages Access of to o r g a n i z at i o n operating nance partnerships. risk ● lower and institutions The of of are the shares in many and thus small of is directors of leave. the their are possibilities to nance. money fewwer business An sole established This do not stability with can the Disadvantages Setting money of up to out, Selling not be le a itself for Owners If a 28 or partnerships, as a with the the little starting the a or to or it all end any those if of a the (with terminating chance often, a have longer often or new small cannot of more and needs have to activities. business, take advantage companies exists. long-term allow of can. Managers shareholder also include sells and shares. relationships the business positions and a legally and thus a great “goes amount and reorganizing involves of give as a a company, the lled agencies. public”, of of nance business business does will has as sold a risk. control up a deal Whether paperwork government company, must cost business company loss a following: required intended Thus, the requirements. unsuccessful, entire last efforts, time company owners be thus greater individual starting or become of of small liquidated grow, can legal the are very and many appropriate if a business. have cash. up partial decides company, IPOs It for take desired The number if Companies time company lawyers, especially that the can up indeed they develop alike. expertise of huge own the limited, investment a structure business company papers risk More every necessary Sometimes business limited a retain relatively company with to nance, expand. the have marketing for is companies. a liabilities), business suppliers the into shares, a build necessarily or generally change company guarantee raised. to operating full must and to performance reorganizing owners and help and individuals enhance For only numbers nance. not expansion. because can that the of nancial partnership. organizational have customers hire for or lose small many bankrupt the companies equipment, traders will and investment have shares go all of sums her can pay opportunities opportunities workers to in or trader more including ● sole sum stability Individuals can investors institutions business his to expand With ● off to invest ● The sells opportunity access to However, a or following: and greater banks owning among large sold than out the companies. Investors By companies the up to individual add or operations. There Many have and loans companies, spread traders to invest else. Each Companies assets continuity ● dies to However, continuity. shareholder all can sole include partnerships. liability. (individuals shares). investors There are benet. company for make nothing different risks also to limited a and likely likely e n v i r o n m e n t perceived traders more and as than are portfolios. investors number ● has investment “small” are shares their easier sole more safe companies ● than investor value is business Companies and institutions a a n d of the especially some business. for control a of public their 51 per (other can of ● of shares is full number with loss others future may a not A of fall, share done ● a being no taken sometimes control damage but news over if occurs to over. their the not want sell through no their of control the information the are a company’s negative – customers weak company, business that offer market. of Share company. an the Such business external in the prices a loss has factor: same an industry, disaster. who buys over are fall, of if to accounts products. shares, prices fault owners percentage its Some with business take Companies share O R G A N I Z A T I O N retain required prots because over to is sharing those stock of natural control to on because a or business another or to jeopardized. image occur loss small Further, down service simply may willing do over about limited are damaging the economy, taken or very still new publishing accounts. further from sometimes the are be after-sales wrong has being can a company including sales the B U S I N E S S public. limited their – to companies, have unaccustomed especially competitor shareholders prevent or can in company example, be can negative downturn A weak owners answer public gone public people purchase has anything A former still can obligations, publishing can which value election, a legal warranties company may has rm been to that of the business has case owners dislike want the must Original performance situation product In they privacy. of Many performance the of incorporation, shares, after There a during signicant. publicly. ● if, the shareholders). be the Even cent O F tnemnorivne business. T Y P E S the the the its shares. business. company especially which, as business If For the cannot vulnerable noted to above, itself. F-p cl p Although the term “social enterprise” has a slightly different meaning TOK discussion or of legal standing business that in different has a social countries, purpose. in general Social it refers purpose to a generally form means Is the label “social enterprise” that the organization aims to improve human, social, or environmental appropriate? well-being. Although social enterprises should and typically do operate Can businesses be separated to a professional standard (regarding legal existence, proper accounts, from a prot motive? Can any management structure, and reporting procedures, etc.), the social business be separated from a aim nevertheless takes priority over any other aim such as growth, social purpose? maximizing prot The they social we do making prots, For-prot not want to which social are typical enterprises maximize prots aim if objectives to make doing so a of for- prot. compromises purpose. for-prot models Social or organizations. However, their sales, social have enterprises organization, enterprise seen already often including have the can (sole one take the trader, of form of any partnership, several other of or models the three company). of business following. Cooperatives Cooperatives and run by countries are all can a the form of a partnership “members” have no more but, than whereby unlike 20 the business partnerships partners), (which cooperatives is owned in most may have 29 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 2 1 B u s i n e s s than running tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 more There A ● 20 of are members. the types nancial aims example lending other of in at housing opposed and of and so a thereby thus A ● ensuring increase the or workers a the pay), out ● as a about reinvest producer in certain common owned in of is also States, each the to 30 not has the rules that is not unit of and the the the building, a member, conditions and operated higher employment emerges losing their to when jobs, reduce (rather and building. signicantly drastically business building in housing owned pay members operation, cooperative (or its become in providing fearful if of only on of type to as prices reinvesting in as grape olive than a expensive large the the of take their pay them provides consumer possible, Thus, a priority thereby are too business low, the of a particularly cooperative cooperatively aim is to equipment afford. stage many the would of At that other the times, production producers pool its and consumers the involved become at the a who United certain “member”, cooperative, often at stores. is not or to make services lowering the cooperative (and to Europe cooperative products the a service groceries grocery its not when In consumers offers often a collaborate are efciencies. business. purchase having having piece could scale. cost producers farmers producers achieved of cooperatives cooperatives, an be for-prot or groups Producer themselves, cooperative’s price its or obtain them sells where such Individual than the by out to is cooperative entitles prices cost can common case, However, does workers’ in to harmony managers producer owners stores. cooperative close by part a grocery In a agree can its common addition, who to money. own its At (loans) apartment and In for mean non-lending for A housing building business and an and institutions. housing one over might borrow cooperative, social a to ethical nance landlords. lower. which prots facility carried consumer lower the the production. members, resources which the Sometimes, aims providing able to the nancial owning Workers, the utilization efciencies process are all With the individual A fail. agriculture, press. maximize ● is cooperative stages wine-production their in dividends). A cost to is are of or provide members Often, sack be prots. social provide private control managers, priority. is in members all will entitled themselves, to to for through have over the other not run likelihood business, and as is rent cooperative salary business over the workers wages might reinvested that or cooperative members, typically workers’ by actively institution interest cooperative individual cooperatives of banks “member” are nancial unions, rates than providing housing a precedence otherwise each The to lower cost is credit cooperative surpluses costs at of nancial to having building. a who as activity participates cooperative: take case lower A of which the times, members e n v i r o n m e n t member cooperative money services Each a n d business. many social ● o r g a n i z at i o n thus not prot. Rather, typically costs runs to the updating at as members. risk its of failure products services) difcult aim to or not period make important or having an some a signicant unexpected prot, but nancial expense. maximizing cushion Thus, prot O F to B U S I N E S S weather cooperatives is not their O R G A N I Z A T I O N a generally tnemnorivne or T Y P E S most aim. Micro-nanciers Since of the the has work developed, simple: would to in specied the other who and of for parties, with good the While main never of the ideas and a the the always In to many work help of idea is lent The very to and make the proved been to nance with micro- be of very those take low-income have prot tactics to help to a interest aggressive ethic is traditionally individuals, and has founder industry The who money small use model strong through are access independence. business The principal has had those repayments. not aim have to Yunis, whole low-income amounts do a economies. women. scheduled loan 1980s, nance repayment The Muhammad the example micro-nanciers economic own of and and moneylenders. all in low-income for receive previously towards their in it, use (interest). low, forms to to of winner amounts communities, individuals open small access would steps Prize Bangladesh have expects protable in rural loans are Nobel particularly conditions nancier rates the Bank provide not families on of Grameen the rst economies, been able to micro-nance. Public–private par tnerships (PPP) A PPP is public a a social a specic or a business sector. aim part in such doing reserve. a projects. in between France the ● main a PPP in the nance The to and common is PPP is not service construct a be but make business to the limited can of It for prots. a to could a return The the the also be for the sector expertise. large the with energy on public small company Eurotunnel, and facility alternative private involve Swedish the site to not private multinational the of incentives may business education). expected the tax sector construction or priority and offers help the development business A private healthcare the but a involves sector to take partnerships businesses Skanska channel was tunnel UK. features of a PPP (for-prot social enterprise) include following: Prot is important precedence. need to These generate business. ● the it, between PPP rehabilitation involved The The into partnership. drug big as government the as such provides the a example invested usually Often, (for project nature money created Typically, The sufcient There is activity sustain For-prot cooperation because to both or by is the priority and the not a the to social survival aims social and maximize the take enterprises growth prots business enterprises business need – for-prot but of the to earn business. between social between recognize the vary ensure however, collaboration community. for to not may prots aim, prots but aims being usually community met by and the signify and ordinary a local desire government business government. 31 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 2 1 B u s i n e s s There is greater organizations. tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 ● o r g a n i z at i o n be more stems typically share to or ● The to in any other to be A legal in business There often is working a a are their because or ● help and to which and may be business are the social with as of governance rely lower etc.). generate supportive. any nance other and must decisions, the compared just business which as have often have to traditional sole these: Anyone or can the enterprise being engage in environment. allows personally traditional individuals liable (maximizing and that the or prots) rely social of social that enterprises stakeholders purpose. knowing Employees they complex the help the are often doing the is For-prot direct not social beneciaries government ameliorate government If the more, human, social, addressing, and so many this traditional sole consuming. social In enterprises parties are extended being often involved take with decision-making the time business. may prot investment as to these: time capital capital compared include and case, of healthy working may typically for-prot enterprise for community. including enterprises decisions. on sense other community. insufcient retained, a companies often social provide They transparent, is For-prot and stakeholder enterprises in is identity. employees services. effectiveness for-prot to be not market often rates, and and take of for businesses, society, without common problems make the which 32 time limit Most style work businesses, achieved. stakeholders, social making can a to to partially good which spirit to areas include satisfaction, for-prot decision, for as tends society. to problems of a of for and partnerships, There is for-prot with many for-prot consultative ● other humans, communal positive reduce long for a degree products Decision a are do discounted social and enterprises motivated benets Disadvantages traders, HR, companies status of strong environmental help at to This functions respects, than shareholders together enterprises of some activities highly high something There the enterprises governance are to other making interests. have report to willing stakeholders same of enterprises, properties in (such prots). social convey of the social good those part style which strategies (workers lease care and legal are of than decision protability. structure accountable ● and favourable engage In This maximize marketing, greater for-prot that to social business. prots to others the business enterprises, business transparency on the enterprises, nature operates with of or willing and partnerships, The ● from production, run activities to aid e n v i r o n m e n t transparent. social the For-prot attend Advantages ● from business greater and of in social aggressive willingness business. traders, spirit landlords Consultation greater for-prot competitors stems support wages, the devise from partially on democracy In consultative from a n d for not growth. sufcient margins in and property, working The in prots, plant, capital business the long much and model term. of equipment requirements social There ● with the prot may social be their products less can business. services them to to as Without survive and for have not survive a prot because inexpensive tend to large as have recession B U S I N E S S prots, O R G A N I Z A T I O N for-prot expand. nancial lower businesses enterprises permit to capital tend for-prot and social the struggle insufcient traditional for-prot of may enterprises than that size enterprises O F strength. margins they often possible. deep or As a nancial times For- and try when tnemnorivne increase T Y P E S prots to make result, strength nance is available. Non-prot social enterprises The main (NPOs) Some ● features are as businesses prots at where the from main these aim similar the which A surplus costs. A operating These to aim is social Red to a social business, the is any and Foundation, than the extra is (commercial) a private are also social surpluses to set revenue social = as sector social purpose in that organizations do not aim enterprises – but they do they not – are aim to make that is, different to make any enterprises can is used as businesses, than revenue) than to prots. be A is, they conceptually, distributed advance the generate surplus to social the very owners purpose for up. generated after subtracting an NPO’s follows: the revenues are very total large: Mohammed Gulbenkian organizations, traditional run surplus enterprises Calouste are rather rather total Crescent, the as surplus was calculated Red and These many Social for However, business non-prot examples. the enterprises referred prot. surplus Cross in enterprises Surplus Many based businesses generate) (sometimes of non-prot whatsoever. Though (or all. for-prot prots ● of follows: and many bin costs the United Rashid Foundation other large Al are Way, Maktoum just NPOs, a are few bigger businesses. take many possible forms, and the differences Student workpoint 1.4 between them categories of can be subtle non-prot (and social confusing). enterprises Nevertheless, exist: NGOs and two broad charities. Be a researcher Look Non-governmental organizations (NGOs) NGO was become aim of a a single such as rst common these considered a term way various socially issue, such used as United describe Save Some the Others Network, the a of is to may be or of NGOs with have it social apolitical, others and support these Whales while Nations variety enterprises desirable. Greenpeace. Development to social by a a has enterprises. cause are such as when The is concerned broader political that with the Aga Amnesty International and the National Rie a common element of these is that they websites one local Kahn they news articles any funding do for and Make were they notes about established, and any about the recent them. information and two one Can about you their organization? such are the main similarities Association . and Regardless, the work nd spectrum aims, – international. since What as at NGOs are not organized differences between the two or NGOs? run by any government. 33 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 2 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t Charities tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Charities relief that as are their help focus charities emergency a the such is form those on as may Sky. the of in NGO need. whose aim Charities philanthropy sector the Save and a is to differ desire the can run such be any that disasters Children as or the partisan Charities by charities natural apolitical Others not addition above, be single-event specic Catholic is of for issue: business In for are aid single charities Half specic provide from to help as other those much NGOs who in cannot themselves. Some on a possible USA. provide, or war. Oxfam. Red and As Cross or with and have and example, charities regular Red that the it focus NGOs, Crescent particular Nevertheless, government for Other idea and preferences, is operates that in the the private economy. to the common common features features of of social enterprises mentioned non-prot social enterprises include the The surplus generated from a following: charity’s business activities, such ● Prots are not generated – instead, these businesses generate as this second-hand clothes shop, surpluses and surpluses are used to advance the social purpose of the are used to advance the social business. Sometimes a similar non-prot social enterprises retain surpluses, in purpose of the organization. ● fashion the organization. the goods and Donations revenues cases has welcome There Who is large unclear to others? of such executive of a are skill-set, questions among Finally NGOs it 34 have United ofcers also worth are social of if be To not not example), all when salaries the be the selects charity new of than compensation? charity the the the These source of is skills head CEO necessary necessary? can to and amounts Should as want – charity? requires amount of a the the charity organizations. large of their some provide Who appropriate companies. and and operation executives the need owns management same in of In charities those Who thorny provide on part endowment directors? is rely large individuals. contribute the to of a calibre kinds of discontent effectively. there because paying is of one their taxes. clear distinction charitable Other status NGOs, as between and with all exempt. enterprises discussed its charities that of What the attract from in for-prot paid handled noting exempt and corporate charities, are say especially major, plague who a individuals control. board selected? is Way, for-prot charities: businesses larger for directly of created. so for the requirements cannot virtually from individuals a from services and the used was from Foundation, Nevertheless, on are income, donations and capital charity of proceeds sits the businesses donations charity company? are businesses, Non-prot the the routinely philanthropy, other who stakeholders is and small the these goods managers multinational multinational and the compensation as of and for surpluses forms Gulbenkian Should charity How issue huge, a – ownership decide members? money the which voluntary more and prots, other revenues. provide should board The Calouste – or from ongoing more for important endowment reliable do Typically, funding comes (the an retaining services are government ● to have above. many These advantages are some of compared the to any advantages: of They and of help people governments the needs enterprises specic of or local cannot groups or social enterprises They can causes almost people address causes is in never need. have and/or all that crucially the are Individuals, sufcient either. supported, important and B U S I N E S S to solve Non-prot work of all social Nevertheless, the O R G A N I Z A T I O N organizations, resources communities. needs O F for CULTURE tnemnorivne ● T Y P E S Many NGOs work across national the non-prot valuable. boundaries, providing assistance and aid all over the world. What cultural diculties might they encounter? Do some ● foster a philanthropic spirit in the community. research to nd examples of such People may feel good about helping others, which can foster diculties. socially a constructive community general ● They can all of needs non-prot and distant ● They can creative – solutions Non-prot any of the to almost local – never can turn, to positive live lead and attitudes can to in improve non-prot better or the various decision to to solve actions for about of and local information, government making. are address often “forced” problems are not disadvantages These about organizations, working better enterprises many above. With members tactics The information causes. social have community resources individuals including and discussed sufcient informed Employees ideas the individuals, communities. the and more enterprises businesses have and in above, and/or issues, out new because social place noted organizations, carry try In discussions As enterprises innovate. to general. better people them and can a informed problems, individuals agencies, of social contributing it resources. governments the make in climate. foster allocation and can business views and tied to compared disadvantages to be nd prots. to include the following: ● The lack of control undesirable lobbies for goods. Artic but For coastal intense lobbying example, High communities can North and lead to Alliance seeks to socially in protect Norway the rights 1 of whalers. the United National lobby In States, Rie state hand related it the supports power Association and meaningful of effect, national restrictions guns and deaths are two Gun gun in in the the Both of meat. lobbying America, groups, to the ownership States than In the effectively States including gun United whale United ownership, weapons. higher of non-prot Owners legislatures on assault far of and consumption prevent possession and in gun- other 2 industrial ● Sometimes have a cause. direct illegal ● countries. the passion employees and Greenpeace action, and acting can Funding can generally very economic lead be zeal of that employees, as to pirates loss of irregular. reliant on non-prot ill for by serve example, boarding support for Non-prot donations, social the have times ships, organization social which at whaling the enterprises organization enterprises can be a or its taken which or is business. are problem in recessions. 1 http://www.reuters.com/ar ticle/2008/03/03/us-climate-whaling-idUSEIC37493020080303. Accessed 5 October 2013 2 http://abcnews.go.com/blogs/health/2013/09/19/u-s-has-more-guns-and-gun-deaths-than-any- other-country-study-nds/. Accessed 5 October 2013. 35 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 2 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t ✓ Businesses tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Revision checklist and in the controlled private by sector individuals are or ✓ owned groups Companies owners of – business individuals. and has Businesses in the public sector are owned by governmental Sole trader by single businesses are owned and person. The from individual is liable any debts Registering relatively the a businesses business quick and as a For-prot might sole A partnership managed should be by be extra a made equally different is ✓ is A social social easy. business more kinds and Multiple of of owned one jointly liable. sources than are legally the business, so they are no and social but enterprises still aim to have make a a social prot. mission is enterprises. Most the main Any aim money charities fall of non-prot made into this is called category. Decisions partners partners expertise, debts. and person. all for incur. trader surplus. ✓ themselves a or liable mission, for company managed ✓ a owners a authorities. longer ✓ as multiple When and separate controlled the have shareholders. registered corporation, ✓ corporations usually can may will bring also bring nance. Practice question quality Ecosoluciones as Ecosoluciones is a non-prot research a is to in try Madrid, to electricity Spain. introduce in One of their non-polluting developing the successful sources Alumbre created by Project. wind This of Europe their research provided generators to the of the of and Peru, which previously to government develop other saw this depressed its in the 2008 a Spanish funding for severe nancial government research crisis hit suspended organizations such was as Ecosoluciones. of Ecosoluciones As a direct result, the management electricity remote village had felt it may no longer be able to of maintain Alumbre, Peruvian country. Unfortunately of countries. application The solution objectives part One life. organization areas* located of practical Alumbre’s wind generators. none. [Source: adapted from http://ecoworldly.com/2008/06/17/ In Alumbre, wind generators were installed by wind-power-blows-into-peru-and-brightens-future/, 17 June Ecosoluciones to supply, for the rst the few time, electricity 2008] to a textile operating agreed was a to factory, in the of secondary maintain complete one and sector. repair the transformation in rms in the area Ecosoluciones generators. the also a) Dene the b) Prepare term secondary sector. [2 There a PEST analysis for the textile The factory was able to buy Productivity increased [6 Contrast the objectives jobs were also promised, in partnership Telecom as non-prot Ecosoluciones to those of and the Peruvian organizations. [5 marks] with d) Peru such created. prot-based Ecosoluciones of dramatically. organizations New in marks] new c) machinery. factory production Alumbre. process. marks] government, to Discuss two possible areas of conict between help stakeholders fund the improvements in communication between in Alumbre regional and trade experienced * the to rest of Peru. develop. signicant The This also entire community improvements in Alumbre IB, May 2010 their depressed area: a region or locality where business, employment, and stock-market values have declined severely or are at a very low level of activity 36 the allowed Project. [7 marks] tnemnorivne By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: Explain the denitions and roles of vision statement and mission ➔ statement Dene aims, objectives, strategies and tactics and explain their ➔ relationships Explain why organizations change objectives and innovate in ➔ response to changes in internal and external environments Describe ethical objectives and corporate social ➔ responsibility (CSR) Outline the reasons why organizations set ethical objectives ➔ and the impact of implementing them ➔ Explain the evolving role and nature of CSR ➔ Prepare a SWOT analysis of a given organization ➔ Examine the Anso matrix for dierent growth strategies of a given organization v Successful of businesses purpose this that identity, purpose, will both of types focused Mission and however, looking of a other, way with mission or one statement to vision speaks business. the have day A accomplishing on businesses different and have to these of help and mission others a shared with. values, these, statements purposes. to the vision are The To values create maintain and both. business vision When reach long-term to is achieve The two statement the sometimes vision statement vision. statement, identity, identify produce can objectives the clear its and or a sense reinforce focus on the statements. properly loftiest Some done, aims and day. mission the a stakeholders communicate many businesses stay all vision aims and more the mission, an a aspirations in the aim of step complement rst. as have, forward intermediate should serves They more highest produced statement is grounded statements being confused. statement Less specic guiding each than a principle principles. 37 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1.3 Organi zational objecti ves 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t Vision tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Table 1.3.1. Comparison of vision and mission statements Mission Concept What do we want? Why are we doing what we are doing? Purpose A vision statement points to the future. It is A mission statement, based upon where the business is what the business would like to see itself as. now, communicates what needs to be done in order to achieve the vision. Audiences To internal stakeholders, the vision To internal stakeholders, the mission statement provides statement inspires and motivates a means for accountability by dening key performance employees. indicators. For external stakeholders, the vision statement For external stakeholders, the mission statement measures binds them to the business by giving a sense how successful the business is at achieving its vision. of shared beliefs. Change As an expression of the business core A mission statement may change: in a world of values, the vision should never change. dynamically changing external environments, a mission statement may need to be modied to meet new circumstances. a, bjc, , cc Businesses may also distinguish between aims and objectives and TOK discussion between and all strategies these and terms, tactics. including All of vision these and concepts mission, are are interdependent linked in some “Futurists” or “futurologists” way or another. Figure 1.3.1 is an attempt to show their relationship are regularly wrong. In light with each other. of the unpredictability of the future, to what degree is planning for the future vision good use or a misuse of a business’s resources? strategies mission tactics strategies objectives aims Figure 1.3.1. The vision and mission statements – relationship between aims, objectives, strategies, and tactics The the aims year aim 38 of future. a through might business An be are example the of its production more long-term an focused aim of on goals might tasty, the be: – what “We high-quality delivery of it want the wants to meat be to achieve protable products”. service: “We aim in every Another to deliver staff”. the The sum high-quality vision of these plant statement aims, at is and a garden summary other times products of with these through aims modied a helpful (sometimes O B J E C T I V E S sales literally tnemnorivne consistently O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L wording). T wo examples of vision statements of major corporations you probably know (and the products of which you might use) are from Microsoft and T oyota USA. Examine their Microsoft: ● vision “A statements: personal computer in every home running Microsoft software”. Toyota ● USA: “To be the most successful and respected car company Key term in America”. Vision statement In both are cases, high sense of and in In or in at are lofty being will aims, the They purpose. this USA they to how statements term. not Toyota contrast mission long are America), clarify vision condence companies home the not the give summarizes will these brief and inspirational. Further, place yet most up objectives business are Both (Microsoft they the achieve aims sense to and convey that, car their if its a a philosophy, vision or set of the in principles which steers the every company direction and behaviour of an organization aspiration. short-term reach that software respected reached medium- its the running and have aspirations statements convey successful until are they express goals vision. that A objectives. Student workpoint 1.5 Be reective You might might What Does for your your grade a What 7 in IB statement mission mission does in Business Management. What be? statement statement? mean for be? If so, your what does teachers? If it mean not, try one! the middle a vision have have specic objectives medium- Tactical for personal pupil? should the guide ● school Strategic are ● your a design Objectives ● as aiming personal might you and be to company Operational in to the are achieve (and can its tactical referred direction medium- the are sometimes They objectives right the objectives managers reach sometimes long-term objectives managers – characteristics. to strategic the to set to as by come global senior achieve short-term in three types: objectives managers the – to aims. objectives set by objectives. day-to-day workers also objectives themselves) so that set the by oor company objectives. Table 1.3.2. Vision and the three types of objective Vision (summary of aims) Long-term and Strategic objectives highest aspiration Long-term goals Tactical objectives Medium or Operational objectives shor t-term goals Day-to-day goals 39 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 3 1 B u s i n e s s use the term a n d hierarchy of e n v i r o n m e n t objectives to describe the Student workpoint relationship between all of these goals. few in number At the top of the hierarchy are 1.6 tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Businesses o r g a n i z at i o n the aims, the chief which are executive ofcer (CEO). and The set by aims the are entrepreneur (and should be) or rather Be reective general. How the business achieves these aims is through the next level Here of managers – the senior managers (directors or executives). are the statements strategic objectives will be greater in number and concrete. vision These Ideally, of two large these organizations: objectives will objectives, to assess the are set, the did be SMART entrepreneur performance objectives or also the not met, the directors the objectives? the CEO may If the decide of or below CEO the has must executives set for or more details). some executives CEO directors to (see or ask: not fair and their Were the perform executives ambitious With and SMART measurable divisions. objectives properly vastly exceed objectives the in If way SMART properly meeting the without year. earth’s achieve those their that strategic are tactical. objectives Tactical through objectives the next tend to tier be than managers At the will – strategic the lowest level, determine objectives will objectives middle operational specic be managers and are (heads usually of objectives objectives that, in set by the department will be sum, set: or where to nd that level buy the What do reveal tactical and they and the of objectives shown in Table build can discover might want about statements the attitudes of organization? met. hierarchy to people online. carefully Consider to of managers the is customer in supervisors). oor ensure vision of greater next Our most company; place to number world a anything objectives, just centric come Businesses A poverty Amazon: be objectives, following Oxfam: at aims the Look the words that 1.3.3. each statement affect do they uses have – what on you? Table 1.3.3. The hierarchy of objectives Aim Strategic objective To be the most successful To have the highest market To hire and retain enough To have the average amount car dealership in the city share of car dealerships in salespeople so that the of time that a customer the city dealership has sucient waits to be greeted by a salespeople to serve salesperson to be less than customers at all times two minutes In the example dealership determines market that to means that share have the of car highest more realizing greet go more by a An during vision allows is even if in share sales their means city. of a The by particular head having sales time customers. making group a sale that greeted salespeople will the highest realize frame Then the the customer offered not car sales increases no and of managers specied serve a being that is The a that city. success to as aim the within chance agree the in the staff without it sets measure market minutes will service nish their break. be “To not between translated be everyone are to customer, motivating, almost abstractness as way CEO successful dealership that difference can such America” – their important and the two salesperson concrete A than the most qualied sooner they 1.3.3 the best any the having Table be salespeople, coffee 40 in should Tactical objective the most but to it is feel qualities aims into and successful also and to it, employees is specic that and respected (purposely) connected that objectives something vague. but can objectives car This company vagueness vagueness act on in are measurable. and unison. in Operational objective specic are effective objectives. objectives are as The when best they take business that vision objectives are and transform SMART. it O B J E C T I V E S into SMART Specic tnemnorivne Businesses O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L follows: Measurable Specic – Is the objective clear and well dened? Objectives should Achievable relate to the nature of the business and be unambiguous. Rather Relevant than set an objective objective would “increase the Measurable been of also – Achievable objectives are have they goals also support Is that are school, for or, not the Telling car a A staff business to work to long is by the a of to it reach the the it has specic were but it (number When Objectives its that employees giving up because objective. distractions of be realistic)? or Time-specic share). motivational. business or share”. whether cases market (is smart membership” see above employees to of IB that, (when business the to a by plan aims of Achievable employees are going to lower time staff 5 that achieve the by specic or to is a that the per not they cent set? sales strategic managers need is If of are to relevant. objectives cars For sold unless target do a per the is to be objective in order strategy to a relevant. meaningful. number At objectives meaningless This the responsibility. been new can of employees particularly 7 are the cent business. of purpose expenses, frame the for staff not they per senior and/or is Businesses main area supplies which the require owners by use? the custodial deadline, sales date any objectives scores sufcient increase will the high or of from employees’ a tell is set cleaning the the actually the staff frame told and be aspects of Has strategy term approved – must towards to member time dealership sales and the its a market objective achieved of with the size be distractions achieve amount salesperson of can commonly, custodial the have a to Time-specic not are more telling the reduce objective that relevant students each sold, other “increase “increase measured cannot dissonance to or grow”, objectives). objectives company they how be “should should reach effect, that wonder – as they reasonable fear sold” objective opposite or wants only units achievable, the it objective Not of the business units measurable, Can these Relevant the the that of not? reduce managers set – the think or number are beyond can Can be members, clarify number achieved should that make will the be met. medium decisions STRATEGY Whatever the business, devising CEO. a strategy means asking ‘who, when, what, where, why?’ Strategies are not unplanned or spur of the moment; they involve What are the implications of careful analysis of: missing one of these questions? ● where ● development wants the to ● careful ● a be of a is plan periodic has (strategy) of how to get where the business (aims) consideration determine time, business evaluation whether of how to process the plan implement (in is well-run working the strategy organizations) or, after a to specic period of worked. 41 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 3 1 B u s i n e s s business towards tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 A to the the managers. long-term business objective, area. customer on a or might to the be observing (but otherwise to it t change. They rather be but offering the be work the short are less on path term approved focus poor food by and the closely how more not be a tactical that quality customers’ a the a highest customers’ might will decisions to are to tied achieve strategy. obtain with objective themselves tactic the but strategy of tactical This to rm determining be a which make easier the might e n v i r o n m e n t achieve business, sound to a n d business. are of within for quality not Tactics example, count to the the health have tactic tactic food does of customers One better can plan of managers targets for restaurant a aims middle measurable A is strategies require senior to tactic the reaching will o r g a n i z at i o n reactions better as form form mix of type in might they of if A perceived its satisfaction direct marketing is of plan. eat by a the market be the customer the strategic direct food. A feedback feedback restaurant). th f ch bjc Businesses changing often need strategic tactical objectives change operational because the ● of ● and, the change day in to either objectives. More day, objectives. changes internal within to objectives. environment, oor these it of the this involves managers Regardless of Sometimes commonly, and level, requires changing supervisors objectives change environments: which refers to changes in the conditions business the external environment, the business that which nonetheless has refers a to anything bearing on its outside operation or performance. Changes in the Leadership and to a Apple. – the business. down an changes as when organization In other modify of all from can when, brought their resources” related to lead in the to 1996, into a a following: change Steve company predecessor, of covers HR Industrial forms – business Kraft the aspect business – can action, organized a vast change which labour, of its organizations which array and can of can refers Cadbury, new organization internal to often are sold product in strategic in in to a in Jobs will can aims returned have require elements alter of a objectives actions taken precipitate merger ripple area tactical the can or all by change an acquisition, effect many cause given marketplace. the a rethink may one or A have However, changes to can pressures business. changes the change. over functions, products performance the some of including Product took causing instances, one another, 42 leaders often is include organization. Organization such example might objectives. “human other leadership style to hierarchy. or of new leadership term environment famous Conditions the unions A Sometimes signicant in change objectives. different HR – internal of through its an objectives. organization to interconnectedness require changes in objectives. Sometimes, marketplace may the require changes in for the product example, sports drink, of product, the sports and drink, objectives changes Finance to All of become and 2009, had their FIFA modied to how other recession sets and limited by more of everyday any of Social change to – or the this result, the 1980s, itself branded as a identity energy-providing strategic and tactical number could When when of their Play” on of nance organizations of Fair spend the sources decreases, “Financial to product a because of have business. rule, players, In which and teams is the are a in force of an environment can products can also more force a if a or as had in not methods that Whether is, by occur for because operations era of for be suit the rapid business than to did can as few are how that struggles develops other change to can attending ago from of of and, as course women. which ways. A new “softer” Blackberry compete force changes methods businesses. for Social objectives. uncompetitive quickly innovation for Aroma). change, number or issues follows: decades number obsolete people frame its objectives, any business demographic Coffee women a a often preference technological in as may objectives. and to reappraise their (think competitor cheaply to greater rendered one such or its business are increased More business to factors culture, of business Usually, Often, Starbucks many to the changing framework an they Technological techniques – environment, Steeple by than product “hot” they operations then by them. education. being a better environment. business innovation smartphones). in changes them to (such modifying offers world constantly, product factory. altered, society the degrees is a “STEEPLE” supplied practices, today or changes external technological production producing – the response use business residential are external change may developing reason, environment. obtaining the in changes these by service pre-empt the those because innovating relocating factors over cultural the lending objectives. even in After raised activity. are Sometimes as nance. banks adjustments also core everyday in change business from new or but their such more like many businesses products to change nance students or as and change changes to can example, make most external Technological in the greater emphasis to internal universities offerings with the the to occur coffees, example went even In reoriented an nanced. had control refers such university can be nance teams for changes and (social) changes the no have expensive a an capital reasons, also or teachers related to respond can objectives One line. in to Lucozade’s to especially of change operations. above to limited and change beverage of must circumstances delivering other the have Changes has or 2008, new or their innovation well led change, amount money ideally, offering necessitate If activity businesses – producing innovating of in access Operations for aspects introduced much this product Lucozade objectives). strategies began standards just With (which nance football entire illness-curing different the an pressures respond. Many more tripled. business fewer market an operational – modify of change circumstances to sometimes sales from many had in or because O B J E C T I V E S tnemnorivne either O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L for Technological reasons. All 43 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 3 1 B u s i n e s s in tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 businesses it need because previously time those Economic new global company a sells on – a Paul many business were if the concerned certainly diversity changes to to in in their have and in a harder using companies actions ways child could often the force demand years ago, to capital of changing the can changing is in a strategic economic cost If income an as have the investment. fall presence such change raising which may as them increase, for such economy, because can sales in of a elastic economic economic conditions can change. quickly, in or its values of their harm. In a not host attentiveness society’s values of a have to of Fifty to years business ago, was the business not ethics harassment, changes in society even few practices– of. Today, genuinely will environment, – a or relatively stakeholders ways sexual of unheard were external harm to values encourage sustainable other led the society capitalism” practices, business a about “natural executives slowly, in practices. concerned sustainable hiring, sometimes ethical change owners that would when several and preventing reasons, concept expect began 4.x), Nike economies conditions, changes loans the and communication discovered. example, on and deeply about minimize For environment allow ago, market that Unit Changes Hawken’s even in being businesses product their example, decades the rates sometimes businesses to For change. force a this business Ethical can objectives. interest downturn. force on of e n v i r o n m e n t low-income simply crisis businesses more in or for in without nancial for aware Today, changes a n d technologies several inuence tactical (see to tactics – conditions capital more shoes competitors, profound and be unknown. compared follow the to information manufacturing labour of o r g a n i z at i o n in or least lending, product many almost at safety– businesses’ objectives. Political change and often particular the risk – its change will can determines results a that scandal, an a “country country or at the the political of political drastic occur centre-right, though, a that the If legislature change or a a can occur an in a outcome country of a decide accident, that to in could and turn a at risk, election from take put Political change. in determine political changes can to possibility investing to country there. business this before unexpectedly can forces for attempts business environment Legislatures even change of the of often plan assessment” assessment political home. very businesses risk risk operations business election. crime, system Multinational A investment however, to have country. likelihood the to approach. centre-left Sometimes, not from action affects the because the of business environment. Legal – to other, the when environment can be 1980s the country occurring 44 one, in to one often changed the by responsibility or tired young state to statute, States, of legislation another, Regulation, by United grew most occur. merely the for coalition the people for legislatures to taxes, and of a the or the host have many fatal excessive raised and from in businesses example, number due changes changes one of to other traumatic factors respond. individuals alcohol minimum party legal In across injuries consumption. drinking age One in the States from targeted customers business strategies. Ecological revolution example affect – with had the businesses Canada, change in ways in sources or oil of such taverns, types huge for and to and as the from can spills, are sources demand of force focus a off can on the nonetheless for to their highly especially declining coast business notorious energy, and for factors sheries sometimes that their “green” businesses, Ecological mining, clubs modify now-dominant such oil bars, had many cars. the of new rising as on hybrid than range awareness effect companies, as search anticipation energy, Many depletion, such they of other some Large disasters energy, signicant through as years. 18–20-year-old environmental a Ecological or innovative 21 the emergence strategies. ecological to in growing have sustainability. of 18 O B J E C T I V E S tnemnorivne United O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L clean traditional oil. Why hcl bjc Ever more ethical codes of social or the commonly objectives. behaviour business might objective might are Businesses and is set up likely a certainly at the are the its goals a not prot. employees to favouritism. customers range themselves to to hurt For be on established provide treated or a without ethical respect activities some society example, Another with of for based business least, making whole including customer and positive true: establishing allow even treat a themselves shop of are these and and honesty. today many them. Customers to to or, all or cover respect, Creating expect as met, process always can setting businesses. trust to such benet the reasons, Building are be may commercial business when harassment, objectives businesses ● in aim discrimination, ● that, environmental environment Ethical today, Objectives at ethical loyalty are more ethical image – repeat likely to objectives – both businesses customers objectives for some very good these: and existing with will customers return good avoid to a ethical and are action potential reputations. businesses vital to business with most they foster this. customers The opposite reputations for This poster from the clothing company Matalan clearly states the business’s untrustworthiness. ethical policy ● Developing have a be and Reducing staff to the risk money, or behaviour. redress rm’s from of not unethical process enjoy Businesses many returning customers who environment potential working with – businesses for strong employees the business ethical and that have objectives serve to improve motivation. company legal work advantage. attractive morale a positive well-motivated competitive can ● a by the the be only bad redress from being unethical government, Even expensive – dissatised word-of-mouth Sometimes themselves. can legal if and a by other business cause unethical can customers reports generated behaviour businesses “wins” signicant cost not in can or by court, damage to by lead to the the the reputation. 45 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 3 1 B u s i n e s s Satisfying customers’ behaviour tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 ● o r g a n i z at i o n decisions – with and consumers behaviour and patronizing are aware often certain of e n v i r o n m e n t ever-higher improved actions are a n d ICT more what the visible is “punish” expectations and than ever considered unethical businesses. Few for worldwide before. ethical and behaviours businesses can ethical web, by business Today, unethical not disregard public opinion. ● Increasing are prots growing. Banks manufacturers use “fair from – will trade” opportunities will not coffee. businesses that often use not for businesses lend to “sweatshop” Many behave people dubious workers, today ethically, to seek which ethically businesses, and out can behave coffee and lead clothes houses purchase to higher prots. th pc f pl hcl bjc When a business business implements environment will ethical be objectives, affected. The many effects areas may be of on the the following: ● The business experience short term certain ● policy have ● The a objectives – the if the long to rise, and run ethical the resist competitors may have business objectives, employees, may the business to respond – only in in may the accustomed to change to respond brand community generally local to maintain their recognizing are and – other to protect likely ethical ethical to their trust objectives businesses, includes suppliers orders. the business more and loyalty – businesses an community, Government increasingly see implementing from order customers strong employment ● likely buying local with in implementing practices, of Customers develop although position Suppliers may – – from are and Competitors the ● costs norms market ● itself benets that improvement which can have in and their benet follow ethical relationship them in terms of goodwill. feeling local, pressure regional, businesses government–business with and from voters national ethical environment and levels objectives, fostering of other stakeholders, government overall ethical creating are a objectives. th c bw hcl bjc cp cl pbly Ethical based are objectives on closely concept have a would 46 are established related that a to impact assess of goals has on its that a behaviour. corporate business positive want to specic codes an social business Ethical responsibility obligation society. actions. As As a may part to of result (CSR). operate its of set objectives CSR such in a itself differ, CSR way policy, an for a is that but the will business assessment, business example, day-care a may wish business centre) to implement might for its open a a particular crèche facility ethical (an objective. early O B J E C T I V E S For childhood tnemnorivne the O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L employees. th pc f cp cl pbly CSR is broader committed in all as a whole. the likely with valued the of position this and can highest for and been its objectives. good not only a company obeys and By business is citizen”: benets laws society but reduces business model . the that customers CSR, A “ corporate manner CSR business increasingly be with as for more is its more building more responsible the Although CSR, signicant since and businesses, models difcult through for big role led – and also impact than strong likely see to links be In an the – a integration do not in of of companies reach movement changes and setting international opinions multinational 1980 dramatic citizens different greater of themselves leading businesses around to of the actions many as behaviour. because globalization possible. of a a with recognizing everyone aspirations practices as in to honestly themselves but be and environment, economies still has By ethical act society. might values, world’s and the the than to committed sustainable businesses, to ethical CSR a and standard this business have specic intending responsibly responsibly part context the acting A society want less is environment. to Many and CSR matters interacts on to the their towards attitudes businesses. sWot ly SMART a objectives business set these tool – are the objectives. criticism, in planning purposes. SWOT helps general analysis is managers opportunities, combined in a part a coherent analysis Although many meant to of SWOT use – of this businesses tool rely on be the rst the perceived threats matrix as facing shown in stage the Table plan. developed brainstorm and to strategic was has not SWOT in the In to been planning These 1960s, business without analyses strengths, business. the help for process. It weaknesses, elements are 1.3.4. Table 1.3.4. The SWOT matrix Positive factors Negative factors Internal to the business Strengths Weaknesses Ex ternal to the business Oppor tunities Threats The the SWOT more SWOT poor, Like matrix reliable factors. sloppy, any is The or based the data, on opposite uninformed business tool, it is perceptions. the is stronger also true. fashion, useful it only The will If a can be wider the SWOT actually when the sources analysis analysis mislead thoughtfully of is a and the done in a business. and properly applied. 47 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 3 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t Student workpoint Table tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 a sWot ly f 1.3.5 January shows an example of a SWOT matrix for Apple Inc. (as of 1.7 2013). Be a thinker Table 1.3.5. SWOT matrix for Apple Inc. Choose Strengths ● Well recognized among Weaknesses ● Patent infringement lawsuit may aect a business – such well-known in as Complete ■ January 2010 ■ Nokia 2012 Samsung dispute Four th largest player in the global mobile phone market analysis Think the ● 18.5% market share of ● ■ 2010, antennae problems in iPhone 4 Strong brand image ● Product defects harm Apple’s reputation and add signicant warranty and other competitors expenses Very protable – $100 billion ■ cash reserves 2012 embarrassing discard of Google maps and the failure of Apple’s own ● Focused research and maps for the iPhone 5. development creating ● Poor design and limited innovation in the stylish products latest products ● Provides integrated ● Death of the inspirational leader Steve operating systems, Jobs in 2012 hardware, application software and service to its ● Loss of share value (25% in three months Sep–Dec 2012) customers ● Proprietary systems that do not allow individuality ● Price – other products are more aordable and of similar quality ● Oppor tunities ● ● Strong growth in Foxcom – has been a PR disaster for Apple Threats ● Rising popularity of Google Android may smar tphone aect its market share Strong growth in tablet ■ markets 350,000 Android smar tphones are activated daily; 150,000 iPhones are activated daily ● Mobile adver tising market ■ More rms like HTC and Motorola are is forecast to reach using Android approximately $25 billion by 2015 ● Intense competition may aect revenues and protability ● ● Increased scope in the educational market ● Increasing popularity of Kindle Fire Streaming and television ● The business sector is not dominated by markets have great potential Apple – the eld is more open Source: Adapted from Datamonitor ’s Apple Inc. Company Prole SWOT Analysis http://paigebalash.wordpress.com/2012/02/28/where-is-apple-going-now-swot- analysis-of-apple-inc-2/ 48 carefully business. about factors all which Product recalls may harm Apple’s four ● food. SWOT that different could provides an edge over a for affect each reputation global smar tphone market ● sector or nancial condition and operating results most consumers ● another tourism sections. of the that strengths of the purpose and developing weaknesses can be of a weaknesses the of strategy the analysed SWOT of by business. and so a a analysis business identifying Once strategy these can is not strategy the are be to brainstorm itself; it different known, is the the rst strengths the O B J E C T I V E S SWOT part tnemnorivne Note O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L and matrix formulated. sWot ly k p Use of from the each Table SWOT matrix quadrant and can be then strengthened adopting a by “pairing” relevant key strategy, as factors shown in 1.3.6. Table 1.3.6. Pairing key factors to determine the relevant strategy Oppor tunities Threats Strengths Weaknesses S–O W–O Growth strategies Re-orientation strategies S–T W–T Defusing strategies Defensive strategies Source: Adapted from: http://www.quickmba.com/strategy/swot/ Growth a strategies business positive should issues with short-term pursue in any Defensive business help the other When to Re-orientation addressing available term. its in Their Defusing focusing the can a act business simply neutral the considered its re-orientating which it the is the strengths produces matrix. condent the The that of most business it has no big when and a business exist quickly. strategies, in is at Defensive but its most combination, they may the strategies be are necessary to survive. can are that re-orientate of a to threats medium- to – Table a for on strategy. then positive rst and address in the strategies long its market assume opportunities core For it on direction. market focus 1.3.5) are focuses opportunities threats Defusing new a the will new eliminate through (Table see in business for strategies business. look a them business itself to when use the short-term matrix strategies to designed need the adopted order Re-orientation are not SWOT in assumes strengths does combining from weakness short-term market. defuse and adopted and strategies then by when defensively strategies on are threats adoption weaknesses, available strategies weaknesses the achieved opportunities, area. “negative” business best strategy growth needs most are market strategies vulnerable. the the strengths. instance, may have if by that but This Apple focused is had on 1.3.7. 49 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 3 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t Strengths tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Table 1.3.7 . Apple SWOT analysis – re-orientating strategies Weaknesses Product defects harm Apple’s reputation and add ● signicant warranty and other expenses 2012 embarrassing discard of Google maps and ■ the failure of Apple’s own maps for the iPhone 5. Poor design and limited innovation in the latest ● products Death of the inspirational leader Steve Jobs in 2012 ● Threats Oppor tunities Mobile adver tising market is forecast to reach ● approximately $25 billion by 2015 ● Increased scope in the educational market ● Streaming and television markets have great potential Apple may business products rescue also conclude lives (in its signal moved digital the a move as needs – to signal To do and innovative from just the Jobs. streaming an away from it Steve growing markets away that after reputation smartphone it on as the the home to so, it the market must television producer. intensely company computer a in market the and the new markets) Such to move competitive did that create tablet past would and when into music. th a x Another is the 1957. Many growth The business Ansoff to help which businesses use businesses was the Ansoff matrix looks and markets at the considers and growth both products (see existing Figure gnitsixE Existing New Market Product penetration development Market Diversication a r k e weN t development Figure 1.3.2. The Anso matrix 50 by and Igor matrix potential the Product M plan designed to set objectives Ansoff help in plan their strategies. product, new tool matrix, in terms markets 1.3.2). of the and market products, and and There are four possible growth strategies, explored O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L O B J E C T I V E S below. TOK discussion penetration market share, Market penetration for increasing market. in order to lure to or same would fall into to the growth ● the strength ● the power Market and or for development business may a was had underestimated unsuccessful from Key to factors effective ● having local ● having an market development market. different existing Australian Product to on ● effective ● having a ● having rst When business ● lack ● the of risk add value? To what degree, if more Man”, any, do they obscure rather than clarify? are: market in new the For in new as public Starbucks Wal-Mart Wal-Mart to development Market the example, Australia. Germany. German market for market. penetration, stores into looking existing markets. coffee of by the market expanded of on market development the existing requires different are: ground channel. development it may be so-called the other this a of products 2, was iPad 3, iPad case ght is when off for the wholly are product” the to and products “new “Scoot” new genuinely iPad times, airline a “new” iPad, example, is risk new upgrades mini a and of all variation Singapore competition the on an Airlines from the of product research and riskiest are penetration, to the development familiarity development growth introducing two untestedness market with original much products. Key are: system advantage. the – than customers research mover is riskier loyal strong combines successfully. Do these tools operas, tell businesses operated airlines. the diversifying the Anso matrix existed, loyalty that “Iron such as SWOT analysis and the general soap sequels or in Long before business tools penetration. the budget market Diversication it loyalty as At For how reduce the distribution is development depending factors their Television with in brand promotion “Shrek” success than Successful such budget the opened however, product. of segments Sometimes variations. introduced it knowledge products market. competitors promoting on same opportunities research existing existing the but its competitors. when effective Often, of the Product product. and the increasing market strategy market reduce ● on blockbusters expands the superstores. approaches by by loyalty understand when also (German) limited Story”, in option competition. “Toy the market riskier not unsuccessful products safest heavily chance of ability new is be the as customer development markets was the potential of the grows category. increase ● business customers from such a existing relies Hollywood story, this its may repeat away even the factors of share encourage customers when considered penetration less Key more is market Market telenovelas, or selling occurs tnemnorivne Market elements and of a of new a product business into a can new pursue. market – a risk: experience any strategy new in the new market product. 51 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 3 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 When Apple moved digital music market diversied. Many example, British a lawnmowers. garden failed of the Key Its patios at business to ● effective ● due and from then attempts at cement rationale would attempt factors away want computing handphone diversication, producer was a e n v i r o n m e n t that ‘Blue was a using to cut factor entered it however, Circle’ people lawnmower and market, have decided their the the successfully failed. to cement grass. Blue contributing to For produce to build Circle’s the takeover 2001. reduce market diligence home the diversication in a n d the risk diversication are: research testing to ■ the attractiveness ■ the cost of entering ● recognition of the ● possible tie-ups of determine: of the the existing with other market market business businesses with the necessary experience. Apple’s iPod is an example of r chckl successful diversication ✓ A in ✓ A vision the statement future. mission might ✓ Aims ✓ Objectives meet its A ✓ to ✓ Ethical ✓ have an impact ✓ A on SWOT inside The new be a hopes to be what time the business is doing now. It passes. goals. and is are codes social an should goals be which SMART allow (specic, a business to measurable, time-specic). over-arching plan of objectives which will the actions and objectives which allow a business are of goals that a business sets for itself based on behaviour. responsibility to operate (CSR) in a is way the concept that will that have a all businesses positive society. analysis is a strengths, Ansoff matrix penetration, It used in is business planning. opportunities and It involves threats, both externally. used products allows market diversication. tool weaknesses, and existing opportunities. 52 business strategy. business and as the met. obligation analysing ✓ to objectives Corporate describes what constant. short-medium-term tactics established remain Objectives strategy implement encapsulate modies relevant aims Business be are aims. business enable to long-term achievable, ✓ should statement need are It should a to plan and business new business development, and to growth. existing identify product It considers markets areas of to identify market development and O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L O B J E C T I V E S Practice question Traditional provide has online holidays) To research seasonal a as forecasting correlation and levels of many is to and identify cyclical products becoming between online trends, are sold popular. sales of Google™ to variation forecast is through Google™’s products searches (such for and to increasingly e- commerce. chief as economist cars and information about products. make using about particularly found those future secondary data outdated, Today the tnemnorivne Predicting market predictions, social media* to consumers’ moods. They measure of consumer market collect use online researchers messages web-based emotions and data are in to increasingly order build preferences and to a understand “real then time” use the results ® for predicting consumers’ behaviour. Some companies such as Coca Cola , ® Starbucks and Dr of Bollen Twitter A Indiana users’ after of an unclear Users exists Twitter increase why Investors of software order to media media such forecast Technologically meanings anxiety and expressions social United changes trends and in media States, coincide national changes levels, for share in online found with prices events. (expressed prices. tend research. that: national mood share market to Three fall in days (although it is happens). to share intentions. using mood between social social use University, messages) in this use purchasing already collective correlation millions Disney as guide their information They are “Wise decisions. online unconcerned Window” to about by follow feelings market them and researchers constantly in demand. advanced cultural remains software references. a challenge. Internet researcher can recognize However, sarcasm, interpreting double slang ® Mr a Watts, an forecasting known. other The technique use sources methods of based of must social on the add media information at analysis only limited. of , something will are Yahoo! Twitter said add He that new to value to warned messages, to be what useful, is already forecasting that blog if sophisticated postings or ® Facebook pages have limitations. [Source: adapted from “Can Twitter predict the future?” The Economist Technology Quar terly, 4 June 2011 and John Plunkett, Media Guardian, 25 July 2011] * social media: refers to various forms of relatively new electronic technologies that allow individuals, groups and organizations to communicate with one another. The communication is “vir tual” (across the world wide web and through electronic transmission) and is typically interactive. One frequent feature is the ability of a par ticipant to pass on a communication it has received to other persons, groups, or organizations. 53 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 3 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t Age tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Twitter Demographics (Infographic) Caucasian 35–49 Caucasian 50+ (38.54%) (25.4%) (17%) African American African American yticinhtE Caucasian 18–34 African American 18–34 (3.3%) Asian 18–34 (2.4%) 35–49 (2.2%) 50+ (1.5%) Asian 35–49 (1.6%) Asian 50+ (1.1%) Hispanic 35–49 Hispanic 50+ (1.6%) (1.1%) Hispanic 18–34 (2.4%) a) Describe one organization b) (i) Explain (ii) Examine identify d) in order the the to IB, 54 Nov. 2013 benet one disadvantage to an of sales [4 forecasting seasonal and for cyclical an usefulness trends use of of and “social traditional for variations secondary media to collect moods” research online for [4 marks] [4 marks] [6 marks] to to forecasting. consumers’ marks] organization. trends. understand predictions. and e-commerce. between sales market Evaluate using one Distinguish predict c) advantage of message making market [9 marks] tnemnorivne By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ Outline the interests of internal stakeholders ➔ Outline the interests of external stakeholders ➔ Discuss possible areas of mutual benet and conict between stakeholders’ interests Stakeholders direct affect a interest them stake or nancial and at in any a interest (they They in are the or it is the called business. less groups because are shareholders, times operates. individual business directly. other business the are individuals actions Sometimes such all of stakeholders lenders, direct, Nevertheless, of as the the stake or is have a will they have directly employees) community stakeholders have business because suppliers, the who an in which interest a in business. il xl khl In ● general, Internal the ● ● ● grey areas employees, As democratic and citizens have Consultants the they in have Small a an in some of stakeholder: individuals or groups individuals a as or are ability to are of in are way on that groups work within that are outside such area. large inuence where stakeholders; the as business residents is of stakeholders. (internal external nancial brought However, publicly in stakeholders) stakeholders, planners, largely once a hired, are as are voting voting external because in of some the company, someone publicly business companies, stakeholders, traded However, large traded internal publicly (GE). of stakeholders: government. as people external their fashion position. large shares, are and community internal the considered a the employees business, internal in internal external some They Electric 100 they particular fraction live claim shareholders General such the types are are societies, to shareholders, tiny they thus business. expertise no two between business community, citizens or a exist located. a are stakeholders of In about stakeholders Employees to ● talk business. practice, the ● usually business. External the In we traded and in who for if all they example owns company most like even a small has respects is own Apple stake, virtually external to business. 55 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1.4 Stakeholders 1 B u s i n e s s addition, in other instances a n d e n v i r o n m e n t individuals have multiple stakeholder Key terms interests: tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 In o r g a n i z at i o n employees management team, who have own shares multiple and managers, stakeholder who are part of the interests. Stakeholder an individual or group who has The interests of internal stakeholders an interest, often nancial, in Shareholders ● focus on returns on their investments. the activities and success of The ● CEO business or managing strategy and director delivering focuses prots on and coordinating returns that an organization the satisfy the Shareholder shareholders. an individual who owns a Senior ● managers focus on the strategic objectives for their share or shares in a company functional areas. Competitor Middle ● managers functional focus on the tactical objectives for their another business or areas. organization oering very Foremen ● and supervisors focus on organizing tactical objectives similar goods or services and formulating Employees ● working operational and their objectives. unions focus on protecting their rights and conditions. The interests of external stakeholders Government ● in the ● Suppliers ● Customers their in business focus on and the in ● Financiers ● Pressure ● all levels) focuses on how the business operates environment. maintaining consumers a stable focus on relationship. the best product that meets needs. People ● (at business local the local focus on groups area of The media community focus on the impact of the area. returns focus on on their how the investments. business has impact on their concern. focuses on the impact of the business in terms of news stories. Note a that competitors business actions directly wants in at the may the have an are stake with the to considered indirect marketplace, business not the impact on to itself. In stakeholders. competitors competition business be does fact, not the Although through have its anything competitor usually fail. Possible areas of mutual benet and conict between stakeholders’ interests Groups have of people differences stakeholders Consider object on 56 to the the with of have a investment. At common “stake” example idea, a opinion. as it the of a This in pay could other interest, situation the business, rise for decrease end such of as makes their the and, spectrum business, may although focuses employees. prots a sense: are different. Shareholders therefore, are the also all may their return employees higher In between mixed these CEO paying meeting worried and the that extrinsic more this feature of a theory shop community, business for complicated. pay to be for in other may be the a the pay for of of with support happier. responsibility ratios, reinforcing might for would the undermine in principle that also use be of their in any community such as a from and favour employees community – at way efforts higher would general not pay different have restaurants threatened would alliances the is that time. particularly trader and have (though the favour rise and at the may be idea. the stakeholders. formed always) the business, satisfying required the and has shop and have are the mostly sole of In as each An or suppliers, such being a such in as external stake in inconsequential. of an internal While these small stakeholders protable with government few two. stakeholders, interests trader managing individual relatively relatively is stakeholders instances, employee external of laws an nanciers not interests some typically several provide the In complicated. perhaps decisions with probably employees position. sole is the by mean rises friction trader business, operates in for the into especially a have case of was working be (who Even major a It in enough income, regulations not might be in to the that and make this and with is if up their the for town, this of lead might year-end losing not to in a reduced out were workforce. the CEO bonuses). their like the business. retained smaller as would instance, the a factory productivity workers the When the employer might greater Those jobs In main outcome, greater a success the the challenge. in area. the mean dissatised. keeping coordinating or workforce also receive city in retrenched, with ones, formidable small stake the might harder would a factory happy those in large more employer a reduction that however, much factory business. might managers unhappy. a is important the workforce workers, be of most Shareholders senior a rise reactions not stakeholders 20-per-cent pressured is and stakeholders expenses of types of example, town, be standards. business various For a prots. would businesses What compliance interests large of expenses community For type pay government, the is to this be would the Thus, not them would principle investment that, local the most as sole typically that the jockeys business stakeholders the give motivation. importance, may on would the different satised the it in if successful small the of interests stakeholders: a community as in make lower intrinsic business, there group stakeholders’ the would stakeholders managers, return concerned spend the elicit sufciently running to senior factors, of local decision will stakeholder are which would would would be However, of situation, One also this and employees, etc. any business, and rises culture money existence as targets pay the for shops, CEO may a in wages Thus, rises, various managers wages, motivating foster Those ● pay positions, senior prot Managers to favour living. two higher However, ● would of mind. The ● who standard tnemnorivne themselves, S T A K E H O L D E R S jobs and The would seeing their 57 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 4 1 B u s i n e s s workers tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 co-workers a to general Many go. ● sense other if the harder of fear – for the a n d business make up of more job would local be e n v i r o n m e n t were to stakeholders for not the cuts – and work would affected community pressuring lost as the well. remaining those affect local the of the Just a retrenched, workers. few of government the would be follows: Many employees expenses ● Even work implications as o r g a n i z at i o n Probably houses would (support many or for people moving struggle the out would of to nd unemployed move rental new away ats, jobs, persons) thus from and government would the increase. town, depressing the selling real estate market. ● When fall, ● families thus Local businesses would shops Large mean and approach decision or to away, the lay-offs would of suffer, people number teachers as with fewer the of in children the employees resources in the school may school. to of the factory purchase at local restaurants. often prioritize to fewer businesses interests move leading or those perform rank this making the step in a businesses interests is the that stakeholder to of various determine business. have is The rst stakeholders. how This complicated analysis. “close” shown in each stakeholder step One is to conceptual stakeholder Figure is to 1.4.1. government employees suppliers owners pressure media groups managers nanciers consumers local community Figure 1.4.1. The comparative closeness of stakeholders to decision making Under this making, further media approach, while the stakeholders Another local closest the valued and to managers employees, distant are community. the models model power–interest are nanciers, government, Decision central and to consumers pressure makers decision try to are groups, satisfy the those centre. approach Numerous particularly 58 Most conceptual mapping. called suppliers, removed. and owners was involves for a tool mapping formulated model. called stakeholder stakeholders by Johnson exist. and One Scholes and 1 . 4 S T A K E H O L D E R S Level of interest High tnemnorivne Low Low Degree of power Figure 1.4.2. The power–interest model (Johnson and Scholes) Source: Johnson, G and Scholes, K (1999) Exploring Corporate Strategy, 5th edition, Prentice Hall Europe By placing on likely each Stakeholders interest in problem the for or group feel conveying kept A. and business. at group a least in These stakeholders, have the limited Owners devote to must business on satisfy in and matrix, power a business energy who over managers limited in C. have ways to feel group not any needs For belonging group must their B. owners important. They them before these is of nd make them group sense Stakeholders focus in satised. business with group included Stakeholders The group can decide have it, fairly and minimal are rarely safely attention a ignore to these satisfying interests. Stakeholders be in business the stakeholders, their stakeholder strategies. events, making and this other ways of pivotal the group to of stakeholders inuence self-esteem other of must groups. members of The this important. D. These merely stakeholders communicate decisions preference stakeholders managers, important. power atter major in are This the and Newsletters, can to have are the very are with made. others. the them The but important. also business Failure negative most to consult should involve consequences for and the business. Group Least to A important the business Group B Group C Group Most to D important the business 59 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t ✓ tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 r chckl Stakeholders the ✓ Internal such External such ✓ individuals stakeholders business, ✓ are or groups who have a direct interest in business. The as as stakeholders customers interests include are of return conditions are and the on and individuals employees and groups that work within the individuals or groups outside the business, suppliers. various stakeholders investment, the or managers. quality of the the will impact product on differ. the Interests local area, might working produced. Pcc q Anigam Anigam animal is one drugs promotional of the biggest industry. In campaigns. multinational many It uses countries, both companies Anigam above the is line operating well and in known below the for the its line promotion. Anigam has life cycle: ● Anitox is a a is portfolio the rst of animal animal business-to-business worldwide. That gure Anitox has established has been product drug a a at that (B2B) high stable in drugs Anigam product 25% for different the market that of 10 is of developed used share last stages in their and sold. veterinary the global years. and It clinics market. Anitox saturated product is a well- growing very slowly. ● A range Anisan, a high animal 15% share however, which is as u and Last year, helps to other is the rst whether a) Analyse b) With group reasons companies. IB, 60 Nov. 2013 performing launched in to new efforts were for it as It Anislim of well: is, The and in has animal Aniplus, against products such Anislim Thanks appropriate which to signicant promotional too early to maintained. drugs other the mix, forecast by applying the Boston [5 one increase them, competitive. called be other systems for of already example, market very however, will animal for One it Some immune animals. an ago. animals; market. drug and good. is years matrix. Anigam the but domestic portfolio for a four aging animals’ diseases. rapidly, (BCG) in growing strengthen sales Anigam’s reference discuss not marketing present consulting rapidly obesity results launched attacks contagious Anigam sales to was heart a growing reduce introductory of are designed Aniplus drugs prevent drugs, the ● of helps company number of of your marks] choice, multinational [7 marks] tnemnorivne By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ Prepare a STEEPLE analysis of an organization ➔ Exaplain the consequences of a change in any of the STEEPLE factors for a business’s objectives and strategy The impact of the external environment on a business All In businesses, business, “ecology”, as the environment to the a business Businesses external plans word for analysis, – to Even that will have tool for which have All STEEPLE in They the highlights elements framework, alone means of to of those focuses to environment. meaning in ecological) control difcult – of business, its external internal elements external it. plan on were elements make a of with external PEST the contingency environment. begins these included the and external process analyses in be an Rather, (including inuence the in narrower implies. however, analysis shown on planning operate the manages can impact and STEEPLE or conditions can, of big, have means elements type or not business an limited this of a challenge still small does various when only changes versions analysis. how usually environment. common Earlier matter refers business. environment to no “environment” a One STEEPLE elements. or a incorporated PESTLE in the Figure1.5.1. Ethical Economic Political Technological Legal Social The business Ecological Figure 1.5.1. The STEEPLE framework What is the – difference ● PEST Political, ● PESTLE – between Economic, Political, PEST, PESTLE Social Economic, and Social, and STEEPLE analyses? Technological Technological, Legal and Ecological ● STEEPLE Legal and – Social, Technological, Economic, Ecological, Political, Ethical 61 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1.5 The ex ternal environment 1 B u s i n e s s addition ethical) tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 The the last of reect 50 has the an years multinational legal o r g a n i z at i o n occurred years ago as businesses practices have and in businesses even in with many elements evolution and frameworks extra addition broader treating so legal of A had on and have consider then over become the different transformation ethical. making including stakeholders and thinking Many to similar ecological only ecological and larger. have operate. focused and practices grown they concerns, all (rst have they businesses e n v i r o n m e n t business global, which the a n d Whereas prots, striving 50 today towards most sustainable ethically. th pc f ch y f h steePLe fc If any of the objectives rst considers Then the are in a of particular Once develop listed factors strategy business inuences. can STEEPLE and inuences most strategy change, business. conducts the Table a to an of them a will have STEEPLE each analysis important take this In to element on determine inuences into an are account. impact analysis, the the a on the business business. most isolated, Common important the business inuences 1.5.1. Table 1.5.1. Common inuences in a STEEPLE analysis Social inuences include: Technological inuences include: Economic inuences include: Ethical inuences include: Political inuences include: Legal inuences include: Ecological inuences include: Not all with need 62 businesses the to same be react degree concerned to of the lifestyles ● education ● social mobility ● fashions or tastes. ● demographics ● technological improvements ● ICT ● new technology transfer ● research and development costs. ● infrastructure ● the economic or business cycle ● the rate of unemployment ● the rate of economic growth ● the exchange rate ● the rate of ination ● interest rates. ● corruption ● codes of business behaviour ● transparency ● fair trade. ● political stability ● regional policies ● trade policies ● lobbying or electioneering. ● regulations ● health and safety legislation ● employment laws ● competition laws. ● depletion of renewable resources ● organic farming ● global warming ● carbon footprints. inuences energy with ● or or purpose. changes in changes Often, particular a shown in business laws (if they Table might are 1.5.1 not not relevant to the business) or to changes in fashion or T H E tastes (if E X T E R N A L its E N V I R O N M E N T product ToK discussion service react to is (or not try determined to pre-empt) by fashion these or tastes). inuences How will be a the business function of will tnemnorivne or their To what degree are relevance to its current strategy and objectives. businesses limited in how Businesses successful an early useful factors, to than have are exible businesses adaptor for elements that and businesses often which a rst may a can are it the adapt to change inexible rst move mover fast business give mover that having that allows and to and not advantage enough. Planning determine opportunity do will to adapt. can to much they can “know” about more be based changes respond be Being the external environment? very on STEEPLE environmental and perhaps even advantage. yduts esaC C’ s, Jp Cat’s Store was the rst ‘cat café’ to open in Tokyo, Economic – visiting a cat café is a luxury that people Japan. Customers pay a fee to visit the café, where may not be able to aord if the economy slows down. they can sit with the cats who live there. There are Can the café owners aord to pay for vet bills? now around 40 cat cafés in Tokyo, with many more Ethical – is it ethical to keep the cats in the café? Are throughout Japan and, increasingly, across the world. the standards of cleanliness and hygeine adequate? A STEEPLE analysis for Cat’s Store might consider the Political – is there a risk that animal rights following factors: campaigners could call for laws to be changed? Could a new goverment change the rules? Social – is the interest in cats a fad or a trend? Is there a risk that a new animal could become more Legal – the café is subject to strict health and safety ‘fashionable’? Is the population ageing? Is the café and animal rights regulations. Could these change? visiting by more young people than elderly people? What if a customer was injured by a cat? Do customers need to sign a disclaimer? Technological – How can the café best market itself in an online world? Social media such as Instagram Ecological – each cat will require food, shelter and and Twitter could be used to generate buzz. Is the café warmth. What is the ecological eect of this? utilizing the most ecient technology? Student workpoint 1.8 Be a thinker Work in a following pair or ● local ● international ● high-street ● local ● global ● online You to create a STEEPLE analysis for one of the restaurant car hotel to chain bookshop mechanic electronics might ndings group businesses: clothing base the retailer your rest manufacturer analysis of the on class a and real company. discuss the Present your differences in your ndings. 63 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 5 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t ✓ tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Revision checklist A STEEPLE which ✓ The factors legal ✓ If analysis might and any of is a inuence are: social, way the of evaluating success of technological, a all the external factors business. economic, ethical, political, ecological. the factors change, a business may need to adapt its strategy. Practice question China China, with economic 9.7% on per population year mobile night a growth. the neon Nestlé, Beijing and years With world as 40 demand and in the of with Trade 70% of down from 15% music and of is hungry grew coffee their news foreign Standard dynamic as to and and costs. each year. pay Acer now at for at Starbucks, and investment. as Hong talk fashions. Chartered . as a China By They Shanghai, Kong Taiwan full million more was and of companies have than about $6. US 50 a two towns million cents Sony per such technology mobile-phone as such and manufacturers in turned companies Japan’s motor Boom falling, particular, are than Foreign country 178 In in Wages taxpayers. and services Japan more of China. rules, a gap between centrally new tariff to government, cuts 12%. such as rms rich planned Organization the foreign and well users US cutting China the about new as products the Chinese wealth with the against Pepsi are GDP drink for extent people, its Hitachi are now Shenzen fanatics. owners It has which is America. associated World as qualify as Internet bureaucratic ICT production highest than However, and 2000, Chinese the manufacturers, image million more for towards Siemens the an billion Internet Canon, cities such graduates moved create 1.3 and Young the illustrate coastal American among use Samsung, the innovation Dell have signs markets, university hour. and some 1979 ago. expensive from average. phones display few on of Between (WTO), agreed However, health who also and to and poor economy. but after China on safety complain a can entry. some is widening. There year are as claim Overall agricultural member have tariffs tariffs requirements, about a to illegally China political is risks of achieved have have come risen discriminate copied books, software. [Source : IT puts re in the belly of dragon economy – The Times, 12 Dec 2002 and China: Welcome the Final Frontier – Sunday Times 3 Nov 2002] a) Evaluate the the extent development of to which new ICT globalization (information is encouraged and technology). b) Using a IB, 64 May [7 STEEPLE disadvantages 2004 by communication to framework foreign analyse rms of the locating potential in advantages China. marks] and [6 marks} tnemnorivne By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ Dene the terms economies and diseconomies of scale ➔ Discuss the merits of small versus large organizations ➔ Outline the dierence between internal and external growth ➔ Explain the following external growth methods: ● mergers and acquisitions (M & As) and takeovers ● joint ventures ● strategic alliances ● franchising Explain the role and impact of globalization on the growth and ➔ evolution of businesses ➔ Outline reasons for the growth of multinational companies (MNCs) ➔ Evaluate the impact of MNCs on the host countries ec c f cl Businesses use to the the that larger size or operations, increases efcient, “economies business increase of has Efciency more refer as to in is Unit size. the variable in to and the cost in of think of of rent the process of costs of of a situation of as a experiences the to an size. per cost production term cost refers production of more unit in refers business occurs, which types often scale The business increases different costs a scale , business scale. average sometimes this When its becomes of can operations increases volume. in of unit. of with For a production, the formula: costs abbreviations costs, costs example, the When the operations business reduction the terms explanation now, as the TC formula = xed for total if a are payments business. costs that business are the do same = not operates Variable cost cost, + variable FC for xed cost cost and VC for is: TC Fixed in of Scale economies However, larger. a greater diseconomies unit measured For or scale efcient. When achieved refers Total Using has achieved 5. more their more output. becomes average complete following it increase operations scale” increases in of business inefciencies business of or become produces scale the to volume it its expand scale in FC change a are VC as rented regardless costs + costs of production (leased) the that quantity vary as changes. factory, of the For monthly production production of changes. 65 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1.6 Growth and evolution 1 B u s i n e s s example, if a furniture a n d e n v i r o n m e n t manufacturer expands production, then it will Key terms require tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 For o r g a n i z at i o n more Further raw costs unit costs. with the are All materials known three (wood, as refer metal average to total springs, costs cost or per cloth, unit unit, leather, costs which or can etc.). average be Fixed costs calculated costs which do not change following formula: according to the amount of goods or services produced total cost __ Average cost = by the business. quantity produced Variable costs And if AC quantity is average produced, cost the (Unit costs formula or average Unit costs) and Q is becomes: costs which increase or decrease according the TC _ AC amount of goods or services = Q produced As we Thus, saw above, average TC cost refers can to also be total cost, derived calculated with from the adding following FC and VC. formula: FC + VC _ AC = Q Expressing the economies and producing costs are a spread average has achieved Sometimes scale. year. is For As that units It have In example, it will at factory, for of can a or the some it concepts produced. of expands However, becomes As the a more spread point next grow changing year for is or years locations (See to by xed result, efcient. It a growth for the Unit for greater come on for number of The its this of continues), the factory. business will production. year next amount without on year. factory probably the of year reason size 5). another should even One larger expand – inefciencies diseconomies production expanding space to (if level space signicantly to scale. over time utilization business of out in business experience refers economies additional the to expands production the – starts situation additional or a the business increase. units business being capacity acquire business disruption at example space that is remember, for This achieves different of the business expands, maximum cent different probably the its per scenario, enough and at acquiring should way, be explain as costs quantity costs. rent However, 100 acquire initially of variable the to First, scale. imagine cost helps scale. Thus, of unit way of greater business xed this larger a average does, to When just when it be a down. economies produced. will go the business this quantity, over costs increase in diseconomies greater the that formula not two of or a acquire years. space. having It That the cost TOK discussion frequently. As businesses grow, how do When a business doubles its factory size, its capacity utilization will go down their methods of knowing (initially) and its rent will increase. In our example, in the old factory or old (knowing their customers, space, the business had 100 per cent capacity utilization. When the space is knowing the business doubled but production remains the same (initially), capacity utilization will environment, knowing their decrease from 100 per cent to 50 per cent. The business’s rent expense will markets, etc.) change? Are increase signicantly (it will probably double). The higher rent will now be these changes for the better, spread over the same (or a slightly higher) number of units produced. With or worse? How are they the higher rent, initially, the business will have higher average unit cost. dierent? Thus, 66 it will have achieved diseconomies of scale. Figure 1.6.1 shows this G R O W T H A N D E V O L U T I O N progression. tnemnorivne Costs average costs economies diseconomies of scale of scale 0 Optimum Quantity production produced Figure 1.6.1. Progression from economies of scale to diseconomies of scale As the costs of business go down. lowest our average example would grows, The costs, using produces rent the as the point utilization. As the business inefcient. Average curve costs are Efciency more the is at the the is not efcient business if in it can which to to is of to cost, is at average per their alone. unit unit After it At the the average point production”. 100 per cent to point that In production starts minimum production. at initially optimum expand, The are and efcient. “optimum business production savings at xed rise. prots lower the the level and related chief output more continues start optimum lowest business where costs more becomes the be cost also it business capacity become of point, the more average average maximum. A business costs, can regardless become of the area of occur. T able 1.6.1. Internal economies of scale (eciencies that the business itself can make) Type Explanation Example Technical Bigger units of production can reduce Operating a container ship with one crew, fuel bill costs because of the law of variable and ber thing fee is cheaper than running two or more propor tions – the increase in variable smaller vessels. costs spread against a set of xed costs. Similarly, the A380 passenger airline will be cheaper to operate than two traditional long-haul aircraft; an articulated lorry will be cheaper to operate than two or three smaller vehicles. Managerial A bigger business can aord to have Managers specializing by function, such as production, managers specializing in one job as marketing, nance, and HR, as opposed to having a opposed to trying to do everything. “general” manager, can typically work with greater eciency. Financial Bigger businesses are less risky than Banks and other nancial institutions charge lower smaller businesses. rates of interest on loans or overdrafts to businesses they consider safe. Marketing Bigger businesses can direct more Only large business can aord sponsorship of major eective marketing campaigns. spor ting events such as the Olympic Games, the Super Bowl or the Football World Cup, which are especially higher yielding promotions per dollar, pound or euro. 67 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 6 1 B u s i n e s s tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Purchasing Risk bearing o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t Big businesses can gain discounts by Supermarkets such as Wal-Mar t or Tesco buy large bulk buying – buying in large quantities. quantities of food at very low prices from farmers. Big businesses can aord to produce Pepsi Co owns a number of dierent brands such as a bigger product range and in doing so Pepsi, Gatorade, Tropicana, Lipton’s Teas, Quaker Oats, spread the risk of one product failing – and Lays. hedging their bets Table 1.6.2. External economies of scale (eciencies that the business achieves because someone else has expanded) Type Explanation Example Consumers A shopping mall increases the number of A shopping mall, an international airpor t, and a potential of customers as more people go to the business park or zone all require servicing and mall compared to an independent shop because maintenance as well as their core business. of the ease of one-stop shopping. So, a whole range of other businesses benets from someone else building the infrastructure. Employees Labour concentrations – some cities or Hollywood is famous for having many actors geographic areas concentrate on cer tain and others skilled in various aspects of lm and industries or sectors. Individual businesses television production. located in those areas and operating in the London is a major banking centre, where industry that has the concentration can often numerous professionals in nancial services live benet from lower recruiting and training costs. and work . As we have achieve noted, however, diseconomies of if scale a in business the expands same too much, then it can area. Table 1.6.3. Internal diseconomies of scale (ineciencies that the business itself can make) Type Example Technical A container ship can be too big to berth in a harbour, an airplane too big to land at smaller airports, or a lorry too large to drive on minor roads. Managerial Businesses may have “over-specialized” managers who cannot (or will not) work outside their area of exper tise or for everyone’s benet, which often occurs in the investment and commercial banking sectors. Financial Sometimes big businesses with large amounts of “surplus” cash make poor investments. Poor decisions occur because the businesses do not think through the consequences of investment choices – Singapore Airlines bought a 49% stake in Virgin Atlantic for US$ 965 million in 1999 but in 2012 sold its stake to Delta Airlines for US$ 360 million. Marketing Sometimes big businesses can make big marketing mistakes. In the 1990s, Hoover oered free ights to anyone who spent more than US$150 on a vacuum cleaner. Hoover did not realize that, for many people, an expensive vacuum cleaner was wor th buying if it included a free ight anywhere in the world! When Hoover refused to honour the deal, the cour ts ordered the company to pay US$ 50 million in compensation to customers. Weakened by this expense, Hoover was acquired by a competitor, Candy. Purchasing Large businesses often buy too much stock , which can be costly if the capital funds used to purchase the stock are greater than the cost savings from buying in large quantities. Stock can also become spoilt, obsolete or unfashionable. The rst stock market crash was as a result of too many tulips being bought by Dutch traders in the 17th century. Risk bearing 68 In 2005 eBay bought Skype in the hope of broadening its range but in 2011 sold it to Microsoft. G R O W T H A N D E V O L U T I O N Table 1.6.4. External diseconomies of scale (ineciencies that the business Type Example Employees If one geographic region becomes too concentrated on one tnemnorivne achieves because someone else has expanded) economic activity, typically a shor tage of skilled workers in the industry will occur. For an individual business this relative shor tage of skilled workers means that the business will have to pay higher wages than before to attract and retain skilled workers. th f ll l Not all businesses remain small. growing Many their and their only a used and few by make big-wall manufacturers entrenched Many law are the – the example, rms In their of Big small close are portable niche pool to tent to of specialized their markets manufacturers, hanging market of tents means customers that and the remain climbing. to stay small. preferring major However, businesses (high-quality, stay companies, four prefer headache business. many small lawyers Four. to simply the the this prefer want products big-wall accountancy, so-called needs also businesses not large which their of a prefer Serving to do among multinational exist, world high-end culture large clients. managing businesses close Many owners “portaledges”, the practices expand. climbers. stay familiar serve For professional rms small in or offering service clients. to business business businesses products) want Some but to In the serve rms a serve countless everywhere legal around in sector, world small some many group clients small the the of around accounting the rms world. Advantages of being a big business These ● are Survival less ● of the large to Economies fail of balance sheet. Higher status advantages rms and into – rm status to such large as fast-food leader rms some and status restaurants McDonald’s large can in to shape be rms have & higher or is by enjoy and be, giving and market smaller can a of This ‘por taledge’ tent is an example of a niche market product scale, healthier working ones. for a provide other employees. leader world. it a are rm. economies Benetton the They another than may industrial habits, surviving. returns, managers McDonald’s market of over status brands Fitch the business: chance motivate of big taken greater clothing most a typically prots, can – being greater Abercrombie employees Market – a of likely greater fashionable larger have less scale translate However ● – likely which ● some All in by itself, competitive advantage. ● Increased market market share deciding can which share control services – large the will companies market be the by that have determining industry a large prices and standard. 69 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 6 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t ● tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Advantages of being a small business Greater “be all where lies. they They they ● focus things Greater greater some cachet small Greater and by and – small businesses to that they have they a are and – to prot having matter to time can the greatest sometimes charge on have for to protability but often investment. more businesses. more business investments businesses returns larger small focus As their cachet, a a result, goods and margins. more Sometimes, hard expect larger higher than able not believe than businesses higher do businesses prots protability employees. idea where lower motivation sometimes small exclusiveness, leading other the of customers people”, have greater sense services, ● because all want may have – to prestige as the well, business. conveying can motivate employees the Very are large sense that managers motivated businesses all employees matter. ● Competitive service, ● Less and advantage being exible competition niche market) getting that involved. – – being can sometimes big This small, give a a businesses situation providing competitive market do not often is so even means a a more personalized advantage. small want (a to market true consider with limited competition. th c bw l xl wh Businesses choose with ● internal ● external Internal slowly without major or by strategy another may of such the The its internally as out take risks. outlays, have two broad options to a organic of the long product still as time, business have to from expands or because by money expand can from property, is occurs the this selling most growth of grow simply Although internal it operations business borrow update expansion a range. to growth existing way more businesses banks plant, for and self-nanced prots. growth Instead by known occurs developing most retained expands it many growing External 70 a growth. often and Although capital growth. is steadily equipment, using as growth (fast-track) taking products are (organic) growth and business. that growth from: of is entering business, ● a merger and ● a joint ● a strategic ● a franchise. a quick selling into such some alliance riskier of its type method own of of products or growth itself, arrangement as: acquisition venture and more takeover (M & A) to than the work internal business with the risks increase growth are usually greater, market requires the share signicant potential and rewards decrease external are that competition nancing. the very A N D E V O L U T I O N Although business can tnemnorivne External G R O W T H quickly. External growth methods There are common many are as ways of expanding externally but some of the most follows: M & As This INNOVATION type of expansion occurs when two business become integrated, When two businesses are either by joining together – one and forming a bigger combined business – integrated, they nd themselves a merger When term the or by business acquisition typically used is is taking unwanted “takeover” over by or the the other – company “hostile an acquisition. being acquired, sharing ideas, people and the resources. takeover”. How might this encourage innovation? One result of a merger, business. However, can In vary. reasons, Integration ● not line of Unit was ● can 1.1). the the further vertical a of to vertical outlet for and its business among its for the the one bigger integration following four two of businesses but actually production acquisition of (as integrated in the same outlined Chrysler in Motors occurs further wants to bought sure a when back vertical protect coffee its one (at business an earlier integration supply chain. manufacturer, Starbucks had control stage) usually In The 2008, Clover over processing still later in occurs products. (Disney) The occurs stage) (and chain when For with company, has a a business in the wants 2002 major the US television ABC with an to Forward ensure Walt television Broadcasting Disney–ABC secure integrates production. American rm, provides one of business example, merged combined Disney when the Television and multimedia additional supplier programming). and occurs occurs type for For Motors and or businesses integration many Taj the successful two of example, businesses business have when This risk. many Tata chemical would its that corporate Television, the Fiat’s Backward usually integrate. diversication has a products high-quality overall the broadly chain business multimedia Conglomeration of of same: integration. integration (ABC). ensures for the reason one when same maker make (to integration Corporation ● Starbucks is different. integration business for industry production. a very horizontal Corporation Group, car business occurs occurs the takeover ways: same in or beans. broadcasting of of is four another forward secure Disney outlet and System, Forward the vertical example, coffee in Italian with when Brewing ● The chain occurs for in example integrates process integration merely Backward in the business an underlying integration happen Horizontal are the general, although acquisition, Tata reasons the but Indian If any business businesses in – known mainly to company Tata one were other unrelated also Chemicals, Hotels. steel in is of the reduce Tata Steel, to lines as Group Tata businesses fail, Tata – Group industries. 71 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 6 1 B u s i n e s s reason that complementary tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Another o r g a n i z at i o n sales its in the sales have in Integration has scale, of production. in addition of many to the M of company, new, for activities, & the Sometimes Employees diversify a is business purchased the advantages cost If a to have that business combined does that most had enterprise of its most would of not inactivity. However, fees. another occurs. months e n v i r o n m e n t may activity. months, complementary consulting with summer periods of business seasonal winter long a a n d As can the two costly being one if control be business when especially from businesses, and or and do the typically high acquires takeover companies economies down acquired, company the including up is legal or hostile, not work chain include, and combines a culture well clash together. Joint ventures Joint for a ventures specic business the or is occur goal created dened time incorporated rms decide temporary transfer and to in of specialist venture then buys Examples out of by the the partners Although areas This party is begins of the to a the a separate After dissolved two parent venture business, skills, future. play a businesses. joint of resources result, either or a transfer in combine As “parent” business new occur. either to time. businesses, frame. up agree of two new parent opening can period the the time benet of the the by businesses nite over, of skills could one is one extend a funding period into two over with nature expertise joint when and may be considerable knowledge, Sometimes dominant role in a and other. joint ventures include Sony–Ericsson (2001–2012), Channel The Channel Tunnel, which links Tunnel Group–France-Manche (1985–1994), New Zealand Post–DHL the UK and France, was built as 2004–2012), and BMW – Brilliance (formed in 2003 and ongoing). Joint par t of a joint venture ventures sales, also but the can other company doing At least loses joint brings, ventures realizes without that All will effectiveness it having that legal that different conceptually partners its advantage bring partnership. joint advantage business sometimes is the neither have venture the have do to not Sometimes of partnership breaks a or its expertise, a identity. the prots risk the with the legally), a disagreement a or with the other joint be or joint a venture company. venture so the what However, disagreement may compromised ventures outcome what greater joint combination combination. desired that enjoy Joint forming in powerful always the is typically accomplished the run rms businesses produce not occur. venture) of have share (though partnerships the two create could two existence the areas to the is a between severe that partnership the (or apart. Strategic alliances Strategic alliances businesses differ ● from More joint than Strategic similar including United, in for ventures two In in the often, airline Singapore the a to joint several goal. because However, fundamental may though be not industry, Airlines, alliance. ventures specied businesses alliances businesses. 72 are collaborating part of always, the Star Lufthansa, they involve strategic alliances ways: the alliance . involve Alliance South more has African 27 than two airlines, Airways and new business existence work but together Individual ● existing Strategic strategic the All of these businesses a a the agree share otherwise are legal is alliance to more membership join entity typically remain resources compete uid can comes an into agreement to independent . but against than change the members also alliance, enterprise. joint they each The remain other. ventures . without alliance?). external means that more think However, do not nor get do the In a destroying businesses will, they capital enjoy lacks has may less gain otherwise remaining the that coordination alliance businesses they provide. alliance more challenging Individual growth the The existence, they enterprises, of the legal businesses other forms weaknesses. (presumably individual with also Without extant alliance other are strategic becomes. they the merger that alliances new alliance benet. in may often alliance, legally the would that and No strategic mutual strengths in agreement from created . a E V O L U T I O N alliance. involved than for businesses independent ● is rather A N D tnemnorivne No ● G R O W T H and force benet why independent means strength of legal economies of scale Lastly, greater are uidity of stability. Franchises Franchising, popular the original business to offer the to, external want have sells the a also to that rapid to right or the other the concept local know growth, expand grow There are business, other is becoming globally. increasingly Franchising involves of where the concept languages, many many it is or The conditions, which is of of developed businesses the right the in the by the the right business can then expand – as franchisees local (the to long identical is actually franchisor) is can proving franchisor other as it typically cultures. if not Franchisees The sell helpful franchisee franchisor. Franchising globally. The the sells instances does franchisees). grow offer Franchising franchisor the to franchisee some franchisor. the and the franchisor. and especially the buy the companies. to other developed franchisor wants examples by (the to to words, with, Instead, means countries other because enterprise. local In originally new. The sells that product. franchisees, franchise a franchisor, then the businesses as country. markets, in to the consistent partnerships, places local be growth attractive home the business of sell product. anything to individuals, to starts form produce that as the as product, and developed has original particularly host sell known and known products business often to of that concept and usually of concept the concept be form business, Businesses, ● A another businesses following: An ● for nds have buyers a in of knowledge Franchisees the has businesses also franchisor wants world. franchises in many different areas of including: ● McDonalds ● Budget – – car fast food hire 73 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 6 1 B u s i n e s s tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 – o r g a n i z at i o n ● Hilton ● Kumon ● Blockbuster ● Wokinabox – ● Spar stores ● Benetton ● Body ● Edo – e n v i r o n m e n t hotels – education food – fast – entertainment fast food clothes Shop – a n d – cosmetics food. An outlet of Spar in Berlin, Germany The cost must of pay business for fee franchise the – must concepts and agreements (KFC, Taco franchise the as to would division of pay not and parts. essentially concept royalties franchisor. somewhat agreement – two – For be exactly other for a in according example, the responsibilities a the right the their same between operate as Then of sales franchisor those and a the These business of Yum! the and Brands same However, franchisor or franchisee exactly Cars. a the relationship. individual nor Rental to percentage to franchisee product. McDonald’s restaurants), Enterprise First, and Both responsibilities industries. Bell, itself the specic vary in franchisor’s goes have responsibilities the typically which franchisee comes franchise offering franchisee at the in as the general, franchisee are follows. The franchisor will provide: The franchisee ● the stock ● employ ● the ttings ● set prices ● the uniforms ● set wages ● staff ● pay ● legal ● create ● global advertising ● sell ● global promotions training and nancial help an will: staff agreed local only royalty on sales promotions the products of the franchisor advertise ● Which party start-up of the costs brand. strong. Only McDonald’s name 74 can very to the vary Some a nd brands hav e the hi g h rights respons i b i l i ti es businesses has many (regardless advantages of mar ke t less and as a c c o rd in g cer t ai n so of the o wni ng po w e r. the legal pa r ty to M cD on a ld ’s, b ar g ai ni ng of wh i c h McD on al d’s sa le s , te rms may For a a lmos t franchisor and s uch doe s is less ha v e and cons id er a bl y rarely dictate o utl e t b r a nds , restaur a nt recognition position Other provi d e s pr ov i de s the ar e the s tr en g t h e s pe c ia l ly re s tau r an t clo se . i m m ed ia t e ly to ha ve f ra n c h is or in a a In is Mc D on a ld ’s t h o se st r e n gt h fra n c h is or A and n ew s t ro n g s t r on g f ra n c h is e . cir c u m s t a n c es , wh e n organization), disadvantages locally. s e t t in g the the fr a n c h is e e. acquiring compared to a franchise developing their are business as model. For the franchisee, The well exists and The is format product is for selling has the has ● The set-up ● The franchisee The of costs and are has reduced. a can nancial, tecÚical Franchisors to pay royalties secure no control over what ● has no control over supplies ● makes also have advantages and all the quick access to wider loses ● some of local knowledge can ● not see its franchise gains ● some hand, enjoy Perhaps, expertise many the break way to image fails or in the the suffer does day- business if a not properly. and franchise and the for into gain to eventually but by start franchisees, great Regardless, to prots risks the of fees. franchisees company? enough the running more sign-up Do assume of control running perform liability decisions. franchisor: to-day use global disadvantages. expertise does sell help. markets ● to managerial, The and the provide franchisor: makes to has The ● the ● Disadvantages gains for franchisor Advantages ● liability stock. franchisor legal, unlimited franchise established. ● supply franchisee: known. ● The ● disadvantages Disadvantages product usually ● and E V O L U T I O N follows. Advantages ● advantages A N D tnemnorivne own G R O W T H new an their even protability the markets the own if can over a its of the of independent of the come selling with tired operators tired that franchisor, advantage become then, franchises minimum of a of an the the easy difculty parent may On the have other franchisor, successful is of franchise business. control with control the franchise. and and fast risk way and is a competitors. th pc f lbl Globalization evolution. the the different and The of Roman in services is and War, earlier terms being of the one impact process other forms intensity, exchanged, which the unit. Road, the examples known growth world’s The Age and interdependence. phenomenon of businesses’ global Silk historical global the the on by integrated Empire, economic World from just signicant becoming Empire degree Second First, are new. British some had Globalization economies wholly has and regional process of periods not saw Nevertheless, as is Exploration, since “globalization” is interdependence. scale, global speed, and economic interdependence value today is of on goods a 75 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 6 1 B u s i n e s s or tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 completely o r g a n i z at i o n different order of a n d e n v i r o n m e n t magnitude from that seen in earlier periods circumstances. Second, small current number national record means (the businesses record, their any are home. to can for domestic is c h ar a c t e ri z e d “po st - n at ion a l” the s e le g al l y co m pa n ie s re g is t e re d tr a ns na ti ona l ; cons id er do no busi ne ss co mp a ny cost ap ar t pl ac e and to in on e fr om a a r el a tive ly P ost - h om e of c ou n t ry) , the hom e t h ey its by bu si n es s es . h a ve t h ei r wh e re ve r itse l f, of c an pr o t s , l e ga l or t he hom e eve ry ma ke an d a of pl ace pr o t . n ot to has mo r e and – large be come choi ce . se r v i ce s become its to for mo r e work e r s impact on the growth of domestic reasons: foreign mo re “Gr ea ter is e xtra cti ng as by s lo wi n g mea n on e the for ce dome st i c can Ho we ver, g re a t er ca n the e f c i en c y” cons ume r s. e fcie nt a nd bus i ne s s e s e f c i en t l ower- way th a t g ro w t h pr odu c t i vi t y in o ut them. Greater with big selling local sold a which lead multinational particular and a at global new they and to producers create do products do their this by have own rms. can make to compete unique emphasizing compared global so, businesses, least two-way rm while to the the “foreign” Regardless, many businesses some no of transfer will those matter their of learn how knowledge from workers big, workforce the can and workers learn must must new use be skills. hired local, The in approaches skills. collaboration strategic their to efcient. foreign to or of forced and countries, develop Closer – if knowledge: will domestic need multinationals even transfer – so Sometimes origins by USP , local and (USP). competitive Skills some awareness names national creating more brand brand point or products or signicant compe t i t i on businesses of a following produce r s goods wages have the consumer ● be in g country. Increased ● o fce wi l l the is l a rg e a l tho ug h othe r wi s e They are businesses ● tha t, busine s s e s Globalization ● e x tr e me l y “home ” these Loyalties g l o b a l i za ti on of alliances, – whether domestic through producers joint can ventures, create new franchises, business opportunities. r f h wh f ll cp A multinational one country connotation many a of legally the but in the United Multinational they often is business multinational in in that more “multinational” the small whereas States companies generate a registered word operating multinational, only 76 company is countries, company is or more is a has a may be one of company in more than country. global narrower countries large operates than or meaning. Luxembourg registered in The operating A and and in small Belgium operating not. are the biggest revenues than type the of business country and they in fact operate in. example, countries Table and 1.6.5 shows businesses in a comparison terms of GDP and of the sales world’s A N D E V O L U T I O N leading revenues. tnemnorivne For G R O W T H Table 1.6.5. The world’s leading countries and businesses – GDP and sales revenues Rank Economy US$ millions Rank Economy US$ millions 1 United 14,991,300 18 Turkey 774,983 States 2 China 7,318,499 19 Switzerland 659,308 3 Japan 5,867,154 20 Saudi Arabia 576,824 4 Germany 3,600,833 21 Sweden 539,682 5 France 2,773,032 22 Poland 514,496 6 Brazil 2,476,652 23 Belgium 513,661 United 2,445,408 24 Norway 485,803 2,193,971 25 Royal Dutch 7 Kingdom 8 Italy 484,489 Shell 9 Russian 1,857,770 26 Exxon Mobil 452,926 1,847,977 27 Wal-Mar t 446,950 Federation 10 India Stores 11 Canada 1,736,051 28 Austria 417,656 12 Spain 1,476,882 29 South Africa 408,237 13 Australia 1,379,382 30 BP 386,463 14 Mexico 1,153,343 31 Sinopec Group 375,214 15 Korea, Rep. 1,116,247 32 United Arab 360,245 Emirates 16 Indonesia 846 ,832 33 Thailand 345,672 17 Netherlands 836,074 34 Denmark 333,616 Source: Adapted from World Bank & For tune Global 500, 2011 Four and ● factors with have such a Improved ● ● of materials, transfer Increasing trade of of the economic which and world’s funds and and companies – middle- low-income and – not barriers components Deregulation easier companies to grow so rapidly only ICT but also transport and networks Dismantling raw multinational communications distribution ● allowed reach: can be – allowing nished nancial also tax easier movement of markets – allowing for avoidance political of for products power enormous of benet the multinational especially in countries. The impact of multinational companies on the 77 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 6 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t h c tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 th pc f ll cp h Multinational the host companies (domestic) can have countries in both which positive they and negative Ad vantages for the host country include: ● ● impacts on operate. Disad vantages for the host country include: economic growth – multinational companies prots being repatriated – the multinational ● can boost the domestic economy by providing companies may pay into the local tax system but the employment, developing a local network of suppliers, bulk of their prots will be rerouted away from the host and paying taxes and providing capital injections. country. new ideas – multinational companies may introduce loss of cultural identity – the appeal of domestic ● new ways of doing business and new ways of products, ways of doing business, and even cultural norms interacting socially. may suer. This is especially important for the younger generations who are more likely to buy global brands. ● skills transfer – multinational companies may help brain drain – many highly skilled employees may ● develop the skills of local employees. Domestic look to work for the multinational company in another businesses can benet from star ting their own country. business with the skills learned. ● more choice of products – the domestic market will loss of market share – as multinational companies ● benet as the variety of products will increase. take over more of the domestic market, domestic producers may suer. ● shor t-term infrastructure projects – multinational shor t-term plans – multinational companies may not ● companies often help to build infrastructure (for plan on staying for a long time – if lower-cost producers example roads to the factory, schools for workers’ can be found elsewhere, they may move out at shor t children). notice. r chckl ✓ An as ✓ the might only printed The ✓ Small External an this is gets example, negotiate a a if costs a of a business publisher cheaper diseconomy larger i.e. might and might high the benet competitive organic) growth this can sort acquisition, ✓ Multinational ✓ Due to price of scale business from advantage benet market growth and MNCs have which they be of prints for go down 7000 paper books than if they from – where becomes greater and the less focus, less cost goes up efcient. greater cachet competition. economies of scale, market- share. is the quicker growth through companies improved number ✓ the gradual expansion of a business within. experience 78 of status, (or For when 500. organizations Internal or to organizations Large occurs grows. motivation, from ✓ scale able business leader ✓ be reverse the and of business they as ✓ economy size both a and joint (MNCs) MNCs positive operate. has and a of operate and grown A less with through in more in effects might another than the one country. regulations, recent on company franchising. restricting rapidly negative business merger venture communication of riskier. through years. countries in the G R O W T H A N D E V O L U T I O N Practice question The panettone large Italian company Bauli produces a variety of baked tnemnorivne Bauli’s products 1 such a as croissants specialty luxury easily. at bakeries, the technology bakeries success luxury Bauli year a hard mainly major on challenge on its costs is few a A workforce of his investment be planning. 12 and in were is relatively million meets luxury that produced costs and small however, , small what research that Bauli’s by a €8. panettoni American Bauli panettone panettoni product panettone Baking its panettoni panettone European for quality argued, A Bauli scale. in of uniform price. €30. famous expensive quality could low and a most producers “High It industrial Italy it the guarantee achieve”. an of bake that success: to based across but original could typically produces sales us to The claims company’s bakery for which Bauli allows nd is biscuits, Christmas. Michele explains and per markets the is seasonal 2 demand each for year panettoni (from by August signicant technological According to Michele, technologies Bauli cake, has Bauli also which product mix has relied two market panettoni “Attention at give a The workers company product for internal of the will time a for has and of the growth. four also months made also help use of including year. The of ve the new months”. Colombo broader workers. In 2009, multinational these the shelf-life mix, temporary panettoni, They ingredients panettone different on American to the broader need produce share. in a the only temporary innovations. subsidiaries subsidiaries Bauli’s for popular reduces 1200 November). production developed is not purchased both in hiring to food acquisitions Bauli meet the company group have the Nestlé. As increased growing demand markets. [Source: adapted from http://www.economist.com/, 10 December 2009] With reference large organizations. IB, Nov. to Bauli, evaluate the benets of small versus [7 marks] 2011 1 panettone: in Italian panettone is singular, panettoni is plural 2 seasonal demand: demand that varies at dierent times of the year 79 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 6 tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 1.7 Organi zational planning tools (HL only) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: Describe the planning tools that organizations can use: ➔ shbone diagram ● decision tree ● force eld analysis ● Gantt char t Evaluate the value to an organization of these planning tools ➔ To ● help businesses organizational ● shbone ● decision ● force ● Gantt Each of aware achieve their tools, objectives, managers may wish to use including: diagrams trees eld analysis charts. these of to planning tools their has strengths limitations, these and weaknesses. tools can help As long managers as to users are plan. The shbone diagram While working for shbone diagram attempts to usually show used Ishikawa tool procedures, all these terms The the causes shbone whys”, and and a service get or customer of people what some so, symptom areas of not only (and the is to business). Ps” and is to for deeply In as its a to tool is of materials. Since then, (places, administration to tool Sakichi The into “5 the x to may use individual to help Toyoda’s provide whys” nature form, may When underlying Ms” Managers a The circles businesses for the diagram brainstorm problem. simplest other Ss” developed and “4 according problem problem. many “4 The problems. and service skills). developed problems. quality the provide linked he or for the and quality determine the possibly “4 Ishikawa quality machine, Corporation. more reports is a closely underlying goal idea of diagram combinations of Kaoru quality managers, systems, dissatisfaction. the the technique Toyota probe someone other followed, doing the to to general is effects of politics) effects diagram at to that and questioning and 1960s, identify manpower, various the the help shbone suppliers, in in groups applied circumstances. The 80 the people to cause method, been (surroundings, tool small designed has a the with manufacturing: the Kawasaki as the the problem “5 technique of the just quality “5 be whys” resolved showing is presumes a symptom problem. so up “5 intended technique but of quality problems whys” merely underlying symptoms concept better is in the is In original various same problem 1. The asked idea sh. by principle is For an is applies to that dig the example, airline to effect Figure losing the deeper shbone and of the 1.7.1 market look diagram. at the problem shows share the and A P L A N N I N G group T O O L S discussing ( H L O N LY ) a interconnections. is placed shbone wishing to in the head diagram address of tnemnorivne The O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L the prepared the issue. Loss of market share Figure 1.7 .1. Fishbone diagram – the eect of the problem 2. Then each caused shbone the possible to is problem. create allocated Typical other to a factors factors particular are relevant set to factor out a that below, particular may but it is have also problem. Table 1.7 .1. The “4 Ms”, “4 Ps” and “4 Ss” in relation to dierent types of business Manufacturing Ser vices Administration Manpower Places Surroundings Methods Procedures Suppliers Materials People Systems Machines Politics Skills In this shown case in the airline Figure may decide to use the “4 Ps” to brainstorm, as 1.7.2. procedures places Loss of market share politics people Figure 1.7 .2. Fishbone diagram using the “4 Ps” 3. After and discussion is drawn as by a the group, smaller each shbone factor is coming procedures broken out of down the into original a subfactor one. places routes bookings airpor ts depar tures Loss of market share management strategic employees politics people Figure 1.7 .3. Fishbone diagram showing subfactors 81 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 7 1 B u s i n e s s Finally, issues tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 4. the o r g a n i z at i o n after brainstorming (“shbones”, problem, this thus example, analysis that large and or determined an that that which airline the e n v i r o n m e n t discussion, small) identifying involving expanding a n d group not shbone losing airline the are the is the market had discards root cause problem. share, insufcient the Asian those of In shbone routes in market. poor website procedures places gates are far away routes bookings airpor ts not enough Asian depar tures destinations Loss of check-in too slow market share bureaucratic poor par tners management over worked strategic employees slow coordination politics too much of ser vices low wages people micro-managing Figure 1.7 .4. Fishbone diagram showing the root cause of the problem The shbone diagram has many benets shbone is ● is to exible virtually is ● simple The diagram: motivating together ● limitations. Limitations Benets The and as it brings discuss – and may ● problems applicable any people but to be can highlight before many singling out causes show of a specic divisive and problem solutions lead to arguments attractive requires ● honesty ● diagram: show not can ● situation visually shbone knowledge to justify and assertions factors the most begins ● signicant. a the problem follow-up process and of xing requires a process. dc A decision tree decisions. It providing a make To 1. is is clear sensible construct a planning visual a tool structure, decision tree, a ‘node’ choice has and the designed probability decisions. square with to strategic Where node a similar to the choice a decision help in tree conventions made, possible written to used simplify complex mathematics. can help By managers Site A certain be tree the decision choices above as the should is lines be followed. represented stemming by a from the line. Site B 1 For example, from in 2. If a choice order any are to a business of three identify given by new them decision represented a has to sites decide (A, correctly, has multiple circle node. B as whether or C). These shown possible Possible to in build nodes Figure new are factory numbered 1.7.5. outcomes, outcomes a these are outcomes represented Site C by lines stemming from the circle with the outcome written above Figure 1.7 .5. Decision tree – initial the line. Again, the nodes are numbered to help identify them (see stage of analysing three new sites Figure 82 1.7.6). O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L P L A N N I N G T O O L S ( H L O N LY ) tnemnorivne succeed Site A 2 fail succeed Each outcome has a possibility of being Site B 3 1 a success or a failure. fail succeed Site C 4 fail Figure 1.7 .6. Decision tree – sites analysed for success or failure 3. Then, the using whatever probability mathematics from one These as that in node are Figure is available, outcome probability outcome possibilities shown data the trees, must put the sum always below the actually the of be all 1 line manager happens. with probabilities (or for estimates As 100 that per the stemming cent). particular outcome, 1.7.7. succeed 0.4 Site A 2 fail 0.6 Choice Outcome and probability succeed • succeed 40% A 0.7 • fail 60% Site B 1 3 • succeed 70% B • fail 30% fail 0.3 • succeed 60% C • fail succeed 40% 0.6 Site C 4 fail 0.4 Figure 1.7 .7 . Decision tree – probability of outcomes 4. Using the estimate values best of are outcome, data the written as available, values at shown of the in that end Figure the manager outcome of the must actually line then make happening. represented by an These that 1.7.8. 83 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 7 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t 60 0.4 tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 succeed Site A 2 fail Returns 20 Choice 0.6 Outcome Probability (US$ m) succeed 30 0.7 succeed 40% 60 fail 60% 20 succeed 70% 30 fail 30% 10 succeed 60% 40 fail 40% 30 A Site B 3 1 B fail 10 0.3 C succeed 40 0.6 Site C 4 fail 30 0.4 Figure 1.7 .8. Decision tree – probability of outcomes 5. Then, costs again of the using the choices are incurred are written in the under best being choice, the data available, considered a gure respective (see “0” the need choice manager Figure not estimates 1.7.9). be If no shown. the costs The costs lines. succeed 60 0.4 Site A 2 15 fail 20 0.6 Cost succeed Choice US$ m 30 0.7 Site B A 15 C 20 3 1 25 fail 10 0.3 succeed 40 0.6 Site C 4 20 fail 30 0.4 Figure 1.7 .9. Decision tree – cost of outcomes 6. The manager values (EV). following Expected can now Each calculate outcome the node results, will in value EV this node = (probability case the calculations are as = (0.4 × 60) + (0.6 × 20) = 36 = (0.7 × 30) + (0.3 × 10) = 24 = (0.6 × 40) + (0.4 × 30) = 36 3 EV 4 84 × EV as the based return ×1 2 EV known an expected upon the formula: x So have follows: ) ×1 + (probability × ×2 return ) ×2 7. The decision would normally be the O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L outcome that P L A N N I N G gives the T O O L S ( H L O N LY ) succeed highest 60 0.4 EV . However, in this case, the manager must include the Site A costs by building the factories. The cost is subtracted from the tnemnorivne 2 incurred 15 EV fail 20 for each choice. This process then indicates the best choice: the EV 0.6 succeed with the highest value: 30 0.7 Site B EV cost 2 = 36 15 = US$21 3 1 million A 25 fail 10 EV cost 3 = 24 25 = (US$1 million) 0.3 B succeed 40 EV cost 4 = 36 20 = US$16 million 0.6 C Site C 4 8. The decision taken is to build the factory at site 20 A fail 30 0.4 As shown crossing in out Figure the 1.7.10, choices this not is indicated taken with on the the decision symbol tree by Figure 1.7 .10. Decision tree – // selection of site A Using a decision tree has benets and Benets A Limitations decision gives ● limitations. a tree: A clear complex answer to a decision is ● decision tree: based on outcomes estimates and of both probabilities of outcomes is ● exible to many and can be applied situations is ● based and is ● simple and so on quantitative ignores data qualitative visually issues attractive. can ● be highly with difcult to complex multiple interrelated draw for decisions outcomes and choices. Fc l ly Force for a eld use in analysis planning tool management and 1. against First, was psychological a the example, for of change change factor may It Lewin’s concept change business designed experiments. businesses. planned a originally in an being be to has by force focus Kurt since eld on Lewin been analysis the as a adopted factors uses model as the working for organization. considered thinking of is highlighted. changing its For logo. Change the logo 85 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 7 1 B u s i n e s s Then the change, tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 2. against o r g a n i z at i o n decision which that makers are Driving Market research consumers current The are e n v i r o n m e n t brainstorm driving change, a n d forces, so-called factors and acting factors restraining positively working for that negatively forces forces reveals tired of Restraining that The the created logo logo founder of the and do has not for 20 logo not the want to Change research reveals of the logo is familiar not New potential are recognize brands gaining innovative 3. The being a reect Market consumers current are each factor eld a weight managers analysis weighting. their costly products the can scale Sometimes, weighting to give is the a corresponding use any from 1 forces simple scale to 5, are visual to they logo with drawn reveals tired of logo a not as a products patented one design would and with picture: that the be protect 5 Restraining The 1 5 and that founder created the of logo not forces the and want business her to family change it been The 20 is new to do has for recognized want, logo changed is good-quality creating for forces research logo The market Although force Driving The gives strongest that the modern then of logo recognition and with the arrows the importance. typically the customers entering manager factor’s to customers logo symbol do it that The 60% family change years loyal Market business her been The changed forces logo is familiar to the 3 2 years loyal customers Change Market research reveals that the 60% do of not potential recognize logo The customers the a logo logo symbol is recognized of as good-quality products New the brands market recognition entering are for gaining The innovative creating 4 and 86 modern products logo a is new patented one and would be 2 costly to design and protect The forces action to are be Restraining Driving In Using this then up. The forces case, = the eld = ● gure indicates O N LY ) the 14 decision analysis would has many be to change benets and the logo. limitations. Limitations eld gives total ( H L 7 Benets Force greatest T O O L S taken. forces force added P L A N N I N G tnemnorivne 4. O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L a analysis: clear difcult Force answer to a eld analysis: involves ● decision interpretations determining which in factors to include ● is exible many and can be applied to situations is ● based value ● is simple and of on estimates each of individual the factor visually attractive. is ● based data, on not mainly qualitative quantitative issues. g ch The Gantt work have chart schedules. multiple determine labour, the key The or the It most deadlines charts It project. on wants to developed is tasks. capital. whole who was commonly It is a use gives Progress of Henry used means efcient also by of of for Gantt as a tool production organizing resources, the project the whole to production whether managers project a can help projects in raw clear be plan that order to materials, overview measured of against (milestones). the following plan the pages production take of a the example new of a music producer CD. 87 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 7 1 B u s i n e s s First the shown tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 1. weeks tasks o r g a n i z at i o n producer in or Table must 1.7.2. months) that need to and be create The the a n d the e n v i r o n m e n t framework horizontal vertical completed axis axis before is is split the by creating measured CD up is into in the nally a matrix, time (days, individual produced. Table 1.7 .2. Gantt char t matrix Tasks 1 Band writes the music for 10 songs 2 Band writes the lyrics for 10 songs 3 Initial recording by the band 4 Full production by the band and other musicians 5 Creation and design of the cover ar twork 6 Production of the completed CDs 7 Production of the online version 8 Promotion of individual songs on radio shows 9 Promotion by interviews and press releases 10 Promotion of the music through concer ts 88 Jan Feb Mar Apr May June July Aug Sept Oct Nov Dec The tasks others by are need shading then not in scheduled. be. parts The of Some order, the time, matrix, as must and follow sequentially sequence shown in P L A N N I N G of Table tasks is T O O L S ( H L O N LY ) but denoted tnemnorivne 2. O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L 1.7.3. Table 1.7 .3. Gantt char t matrix showing timing of tasks Tasks 1 Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun July Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec Band writes the music for 10 songs 2 Band writes the lyrics for 10 songs 3 Initial recording by the band 4 Full production by the band and other musicians 5 Creation and design of the cover ar twork 6 Production of the completed CDs 7 Production of the online version 8 Promotion of individual songs on radio shows 9 Promotion by interviews and press releases 10 Promotion of the music through concer ts 89 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 7 1 B u s i n e s s Once the always tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 3. check schedule check by colours o r g a n i z at i o n the the has been progress marking in Consider for off chart the as example in e n v i r o n m e n t created, as the tasks each a n d as task Table then project time has the is management running. elapses. been team Managers Typically, the do can this manager completed. 1.7.4. Table 1.7 .4. Gantt char t matrix showing progress checks Tasks 1 Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun July Band writes the music for 10 songs 2 Band writes the lyrics for 10 songs 3 Initial recording by the band 4 Full production by the band and other musicians 5 Creation and design of the cover ar twork 6 Production of the completed CDs 7 Production of the online version 8 Promotion of individual songs on radio shows 9 Promotion by interviews and press releases 10 Promotion of the music through concer ts If in the April the project artists are running readjust 90 its plans looks like slightly accordingly. Table 1.7.4, behind the schedule. business The knows business that needs to Aug Sept Oct Nov Dec Using a Gantt chart has many benets O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L and P L A N N I N G T O O L S ( H L O N LY ) limitations: Limitations A A tnemnorivne TOK discussion Benets If business is a human Gantt chart: Gantt chart: enterprise, is it possible to ● gives a clear progress of picture the of current various is ● tasks based timings on of estimates each of the task quantify (express in numerate form) various business scenarios? What role should ● gives a clear picture of the is ● difcult to follow when “human” methods, such overall project applied to very complex as intuition, emotion, and projects ● is exible many and can be applied to “hunches” play in business situations is ● based data, ● is simple ● allows and visually not to plan of resources to quantitative as project in the decision making? data costs) cannot separate out complete interdependent the qualitative the ● use mainly attractive (such managers on most tasks efcient manner. places ● a premium deadlines may lead quality to of on meeting (milestones), erosion the of which the work. The value of these planning tools Each of these However, and be for the borne Also, in each have same tool with depends on is by just other the factors planning different reasons. mind together indicates organizational they All of potential one tools, are tools can not have be useful applied at for a the limitations, business. same which time should users. data, should tools and the available circumstances that uses or managers techniques. and be to the taken way into it and The has should value been account of be used each applied. before using tool Table the 1.7.5 tools. 91 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 7 1 B u s i n e s s o r g a n i z at i o n a n d e n v i r o n m e n t tnemnorivne dna noitasinagro ssenisuB 1 Table 1.7 .5. Factors relating to dierent business analysis tools Tool Fishbone diagram Decision tree Force eld analysis Gantt char t What is its major It is used to help a Senior managers use It is used to facilitate It is used for day- area of focus? business react to it to indicate the most management of to-day project issues that require eective direction change. management by quality improvements from a variety of middle managers but and may involve the options. is open to all to view. whole business. What time frame is It is a shor t-term It is used for medium- It is used for medium- It is used for shor t- involved? response to an to long-term planning to long- term to medium- term identied problem. of future directions. planning of future projects. directions. At what level of Tactical planning Strategic planning Strategic planning Which par t of the Initial – Final – based on as Initial – decision making brainstorming much information as brainstorming Tactical planning planning is it used? process is it used Ongoing possible for? What should it be Quantitative data Qualitative data Quantitative data Which depar tments Mainly production Mainly production should use it? (but it can be used by and marketing Quantitative data used with? All depar tments all depar tments) r chckl ✓ A shbone identify ✓ A diagram underlying decision simplify tree allows provides complex businesses to look closely at problems and causes. a clear decisions and visual structure identify the to most help mangers appropriate outcome. ✓ A force eld focusses ✓ Gantt on charts enable of are the is factors used businesses overview 92 analysis the to used to plan allocate entire to which help might businesses inuence complex resources workow. manage the projects change. planned and schedules. appropriately and It change. give They a clear Production O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L P L A N N I N G T O O L S ( H L O N LY ) Primature Following Inc is a Option factory $3.5m. 1 two – 2 – just in Capacity could invest in growth will be at next of remain asked The outcomes of last six months, facilities. The Primature It is production additional a presently manager on of the costs present by at a 16%. cost of production and resource provide advantages. price and for the it is next can that over in the will economic prot/loss predictions: Option 1 Option line) (new $m 2 Option factory) (no $m strengthens economic Declining a) (i) growth economic Construct options a growth fully increase with the 6 9 4 3 4 3 1 2 1 labelled decision nancial costs tree and showing outcomes Primature for each Using your should working b) Describe c) Evaluate and to IB, of the on benets extent tree, purely support to factors option question May to three nancial choice decision select your of selected (a)(ii). which using decision additional support, for option grounds. Inc’s option. Primature Show or Inc trees. [4 marks] [3 marks] [ 10 marks] non-nancial not Primature marks] full choice. which may decide nancial unit $m [3 (ii) 3 expansion, price) Constant be years. period decline following to constant ve strengthen a wise economic remains the over be in revenues growth will will economic increase growth there the cell convinced forecasts estimates in unit for improved economy believe (new Economy is 40%. not unit average manager cut economic their the of that believes allow human is line capacity factory to would and result clear that 30% these This director is that believe increase designed provided differ production will maximum as it He believe whilst each an be a is before production for extra This exibility by output, 30% of nance maintained. years. an could orders the option constant, growth. in the production capacity. management. Economists those ve of of$I.5m. increased current over its options: production However, improves. 40% cost (JIT) of production building be either increased a increase conditions. its construction new time orders construction future recent of at The in expansion expansion The The additional or increase the 98% building Option The 13% at examining and Inc considering producing tnemnorivne Pcc q Inc support, in your the answer 2008 93 dna noitazinagro ssenisuB 1 1 . 7 2 H u m a n r e s o u r c e m a n a g e m e n t 2.1 The functions and evolution of human resource management tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ Dene human resource planning (workforce planning) ➔ Explain the concept of labour turnover ➔ Identify internal and external factors that inuence human resource planning (such as demographic change, change in labour mobility, new communication technologies) ➔ Outline common steps in the process of recruitment ➔ Dene the following types of training: ➔ ● on the job (including induction and mentoring) ● o the job ● cognitive ● behavioural Dene the following types of appraisal: ● formative ● summative ● 360-degree feedback ● self-appraisal ➔ Outline common steps in the processes of dismissal and redundancy ➔ Describe how work patterns, practices and preferences change and how they aect the employer and employees (such as teleworking, exitime, migration for work) ➔ Explain outsourcing, oshoring and re-shoring as human resource strategies ➔ Evaluate how innovation, ethical considerations and cultural dierences may inuence human resource practices and strategies in an organization Hr ( wkf) pli Human resources resources tertiary 94 (HR) and is are critical especially quaternary for any business. important sectors. for The issue businesses Nevertheless, all of human operating businesses in must the ensure 2 . 1 they have the (the the as they part correct the plan of of of employee director many can that of HR a and or clear HR that and O F that H U M A N those R E S O U R C E employees (which resources M A N A G E M E N T are is be to. referred owner of employees the its that to are in jobs At the same future HR needs as possible increases costs) or too framework referred plan by how continuous rarely With upon for a as This this decided so is suited. estimates businesses, the their employees), productivity). but framework planning properly business of human can a sure employees large written have make hurt their to resources. trained number With be to planning, too document not strive and from plan. likely human properly HR has most may the are (which workforce written types are their type business employees get from Businesses which time, businesses best process. for right E V O L U T I O N effectively. Successful get the A N D as the almost smaller and small to will for how HR to plan always businesses, remain “in few the tnemeganam working F U N C T I O N S be or a the head” business. Lb v Labour a turnover business how in stable Labour a a refers given business turnover is to the time movement period of (usually employees a year) and into is an and out of indicator of is. usually measured by the number of following staff formula: leaving over a year _____ Labour turnover = × 100 average A high labour problems. period of For by may lead turnover, the problems for New the business. some with in they be look the aspect their should can for can to affect employees high hire than remain business that training those the turnover at can who In business if This the lead a year a long business labour which be are source high are can cause expensive. established as addition, has workers may for workers motivation, routines. Even stay has in labour that labour, employees’ and not situation. new and there. labour a do has suggests who When practices employment a are them it in leads high problem otherwise to believe dissatised. anticipate than new workers employed business employment productive work the staff employees Recruitment less in jobs, be their of turnover frequently turnover of reasons, affect must that labour productivity. often High or of business. are higher younger also communicates some Business will may lower suggests high aspect interruption satised that reason some to rate itself, business workers turnover to By dissatisfaction and to some time. dissatised of turnover number certain others. In opportunities employees tend to circumstances a booming since swap jobs jobs when economy, are more labour plentiful. often turnover employees In than tend addition, middle-aged employees. Finally, some rate may and lack ideas, labour indicate of a stable progress. especially if turnover New they can be business, but employees have just good left for a stability tend to college business. can bring or lead A to energy have been low turnover complacency and new retrained and/ 95 ecruoser namuH 2 that T H E 2 H U M A N or reskilled. or who R E S O U R C E Sometimes, M A N A G E M E N T a business has employees of lesser productivity TOK discussion provide make no minimal basis for contributions separation to (being the business red or but sacked). otherwise When a worker To what degree should such as this leaves a business, managers may actually be happy. businesses resist workforce The HR rate is plan kept industry grocery tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 labour see and an the against might any can make which experience expect its its will if but it a experienced or business sure get can try did the rm in a the for the want) would business. of By internal turnover to the fairly not want would factors of its current and available to workforce? pay change the or strengths and weaknesses rate. signicant tracking A high turnover a planning and instead base human resources on the position. Managers labour result correct labour according not lawyers. as the to vary law changes higher outside that requirements (even cashiers, signicant in to level, quickly either the external and among to circumstances rate, designed among turnover turnover skill turnover attention be acceptable chain turnover Labour in at store high close should labour mitigate factors. th il d xl f h i Hr pli Many factors business on the pool business that is can employs of itself inuence labour may already in an someone, organization’s some available change place. for and This is external potential internal shown in HR plan. factors Even can employment. factors Figure before have an Also inuence the a effect the HR plan 2.1.1. technological change government regulation/ laws changes in changes to the business business demographic organization nance change Pool of labour available for social work trends The HR plan state of the economy changes in changes in labour the business reactions strategy changes to education labour mobility External factors can aect the Internal factors can labour pool of potential aect an organization’s employees current hr plan Figure 2.1.1. External and internal factors aecting the HR plan 96 2 . 1 The of external the pool T H E F U N C T I O N S factors of have potential an A N D E V O L U T I O N impact employees for on the the O F size H U M A N and business R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T availability and include the following: more improvements, make ● Government potential equality disability. or just the to or of a pool a of the an or easier laws issues of lead transport or links, than can issues, gender, obligations can before. inuence regulations age, to government can contractual ageing and such population, external changes available and available levels Labour which to can a affect such as ethnicity, as or pension reduced migration that can their have specic fertility patterns an are impact on Recent technological change has meant that more people in cer tain sectors can work from home requirements refer labour case, – opposite may a accept would direct relevant is can boom consequently demography. have role of women families, balance” economic and some the all or the have pool. an the so as parent effect lower as consider on range lead to more to a strain increased unemployed wages. changes Regardless, impact the will lead the and rising in or suitability type of levels falling of labour courses or the – many either to factors geographical mobility can occupational of mobility the inuence mobility labour (changing workforce mobility, (changing locations). signicantly In affects the pool. internal impact have – such single students. occupations) either labour and of of “work–life available Also mobility can the will factor employment. society, the education a in economy labour available in education ● – number in on recession education for the leisure of are Changes the hours irrespective internal changes in of state the workers of – rise The wages; an in safety can Infrastructural away government demographic impacts The changes determine employees trends society, on ● other further and ICT retirement. in signicant of or in home. work. importance ● of change the potential Social in ● age – or working generally changes some Laws from roads from health workplace Demographic rates, ● the Laws provisions new regulations regarding weekly in as improvements working someone workforce. maximum – and such employing regulations ● change teleworking tnemeganam Technological on factors the stem current from HR within plan, the which business may have itself to and change will as a have result following: Changes they are in business organized reorganization can to organization better affect meet the – their current businesses strategic HR plan. change the objectives. way Any Organizational 97 ecruoser namuH 2 ● 2 H U M A N ● R E S O U R C E changes affecting acquires another Changes in labour chooses unionize, of a with union more the tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 circumstances Changes in to ● in also – labour on example, the when relations planning. the requirements other workers. occur a business acquired. the business of the hand, Either If will have If have the business the a force now union. the way, can labour may long-term to power have labour change. in in can is strategy the market business – whether or to strategy the may in response business well to changes re-orientating lead to amendments plan. business limited factors in business will have resources salaries, can for business changes the Changes which can a nance bearing may can have inuence signicant of will or workforce work with circumstances itself, on decreases, exibility plan relations impact to HR business signicant contend ● the M A N A G E M E N T not affect an increase be in the the able nancial HR to as well. resources the and the may situation A Other pension current a that wages retention. allow of business highest Unfunded for protability plan. pay recruitment impact available – on nancial liabilities workforce, for a has and greater or a number staff. th Hr ( wkf) pl There path ● are as parts to employee recruitment right ● four the – the HR plan, progresses how the in which the business follow an individual’s recruits the right person – how the business professional development, professional development ● appraisal how ● termination situation – or when the leaves employee is of red ensures whether employee’s dismissal the employee – job how leaves, his own for her cause or is employees training performance the employee or that initial business whether free will) or is receive 98 the evaluated manages stage of ● identication ● application ● selection. the HR plan can split into (the involuntarily retrenched). be the voluntarily or three proper ongoing The processes of recruitment rst for job training The career business: parts: (the 2 . 1 T H E F U N C T I O N S A N D E V O L U T I O N O F H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Identication The business realizes that it needs a new employee because of a change in its internal factors. Job description This gives details about the job, such as: the job title ● what the employee will have to do ● the employee’s responsibilities. This gives details about the type of person required to do the job, such as: ● the skills required to do the job ● the qualications necessary ● what experience is necessary. Internal or ex ternal The business has to weigh up the advantages of recruiting internally by promotion (or recruitment redeployment), such as it being: ● cheaper ● quicker ● more ecient as the person would know how the business works. tnemeganam Person specication ● It then has to weigh up the advantages against the disadvantages. For example, recruiting internally: ● limits the pool of potential candidates ● may cause resentment ● causes the “domino” eect as the person promoted would leave a vacancy to be lled, and so on down the hierarchy. Searching externally would be the reverse of all of the above. The application process Application The business has to decide how to nd the best applicants for the job. Job ad ver t The business will need to consider: ● where to place the adver t so it is seen by the right people ● what should be included in the adver t so the applicants have sucient information ● the legal requirements that have to be met. Application form What is the most appropriate tool to process the applications? Every tool should include or résumé (CV) the same elements (personal details, skills and qualications, work experience, interests and hobbies, and references) but application forms are: ● standardized (so they are useful for jobs with lots of possible applicants) ● designed specically to match the job requirements ● focused on the issues that the business wants ● legally binding. However, a résumé (CV): ● is better for jobs with limited applicants (such as senior posts) ● is more personal and can reveal more about the applicant ● can be more exible ● is quicker as it can be prepared beforehand. 99 ecruoser namuH 2 The identication process 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Internal or ex ternal agency The business has to weigh up the advantages of nding the best applicants internally by using its HR depar tment, such as it being: ● cheaper ● quicker ● more ecient as the HR depar tment will know precisely what the business requires. It then has to weigh up the advantages against the disadvantages. For example, using tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 its HR depar tment: limits the pool of potential candidates; agencies may have plenty more applicants ● in their databases ● may cause a lack of focus in other areas ● may not cater for specialist skills, in contrast with an agency, for example that specializes in administrative vacancies. The selection process Selection The nal par t of the process of recruitment is the selection of the best applicant for the job. Shor tlisting The business will have to discard many applicants on the basis of: Testing ● their overall quality ● how many are required for interview ● any legal requirements that have to be taken into account. Many businesses like to subject the shor tlisted applicants to some form of test, to be used as a complement to the nal interview. These tests can be: aptitude (task-oriented activities, designed to test understanding and application of ● theories or concepts) psychometric (personality questionnaires, designed to test reasoning skills and ● personality traits) team based (exercises designed to focus on the qualities necessary for working in ● project teams). Inter views The interview is the nal par t of the recruitment process and there is no one best style of interview. It will depend on circumstances but may include the following: ● face to face (one to one) ● panel (with more than one person) ● video conference (or telephone) ● multi-stage (one interview leads to another) ● multi-day (conducted over a number of days). Training The second stage professional the latest career from 100 ideas path losing of the HR development. by a and technologies. being skill plan, reskilled. that training, Training they It can may Training had can keep lead to might learned help the an employee’s employee the even previously up employee prevent – to date nding the deskilling. with a new employee 2 . 1 training ● improve ● lead ● motivate ● reduce some time quality greater the Training of the for a business. O F It H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T can: work employee labour to important E V O L U T I O N productivity turnover. countries off also A N D a full-time worker has the right to be allowed to take train. can take many forms, including the tnemeganam In to the is F U N C T I O N S following: On-the-job training is often led by an Induction ● – training that focuses on making a new employee experienced employee familiar with authority (who programme that the they their to can to begin – normal business to, ensure work when job. the report helps On-the-job ● way for example). that new straight employees Often functions and A with good employees lines of induction settle in quickly so away. are on-the-job trained while training they occurs are Student workpoint 2.1 doing through Be a thinker mentoring, employee which being training is another to is when trained. shadowing, learn a an Another when new experienced employee common one type employee of guides the A on-the-job follows, or “shadows”, in new restaurant your local expensive skill. food highly-trained Off-the-job ● – when the employee is given time off from work training away from the job. That training may be a or course run by consultants, agencies, or of Today, their many managers employer. In light choose of the to earn an importance The a well-known restaurant waiters MBA with a is advertising of job and waitresses. description for Draw this the role, support and sell by educational up institutions. will cooked workshop, for conference, opening It to chef. attend is town. education including a detailed person in specication. contemporary courses at required post-industrial local of employees universities, the employees gain a better – economies, even if the businesses many employers coursework just want to is not see pay for otherwise Once about their you have how description education. nished, you’d to change suit a busy think the fast job food restaurant. Another but way rather to what think the learning discrete forms training of ● of training aspect of or the training the employees – which is Rather, and processing skills. thinking and processing skills Behavioural does not helps with on employees Behavioural and emotional more training focus others) teams and and to not is. how and Most enhance in other where often, job ways. it occurs, training is about performance. These other Other forms following: business. quicker is training knowledge enhance training the of thinking make ● skills include Cognitive about aim a – develop The (that like positions of intelligence useful is, stress on a particular develop that their with skills), enhanced they can decisions. skills for is cognitive of training, the (how to employees by behavioural business. interpersonal leadership or focused assumption aspect their not employees cognitive intrapersonal is helps effective particular training training it skills Instead (how manage working concentrating they training it work emotions). in on, project for example, management. 101 ecruoser namuH 2 However, T H E 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Appraisal The third stage performance Appraisal know as is of of different opportunity tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 in a a initiate, from tends of of constructive in Appraisal and make the when to of did is the meet may to a a the employee). the failed observations. given negative to do, or the targets. respond and positive be to review review their not on has two-way, foster on is manager focuses not employee managers based employee supposed supportive (from employees order occurs employee process the employee is (the top–down what form inspection, judgments Communication feedback environment. – of one-way and which traditional system and the appraisal, reviewed. more a appraisal, discussion. is is inspection, which system a be performance with judgmental to respond) system of frequency Under to plan Under performances Communication indicators HR employee inspection. employees’ Often, the the to, or even managers and include inclusive non-threatening, working non- process. Benets of appraisal For an employee, ● be motivating ● be instructive from ● help past appraisal – employees For can learn lead act well. ● a progress are stabbing” ● order not to along be ● help ● be their or look better employees appraisal to the In be rather Appraisals has and to be the positive than on role of out those overall, is to on review useful to can: performance new record initiatives and performance of an the which honest Everyone areas of promotion. for their focus be systems. failure of to perform. Linking appraisal. paperwork. or having line the is process time on discrete accomplishments exchange be of views. should Though strength “back performances in name issues. involved should or performance of done Linking positive. essence minimal may them. some be forms formally atmosphere. disciplinary to it performance. when behaviour, positions poisonous whole substantive around a supposed puts especially as good characteristics: others’ from the motivating mercenary punished documenting it or to and require conversations about pay numerous more provide be destroys many transparent. conversations 102 ll certain sabotage to hand, consuming, lead separate have addition, accomplishments, to can to systems excessively consuming. ● are other employees managers only, check recognizes have themselves), punishment appraisal Having try time to linked people systems on and tend promotion Sometimes Good a document direction. costly systems Appraisal Appraisal, ● career directly pay (when to in can appraisal appraisal in change systems Good They as appraisal path to Appraisal business, ● ● ● the mistakes employees career can: appraisal honest, and know areas Appraisal their should with role be appropriate needing improvement. systems Formative ● often an it is – a had because have a set judgment of assessment and 360 ● A degree to the and at not the also in R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T be a learning performance typically run in employees on process, during a one-to- feedback which they improve. when have This type of employee. employee’s sums a and to each failed. against a making clear how Summative contract, or an appraisal a specic termination. employee four of Summative summative) appraisal between according element skills standards. lead provides an or (thus, project, performance performance has passed up the of necessarily from to areas knowledge end H U M A N employees assessment against method receive but help then the is O F appraisal: evaluate giving also an of intended to employee employees’ this to manager is “forms” performed – on and measures should is Appraisal is summative conducted opportunity line well idea markers Failure work. E V O L U T I O N methods approach whether has usually goal. this tests explicit employee is – standards. these focus done The A N D appraisal at The presumably Summative to time difculties. appraisal include continuous cycle. appraisees ● may employee’s three-year F U N C T I O N S tnemeganam Appraisal T H E to not eight with only the from their co-workers, customer/ subordinates and even customers or clients. This method involves manager client an element multiple CEOs upward perspectives. and several of other groups appraisal The 360-degree executives of and who stakeholders serve (see is the most appraisal and Figure is complex, often interact having used directly with with 2.1.2). Appraisee Self-appraisal ● processes of which this is reection or it can done can during be also used the on suggest strengths, the part reect with themselves accomplishments, faced important employees is rate employees problems an above individual employees Typically, their this outlined appraisal, Usually – of the by on help itself. their of various their a time With own this method self-appraisal training and appraisal performance. performance weaknesses, relevant performance needs, any form on indicators. and subordinate co-worker discuss potential period. Figure 2.1.2. 360-degree appraisal Termination, dismissal, and redundancy The nal This stage situation in the might ● the employee ● the business ● both best Good of For HR plan of to that and both will to is when an employee leaves the business. because: leave the the the business employee employee should agree no that longer work separation is there in the parties. have a minimize set of the procedures impact of ready losing to deal employees with and this part acquiring ones. several happen ● employer interests plan chooses decides businesses the new the HR happen As too reasons, termination of a business relationship does not often: employees develop replacing them reluctant to go more increases through skills and considerably the whole HR experience, and so the cost businesses process of are very again. 103 ecruoser namuH 2 2 . 1 2 H U M A N ● Many of R E S O U R C E businesses recession, workers go” business ● Finally, only to tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 business such the have and to Nevertheless, on have the can from as redeployment, hours re-employ rights. it basis one to of If could of a rather them business face “unfair legal than (or or, in having other time, three breaks action dismissal”. additionally, dismissed time in to result, unfairly occur policies working times to people) “let when again. unnecessarily, expensive can up employees ex-employee which prefer reducing picks contracts M A N A G E M E N T in employment initiated Court damages by cases paid by the are the employees. an employee has to leave a business, ways. Termination Employees contract can for a ● change ● professional ● promotion ● retirement ● lifestyle ● family These to of “terminate” variety in the business at the end of their including: development reasons. to employees their leave choice their according or reasons, career employees use of would search country, should resignation their some be to receive new industry, give will expect for and job. the advance a reference Though the from the practice level of the notice to their employer varies employee, employer in general of when effective. Dismissal Dismissal their is when contract. employee reasons ● continually ● poor discipline ● drug or alcohol ● theft or dishonesty. Employees the ● a conviction ● an ● refusal of unresolvable to their accept an be dismissed employment when the for employment. broken one (or more) of the terms of include: work sometimes occur image has may abuse under circumstances harm missing may performance 104 an The an employee business, offence personality a which or company for reasons contract. has may other Generally, done than non- these something that might be: imprisonment clash with a co-worker reorganization that changes the terms of employees reference. a length a of so bad property fears of commonly the the business the business). the they a to example, may some dismissals (either damage not actual take a to continue can physical computer receive to or will a (for that do takes when the damage damage or, are or M A N A G E M E N T notice”– which happen systems) les of work dismissal”, also R E S O U R C E employees dismissal les H U M A N “period instances, facing computer O F expect receive “summary employee business (for would In face Summary that today, when they E V O L U T I O N should notice”). that immediately. employer time A N D they employees “two-week something effect dismissed, However, specied example are F U N C T I O N S the more steal the from property of tnemeganam If T H E Redundancy Redundancy an may employee, drop in ● a ● changing ● a ● restructuring ● the business ● the job done demand market by a restructure ● a merger these their would to (one the business no longer has any work for include: business’s products industry becoming has the or or insolvent been or doing introducies bankrupt being new replaced by technology mechanization (i.e. the job can be reorganization because (that is, of employees their expect The the month’s to amount country with business the business takeover. normally been of of cases, own reference. country be the a may machine) ● has for employer relocation of when which circumstances someone the ● of for recession when In happen causes and receive of by for the lost a the every is their not year of the through for the longer employment, and can redundancy or no fault “cause”), payment payment Typically, greater job ended redundancy redundancy industry. business, pay have employment a vary an they letter from employee payment some will other formula). When a large employees have ● two to number retain options Voluntary it reduces With made the lose stress They prefer to it – made for redundant, managers. typically, animosity approach, They will with employees would and receive which problem are difcult redundancy the voluntary reference, positions be They deciding would which normally offer: redundant. anyway. The to of can the may the some have them voluntary prefer is in the the to may look payment their efforts approach to preferred decision employees wanted redundancy help would this that retain or is and that retain a a get the as generate. choose for to option can to be new job letter of a new job. business employees may it lose. 105 ecruoser namuH 2 2 . 1 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E Involuntary ● than on the age, other redundancy voluntary years constrained form approach employees of by of is M A N A G E M E N T service, a some labour that will – option. the this approach Involuntary or some type of other leave based the can upon with benet have the typically criterion agreement agreement, business is redundancy criteria. it based If not unions the involuntary inuence criteria desirable be the of more or less may or over some which selects. tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 ch i wk p, pi, d pf Over the past employees Some the to of these pool want of a respond Some of the of the For in have of internal the new factors the and external many affecting employers practices, trends employees. factors work affect from social balance their that patterns, stemmed have and factors led social businesses, affecting many businesses Other and preferences. are employees trying trends which to have can benet practices. changing and changes work example, work–life desires privatization ● many changes from some years, occurred labour. better to stemmed from 50 have the move working away environment from public-sector include: to private-sector employment increased ● and migration across ● increasing ● changing ● increasing ● an ageing the of potential employees in a country or region globe participation educational females in the workforce opportunities urbanization population of and and the consequent increasing rise average in age stress of the levels workforce. Changes in work patterns One by change has businesses the results selected of as been well some in as the the opinion patterns types polls of of work jobs – the people analyzing the types want. most of jobs Table required 2.1.1 sought-after shows jobs in countries. Table 2.1.1. The ten most sought-after jobs in selected countries in 2013 US A India Singapore South Africa El Salvador 1 Actuary IT personnel Financial adviser Engineer Skilled labour 2 Bio-medical engineer Retail sta Electronics Driver Sales agent specialist 3 Software engineer Healthcare worker Engineer Skilled Technician tradesperson 4 Audiologist Hospitality sta IT personnel 5 Financial planner Engineer Media personnel Labourer Manager/ executive 106 Engineer Bilingual administration sta T H E F U N C T I O N S A N D E V O L U T I O N O F H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T US A India Singapore South Africa El Salvador 6 Dentist HR personnel Accountant Teacher Manager 7 Occupational therapist Aviation personnel Actuary Legal sta Driver 8 Optometrist Psychologist Retail worker Secretary/PA Mechanic 9 Physical therapist Financial adviser Proper ty agent Technician Logistics personnel Computer systems Teacher Brand manager Accountant Accountant 10 Table 2.1.2 United One shows States, the based signicant ten on change least a sought-after recent that opinion has jobs in 2013 in the Table 2.1.2. The ten least sought-after poll. happened, tnemeganam analyst jobs in 2013 in the United States especially with the US A 2013 improvements geographical determine of Traditional will mail and then seek Similarly, positions skills. of of For for letter acquire is both pharmacists or which are or skills common re g io ns than wi t h a nd che fs. which the and in those match s ho rt a g e s B e lg iu m , need online in of for t he Lumberjack 3 Military personnel 4 Actor 5 Oil rig worker 6 Dairy farmer 7 Meter reader 8 Mail carrier 9 Roofer 10 Flight attendant for bill are growing Thus, eras. s e ek in g p eo pl e wi t h e xa m p le , h ave ICT 2 contracting pe opl e c ou n t ri e s Be fo re number positions. earlier News repor ter contracting. occupations for 1 to the are individuals to Man y pro fe ss io na l s . for banking which and individuals decreasing op por tuni t ie s a nd for occupations other learn Kingd om nur s e s occupational easier electronic to in occupations necessary more ICT – carriers, p r o vi de s and much and easily Uni te d increase example, the countr i e s The is – email, relatively also an occupations mobility with it expanding services, to ICT shortages of is been Today because it occupational certain be services. professions, has mobility. carriers payment ICT, “growing” positions letter in h a ve s h or t ag e s re vol u t io n, Source: http://www.careercast.com/ matching skilled pe o p l e to pl ace s whe re t h ey we re n ee de d was va s t ly jobs-rated/worst-jobs-2013 more data challenging (who has geographic that an tha n wha t regions ) . information. interactive it is s k il ls to da y. and T he n, wha t I CT R e ce ntl y, sch e ma ti c I CT s ki ll s a ll ow s B BC Ne w s s howi ng a ll ow s a re for an t ype s fa s t e r ne e de d e a si er ra n what fo r in tha t sk il le d of pa rt i c u l ar dis s em i na t i on ar t i c le of pr oc e s si n g of c on t a in e d Student workpoint 2.2 e m pl oye e s 1 different that countrie s many people ne e de d . are A result mi g ra ting of this be cau s e of im p r o v e d infor mati on is wor k. Changes in work practices Be reective Look at 2.1.1 and surprise are Not only have the types of jobs the changed. The nature of work changed as businesses have responded to greater likely working to listed Do What in any tables results factors inuence people’s routines demands for Do you think money is more the exible 2.1.2. you? opinions? has jobs only consideration? practices. Work practices in decline Full-time work When week 35 employees accepted hours Permanent An contracts without a week employee a by work law in who the (for maximum example, hours per working Europe). has been predetermined hired time for a position limit. 1 http://www.bbc.co.uk/news/business-21938085 107 ecruoser namuH 2 2 . 1 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Work practices on the increase Student workpoint Part-time When employees work weekly work maximum less than the 2.3 full-time hours. Be an inquirer Talk Temporary Work that is temporary leave). a xed-term nature The tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 agency on (for employee who nds contract example, would work for to usually cover normally the of a maternity sign up to to know an employee. and Freelance When someone who different is self-employed employers at the works same Work taking place from telecommunication would to Homeworking work When the he at an the has When the at an on a own have work dress at the hours from have work work? remainder works would to the of a employee he or from home. core the she in does work the xed? has work of a Are hours similar these Where do per hours they from? home. Usually number ofce, – for a Usually number ofce, involving would Fridays centre. or ways work nd of hours remainder home. employee’s Casual core employee she Work to a employee or from Flexitime have home their you time. number Teleworking can the they everyone several parents about What about which you teachers, friends work. out people – a set core the ofce; Friday so the is of of rest it is the hours is allowed that hours Usually number employee a number choosing. up to to to an employee he or the wear easier of she employee. less go has formal away at weekends. Three-day Instead weekend employee of works working, three-day weekend. say, four ve days days of ten of eight hours hours, and so the has a yduts esaC Wk-lif bl i F In 2000, the French government reduced the statutory temptation to look at work-related material on their working week from 39 hours to 35 hours. Now, under computers or phone–during their free time. Companies a new deal, French employers’ federations and unions must ensure that their employees come under no have signed a legally binding labour agreement that pressure to do so. requires employers to make sure sta “disconnect” outside of working hours. Exam-style questions The deal, which aects around 250,000 employees Explain the impact on a) employers and in the technology and consultancy sectors (including b) employees of this new change. [6 marks] the French sectors of Google, Facebook , Deloitte and Discuss the impact this change might have PwC), means that employees will have to resist the on the culture of businesses in France. 108 [8 marks] 2 . 1 T H E F U N C T I O N S A N D E V O L U T I O N O F H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Changes in work preferences of business, working many changing lifestyles. Career ● usually same c a r e e r. take These breaks time, to continuously employees the a – an year are are for now some 20 of employee or more, Sometimes employee the back to 30 adapting the most decides before the for the work to stop to – this to suit methods: working work formalizes break same routines common returning employer after years their this is for in a the and agrees known as a Job ● free share up – two more Downshifting ● – paid employment eld or Study ● or time new area of leave – more for an in employees other to share a job in order to activities. employee order decide tnemeganam “sabbatical”. to gives up change a senior career into position another or highly lower-paid interest. an qualication employee such as is an granted time off work to acquire a MBA. oi d hi Hr i HR costs based can businesses in work and One signicant have a has out operations employ as Imagine design, shown therefore a been many focus their or HR particularly quaternary plans preferences. Outsourcing on In to match doing for service- sectors. so, the they Many changes cut costs its core (also known occurs when activities. This as a subcontracting business way, it or cuts back not need does on to workers. smartphone Figure adapted and businesses, tertiary advantage. company manufacturing, in many the outsourcing work). to in practices, competitive method for operating patterns, gain contracting its be businesses and with current distribution of annual US$42 salary million costs per for year, as 2.1.3. Design team (50 workers) with an annual salary bill of US$2 million Manufacturing (1,000 workers) with an annual salary bill of US$25 million Design team (50 workers) Distribution (500 workers) with an annual salary bill with an annual salary bill of US$2 million of US$15 million Figure 2.1.4. Smar tphone manufacturer Figure 2.1.3. Smar tphone manufacturer before using outsourcing However, it would if the have business US$40 were million to outsource available, as manufacturing shown in Figure and after using outsourcing distribution, 2.1.4. 109 ecruoser namuH 2 Instead 2 H U M A N Although the to the work, be R E S O U R C E it business could specialists have fewer expertise cut in M A N A G E M E N T would costs either smartphone so would business to doing pay this. manufacturing inefciencies and have by and most doing greater likely the subcontractors The or distribution. productivity charge work to complete subcontractors less in than are They these the probably areas cost likely of of the ETHICS It is easy to say that, because production costs are cheaper elsewhere, then production should be moved oshore. itself. But there are many ethical In addition to the lower production costs (which can in 3), be calculated implications for businesses to by the cost to buy/cost to make formulas Unit the smartphone consider. Think about the people tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 business other p a y, not costs of and are thumb”, saves on employing pensions, employees of only wage people. other bill. that expensive. benefits are It will Medical, benefits extremely these its also m a t e r n i t y, businesses In typically save the to and provide United equal on per the holiday to States, 50 all full-time as cent a of “rule an in the original location, and the people in the ‘oshore’ location – what eect will o-shoring have on them? Hold a debate arguing for and against oshoring for a business of your choice. e m p l o y e e ’s than the US$40 significant the cost million savings. of the cost wage bill. m o n e y. N o w, it can saving By The focus is likely to outsourcing, benefit on its to the core be even the business business activity greater – is saves not just designing products. extension outsources of outsourcing outside communication, business Thus, amounts innovative An s a l a r y. its home offshoring environment. is offshoring : c o u n t r y. has been Businesses Wi t h a when growth take a business improved area advantage global in of the the modern huge Key terms wage Outsourcing differences areas of have the been where between world. Many offshored wages fluently workers and are wages are to the customer from high, doing the far service United India, same job call Kingdom where many but in centres, and the people different for example, United speak States, English when a business subcontracts a process, such a manufacturing or packaging, to another business or l o w e r. organization Why offshoring? Simple Oshoring mathematics is often the outsourcing a process or answer: service to another country in ● In the USA, an architect might be paid $3,000 a month. An order to reduce costs architect ● A Java and Philippines $5,000 outsourcing, earns would get $60,000 annually businesses in a around year in £250 the a month. United States India. can cut their operational costs by percent. British every the programmer makes Through 20–40 in Airways 1,000 calculates jobs it that relocates to it saves US$23 million a year for India. Adapted from http://www.economist.com/media/globalexecutive/outsourcing_ revolution_e_02.pdf Examples of typical ● in marketing, ● in operations business using an functions that advertising management , can be outsourced agency licensing a producer to make product 110 ● in HR, employing ● in nance, hiring an agency to accountants “headhunt” to include: run an potential external staff audit. your 2 . 1 T H E F U N C T I O N S A N D E V O L U T I O N O F H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T th ip f ivi, hil idi, d ll di Innovation, have an ethical impact on considerations, the HR plan and and cross-cultural the business’s differences ability to can also implement it successfully. or HR business plan. strategic come A focus from unless it its on recruits stimulating will help the business creative this than The and as any retains creative such inertia to – will the can being other business business have business right a major innovative not be – a impact must function. part of a the greater innovative Developing vital on have Innovations successfully people. environment a HR supportive planning – process. Google individuals. – committed HR people. and A opposite tnemeganam Innovation The prides Google itself on ofce being shown innovative in Figure and 2.1.5 employing reects approach. Figure 2.1.5. One of Google’s oces Ethical considerations A strong ethical reected should so. connection behaviour. in the With the information. employees a result, the way businesses least that Internet, Social treated create always plans treat are the their people network badly businesses to has HR have that can to existed based business between on treats employees have sites, tell be in its ability particular, careful how to planning act today to can they in which employees. ethically, greater other HR relationships, send be have an it Not must and places been ethical and are only do receive where treated. manner – As or at appearance. 111 ecruoser namuH 2 Innovation 2 H U M A N Ethical in R E S O U R C E issues Figure that might M A N A G E M E N T be addressed through the HR plan can be seen 2.1.6. Performance appraisal Salaries and Right to privacy tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 nancial renumeration Lay-os Ethical Health & and/or issues in safety redundancies the HR plan Discrimination Restructuring Employment Figure 2.1.6. Ethical issues in the HR plan One example intersected in the banking perception excessive by their very of with how improved ethical sector. emerged salaries Through that and angry nancial about this packages to some other performance. information considerations the news and executives forms Many of As executives of a the in result, many contemporary executive other were nancial stakeholders situation. in involved forms awarding rewards the many has of ICT, a themselves not banking era compensation matched sector changes got occurred in banks. Cultural dierences Cultural plan for differences any businesses in workers. as varied of diverse the country. workforce. a include Many of workers Businesses many if businesses countries up adapt more effect multicultural multinational grow that are especially signicant a domestic citizenry workforce workforce, have employs naturally migrant cultural also that countries. Lastly, children adopted 112 would different can business as their to also is HR be markets the businesses citizens their likely on Such operating employ migrant increasingly in plan their to as diverse, parents’ suit successful are HR workforce. a more with diverse as a their 2 . 1 In the affect HR the T H E context, cultural F U N C T I O N S Figure 2.1.7 A N D E V O L U T I O N highlights expectations of a some business’s of O F H U M A N the R E S O U R C E factors that M A N A G E M E N T might employees. Power distance Dress tnemeganam Body Masculinity language Cultural dierences Personal Uncer tainty space avoidance Long-term Humour orientation Figure 2.1.7 . Cultural dierences in the HR plan The concept indicate the According power a low this the to Training would are score axis and to misunderstanding It can also important creativity. When help and of a the and diverse novel of society opposite. that take a are have perspectives will be Table to can of see are the parts from of potential differences. most innovation problem the countries scores cultural of gathered increases of decision expectations. from a in 2.1.3. reduce one level from different increased people high example in from emerge workforce: a included different workforces can and Some people backgrounds solution Hofstede Employees shown advantage when Geert with consulted authority. shows, to different be (PDI) diverse occurs diversity from of by inequality. cultures friction businesses from successful in developed of to the index different work benets problems, expect difference Innovation people expect accepting distance of was society employees more from people by not would power one world distance Hofstede, They Hofstede’s As power distance making. with of acceptance and and solve together likelihood to it. solve that a found. 113 ecruoser namuH 2 Individualism 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Table 2.1.3. PDI scores for selected countries tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 Country PDI Country PDI Malaysia 104 Spain 57 Panama 95 Pakistan 55 Philippines 94 Japan 54 Mexico 81 Italy 50 China 80 Argentina 49 Egypt 80 South Africa 49 Saudi Arabia 80 Hungary 46 Ecuador 78 United States 40 Indonesia 78 Netherlands 38 India 77 Australia 36 Singapore 74 Costa Rica 35 Brazil 69 Germany 35 France 68 United Kingdom 35 Hong Kong 68 Switzerland 34 Thailand 64 Finland 33 Zambia 64 Norway 31 Chile 63 Sweden 31 Por tugal 63 Ireland 28 Uruguay 61 New Zealand 22 Greece 60 Denmark 18 South Korea 60 Israel 13 Iran 58 Austria 11 Taiwan 58 Source: http://www.clearlycultural.com/geer t-hofstede-cultural- dimensions/power-distance-index/ 114 2 . 1 T H E F U N C T I O N S A N D E V O L U T I O N O F H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T rvii hkli resource selected, ✓ Labour Human The over a most the ✓ ✓ by Off-the-job of can to ensure most of that effective employees employees are way. in and out of a time. be inuences by both internal and steps in application an takes the and place experienced process of recruitment are selection. as part of employee day-to-day who can work. act as a It is mentor to training allows employees time off work to attend training. Cognitive training but helps Behavioural Appraisals formative, Employees is not helps a leave and given summative, 360 a to on a particular develop employees employees during may focussed employees training allow performance ✓ the movement period planning training led business ✓ the strategy in trainee. external ✓ is common On-the-job usually a factors. identication, ✓ is developed given resource external ✓ planning and turnover business ✓ used tnemeganam Human their business and due of the skills. interpersonal employers The aspect thinking develop timeframe. degree their to main skills. review methods are: self-appraisal. to termination, dismissal or redundancy. ✓ As working had ✓ to practices adapt Outsourcing to carry out their and HR occurs certain patterns have changed, businesses have strategies. when organizations functions, allowing contract them to other organizations concentrate on core activities. ✓ Offshoring perhaps is when because functions labour is are outsourced cheaper or to another production is country, quicker. 115 ecruoser namuH 2 ✓ 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Pi qi Dome Today, such the 13 as 000 of nurses tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 The States who as the Hospital trained in Ghana a to agencies vacancies. ight Hospital working in They the non-nancial of Hospital to changes has in UK Kingdom has saved Ghanaian similar amount African (UK), millions ones. in of The training countries Canada US$ and in the government the same UK. by Given also and offer workforce these shortages demographic severe have difculty tried nurses have set of of a to up improved payment conducted and for a in in countries changes, recruiting number come web pay moving job has has of back site and Dome locally different home. to They attract working expenses. enrichment to primary been is Afua developed guidance and approached which nurses. on to conditions, Dome schemes have nurses to Hospital is increase law by is reduce the Afua a Ghanaian have nurses encountered a lack non-governmental about determined to with they Afua, concerned countries. has that promotion. recruitment however, research discovered experience (NGO), Afua, nancial Ghana Ghanaian international and funding. in and UK retain developing advice sub-Saharan motivation. the organization ability a driven introduction opportunities Dome is events home considering Dome the UK. in United recruiting spent in the experiencing encourage recruitment free by the nurses. methods ll had the is trained Recently, nurses and were Australia, nurses work of US Recruitment used UK now who in (US). however, migration such Ghana work training Ghana, in nurses Ghana United cost of Hospital to and mobility will and Ghanaian help probably retention, considerable of is nurses offer but knowledge hospitals’ calling not of for from Dome Hospital direct other NGOs with resources. [Source: adapted from http://www.medicalnewstoday.com/ar ticles/98545.php, 21 September 2009] a) b) Dene Explain use c) to term two the Discuss 116 May research. non-nancial rewards Ghanaian likely benets nurses for that to Dome Dome stay in Hospital Hospital the advantages 2011 strategy. and disadvantages [2 marks] [6 marks] [5 marks] [7 marks] could Ghana. of support. recruitment IB, primary encourage Analyse Afua’s d) the of Dome Hospital’s 2.2 Organi zational structure By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: tnemeganam dierent types of organizational structures: ● delegation ● span of control ● levels of hierarchy ● chain of command ● bureaucracy ● centralization ● decentralization ● de-layering Describe the following types of organization char ts: ➔ ● at/horizontal ● tall/ver tical ● hierarchical ● by product ● by function ● by region Explain changes in organizational structures (such as project-based ➔ organization, Handy’s “Shamrock Organization”) Describe how cultural dierences and innovation in communication ➔ technologies may impact on communication in an organization Even have the it the most some business must is of to develop organization. and chaotic sense formal in When plan the of a with roles, a more and business clearly organizational responsibilities individuals start-ups survive. a An of organization, as well the formally as one succeeds outlining structure business, than owner responsibilities, the and least grows, structure of represents reporting must at the the lines if then roles between business. oizil h The is most formal in common through an roles, Figure form of presenting organizational responsibilities, chart and – the a structure diagram reporting lines. of that An an organization outlines example the is given 2.2.1. 117 ecruoser namuH 2 Dene the following terminology to facilitate understanding of ➔ 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T CEO PA (to CEO) Production Marketing Finance HR Administration executive executive executive executive executive Assistant 2 Assistant 1 tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 Assistant 1 Assistant 2 Assistant Assistant 1 Assistant 2 Junior Figure 2.2.1. An organizational char t for a business Terminology Figure A few 2.2.1 shows terms help organizational Levels ● of senior, hierarchy Each the level Note that CEO of of someone from to of often the the Note be ● the one Span this how business. in many indicates four (CEO), line and to level case, ofcer assistant This an levels to the a levels level range most of of from most junior, the department. managers who the to – (PA) to bear for and – people who responsibility as is that would junior pass executive the formal In in to this the not a have for the Other route chain: marketing made types by which Traditionally, case, in manager by of – the staff staff. and if a decision decisions are the marketing the included staff decision downwards through then a is as decision. organization. commands. the CEO known administrative organization with the is communicate this the to employee secretarial PA the outside to control are managers CEO included such is typically of whom 118 In refers Each marketing authority of subordinates of a CEO wants department, from assistant the 1, travel therefore CEO and to then to the nally to junior. that the term responsibility referred message this business. indicates through top – the command marketing for structure decisions. be communicate the chart organizational decisions personal travel the in make the a executive hierarchy. could Chain organizational the business. chief those without must the in hierarchy with managers ● of the levels are working authority outcomes the in the “junior” typical chart: responsibility seniority a describe as is – the the PA. Span directly are ve. in the chain communicate control under the responsible Note span of of the of and but of course would message. refers to how authority for. various control command the In this many a case, assistants nor of and would be manager the span the any and of junior staff control are not manager Assistant 1 Assistant 2 2 . 2 following though Delegation a particular of that – this decision. likely has narrow a major have key – a how a the of control high an organization manager with the control usually is structured chart: gives responsibility managers of can rarely likely to be strategic authority for manager. is wide. keeps a A the for outcome Delegation manager tighter with and spans happen to in is keep is who control on centralization within the the head usually more of narrow effective in such an small business. associated and indicates a with spans control of that group This businesses of control their organization of type of that – so that subordinates. and leadership is autocratic. – this is the but other This of opposite senior of that control centralization. may – so that fewer key organization and is of is a core delegated is usually hierarchy allow more leadership is structure levels managers Delegation In maintain authority organizational have subordinates. an of managers decision-making type businesses their such of maintained hierarchy managers. wider to organization associated freedoms is happens decisions, middle degree close structure Decentralization greater likely more to likely to democratic Bureaucracy serving in system. rules originally business and well they are more organizations “red tape” to Delegation show is not De-layering hierarchy strategy is The are – by and more concept of is have been many is of any doing not associated levels get of have importance things. with for This businesses many years. As correctly and type that Typically, accomplished been of has Personal expected. hierarchy. tasks ofcials administrative “bureaucratic” are operating to non-elected relative that ways procedures occurs likely been to typically with built is decision-making reduces levels of a business of businesses for up such such have followed. to capability as the levels of levels business well As such hierarchy. bureaucracy middle business are years. reduce of the This that many many intended costs reduces management. operating have de-layering layering when layers associated have many set usually have removing the so the delegation paperwork that this increase employ to and to means likely. usually established they likely require term indicates and structure and referring this organization thinking established term term An procedures exible organizational are a today the procedures. rules initiative, – government, In and many of span making levels decentralized ● of operating many more of when not remains the decision Delegation ● but to organizational occurs span organizational be an decisions. managers to relevant to That when Centralization all ● are decision more all ● terms necessarily tnemeganam ● not S T R U C T U R E managers. does not have and De- to managers. 119 ecruoser namuH 2 The O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Types of organizational char t TOK discussion There are common many are different described types of organizational structure. The most Why can organizational char ts below. be misleading? T all organizational structure A tall of a organizational business following and is structure common is in the traditional organizational well-established businesses. It form has the features: tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 ● many levels ● narrow ● centralized ● long ● autocratic ● limited of spans hierarchy of control decision chains of making command leadership delegation. Flat organizational structure A at of organizational the more popular with with those structure traditional businesses attempting organizations have is a structure set to the up modication and since reinvent following has the become 1960s themselves. or Flat features: Senior managers ● few levels of ● wider ● decentralized ● shorter ● democratic ● increased spans hierarchy of control Middle managers decision (though more making diffuse) chains of command Junior managers leadership delegation. Super visors Organizational structure by hierarchy Another way to show an organizational structure is by showing Workers hierarchy. below Individuals them. This is at the the top have traditional more way of authority presenting than an those organizational Figure 2.2.2. Organizational structure and is shown in Figure 2.2.2. structure by hierarchy Organizational structure by function An organizational what employees Figure 2.2.3). structure do. They can Employees will then be be presented are grouped organized by by by function – department indicating (see seniority. Board of directors Production Marketing Finance Figure 2.2.3. Organizational structure by function 120 HR Administration 2 . 2 O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L S T R U C T U R E Organizational structure by product Another the typical business organized way of produces. by what presenting For types an example, of books it organizational Figure 2.2.4 structure shows a is by what publisher produces. Board of tnemeganam Current Fiction Technical Educational Translations aairs manuals Figure 2.2.4. Organizational structure by product Organizational structure by region A further typical according example to way where structure of the for a presenting business an organizational operations multinational are. structure Figure 2.2.5 is shows an corporation. Head oce (Germany) Asia Americas Europe Africa Oceania Figure 2.2.5. Organizational structure by region ch i izil As well as these businesses changes standard have in the types attempted business ● project-based ● shamrock to of organizational adapt their environment. structure, structure Two to examples take of some account this of are: organization organization. Project-based organization This structure demands. human In focusing is many each on split teams other project. designed up more around managers projects. at once, each After such as to but team “borrows” project exible organizational reassembled operate team be organized project and because the marketing are have individual Each complete to project-based resources organizations team is a is many who the run members teams on of accountants, is another have focused responsive a projects. project begin they and structure, no employees completed, need market Project-based of project. to completing different to business’s the Typically, interact its with own departments operations managers to and specialists. 121 ecruoser namuH 2 directors 2 H U M A N This type where of business businesses different projects structure (see R E S O U R C E as Table structure are at often M A N A G E M E N T often the the is common under same in contract time. It organizational is construction to also teams run a known are or number as a shown IT, of matrix as a matrix 2.2.1). Table 2.2.1. Matrix of organizational teams Operations Finance Marketing HR Administration tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 management Project 1 manager 4 employees 2 employees 1 employee 1 employee 1 employee Project 2 manager 3 employees 2 employees 2 employees 2 employees 1 employee Project 3 manager 3 employees 2 employees 1 employee 1 employee 1 employee Project 4 manager 3 employees 2 employees 2 employees 2 employees 1 employee Project 5 manager 3 employees 2 employees 1 employee 1 employee 1 employee Shamrock organizations This type of organization is based on a model suggested by the Irish 1 management theorist Charles Handy Core He argued the that changes planning. which The is a or model The a The ● clover that increase of a second of the and leaf or core, The leaf consists calls All its of is impact Ireland on other essential costs, the the to exible seasonal on out to of workforce shamrock – gain important element communicates a business both their with its functions. internal of the with the to creation non-central periphery: Figure 2.2.6. The shamrock model managers, business. fringe, specialist workforce made because businesses. up of workers. organizational stakeholders. Successful and their structure is how Communication is integral businesses external communicate a business to how effectively stakeholders. 1 Handy, C, 1989, The Age of Unreason, Harvard Business School, Boston MA, USA 122 Contractual competitive workforce Communication An Temporary stem. their core the advantage the supporting, to contractual a – each concerned possible and taking trimming represents the by reduce by subcontracted of and leaets which service. shamrock temporary, can time wherever are exible symbol three businesses Handy activities third has employees non-core part-time, more environment response product leaf be national and outsourced technicians ● the multiskilled are rst can external uses suggests delivery ● of and only functions the idea type advantage retain in His businesses with 2 . 2 Communication is channelled communication in Figure can take through 2.2.7 outside shows two the the the routes: formal organizational “proper” process by communication, structure, channels. which O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L a and The which informal communication message S T R U C T U R E is loop communicated. Media tnemeganam Sender Receiver Feedback Figure 2.2.7 . The process of communicating a message The sender what or form she the The some understood can outside has is – the delivered upon encode then media person feedback to from of the either the the gets that party. the the background choice of Background what deliver and has noise. to can he the decodes it. should been message media noise deciding sender message However, so-called to message then the by chooses which the successfully, show wrong message sender through who successfully. because of to take, may not Background something even be due to interference. which Sometimes, most of anything Communication media, said appropriate acted control is should been form clearly be the deliberate the and through noise message message receiver message receive get the considers message. If of the can take increases different common forms several the methods of forms likelihood of using that a the variety communication communication of message include are the different will get across. combined. The following. Verbal This communication communication ● interviews ● meetings ● lectures ● presentations ● telephone Informal relies occurs on conversations verbal the spoken word. Formal verbal in: (recorded). communication might include: Open plan oces like this are becoming ● face-to-face ● gossiping ● telephone conversations more common. What eect could this have on formal and informal communication? conversations (unrecorded). 123 ecruoser namuH 2 Background 2 H U M A N Verbal R E S O U R C E communication M A N A G E M E N T can be quick, direct and effective, especially if Student workpoint combined with other forms of communication. It also allows for immediate 2.4 feedback. the However, wrong the language, message does not can speak be misunderstood clearly, or does if not the sender allow for uses feedback. Be reective Visual What This form of communication communication can take relies place on sight. Formal visual would appropriate through: be the most method communication in of these situations: tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 ● presentations ● videos ● your to ● notice ● signs ● sign manager tell all staff needs that boards the ofce closed for will be tomorrow emergency language maintenance ● symbols ● maps. ● Informal visual communication might include: you want your new is gestures. good of have one. communication can be effective as it can be and immediate. However, this type lots and gures and permanent, data recognizable, done research have Visual a that product language You ● persuade managers idea body ● to your of to back up your communication arguments can be difcult, communication effective may if the respond especially is not image for those positioned or picture differently to the who have limited appropriately. requires same It sight can also interpretation, as or be if the less some ● cultures image. a new product launching is globally two months’ will be the in time. rst of It its Written kind Written communication relies on the written word. Formal to communication is found reports ● letters ● notices sell might than one scenario. what ● forms ● press Informal releases. written ● memos* ● emails* ● texts ● blogs. Written kept, written “tone” * communication communication and written the can be message can may be be might include: effective. communication communication of it method Think so that more for can be Records considered lost. In of amended the or impersonal addition, message revised. and feedback is often not may be However, the immediate. In some organizations, memos and emails would be considered formal communication. your each about your you can bulletins justify 124 want choose inuences choices ● you well in: You ● and written decision. 2 . 2 O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L S T R U C T U R E rvii hkli Delegation occurs decision someone outcome ✓ The of span of authority ✓ A level ✓ The of a of Bureaucarcy ✓ Centralization ✓ group strategic ✓ at have ✓ A tall to is is of the employees are responsibility formal are rules and when found the in a route made for a particular responsibility directly within though at the a for the under the business. which highest procedures within majority decisions senior where management occurs layers wide of span structure control many level individuals a decision level and are of position decisions is likely to an within are made retain organization. are made the by by a business. middle control of key when of has Leadership a business reduces the levels of hierarchy by management. organizational a holds manager. decisions occurs Senior De-layering A authority still decisions. removing ✓ refers of gives manager down. Decentralization managers. a command ✓ manager The how is Usually, communicated small is particular hierarchy travel. a else. decision. control of chain must that when tnemeganam to structure control. many tends has levels to few Decision be of levels of making hierarchy autocratic is hierarchy and and and tends to decentralized. narrow decision spans making of in centralized. ✓ Organizational by product or structures by can be organized by hierarchy, by function, region. 125 ecruoser namuH 2 ✓ 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Pi qi Casas Paolo the Carreras Carreras, largest fashion. Casas Managers tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 By their 2001, Brazil. items of Paolo will cut more have At required by a) by a to tall become Casas cards at in Paolo and the Casas to a on are become structure. decisions. complained management. chain large store to in a the business was is too bureaucratic: key most recent of in household machines) available slowed to autocratic major retail washing has vision very senior sells made Carreras ownership a salespeople largest Carreras and had in organizational slow being 1950, business consult was refrigerators and that exible do not as and by 5% as that 10%, executive the are one organization per as a driver Brazilians. years. passed to his to market incentives atter long store a as and is she needs. meet manager regional planning She proposing organizational they is would manager believes to have by and the up to Evaluate the salespeople right a monthly salary on to will sales. salary $200 be As (the able a to of $350. improve result, Suzanna minimum the wage their average as income salesperson Casas and one Carreras disadvantage from a tall to a of changing atter the structure. their of the job proposed satisfaction, payment scheme motivation and 126 Nov. 2009 marks] for productivity. [7 IB, to 25%, month. impact on They prot [5 b) offer structure. revenue to management. salespeople advantage of a and paid monthly but responsive sufcient commission $500 Analyse more creating proposes much law) business independence salespeople by earn the have freedom reduce earning could had credit consulting to had his communicated items growth Suzanna present, wants stoves, greater prices without rarely the was believes greater targets. of 2006 managers them were Carreras ran Suzanna. Suzanna it in He expected Carreras sales died daughter make as Casas always always many growth However, the ideas (such this of Brazil. decision-making Casas As in Carreras were Consequently, that founder retailer marks] 2.3 Leadership and management Outline the key functions of management ➔ Describe management versus leadership ➔ Discuss the following leadership styles: ● autocratic ● paternalistic ● democratic ● laissez-faire ● situational tnemeganam ➔ Explain how ethical considerations and cultural dierences may ➔ inuence leadership and management styles in an organization Management making sure not the the people of the people with making on sure standards. and functions a do in various (HR, work set of oor. are Other To of For and levels the of organizations are roles a are not they and Top of nance, a television some marketing, even exist, they are to and of work the role company includes the business operations the part the manufacturing major all are that making management the are they supervisory according of with They Rather, ensure actually each management degree, who have made range. charge in charged accomplished. organizations. example, Rather, in in small, responsibilities covers some or made, people accounting supervisors. people large management shop Management management). the performed. televisions the of the special is the up whether who those televisions oor made company company, CEO is tasks, way down to the management. th ky fi f 1 In Administration ve major manager tactical functions at Planning a – large Organizing sufcient organization, as the too plan. the must many based Henri upon his Fayol outlined experiences as a They must set objectives, strategic all of objectives, which have organization. achieve then its make sure objectives. resources organization’s (1916), mine: operational managers to Générale coal must even throughout – et management French resources that of managers objectives, implications mean Industrielle tie objectives up that This too cannot the business process much be has requires capital; too careful few met. 1 Fayol, Henri, 1916, Administration Industrielle et Générale 127 ecruoser namuH 2 By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E Commanding know also which make perform – sure are that going tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 each on, activity situation to have managers In with is power to then make perform. receive done – If sure that necessary, instruction when to and or together business, contributing in all individuals managers how They They can reduce it is they must are to the have output scale of if of sure that be. over to to activities the making to power power resources different activities, changed the various supposed have be the various to these where control. processes expand of coordinate objectives. that bring types activity must managers so must many each achieve quality must are employees Managers Controlling for”, – objectives. businesses. they tasks. Coordinating achieve managers duties their M A N A G E M E N T test, a given or necessary. operations as “control They also conditions require. Fayol argued applied to that any these functions were universal and could therefore be organization. Management versus leadership A manager group, is put into would on instruct ● help ● generally and bear ● generally thus, the like a To by to leader ● motivate ● often a is to therefore is on ensuring deals with in a the that work the complexity. that timely accomplished, is, a of Many manager manner a plan is rather than managers: people resolve strict problems expertise and schedules, virtue the overseeing and task-oriented; of the their bring precise position organization that technical expertise instructions) in the organization function (and therefore tend organization). role inspire is more people deal of emotional to time follow and relationship-oriented. and rely to and progress, tasks make great planning accomplished get technical leader’s ability spends a tasks challenge contrast, leader manager manager setting authority to for group’s coordinate have (by have have a subordinates ● In A that people. ● not the getting leading to responsible effect. argue focused on is monitoring inspire with instincts their even in energy or a great her building leader will voluntarily. A relationships and, Leaders: personal the since him face of qualities evidence that they are TOK discussion choosing the less safe option To what degree is it misleading ● have ● often vision – and others follow them because of that vision to claim that a manager and have the vision that the organization should be doing things a leader are dierent? How in a totally different way and inspire the condence that can lead to helpful is this terminology? systemic 128 change and innovation. 2 . 3 L E A D E R S H I P A N D M A N A G E M E N T Ldhip yl Leadership styles can be categorized as follows. Autocratic leaders as minimally should be they consult) obeyed environment This style of unskilled, likely in on an Autocratic have the do things and A may benet be their of own leave the leader is the what way are is make be are on used not the when valued. results and only Their orders structured some do be by they just to an urgent military rely detailed subordinates when are more make very systems tolerate also the described. democratic to is cannot unsuccessful those in situations since subordinates It has Many accompanied to to leadership is come to the that What to The employees or all (or decision. welcome In unlikely quickly. that decision-making consult may second-guess. employees Highly and skilled who autocratic like to manager – organization. precisely. own a manager. often experienced made their focuses probably Employees style on will the instructions manage told to ideas on to receive. likely characteristics have be they and not making should supervision. be autocratic can leadership can who followed. execute to leadership well decisions to – that power tend when their which close like much They most highly style, opposite individuals is and depend and and as rewards organization instructions – the trusted, that to can. employees leadership autocratic expect on employees and and not an decisions hold possibly tnemeganam authority make lines the depend major tend of leader on authority the guidance negative not to decisions. are clear communicates aspect develop And of the rarely, in is but an also is to autocratic ability any and what to business, decisions. Paternalistic Paternalistic in that the autocratic as leadership leader leaders, “family” – a “Paternalistic” heart for of the the business total of A it will loyalty, become positive great part The stand even will like parents. come As trust, a do some not place They to a for autocratic leadership employees. views family leaders the all “father”, Unlike employees the same. which have great employees. it, the at do want to If gets at the concern is leaders that the the leader on for a like leader’s of down. loyalty, the the get this long necessary a what, often employees is “ownership” importance with matter employees and whatever let no business leader, (gurative) great the leadership and employees that, paternalistic remain to provide believe result, from paternalistic they leaders leader but word Paternalistic probably take certainly, Latin with over business. organization They because the committed of features authority paternalistic style. them. blind they the are by some family, from the a employees totally in paternalistic of leaders aspect pride successful. in gurative derives safety. leadership, and however, employees of shares considerable paternalistic Paternalistic sense has style time aims. take to make business, However, which may mean 129 ecruoser namuH 2 Autocratic 2 H U M A N that they do employees’ “playing R E S O U R C E not have fully performance. favourites” employees, advantage a M A N A G E M E N T (and knowing of the they they leader objective, Thus, are and critical paternalistic may part his actually of or a her eye when leaders play “family”, loyalty to evaluating may come favourites). may at across as Further, times take them. Democratic The democratic tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 informs occur type them across of leader as possible or any consults leader is will major terms and The be of for of and a democratic as a is to it in is matter of the as This much business make leader practical decisions rare is can leader. honours leader and one and team, who because the most They especially democratic many that with it. the also like style word like when leader employees go popular people being the can the among “democracy” involved decisions produce trust, Employees feel have results a in cooperation, as though they voice. democratic leadership effective may also absent, when who belonging process since belonging of making leadership democratic leadership the the most connotations. them. quantity, for probably The on process of decision truly role type in Democratic say. because emotional subordinates is is the However, impact most style common one responsible leadership is democratic process, a from Truly nal them. democratic regularly. the end decision-making sense have more possibly positive one the employees affect ultimately ultimately have employees, the a as that At practical. employees Democratic in facilitates Thus, leader has spectrum. and involves issues organization, decisions. the a manager about enjoy to slow a no the highly down requires style used a always making democracy and team. can out. chaos in may the that make prove team. the If style It and Nevertheless, and “chemistry” work free-thinking, relationships decision of not skilled, effective positive amount may with is can the to result democratic too this likely experienced costly. The characteristic work. Laissez-faire Laissez-faire gives Employees resolve This can do Universities tend told working The work the 130 to to a it of a may goals, be other based on and interests are it of as when style their the manager work. decisions, employees university experts professions, and as freedom. the It skilled, lecturers, in their well, may can and be educated. researchers eld, resist individual be individual appropriate and where when people own. style can the do own motivated, world around their laissez-faire they their appropriate they considerable culture leadership how t. generally In this in make “laissez-faire”, are do. provides individual see In freedom because be successfully benet freedom job demand with alone”. own they style who what practitioners leave their as their professors, being can set problems to “to considerable management trusted and means employees is that foster many creativity employees may employees and enjoy innovations. diverge too far the However, from the 2 . 3 style and eye the and may may can be give provide it, the and an to as and results organization this type the can of be leader Precise whereas employees. can perspective, feedback. employees, disciplined style the employee’s much comfort and laissez-faire under From unnerving, not condent a organization, aims. In employees does away a not from laissez-faire not give instructions where disposed style a to a guidance watchful requires leader be its leadership much and laissez-faire instances are veer a M A N A G E M E N T adopts successful disastrous. tnemeganam of vision A N D Situational Situational different ever be lead the allow The to the but may benet the the either situation of these arbitrary, In ● the the styles may determining may the of in other will the often for even the In determine nature the autocratic: efciently where the of emergency become and require would employees will style. quickly morale, the outcome organization autocratic as leaders a may decide. is the that leaders other switch leader of times, situations change demotivate style subordinates the the At situations leadership appropriate leaders leadership or nature consequential On of professionals) organization employees hand. scenarios, which summary, at most different style the situation. the employee situational change the that one trained Sometimes, the circumstances frequently of of let no Sometimes, altogether inuence democracy: notion democratic and emergency. not the Thus, highly ts highly is on determine employees decision whole best”. versus style will even the through of “the leadership situations, rests leadership. workers circumstances to of deemed (unskilled which leadership styles hand, styles are may match a when not come their leader clear the to across may style too circumstances employees. as In unpredictable or employees. leadership (subordinates’ is likely skills, to age, be inuenced education, by: expectations, Student workpoint 2.5 and motivation) ● the decision ● the leader (whether (the leader’s urgent, important, character, values, or consequential) experience, and Be reective expectations) Draw a table advantages ● the environment (whether creative, standardized, or the disadvantages of repressive, the democratic, showing and ve leadership styles discussed compliant). here. ehil idi d ll di Now let’s inuence look at how leadership ethical and considerations management styles and in cultural an differences may organization. Ethical considerations Ethical considerations management opposed their to to can inuence though managers, people, their styles, whereas focus in on both somewhat “doing managers tend leadership different the to right do the styles ways. thing” right and Leaders, with thing as respect with to respect organizations. 131 ecruoser namuH 2 focus L E A D E R S H I P 2 H U M A N Leaders are R E S O U R C E focused relationships leaders and have people”. to They on on do people. inspiring more must M A N A G E M E N T than actually As a result, employees. merely say they To that demonstrate focus on building accomplish they that care care these about when objectives, “their INNOVATION ‘If a manager is innovative, the circumstances business will be innovative’ require. How true do you think this statement is? Does an innovative Leaders guide organizations toward ethical ends. In the military, management style necessarily for example, leaders are those who risk their own lives to protect mean that the business will the lives of their subordinates. In business, leaders are willing, if produce innovative goods and to take the blame for bad outcomes to the organization if it services? tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 necessary, means serving unwarranted a manager judgment leader on ethical object putting Most for of of the is own time, as of to a leader leader at criticism an when error of a the of personal employee when have a a – but, make. adopts stakeholders nancial many risk might leader some a The employee judgment when or would cost. So argue that all. managers and rewards of intervene give taking that excessive inexperienced. to the is even bureaucratic and is error objectives leadership from made was is judgment considerations, positions who do considerations ethical being this the to organization, not ethical criticized their the thing them example, employee employee’s errors behaviour leader right for employee the the ethical protecting might, young that for because ethical issue are leader a the future of by instance, only any typically is the They not that this example unethical On In objectives – central an for A sack grounds argue responsibility Another to the chance. arguably, employees criticism. wants might second their ahead managers are “rule is of often criticized. followers” their and for employees’. somewhat Student workpoint 2.6 unfair. Be a thinker Managers, to the in contrast organization supervising judgment a sees perspective, employee the business consideration, in If, to sacking is the but In most people, on the whereas or they managing interests an ahead and When others’. a to the in own is thing too due type to hasty of in could ethical considerations these managers, are roles they are are, by behave really are unethically, ● Paternalistic ● Democratic ● Laissez-faire ● Situational cost too hasty of their ethical on centred unethically, not Autocratic mentioned centred are ● fair interests inuenced following styles: sack career. are the this to sacking and managers the is Dene leadership in From do criticism on more manager which process considerations in The error business. judgment, focusing managers They major the criticism, not ethical a right manager the obligations employees. made individual people or that from their organization. of if ethical the errors are managers leaders to has liability the they on their deserves leaders, with are a themselves leaders organization. whether as further manager With than believes giving rather see who However, not employee, considerations. 132 prevent organization summary, employee protect an business manager to or leaders, employee money. employee above. the the the an or young to leading putting their people own 2 . 3 L E A D E R S H I P A N D M A N A G E M E N T Cultural dierences (see and differences, most also famous Unit rened cultural 2.1), his cultural ● power ● individualism ● uncertainty ● masculinity ● long-term and or will be manage. would his to leadership concept business dimensions relevant value is the and theory. business of (such inuenced be low probably by the inuenced from function leaders. as leadership Employees with individualism others style also arguably autocratic cultures over this and of academic According have management. work ve Geert career to Hofstede developed Hofstede, dimensions: orientation. The should (and inuence of avoidance whereas cohesion. can distance cultures example, adopts who inuences Different too, treatment tnemeganam The On power perform or culture by at other the from culture) with least under of great initially) the in resent they for group individual originate people they distance organizations from an democratic cultures), value an power employees might that which cultures hand, distance better Japanese management cultures better, the (Anglo-American the lead prefer with countries autocratic or leader and leadership. rvii hkli ✓ The key functions command, ✓ A manager’s contrast, ✓ is management to for and plan role hold their leaders laissez-are see A and concern Employees ✓ role leaders Paternalistic A of coordinate leader’s decisions have ✓ a Autocratic all ✓ to is as have a style own plan, the and much to organize, to of of a group. be as they can. allows instil trust and employees and In They make obeyed. decision-making and goals work inspire. power should lot employees their to oversee motivate onto also are control. instructions their set and to leadership can to manage power. They loyalty. much freedom. problems as they t. democratic inform them leader of will issues involve which will employees affect in decision making and them. 133 ecruoser namuH 2 Cultural 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Pi qi Rox and Rox was Inclusive a music considerable style. local He CD tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 In personally and awards “Action June band 2010, their Michel music to young support was very realized of nance grow. market In June 2011, To students to many Michel help low afford only nance given from a The the Music” nance band plan. Rox Their last fame. IM’s At of a aim rst, new was Michel Unfortunately, fully. would limited to received start-up ( IM). families. IM enjoyed leadership generously band responsibility. business have The autocratic considerable income a to contributions would opened External be budget needed for he sources for IM marketing to and it mission offered the school’s hoping attendance months, were no Michel not allowed popular adopted creativity than expected music could a Louis instruments Louis “Action and asked allow lower attending and lessons director. would was many longer deteriorating, it statement free instruments. be style, three were the had former a among and gone quickly missing lessons. not attract external nance. action examined Michel argued that and IM’s Without media, poor to student Within with mission, musical students of problem. its leadership took also and to from had social them “Inclusive prepared not Rox corporate asked Michel’s organizations. brought called and Marsaud, nances sources IM Initial worsened. He IM borrow Louis students. IM’s was could support laissez-faire and of had musicians than then decisions. Mbappe. to research. words”. singer, Rox other Until acts school enthusiastic that all Michel thanks non-prot Words” non-prot by success made other for Not (IM) managed commercial schools many Music consulting received the two a) Dene b) Identify c) Explain in the the term two how problems by Rox discovered he to Louis. dismissing IM’s aimed vague to promote signicant dismissed for were Michel a In Louis. the music Journalists mission ensure IM. liquidity that statement IM became term. corporate possible the concert criticism However, long a and anyone, much main marketing. sustainable organized accounts social causes following responsibility . of a may liquidity have problem. contributed to IM’s [2 marks] [2 marks] nancial problems: d) (i) its mission (ii) its limited Analyse for e) the the statement. marketing appropriateness running Discuss two nance that budget. of an possible IM could of Michel’s organization medium- use to to help such autocratic as its marks] [3 marks] leadership IM. long-term solve [3 external nancial style, [6 sources of problems. [9 IB, 134 Nov. 2012 marks] marks] 2.4 Moti vation By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: Taylor ● Maslow ● Her zberg (motivation –hygiene theory) ● Adams (equity theory) ● Pink tnemeganam ● Explain the following types of nancial rewards: ➔ ● salary ● wages (time and piece rates) ● commission ● prot-related pay ● performance-related pay (PRP) ● employee share ownership schemes ● fringe payments (perks) Dene the following types of non-nancial rewards: ➔ ● job enrichment ● job rotation ● job enlargement ● empowerment ● purpose/the oppor tunity to make a dierence ● teamwork Discuss how nancial and non-nancial rewards may aect job ➔ satisfaction, motivation and productivity in dierent cultures Iii d xii ivi In this work. unit If managers will be Intrinsic to ● be will be can achieve about studying the motivate their in goals. this factors that employees, unit All will the be it inuence is more writers and referring to a person likely that researchers intrinsic to those you and motivators. motivation without can they occurs threats intrinsically They if will reading extrinsic itself we managers see put in or when rewards motivated that their more if someone from they success work they are is a will gets outside. in the result following of achieve satisfaction Employees work something more from are activity likely situations: they positive an more have done; outcomes. 135 ecruoser namuH 2 Describe the following motivation theories: ➔ 2 H U M A N They ● R E S O U R C E have some M A N A G E M E N T control over their results – they are given a degree Key terms of freedom. They are interested Rewards are extrinsic ● the individual. motivators may In the provide compensate in the work motivators – workplace, satisfaction workers for they that is an the “pain” that obvious job or Intrinsic motivation doing. motivators pay the are itself come from example. may not the satisfaction of carrying out Extrinsic provide dissatisfaction motivation which comes from outside that a par ticular activity and they Ex trinsic motivation experience at work. tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 motivation derived from external factors, such a Frederick Winslow Taylor money Taylor was a mechanical contribution Revolution to achieve 1912 and since his is of maximize output this have of that be ways Taylor’s were to it is a provoked and a of will the it took get cooked will position to consistent low Industrial to management between scientic apply 1894 and management, scientic for at a given a and of to with a his its large is in often that worth educated factories. managers component One may making. resented a will in his that on system, The by side. The studies watch restaurant, arise far This measuring famous you if at each a The amount move efciently so If study. and cooked each precise not can is movement. and most fast-food burger time for of parts example. busy The of quickly the It poorly work decision was benets and wasted to enforced ensure time. many that in and to time-and-motion and huge role from when starting different temperature little possible style task. amount cooked removed for a ways strikes. precisely. time and methods into each the specic food, shortest adopted and take in precise minimize fast we’ll idea a the methods the understandable down managed have largely cost the circumstances work were hands-on famous prepared is in were perform of working ideas job but some system worker been is a to shovels, temperature, also of to controlled numerous most breaking hamburger you founder phenomenal methods research attempted agriculture more Taylor’s perhaps long of perhaps take workers involved the under ideas leaving of how as the and scientic published to maximized introduction is observed agriculture standardization best situation involved to apply management that the decided Taylor He referred on to who output. Americans In made measurement would recalling had wanted results. often believed adoption he similar ideas methods Taylor science and engineer of from result how then “bit” given fries are time. his of all at low cost. employees can be Each or her this Skill is has employed at training. Abraham Maslow Maslow explain is arranged 136 most famous motivation. these in He for proposing argued terms of that their a hierarchy people have importance. a of human number needs of to needs and 2 . 4 M O T I V A T I O N morality, creativity, spontaneity, problem solving, lack of prejudice, acceptance of facts Self-actualization tnemeganam Esteem respect by others friendship, family, sexual intimacy Love/belonging security of: body, employment resources, Safety needs morality, the family, health, proper ty food, warmth, shelter Basic needs 1 Figure 2.4.1. Maslow’s hierarchy of needs The basic needs individual will considered longer The basic cause strive to people areas One of nd the factories, needs Once are they new key the diagram they these their growth do ways issues more of workers warmth, higher-level labour of if are not needs are met. are most The met, important rst they four go and levels away or an are no not to go needs. away. satisfy potential; these being Once In these fact, needs. the best the needs are individual These they needs can will involve be in as many possible. providing food, bottom anxiety needs. fullled, fullling as the anxiety. remaining initially at suffer for the will and needs managers same will have shelter, may is not initially but the explain that, once motivate been his a need of is worker. motivated failure why a his by in the factories methods satised, So often Taylor’s need to for satisfy resulted in unrest. Frederick Herzberg Herzberg developed a two-factor theory of motivation based on 2 hygiene factors to. At not are needs that or you if don’t are drive Motivators intrinsic the are however, to the reward probably heating things you needs. dissatisfaction will the satisfactory, factors motivational provide school clean, and that is it is are be not at Hygiene work if they demotivated working unlikely to necessary needs if are the properly. lead for to you are not those attended classrooms If these motivation. to get are things Hygiene started, but they succeed. things from that them. get For you working example, if because you play in you a get some football team 1 “Hierarchy of needs”, developed 1943–54 and published in Maslow, Abraham, 1954, Motivation and Personality, Harper & Row, New York 2 Herzberg, Frederick I, 1959, The Motivation to Work, Wiley and Sons, New York 137 ecruoser namuH 2 self-esteem, condence, achievement, respect of others, 2 H U M A N you will and the R E S O U R C E probably be recognition Herzberg’s tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 company ● relationship ● work ● salary ● company ● status ● security ● relationship ● personal policy with by the successes playing as part you of have the notched up team. are: administration supervisor identied different achievement ● recognition ● the ● responsibility ● advancement. work argued subordinates life. ● of for car research completely order needs and with get conditions Herzberg’s He motivated you “hygiene” ● M A N A G E M E N T that true motivators were other factors: itself that their people have a number of needs and arranged these in importance. John Adams Another theorist, John Adams developed a theory called the equity 3 theory His based theory balance, outputs Inputs to a upon is or that are exists of will “inputs”, be between motivated their inputs or affective and organization. cognitive Inputs ● knowledge ● adaptability ● loyalty ● attitude ● personal ● dedication ● skill ● determination ● support ● effort ● time ● exibility ● tolerance ● hard ● trust work are can into qualities ability Outputs when and they the “equity”. perceive business that and their what be an employee negative and in receives thus in that an employee brings sacrice from co-workers and colleagues superiors. from some working sense at subtract the organization. from the positive 3 Adams, John S, 1965, “Inequity in social change”, pp. 335–43 138 a include: ● Outputs “outputs”, it. those business concepts employees equity, from the Advanced Experimental Social Psychology, 62: 2 . 4 (though quantied). ● fringe ● job ● ● that positive inputs and and outputs ● sense ● stimuli praise ● reward ● thanks. recognition ● salary employees will an be organization based The believe motivated. want and upon sense of relationship inputs to perceives a they is suffer B a achievement than giving they between Motivation, will what their more be demotivated. they according inputs, (inputs) give to to this the theory, fairness. restricted has loss of greater are (outputs), equity a of solely by Employees compare employee will of are employees receive. of not and outputs receive organization. outputs A they perception the their however, degree what fairness to that employee than some that If, could include: responsibility organization of believe are reputation security Employees is not ● they benets did outputs ● When to Adams Typically, tnemeganam be it to other more the also employee’s compare employees. favorable their If “ratio” employee input-to-output A ratio, motivation. Daniel Pink Pink argued 1900s and that older largely motivational stemming from models the developed premises of in the Taylor’s early scientic 4 management These series way older of to largely century, Today, and old to Pink, when require reward negative why: the capacity to stemming business. they focus and rather innovate the Workers face. These of in tasks both be ideas have accomplish tasks and satisfaction from their of do the are also their Rewards era skills. jobs, of In and of problem), to and that can humans increase etc.) or older are workers may business. actually focus diminishes of ineffective the the actually (employees systems lose controlled. context, it the which employees. 20th challenging, punishment accomplish for early highly this for punishments the and employees actually bad a best carefully and of ineffective; threats Thus, capacity and the benets, complex merely the Taylor less systems more range creative. mostly assume manager industrial employees or solving A (pay, unchallenging, are the intellectual or rewards changed. the not was perform. problem-solving is work perspective, theories rewards to has rewards than of punishments. failure system for that this them types routine, and control From give more today were results, from for employees’ promises reward and employees creativity is to These offering work tasks and Here the by assumed tasks. was rewards motivated have on to either however, narrow work punishments According have to performance. respond increasing theories uninteresting people their productivity may awed. motivational simple, get monitor are for the complex With their motivation less motivation tasks capacity and get to less work. 4 Pink , Daniel H, 2009, Drive: The Surprising Truth About What Motivates Us, Riverhead Books (Penguin USA), New York 139 ecruoser namuH 2 outcomes M O T I V A T I O N 2 H U M A N Pink argues which of that is Harry biological: biological needs. The satisfaction to outside. Pink motivation that self-determination tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 be autonomous, other people these ends, Businesses ● and they can Autonomy own lives. freedom in (technique), ● Mastery create tasks Easy – cause who bore employees to that work work that them anxiety. “stretch” SDT, and that with will are tasks Tasks for neither beyond fostering themselves and approach businesses: beings want “connected” to rewarding employees do and to to to pursue lives. employees’ mastery develop are their jobs they do (task). innovate, when nor shape employees their learn, easy to give what mastery too rewards revised liberated should employees achieve when or and and and following: they (team), be more permits how to are the businesses allow and have a jobs drive sex, occurs human and people allow (time), Employees to to thirst, threats adopt motivation, rst rewards which post-industrial When more to without should The hunger, response itself According large. employees; excessive with possible, they things. matter tasks at opportunities new that they satisfy the intrinsic drive”. motivation, activity environment when to is “third self-determination, settings as employees’ the businesses (SDT). accomplish an drive closely world much into called intrinsic an that more create – As is from achieve the should drive theory to tap requirement second proposes ts to Harlow their someone from third have F . The punishments. gets M A N A G E M E N T businesses psychologist humans other R E S O U R C E they too are and given difcult. TOK discussion capabilities those their skill that set allow further. Business and psychological studies of motivation assume that a “science” ● Purpose – a sense that their work betters their own lives and the to understanding human world. Employees must know and understand the organization’s motivation is possible. To what purposes (other than prot) and how each person contributes to degree, at both an individual these purposes. To Pink, businesses should emphasize “purpose” goals and group level, is the science as much as prot goals as reaching prot goals has no positive impact of motivation misleading? on a person’s well-being (it may actually have a negative impact). yduts esaC Happiness at work A happy working environment is a win-win situation. ● Research shows that happy people are healthier, more make an eor t to understand what makes your employees happy productive, have more ideas, are more likely to go ● focus on people’s strengths ● give feedback which encourages growth and beyond the responsibilities of their job, and are less likely to leave or be o sick . Happiness is contagious improvement so, if your team is happy – you and others around ● acknowledge and celebrate successes in them are more likely to be happy too. meetings – don’t just focus on problems As a manager or leader you can inuence the happiness ● give your employees the oppor tunity to shape of those in your team. This doesn’t mean that work can’t their own jobs be serious, or that you need to be telling jokes constantly. adapted from www.actionforhappiness.org There is a lot more to happiness at work than that. Recent research is suggesting more and more ways Exam-style questions that we can increase happiness at work . Dene the terms ‘motivation’ and ‘hierarchy’ [4 marks] Changing an organization’s culture or incentive system can be complicated and take a long time, and may not always Outline the benets of using non-nancial be possible if you are not near the top of the hierarchy, but rewards to motivate employees. here are some ideas for things that will make a dierence: 140 [4 marks] 2 . 4 M O T I V A T I O N mivi i pi Many to organizations reward and devise motivate payment systems nancial rewards exists. that complex their Table need payment employees. to 2.4.1 be systems in Unfortunately, identies some of an no the effort perfect major issues of considered. Table 2.4.1. Financial rewards – main issues How it is paid Motivation factors Disad vantages tnemeganam nancial reward Salary Employees are paid The main motivator is The employer is typically relying on the a sum of money per likely to be the security of professionalism of the sta to provide the month. receiving a regular income. quality and quantity expected. Wages (time Employees are paid The main motivator is likely It is possible that employees will work slowly rates) an hourly rate, or for a to be the security of receiving since their pay is not based on output. If number of hours per a regular income and the overtime rates apply then employees could week . It is possible opportunity to receive benet nancially from ensuring that the that over time rates of overtime pay. work is extended to cover time over the usual pay are used too. hours of the working day. Wages (piece Employees are paid The main motivator is likely This might involve tedious and repetitive rates) for each unit (or batch) to be the fact that increased work and employees may not have control produced. output will bring a measurable of their results if they rely on others, for benet. example to supply materials. Employees may work quickly to get as much money as possible. It may be that a system of checks will have to be put in place to ensure that quality standards have been met. There may be an emphasis on quantity rather than quality. Commission Employees are paid by The main motivator is likely Employees may not have control over results, for example, a to be the fact that employees results (and this income). For example, at fee or a percentage will be rewarded by results. during a recession sales commission will for each item sold. fall in many industries. Employees may be tempted to sell products that are not in the best interests of the customer or business and this could create problems for the organization. For example, a bank employee who sells a mor tgage to a customer will receive the commission, but the bank may suer nancially if the customer subsequently defaults on the loan. Prot-related The amount an Sharing the nancial Productivity may be a consequence of the pay employee receives is rewards of a business protability of the business rather than the linked to the amount may encourage a sense of cause. of prot the business belonging and a desire to makes. contribute to its success. If prots fall then employees could experience a demoralizing loss through no fault of their own. 141 ecruoser namuH 2 Type of 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E Type of M A N A G E M E N T How it is paid Motivation factors Disad vantages Performance- PRP is usually a bonus PRP is ordinarily used with As long as the tasks are repetitive tasks related pay paid in addition to the those employees whose that involve physical skills, PRP can (PRP) employee’s ordinary productivity or output cannot enhance performance. However, when compensation. be measured precisely. cognitive tasks are involved, PRP may However, the pay is based actually reduce productivity. In addition, upon pre-established PRP can cause divisions in a business if the performance targets. evaluation of employees’ performance is Ordinarily, in a PRP system, based upon subjective factors. nancial reward tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 employees receive a salary and are expected to reach certain targets. Employees exceeding the targets are then paid an additional amount. The assumption is that employees will be motivated by the opportunity to make extra money by performing better than the targets. Employee These come in two Employee share schemes, When oered as a bonus, the basis for share-ownership forms. The rst is when oered as a bonus, can awarding the bonus must be clear and, schemes as some type of motivate in the same ways ideally, measurable to avoid accusations bonus; however, the that other types of bonuses of “favouritism” in granting them. If payment is shares do. Even when an employee employees have all their savings in a in the business share-ownership scheme company match plan, both their salaries rather than cash. is simply a savings plan, a and their savings are tied to the viability of The second is some benet is that employees the business. type of employee become partial owners of the savings plan whereby business, which is thought employees are to provide an incentive for allowed to purchase employees to work harder (as shares through a they now have a “stake” in the payroll deduction business.) (typically a xed amount per pay period) without having to pay brokerage fees. Some employers will also oer a “match” programme (for example, for every $1 the employee invests in shares the company will give (or “match”) the employee’s contribution with $0.50.) 142 2 . 4 Type of M O T I V A T I O N How it is paid Motivation factors Disad vantages Fringe Fringe payments, or Employees like fringe If fringe benets are not given equally to all payments perks, are the many benets, as often they have employees or on a clear, fair basis, division (perks) types of extras that substantial value. While among the sta can result. In addition, businesses oer their employees may have to claim employees can come to expect certain fringe employees. They some fringe benets for tax benets and may become angry if some can include medical purposes, many do not have to perks are taken away. insurance, a car, and be claimed. This provides the private pension plans, employee with an additional among other forms of benet: for the business to payment. They often pay for fringe benets on a include perks related pre-tax basis is much cheaper to the nature of the than for employees to pay business (a hotel chain for these items with after-tax may oer discounted salary. Thus, the business rates at its hotels to is able to give more value to employees). employees than if it paid them nancial tnemeganam the equivalent amount in additional salary. Table 2.4.2 gives examples of types of non-nancial reward. Table 2.4.2. Non-nancial rewards – main issues Type of non- Main features Motivation factors Disad vantages nancial reward Job enrichment Job enrichment makes an employee’s job Employees typically prefer to Job enrichment “richer ”, or more meaningful and rewarding, have responsibilities that are cannot be by allowing employees to use the full range challenging. Employees who applied in all of their abilities. Typically, job enrichment are more satised are typically work situations, involves supervising employees less and more motivated to work hard. either because making the responsibilities of the position of the type of more challenging. Often enrichment will work involved or mean that an employee does the entirety because of the of a production process to have a greater calibre of the sense of ownership and responsibility in workers. what they produce. Job rotation Job rotation involves having an individual Job rotation benets companies Job rotation means employee rotated through dierent as it gives them employees who employees go divisions in a business over a period of have a better sense of the “big through periodic time. It is often used with young employees picture” of the business. For productivity dips as a form of training but can be used at employees, rotation provides as they begin in a many dierent stages of a career. additional training and the new division and acquisition of new skills and must go through knowledge, which can lead a training phase to new opportunities with before they the business (or with other understand fully organizations). the new position. 143 ecruoser namuH 2 reward 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E Type of non- M A N A G E M E N T Main features Motivation factors Disad vantages nancial reward Job Job enlargement may include job rotation In general, employees prefer If job enlargement enlargement or job enrichment. It may involve giving some variation in the tasks is nothing more employees more tasks to do, sometimes they must do. than giving because of a shor tage of sta. employees additional duties, it may increase tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 employee dissatisfaction. Empowerment Empowerment involves giving individuals Empowered employees Businesses run access to resources and information to do generally believe that they can some risk that their jobs and the power to make decisions. be instrumental in changing the empowered In an employment context, empowerment things and learning new skills employees will means giving employees considerable so that they can be par t of the not be able to control over how their jobs should be done. change process. Employees manage the nd this rewarding. responsibility they have been given. Employees may make decisions that are not fully productive or cost the business unnecessarily. Purpose or Purpose or oppor tunity to make a Many individuals want to If for-prot oppor tunity dierence in the world refers to the ability do more than merely make organizations to make a of businesses or other organizations to money. They want to know overemphasize dierence connect employees to the aims of the that they are making a social or organization other than prot. Non-prot dierence in the world and environmental organizations have this advantage, as are connected to purposes aims, employees they typically exist to meet some social larger than themselves or may lose focus on or environmental need. Many for-prot their organization. People the prot-making businesses today, however, have adopted tend to nd these purposes objectives. the other-than-prot aims to their intrinsically motivating. objectives. Teamwork Teamwork involves working cooperatively The success of teams can When successful, with a group of people to achieve a goal. be crucial to organizations’ teamwork can performance, so an have great yields organization will strive to for organizations. have high-performance However, teams. Individuals tend to team failures be energized by working in can amplify teams, which creates a sense dissatisfaction of group cohesion and common and, thus, weaken purpose. employees’ productivity. All of the degrees in 144 above of nancial effectiveness developing and in countries, non-nancial different many rewards countries people are and have differing cultures. unaccustomed In to general, making 2 . 4 traditional remain Wages In incomes. forms strong. based last 50 countries of In largely tend social be to more increasingly work, some people mostly social such as in and to village, especially high have have in tend changed (and of in weakened. a be many etc.) important. signicantly many where processes. In these rewards. difference in in developed Economies sectors, cognitive non-nancial making Further, association, to living. quaternary require traditional tasks. motivating. standards and and of labour rewards accustomed cohesion the work Finally, contexts, Personally world are of workers. the mostly interested are tertiary teamwork are (family, be interested importance Generalizations can version uninteresting nancial circumstances the forms considerable rates complex people satisfying of simple, cohesion guaranteed) traditional are contemporary of contexts, piece shifted to a Individuals virtually tasks is series countries, years. have a these upon developed the Work production: tnemeganam industrial above can interested in non-nancial be misleading. making money, In all economies, while others are objectives. Revision checklist ✓ Frederick practices were ✓ the more ✓ of to Maslow motivated Frederick motivate John ✓ since Pink needs standardization effecient in needs an the can shortest be employer of ways of working working time. categorized can satisfy, in the be. distinguished between Motivational Financial what can they needs must enlargement, and of ‘hygeine are the needs’ ones employees between and which truly pay, fringe include will what be the most but into a it. their has time changed theories. employee’s salary, empowerment, that balance workplace their include rewards out the prot-related Non-nancial a developed nurture schemes suggests see get that observers rewards ownership theory they suggests earlier commission, ✓ will the most output human more worker equity when and businesses ✓ that The needs’. that the workers. Adams’ Daniel a of maximum argued Herzberg motivated business believed adoption ensuring importance. ‘motivational ✓ Taylor enforced key Abraham levels Winslow and Pink in-built and piece performance dramatically argues that motivation. rate related wages, pay, share payments. job enrichment, purpose, and job rotation, job teamwork. 145 ecruoser namuH 2 signicant M O T I V A T I O N 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Pi qi Fish The Packaging rm Iceland, plant They are tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 happens the are ● an ● a lack ● a shortage ● insufcient autocratic pack go stay has led more feels a it (i) has hit to rate b) Using the 2008 to sh into there and a are shing kg per nothing still number in Reykjavik, Workers in the boxes. 13 is plant market. of boats paid hour. to $4 issues When pack. per local When this hour. including: shing less, so workers are style in day-to-day decision making clothing during the workers working seldom about Furthermore, competition changes of the the is exceed possible sh Russian and day the target imposition packaging factory considering 13 kg shing industry ships. the of of has Management introduction of system. difference between time rate and piece systems. [2 disadvantages payment external and system factors at that one Fish could advantage Packaging of motivation management improve the of theory, Fish evaluate of [6 marks] [4 marks] [8 marks] inuence Packaging motivation marks] introducing Ltd. Ltd. appropriate introduce May two rate Packaging changes IB, the two local that some payment piece Explain Fish c) make Explain a the payment Describe rate (ii) by home concerned governments. badly piece a) by also packaging domestic pack about to breaks complains been at protective rest sh shing, leadership are and to a the often involvement of to approximately out per quotas 146 hour Management hour owns sh concerned home of to not weather staying per workers workers poor ● $10 do Ltd frozen expected boats Reykjavik Packaging sells paid are shing The Fish and in the Ltd possible could work force. 2.5 Organizational and corporate cultures (HL only) Dene the meaning of organizational culture ➔ Outline elements of organizational culture ➔ Outline types of organizational culture ➔ Discuss the reasons for, and consequences of, cultural clashes tnemeganam ➔ within organizations when they grow, merge and when leadership styles change Explain how individuals inuence organizational culture and how ➔ organizational culture inuences individuals The term organizational attitudes, are generally that an and the beliefs, is Managers so, it low and is staff set. the an to as an to will behave in factors the a of the or the treat does will culture. each of not not of with a to the the These The other ways and those organization. share stay its there values long. way spell out their manner that inuence the organization department is old This get beliefs reects the norms these senior done and beliefs be in the managers, operating culture). is a values exist will Doing institutions corporate things cultural team, organization. and strong the will an established and the refers organization. culture culture at different that culture, an clash. the values of corporate and person (institutions the which of that especially members in reect culture organization, The country a managers the nationality often of dress, organization inuence turnover corporate values elements likely difcult, staff In department, the try setting departments. of the or and organization highly New expect have joins is may Nonetheless, managers. an described however, with in organization individual situation culture, beliefs, considered individuals outside If experiences, and role to managers different head the the of staff of culture culture of members. typ f izil l Charles Handy Handy introduced culture culture, when role he a highly described culture, task memorable four distinct culture and way of viewing organizational person organizational cultures – power culture. 147 ecruoser namuH 2 By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Power culture A power power. culture Control organization. usually since but the The comes Power judged ends exists are by collapses tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 merchant of bank their the represented the reward spider; or unlikely and a punish. to not US Handy work these a be few rather than in the Bank are merchant power with a than no there for and how giant as spider a culture, those results of and have web. the are achieved, can result, organization. family-owned power cultures. cultures. The strength. individuals are the power spider’s across People making the dominant no out decision Enron has essential spreads interests to often the procedures. Swift attributed banks retain and long-term culture power rules means. energy-trading web In individuals individuals have results Barings businesses few important may Family from from a cultures more decisions when power The who do comes spider not can t in are operate in a long. Role culture In a role highly are culture, controlled usually Power tall stems procedures) and military Handy play In a uses person’s role the symbol oldest cultures – or buildings buildings in position. roles a decision avoid a temple are town ofces or old often and a long and a and building house to in is post ofce slow services, role describe stable (corporate often have a cultures. role environments. organizations main command. book” Civil often organizations of which risks. industries exist These chain “rule making, taking and the roles structure. with Position nationalized of in in people buildings government dened organizational cultures, and clearly bureaucracies dominant Temples have precise organizations, culture. oldest and hierarchical from detailed. The employees with are role often the town. T ask culture The task culture describes specic problems. person, since different like to with in deal highly net can features is used its (or a the will production a and a net a for task then team new to a can This matrix an project. In Different strong team for The team because However, true. task is culture. often up schools, emerges the to a at they spirit divisive team task can be culture structure. break teams lead passion address person culture A organization will teams from can task be the culture team team a emerge. also describe enters skills of can team. task the another culture. a the The completed, form resemble of idea shifts environment. reverse of short-term culture different the energy lines strands. where is with damage the when task changing but image a like emotional crossing different project net) may the situation people rapidly of a within people seriously consultancies, Once a constructive, Handy a Many great decisions often different times. work a Power found to for the work and drama produce The in a next a strength on new projects. team departments major theatrical one. Person culture A person superior These 148 culture to the exists where organization organizations are individuals and where just believe want employees to do themselves their simply go own to of management to be thing. work and they 2 . 5 see themselves as separate O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L from it – as free A N D spirits. C O R P O R A T E Some C U LT U R E S ( H L O N LY ) professional Student workpoint partnerships, such departments, can as architecture rms and some university 2.7 specialist brings be a predominantly particular person expertise to cultures. the There, each organization. Be a thinker person culture as a constellation of stars. Each star Suggest (or person) is unique and different, and individuals operate on one business own. Person cultures are difcult to manage. Individuals preferring will constraints often they nd working impose on in these organizations individuals difcult seem of because organization this which culture type their would suit: the ● power culture ● role culture ● task culture ● person unbearable. tnemeganam represents Edgar Schein 1 Schein described three levels of organizational culture. culture Organizational attributes Are You sense organizational attributes when you walk into an there advantages disadvantages When entering a government building in a communist and organization. country, in every stern case? signs of a or warnings dominant are leader. conformist fashion. heard, felt and everywhere. People may Outsiders reects the are Often speak visible in viewed is a hushed with picture tones or and suspicion. statue dress What is in a seen, culture. Professed culture Some organization images give that clues to how organizations believe or a These as culture image. organization clear of contain charities, elements of with These slogans, slogans, operates. statements sites customers, classied their certain the give value. employees, Schein “profess” project what Websites the other professed of most businesses statements and statements, statements, about or large profess to commitment stakeholders. or images These are to what culture. Organizational assumptions People talk who about channels. This will These aspect People are not have “how of often really They This an insight helps organization for work”, organizational an to to talk some the to time. may best nd to be also it if long get have difcult to if that assumptions. or understand there the the “ofcial” people understand who person explain to often otherwise. has knows unmentionable. helps who been done—even someone that will “ofcial” assumptions people who difculty way time the organizational state the to ephemeral. The those best Even a organizational really with for opposed the them. are explain The as most literature may assumptions organization the about closely truth is things have. work done” referring and Schein often to organization get articulate how structure is to able know organization “really are assumptions assumptions an really organization afraid be organizational with people the organizational longest. been things The why initiate new to organizational been how with existence some the things of managers new change. 1 Schein, Edgar H., 1965, Organizational Psychology, Englewood Clis, Prentice-Hall, NJ, USA 149 ecruoser namuH 2 Handy 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Culture clashes Reasons for culture clashes When individuals organizations these clashes used to tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 formal comfort is the experience exist in Different ● a an of can Different Different country, are from some cultures an have a – more Reasons – some for organizations organizations typically speak – when to are to also a are highly language well occur if that often differences or – styles. leadership, style both merge, For example, acquires leaders and difcult. tasks and and in organizations leadership to people others organizations, are be – some relationship-oriented. even practices can those from compared greater to when the same other organizations cultures. in some schedules uid can have language leadership democratic situation time the two in authoritarian all and more some not differences of – changes countries times or occur. communication. difference These senses appointment do task-oriented different Different ● who styles the practices have two can informal. Misunderstanding with nd when diversity organizations orientations organizations. are – accustomed organizations ● are experience will or clashes” ethnocentric. non-verbal organization company with are formality leadership employees ● of others difculties. individuals if levels Individuals mode “culture following: languages norm. organization others degrees whereas Different ● the diversity; Different ● an together, include Different ● enter merge sense cultures, are of taken time very is xed: seriously. exact Other time. Consequences of culture clashes Businesses combine management of economies scale resources of of the organization combine, different two or rms organizations. has similar culture goals. clashes that the organization The consequences new should including in new the of at may consequences leadership signs a of themselves can such – a for culture a of a not reasons include serious the be for managing may need the take are The acquiring overarching combine Leaders the is when to or several the a change anticipate The most prepare business. prepared of merger, style. cultures of the benets. Similarly, leadership as the businesses above. signicant. failure accounts when companies managers new such takeover, expected harmonize actual nal the and combining noted more cultures. consequence when or can plan the to or owners benets, from sometimes achieve two with merger, achieving organization, failure a share, two clash the In acquisition the strategic of an an when does struggle typically In clash develop occurs employees severe culture harmonization leadership that a market However, occur of reasons. anticipate increased consequence business 150 the for years after for However, to the reveal rst 2 . 5 years of the signicant as potential managers a ● culture Lack of focus new – Sense the on their of common new that Sense new with have of the fact of jobs. – from purpose they about a Evidence long time recognizing of to ( H L O N LY ) problems appear, early so indicators of may the not new understand leader and, the values thus, are focus their and not aims focused aims. own and or take C U LT U R E S include: employees division leader may sensitive indicators the employees organization. failure organization energy on larger keenly Preoccupation than ● be Early organizational and ● of the on ● must clash. new, C O R P O R A T E employees and isolation organization, their out – the and fact job on the a new some Or, the employees rather suffer. between than in attention leader, differences rather similarities. styles, of performance companies many of employees or focus merging leadership fallen – merger Productivity the new merger the tnemeganam as A N D on their case may of a think favour. while managers employees feel focuses isolated on and the strategy ignorant of of what the is happening. ● Unresponsive not If these concerned early experience ● Lower ● efciencies difcult seek new troublesome greater ● when human types cultures merger can Decreased will have Bankruptcy and run risk of – the nd that managers organization have the new are with a labour in with the then it, not produce organization procedures. new organization many is do new and the in turnover of the norms place purpose can following: organization working dissatised not primary conict out to or and to in the – is employees especially merger workplace likelihood worst” if in was to form in the to – when differences increase. The stress of people, workers conict devote lower the conict are less productive, workplace important resources if increases, to these labour the problems, prots. failure protability of in unfamiliarity may the including actually protability likely enough workers occur, increases, which the of “bring business is – Increased a feel capital. between turnover ● jobs. Various a ● they employees unaddressed, problems, turnover that – well-being. but because labour fearful may go serious productivity Higher and their indicators more expected more management for – if the falls bankruptcy problems too or much, from the a merger organization are can severe actually failure. oizil l d idividl Now how let’s look at how organizational Culture is a very simultaneously individuals culture tricky issue everything inuence inuences to and, organizational culture and individuals. address in organizations, paradoxically, nothing. as it is Culture is 151 ecruoser namuH 2 several O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E everything because and norms of and thus it is M A N A G E M E N T the sum of values, attitudes, beliefs, practices, TOK discussion can an organization. inuence It is the everything sum that total of happens in the a organization business. Even Culture cannot be heard, seen, though businesses with high-performing cultures typically attract high- smelled, tasted, or touched, performing individuals, such businesses usually also transform people only behaviour can. into high-performing individuals. New employees can “feel” the energy Is it correct to speak of of the organization and intuitively sense the hierarchy of values in the “culture” at all? business. Employees attitudes, tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 knowing all serious priority On the “feel” an of with other the individual asserts “We change. In inuence an other emails. only What “She for the takes email, in make think what all odd guilty about break with will long the the shaping their organization. over issue of values, Today, individuals, culture as a virtually high of and breaks of and will – new the employee to but for lacking organization. grumbling employee employees change does. employees, emails new and personal the fellow going personal practices employees, to that employees sending of can imagine occasional Possibly not of these culture fellow are other many the hostile practice. they the what individuals practices time must rather example, follow only be For they norms but perspective, much to and “culture”, norms someone organization”, the too not Culture and When can cannot. touched. practices, not this sends any others the is Possibly care; and beliefs, inuence bad”, what our they they practices, employees. of that sense or beliefs, where decides to remark literal signicantly. company inspire of From breaks scenario? not a smelled, changes culture look culture by often in culture do. breaks and regardless she and starting this us groups organization unofcial her behaviours is the tasted, the employee person to in culture attitudes, attitudes, unauthorized new happens will however, values, authorized that violating will and organizational long, If heard, change an treat t individuals values, value, joins norms organization, words, think, individual include an seen, that to purpose. employees mean and businesses from to strive organizational though of be need actually individuals of hand, cannot of great culture abstraction then practices, power leaders and Culture is beliefs, the will their Possibly, example, the feeling courage to organization. rvii hkli ✓ Organizational culture is the attitudes, beliefs and values of an organization. ✓ Power ✓ In culture role within ✓ In task exists culture, a each when few employee highly-controlled culture, a teams individuals has a clearly retain most dened role of the and power. operates structure. address specic problems within a dened time- frame. ✓ Person to ✓ the culture Reasons different and 152 exists organization for culture leadership urgency. where and just clashes styles, individuals do their include: different believe own that they are superior thing. different degrees languages, of different formality, senses of time 2 . 5 O R G A N I Z A T I O N A L A N D C O R P O R A T E C U LT U R E S ( H L O N LY ) Pi qi Recruiting A company known the and a new can spend successful organization. recruiting CEO a large Chief However, externally is not amount of Executive recently only money Ofcer published costly, but it to recruit (CEO) research is also a from well- outside suggests risky, that disruptive and long-term found the The ● that failure The CEOs those assert is the often Dell™, American and A limited American internally externally) CEOs for two reward have (recruited years or package companies performed better a signicantly internally). higher 40% of less. for “outsider” incentives, was CEOs, 65% including higher feel empowered on the are followed very advantage to impose company, culture. by good needs the at products/activities, a to The skill change before arrival departure rapid be rapid even of they of is gained very or an and managers. eliminating valuable restored to “outsider” senior cost-cutting that and really in when a environment. Microsoft®, companies comparison Intel®, that McDonalds® appointed CEOs and Nike® internally are successful between 1998 is of shown average performance indicators between 1998 and below: Companies led by Companies led by an an “insider ” CEO “outsider ” CEO Return on capital employed (ROCE) 20.3% 15.8% Revenue growth 11.9% 4.4% Earnings per share 13.9% 4.6% 7.9% 6.0% Net prot margin Some critics promoting the than 2007. 2007 and than internally. organizational CEOs competitive CEOs prot-related quickly competitive Apple, stayed authority unprotable a public externally. (recruited and CEOs their “Outsider” ● large “insider” appointed understand CEO 36 promoted nancial bonuses “Outsider” ● than average salary, for CEOs rate “outsider” that recruited “Outsider” ● of following: companies those ● studies tnemeganam Two are of the CEOs already of American efcient performance contribution two internally and indicators individual studies usually have protable. in the table argue a These do that strong not companies corporate critics also measure culture argue the that exact CEOs. [Source: adapted from Alexandra Frean, “ The value of hiring chief executives on the inside track”, The Times, 4 April 2011] 153 ecruoser namuH 2 demotivating. 2 H U M A N a) Describe b) (i) R E S O U R C E two Explain possible the M A N A G E M E N T inuences importance of on organizational earnings per share to culture. Distinguish that c) an Examine the management tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 d) Discuss are IB, 154 usefulness imposed whether more Nov. between organization likely 2013 two external could to by a an use be methods recruit organization new organizations to to “outsider” that successful. a of of promote CEO. rapid CEOs [2 marks] recruitment new CEO. marks] a shareholder. (ii) [4 [4 marks] [6 marks] change internally [9 marks] 2.6 Employer and employee relations (HL only) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: tnemeganam representatives Dene the following industrial/employee relations methods used by: ➔ employees: collective bargaining, slowdowns/go-slows, work-to- ● rule, over time bans and strike action employers: collective bargaining, threats of redundancies, ● changes of contract, closure and lock-outs ➔ Outline sources of conict in the workplace ➔ Explain the following approaches to conict resolution: ● conciliation and arbitration ● employee par ticipation and industrial democracy ● no-strike agreement ● single-union agreement Outline reasons for resistance to change in the workplace (such as ➔ self-interest, low tolerance, misinformation and interpretation of circumstances) Evaluate human resource strategies for reducing the impact of change ➔ and resistance to change (such as getting agreement/ownership, planning and timing the change and communicating the change) Describe how innovation, ethical considerations and cultural dierences ➔ may inuence employer-employee relations in an organization This of unit discusses business situations is that can generally is employer governed differ from applicable in and or employee inuenced country many to relations. by country. the As laws of with a any aspect country, Nevertheless, what follows countries. clliv bii The situation when representatives employment have and the time Sometimes industrial when the negotiate they go on team and terms individual and workers and Large of organizations employees. employee have conditions For do both representatives not workers to sense. collective may with the bargaining. employer better dispute on collective having makes management negotiate called to managers, negotiate is is the who bargaining arise. strike. A A system common strike is may way when in not work which employees and workers stop an take working action to 155 ecruoser namuH 2 Discuss the role and responsibility of employee and employer ➔ 2 H U M A N force an R E S O U R C E employer other means try keep to rule”, and a which standstill. Finally, tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 At to work following overtime. the try with In same case, also in an lock or disputes. may ban the strictly occurs make that is, “go the can The may use a company nd it public rule refuse very also contract of may book bring to they “work – it to work difcult their relations might have means may probably withdraw their which they employees employer to slow”, would workers changes employees by when organization case. a employees representatives Alternatively organization employer its However, Employee start potential. the occurs; forward demands. working rule action time, put their overtime this their labour Workers involves redundancy might meet below every An strike to to resolving negotiating. deliberately to of M A N A G E M E N T to operate. labour. (PR) campaign threaten workers employment. It out. Sources of conict The primary team ● in the Change Either well – this way, to poorly ● causes to in higher goals, conict. ● External resources new and ● available workers workers – changes political or of individuals any in to the see a or external conict in exibility believe that respond adapting the respects shareholders, factors. will employees certain workplace. have focus in the a on lesser their workplace workers do not business. the of of more the world these culture number the the business, can do to lead not resources of differently. differences that differs – external economic unaccustomed changes managers Insufcient in sometimes have management can from Lack cause that of the team. factors workplace: or understanding workers the employees Having who include goals all likelihood managers may and internal Not example. workers, the – either stress. the Managers and Often, – than values management for workers following: by cause increases consider acceptance the driven can which wages. Different of be technology, business between include interests sufciently ● can change individual or conict change new Different stake of workplace an to factors environment migration of laws and disrupt affect labour organization’s new can can can bring traditional regulations the the in culture, that like. no organization has unlimited resources. TOK discussion Managers must employees just to do think their employees’ demand decide jobs. pay. more that how they have Having Conict resources to are compete insufcient often allocated. arises for available resources when Frequently, also workers or resources touches managers pay. When looking out at the world, capitalists tended to see the world as composed of individuals. Peoples of left-wing political persuasions ● Poor communication – sometimes managers and workers clash generally see the world in because lack of communication has created misunderstanding. groups – groups of capitalists, Even when managers or workers have tried to communicate, groups of workers, etc. Which misunderstandings can occur. perspective is closer to the ● Poor performance – sometimes people do not do their jobs truth? properly, 156 a situation that can happen at all levels of an organization. 2 . 6 People not has impact an addressed or even doing their on (the jobs others properly, and can non-performing sacked), that too E M P L O Y E R can whether lead to E M P L O Y E E managers conict. employee cause A N D is If the or R E L A T I O N S O N LY ) workers, problem reprimanded, ( H L is demoted, conict. apph i li from a the third conciliation the groups third and in party employer party is to arbitration. dispute usually situation, both evidence. This and resolve and The in is aim them to outline evidence dispute. help called parties employee a of to process is conciliation nd conciliate their then representatives This a assessed the by and is to a seek An dispute. providing judgment help referred bring resolution. on positions will often to tnemeganam Sometimes as together independent In this appropriate is made. Employee par ticipation and industrial democracy In industrial workforce industrial linked worker workers’ trade For negotiate sharing seen to as implies and more consult workers’ on of means to is consultation the and representatives one industry, boards form which places of before but as changes are with of governing ”worker unions on power managers make the perhaps stress communication: decisions or trade less by extreme, appointment the in At production, company approach for over of takes bargaining fourth participation occurs. control democracy responsibility employee complete approach collective A or the representatives as all partial organization Another managers. retaining an industrial such with of ownership union others, participation”, often running cooperatives. or bodies. the democracy with producer democracies, in are arrangements introduced. No-strike agreement A no-strike undertake agreement industrial undertaken. possibility when the example, rises, be or It of can also taking the mean team management to between when unless that industrial management agreed made occurs action refer all a has team and trade union action. union may to to have has steps has Unions agreed disputes managers a procedural agreed usually certain agreed arbitration agreed have to not rst rule agree out not conditions. to to been any to strike For ination-proof should no pay agreement unions. Single-union agreement Where it is one called difculties between helps to unions one a union of is the in recognized negotiating unions avoid union is single-union the with get a with disrupt the to the managers. the only This several higher disruption dispute can to as agreement. representative situation unions pay and increase organization When production saves reduces than if for unions. one unions the employees, the competition rival only multiple process of managers of are whole It also several involved, organization. 157 ecruoser namuH 2 Conciliation and arbitration 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T r f i h Student workpoint For many Change the reasons, is employees typically internal or “forced” external change as desirable (or and protability, may on resist them by environments. necessary) for change in managers Whereas the the workplace. because managers health of the of 2.8 changes typically in view Be a researcher organization Use for workers are often threatened by change. There the internet research specic ● reasons that Discomfort tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 and want to – workers and employees maintain employees are the often status often happy resist with the to are an industrial change: current situation dispute that in country. your has occured quo. Describe: ● Fear – changes often makes employees afraid simply because they do ● not know what will What casued dispute? ● Insufcient the change the happen. reward requires – employees them to do often more perceive work for that no or implementing increase a it one combination many in Was of factors? compensation. ● ● Lack of job perform in skills the – employees changed work may not have the skills necessary What strategies adopted to by employees environment. a) were the and b) the employers ● Loss that of control they do – not when have managers control over insist their on change, employees feel ● lives. What was outcome ● Mistrust – employees sometimes do not trust Poor communication needs ● Poor to timing personal Prior with or ● in current might may – an do not know why the business is brought occur t an at about a poorly time with employee another for the needs of for either professional that, the may needs have organization or of had at an the or employees. a bad experience earlier time with his employer. support resist social change experience Social who – but reasons, change her employees change. organization ● – – change an employee may choose who to works resist for with the a group sake of of people maintaining relationships. Hr i d h ip f h Good lead organizations and done, a manage change organization to Organizations various change, the steps. degree 1. helps and for Forecast new is vision the and for the forward change the of reduce can team may impact the control to change but When and of rather effectively transition change potential the take process have resistance reaction should with process. the circumstances. the assessing change business set potential managers management a reduce can simply employees’ which the to desired managers rst move through and necessary, vision 158 a blindly its The the Develop If 2. to not process assessing Thereafter, do employees to it, the and its of the determining process. following the through impact and change realign desired largest steps: outcomes. aims and organization. allocate the necessary resources the managers. dispute? ● the of to implement the change. clear Was there ‘winner’? a 2 . 6 3. Involve employees employees 4. Regularly change report in the are not in the is problems process employees’ successes or are the to and all unfolding. process so that not occurring change On from the other process to E M P L O Y E E the do outset not feel stakeholders should dips. when A N D they appropriate Managers implementation condence. in change surprised communicate process E M P L O Y E R not be Pretending they clearly hand, inspire so how that managers O N LY ) Innovation, ethical considerations, weaken should INNOVATION, ETHICS AND CULTURE the to problems will ( H L that powerless. afraid are R E L A T I O N S report and cultural dierences may inuence employer–employee relations in an organization. condence. Train employees in advance of those changes that affect them an organization dynamic and often directly, which should allow them to see the benets of change enhances the reputation and increases immediately. If employees are not properly trained, the fears of lack the protability of a business. However, if of competence will be heightened. an organization is “too dynamic” (that is, 6. Routinely 7. Be communicate the benets of the constantly changing), employees may nd changes. the situation too stressful. They may grow aware of the stress that change can cause and support employees weary. as much as possible, before, during, and after change. Ethical considerations can also inuence employer–employee relations. When going through the change process, for rvii hkli example, if managers fail to consider fully ✓ Employee and employer representatives act on behalf of employees the human element, employees may and employers in negotiations. draw the conclusion that changes being ✓ Collective bargaining through trade is a negotiation between employees (usually under taken benet only the organization’s managers and owners, especially if a union) and their employers to agree wages and retrenchment of employees is involved. working conditions. Conversely, managers can build trust if ✓ Slowdowns than they occur when workers deliberately work less efciently they treat employees ethically: whenever possible, retraining employees for new can. jobs, giving them adequate time to learn, ✓ When employees work-to-rule they follow every rule and regulation and providing suppor t throughout. In exactly, which often means slowing down production. general, whether it is a static situation ✓ An overtime ban is when employees refuse to work any more than or a changing environment, employers should treat employees well, with ethical their contracted hours. considerations in mind. Treating employees ✓ When workers outside ✓ their Employers changing strike, refuse to work and may also protest workplace. may the they so generally pays o. negotiate terms of well can be costly, but in the long run doing by making employees threats contracts. of redundancies This would put or pressure Finally, cultural dierences, both within an organization and relating to the broader culture of where the business is located, on workers and might persuade them to agree to a settlement. play a role in employer–employee ✓ A lock-out employees involves from closing working the and business being for a short time, preventing paid. relations. Some cultures have traditions of workplace democracy, others of paternalism, still others of authoritarian ✓ Potential sources of conict involve change, differing interests or management. Regardless, these internal values, external factors such as the economy, poor communication and external cultures inuence managers’ and poor performance. and workers’ expectations and, thus, ✓ Conicts can industrial be resolved democracy, through no-strike conciliation agreements, and and arbitration, employer–employee relationships. single-union agreements. ✓ Successful through organizations the process of use their HR strategy to manage employees change. 159 tnemeganam On the one hand, innovation makes 5. ecruoser namuH 2 Innovation is a two-edged sword. 2 H U M A N R E S O U R C E M A N A G E M E N T Pi qi Get Get Going Going is a wheelchairs been charity to experiencing employees and Recent changes the tnemeganam ecruoser namuH 2 the to communication issues. employees a) how those the a Identify two Evaluate IB, May are problems aims prot effects and 2005 the a chief and led to a a to provide the low the at and business charity. is this keen has of charity moving of solutions in Get to formal that the Going. and might two be from may a be tall problems examples used of have to led solve to change. different organization. Going has motivation structure executive losses fearing of to leaving tall job objectives Get has ago start, to in Get [4 marks] [6 marks] [4 marks] [6 marks] a structure. examples two This about unhappy years successful from and making on fteen a considering started communications communications After organization more organizational informal d) the of created problems. some have becoming Examine at c) Rumours Explain from b) in was people. nancial among led 160 that disabled of Going. poor 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n t s 3.1 S ources of nanc e By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: explain the role of nance for businesses in terms of capital ➔ expenditure and revenue expenditure comment on the following internal sources of nance: personal ➔ stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 funds, retained prot and sale of assets comment on the following external sources of nance: share capital, ➔ loan capital, overdrafts, trade credit, grants, subsidies, debt factoring, leasing, venture capital and business angels ➔ dene shor t-, medium- and long-term nance ➔ discuss the appropriateness, advantages, and disadvantages of sources of nance for a given situation. All forms they of including future or business undertake. be starting growth clear classied The on as a and the organization money business, for expansion. exact either be its As purpose capital need could a of funding needed day-to-day result, their for for a or various of operations, businesses nance. expenditure the variety need This revenue activities reasons, or to for its ascertain purpose can be expenditure Capital expenditure This is more are money than known vehicles, of a as and initial security bank to purchasing long for assist benets for most van be items used and These the xed accrued include xed assets a to business to the can of expenditures businesses by in a over that over be are the used longer as and from For be to their (nancial such as investments example, expenditure will purpose Due nance long-term grow. this the term. of for items buildings, for collateral source capital last Such land, needed therefore termed will again. machinery, particular are business business and assets succeed is a over business repayment Capital a acquire may assets income pledged intended the xed cost, loans). to and equipment. generating high spent year spread because over the term. Revenue expenditure This is money payments and fuel. Revenue business or spent on expenses They do not expenditure operational the day-to-day include involve needs and rent, the to be should running wages, purchase covered therefore raw of of a business. materials, longer-term, immediately provide to These insurance, xed keep immediate assets. the benets, 161 3 F i n a n c e unlike capital a n d a c c o u n ts expenditure which has a long-term focus. Businesses need Key terms to be will cautious make it not to difcult have for consistently them to build high revenue sufcient expenditure capital in order as to this make Capital expenditure long-term investments. In addition, it may make it extremely difcult money spent to acquire xed for them to get out of a sudden crisis situation. For example, if a school assets in a business is spending paying most food of its money suppliers, and paying these salaries costs are and not bonuses checked, it to teachers may be or unable to Revenue expenditure build new classrooms to accommodate any increases in student demand. money used in the day-to-day In a business, a high level of expenses may also erode the prots. running of a business Student workpoint 3.1 Be a researcher Choose in. any Using stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 each sources internal list of multinational Internet company Separately The two the what each its or any main for a companies other and can you revenue be are resource, expenditures business external that available capital company’s nance sources or on a interested nd out for expenditures are. table. obtained from either sources. irl r f Internal usually include nance from the is money already obtained established from within businesses. the Some business of these and is sources following. Personal funds This is their sole a key own traders shows investors to approach of nance need to traders if these or for because business, for By their it is they especially if it over the and be is of a may the the that It risk their prove only the and is to life’s of In is a a mostly addition, good no start source or In or to need interest savings. this signal might owners to from savings, preferred and the difcult source comes personal business available, great it their business. nance. investing it and with business easily poses large this to sources could not traders institutions cheap However, are sole investing control nancial additional paid. savings nance commitment because be of savings. maximize investment other source personal will sole addition, maintain a Key terms funding. Personal funds Retained prot a source of nance for sole This is the prot that remains after a business has paid tax to the traders that comes mostly from government (corporation tax) and dividends to shareholders. It is also their own personal savings known as business, ploughed-back becoming Importantly, an retained prot important prots do and may source not of be reinvested nance necessarily for into the represent the organization. surplus Retained prot cash prot that remains after a available to a business. Rather, they represent how the business has business has paid corporation managed its prots. For example, whether it has distributed them as tax to the government and dividends or reinvested them in the business. If reinvested, they are dividends to shareholders reected of 162 as retained increases prot to assets include the which could following. include cash. The advantages 3 . 1 ● It is cheap because ● It is a ● It is exible as ● The owners have permanent interference However, are does source can be businesses incur nance used other some not of control from there Start-up ● it it in over a interest as it way their nancial O F F I N A N C E charges. does the S O U R C E S not have business retained such be deems prots institutions to repaid. t. without as banks. disadvantages: will not have any retained prot as they are new ventures. ● If retained ● In some buffer prot cases for is too owners low, may emergencies or it may not overuse for be the future sufcient retained growth for prot expansion. and leave no opportunities. Key term A ● high retained prot may mean that either very little or nothing paid out to shareholders as stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Sale of assets was dividends. when a business sells o its unwanted or unused assets to Sale of assets raise funds This is when a funds. These assets obsolete could The business from also sell capital interest or only an that be may off obsolete needs rm any of that or may option lack nd a back to option, use. that In then be tied case leases to to some which this the is up are unwanted longer or sell sell. the cases a that The In by not will to, the an of the not that asset be not be in a to it No may new ones time- the sale the using. cash used. that may adopt asset sell and especially may include raising is raise businesses being drawback it to business may way are assets cash, they businesses assets to the raise addition, selling back unused good businesses business asset is assets involves the it established to To equipment that in or required buildings. incurred. assets buyer In its land assets costs excess machinery. no excess available any to are off redundant selling borrowing consuming lease that machinery advantage sells case business a of and still specialist business. Student workpoint 3.2 Be a researcher Using an Internet organizations nance and to search that rely operate. engine to What a such large are the as extent main Google, on nd internal internal at least sources sources ve of they use, why? exrl r f Key term External business. provide nance These the is mo ne y coul d funds . be S o me obta ine d fr om of fr om s ou r c es i ns ti tut io ns the se ex t er n a l or out si de i nd ivi du a ls so ur c e s of t he wil li n g n a n c e to Share capital i n c lu de money raised from the sale of the following. shares of a limited company 163 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Share capital This is is money also raised known as shareholders The the term and company shares it as Other will stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 that a there be paid public or and are no limited shareholders be via the are it limited the is a the by and of the to In stock of of new share capital Another may be is from expect addition, company to willing business will stock Nairobi, source the prot. shareholders the securities business). relieves a public as advantage shareholders makes limited London Tokyo, The the sold the Bombay, this ownership is as made. amount of where and world are private known market and known prots shares market by are maximum permanent (repaid hand, when Unlike public, share company shares the raise. exchanges. that original stock to in business the the suggests include other a purchased payments the of these organized stock is of dividends the exchange the when from to redeemed On to special and York companies hands a exchanges interest dividends sold in nance to shares intend bonds) stock New expenses. change not sold and of Buyers capital regulated of need sale entitled share global source not additional a be are oldest Johannesburg, capital is the capital. company are shares The exchange. a that This example investors. as of companies exchange (for may authorized shareholders limited from equity to for diluted investors or exchange. Loan capital Also known institutions however, until the rates not debt these full may does as such as either repayment. A periodically based of this source quickly for a lower The to to of pay owners on it still their in that a have is sum. full on Its on of is and the is burden the amount business if no one that loan The trading oors of the New York (top) and Tokyo (bottom) stock advantage exchanges arranged the can they interest changes spread to organizations is the The be repaid; evenly The of hand, can be rate conditions. repayment the paid. term other to spread interest the nancial loan usually entire accessible Large control the from the interest) xed reducing depending on are market purpose. time, lump it A for rate, prevailing is of charges xed sourced charged plus variable. interest specic period money is (principal or the is (installments) remains nance rm’s interest dilute xed and variable predetermined having amount uctuate this Interest repayments loan be capital, banks. out over business negotiate wish to shares a of for borrow. are issued ownership. Key terms However, there are drawbacks. The capital will have to be redeemed even Loan capital though will be the business required lead to the that took before seizure this is of option a making any funds rm’s may losses be and are assets. faced lent If in some out. Failure variable with a cases interest high debt collateral to pay rates the (security) loan increase, repayment may a rm burden. money sourced from nancial institutions such as banks, with interest charged on the loan to be repaid Overdrafts Overdrafts This is when a lending institution allows a rm to withdraw more when a lending institution money than it currently has in its account, which is called overdrawing allows a rm to withdraw more from the account. In most cases the overdrawn amount is an agreed money than it currently has in amount that has a limit amount overdrawn. placed on it. Interest is charged only on the its account 164 However, exceeding the limit set may attract higher 3 . 1 additional costs. The advantage of a bank overdraft is that it S O U R C E S O F F I N A N C E provides Key terms an opportunity (even in for rms situations to where spend there more is no than they money in have the in their account), account which Trade credit greatly helps in settling short-term debts such as paying suppliers or the an agreement between wages of staff. It is a exible form of nance as its demand will depend businesses that allows the on the needs of the business at a particular point in time. Charging buyer of goods or services to interest only on the amount overdrawn may make it even cheaper than pay the seller at a later date loan to capital. prevent With them an overdraft from facility, bouncing. The banks major can cover drawback a is rm’s that cheques banks can Grants ask for the overdraft to be paid back at very short notice. In addition, funds usually provided by a due to the variable nature of an overdraft, the bank may at times charge government, foundation, trust, high interest rates. or other agency to businesses that do not need to be repaid Trade credit or is an agreement services cash by to pay transaction most between the is creditors seller done at (trade at businesses a the later time credit that date. of In allows essence, trading. providers) the The usually buyer no goods immediate credit lasts of period from 30 nancial assistance granted offered to Subsidies stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 This by a government, a non- 90 governmental organization days; jewellery businesses are known to extend it to at least 180 days. (NGO), or an individual to A major advantage of trade credit is that by delaying payments to suppor t business enterprises suppliers, businesses are left in a better cash-ow position than if they that are in the public interest paid for cash the credit immediately. length purchased after and of receivers) the by the agreed out also the In may even an period. on cash. period may is credit lose paying suppliers It interest-free A disadvantage possibility addition, lead refuse to to means of that getting delaying the is in of funds debtors payment future raising discounts development engage of to (trade had they creditors poor relations transactions with the debtors. Grants These or will the be In prefer high that write on of its who offer recipient. The depending on a so as grant is the to is the that it it Bill how does that and they of agree welfare Melinda promoting not grant foundation, grant, have comes to of plan for be with in people Gates use are example, up areas living in Foundation including to to grant) set social trust, businesses the Governments, organizations on a (providers the mostly the receive showing grant. focus of to improve that objective government, businesses as a a makers US-based with downside the to such to by order proposal receives grants of In grant grants organizations, advantage a cases Foundations most exempt to most to provided businesses. unemployment area. offer usually to expected selective would key funds agency money. very of are other other tax- responsibility. paid back “strings by A the attached” maker. Subsidies A subsidy is nancial governmental enterprises assistance organization that subsidies given subsidies are are to in the to help (NGO) public domestic given granted or a government, individual interest. farming these an by Farm industries. industries to In most in non- support subsidies survive a a are cases very business common the cash competitive 165 3 F i n a n c e environment while still market by price businesses their able goes A to a c c o u n ts being being subvention. for a n d increase especially marred political sell their nancial the produce gain. In cost of production, of granting their demand grants, with for government interference in the do low this is market by not is that charging need subsidies, is to the as it helps lower be that subsidization prices, where known subsidies goods subsidies at situations advantage Like drawback, to reap below major products. by able to prices repaid. they are A often process. Debt factoring This is debt where factor. a It responsibility may stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 these the on the the debt higher the In to use customer it to does it not for to of of may of to risk pay to the a The the is loses is a from counts of getting a a business projects. and to as willing on percentage fees factor money more or customer as the passed repayment loyal the debt that activities debt a on amount possibility service such of revenue owed the debt debt full as takes cent factoring other and losing the the business full per sales debt debt fund a the collecting failing the collecting that receive 80–90 of known factor business. collect due administrative business means court use party the the cent higher upfront, are third to to per advantage can a where between proceed The pay An high to owed 10–20 responsibility charge a debt then prot. that or harsh to be cash addition, factors and prot. invoice business disadvantages because known the remaining will risk The the factor’s factors factor. job. The immediate prots are pay its arrangement collecting invoices debt sells nancial percentage addition, the for debtors. of gets a immediately owed part business is if its factors their the threatening of debt do In to to debt take the debt. Leasing This is where company a business (lessor) to (lessee) acquire or enters use into a particular contract assets with such a as Key terms leasing machinery, Debt factoring equipment, or to it by purchase get period, of into a which usually car leasing that purchase a the lasts are rm a or rm for more lessee. to than lease need Second, the use to three lessor at high takes cases the as on without payments years, assets. a asset some such their have an leasing In where, organizations known not to monthly and agreement Large does asset. lessor lease asset. companies is allows Periodic the nance the This cash. between purchasing and to with agreement may property. is of A major the the given airlines initial are made and leasing the option electronic advantage capital of responsibility for collecting the debt owed to the business and provides the business with a percentage of the owed debt in cash outlay responsibility a nancial arrangement where the debt factor takes on the businesses end it having of Leasing repair and particular In the maintenance assets long are haul, the outright the leasing of required though, purchase charges. the of asset. only leasing an asset Moreover, a In for can due addition, short turn to leased periods out the leasing to of be is time more accumulated asset cannot useful act or when occasionally. expensive total as costs collateral than a rm to use an asset without having to purchase it by cash of for a source of nance that allows a Venture capital business seeking a loan as an additional source of nance. nancial capital provided by investors to high-risk , high- Venture capital potential star t-up rms or This is nancial capital provided by investors to high-risk, high-potential small businesses start-up 166 rms or small businesses. Venture capitalists usually fund 3 . 1 start-ups that nd it difcult to access money from other S O U R C E S O F F I N A N C E nancial Key terms institutions or organizations capital and markets. investment Venture banks. capitalists They own include a stake specialist in the businesses Business angels they invest in with the expectation of beneting from future prots. highly auent individuals However, due the to to the high risks involved, they expect the rms needing who provide nancial funds produce a thoroughly researched business plan to help capital to small star t-ups or mitigate the risk of investment. The key advantage of venture capitalists entrepreneurs in return for is that they provide funding to businesses that other institutions ownership equity in their might regard as too high a risk. In addition, in an effort to protect businesses investment providing is that up the increase their are required venture businesses they guidance capitalists they involved may invest equity in stake in the where set and in very if it is prot are rms, decision needed. high these these rm’s not often making The disadvantage targets for attained by a by the they large start- usually percentage. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 their Business angels Also known provide ownership that show provide a that good they to invest In addition, the or their or they is of rather on the in A They nancial angel how a businesses growth. continually terms This viable they is a of than succeed by invest a in, may the angels institutions are venture using known is. their capital. good for businesses They they nancial who return support other business assume in business because good may individuals high-risk advantage with investors in future or business coupled afuent entrepreneurs invest or major businesses. than very or returns helping the are injection lifetime. favourable that these start-ups high capital experience ownership ownership for start-up focus business small businesses. initial person disadvantage control their more small the to potential give of in extensive in through lenders investors, capital equity or key angel one-time businesses is as nancial The degree therefore of diluting entrepreneur. yduts esaC Vf sfrm Ky: exg h Rg Rlbly f Fl srv h Pr Rrl Ky customers. Micro-Finance Institutions (MFIs) such as Faulu Kenya do successfully provide nancial services for the poor, but they are hampered by poor infrastructure and low levels of technology. In order to address this problem Safaricom Kenya, one of the two mobile service providers currently operating in Kenya, developed an appropriate technology. In Kenya there are less than two million bank accounts The result was MPESA, an electronic money transfer serving the country’s population of 32 million people. product aimed at making nancial transactions faster, The reasons for this disparity include the high cost of cheaper and more secure. MPESA allows transfer banking and the fact that the majority of the people of money between individuals, transfer of money have low incomes with a large percentage of them between individuals and businesses, cash withdrawal living on an average of one dollar a day. Such people and deposit at registered retail outlets as payment do not feel comfor table interacting with commercial for goods and services through the mobile phone banks that typically target middle and upper income shor t message service (SMS). MPESA account holders 167 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts can deposit or withdraw money into or from their institutions and retail outlets. Trials on new training vir tual accounts at Safaricom vendor shops or at an methods for potential MPESA users are also under way. increasing number of outlets such as supermarkets Vodafone also plans to introduce the system in other and petrol stations. Once the money is in their developing countries. accounts, they can use it to pay bills, transfer to other people or purchase goods and services. Exam-style questions In October 2005, MPESA trials were successfully 1. Describe two challenges encountered by launched in Kenya, featuring eight Safaricom dealer Micro-Finance Institutions such as shops and 450 Faulu Kenya clients and concluded Faulu Kenya. [4 marks] in May 2006. Vodafone Group Plc provided 990,000 2. Explain two advantages and one disadvantage Sterling pounds and DFID 910,000 pounds sterling to of Micro-Finance Institutions for Kenyan nance the pilot project. Consult Hyperion a British people. [6 marks] ICT rm developed the technology that was utilized by mobile service provider Safaricom Kenya through 3. Compare and contrast the nancial services stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 dealers, retailers and MFIs among others. The product provided by Safaricom’s MPESA with those of has been successfully launched by Safaricom commercial banks in Kenya. [10 marks] and plans are underway to recruit more nancial Student workpoint 3.3 Be a researcher Find out how the organizations various compare sources with the of nance sources for for private public sector sector organizations. shr-, mm- lg-rm In determining long the be term, type of be to of following under the with nance. duration whether a to important classify to of with asset is source no of source the being long-term medium-term There a consider consideration. type nanced nanced term is asset matched should be it The of nanced. nance but nance type nance, uniformly nance, of investor’s a and agreed most as short, personal nance Thus, a should a short-term of nancial asset asset literature asset should with determining the uses or or therefore long-term medium-term way medium preference short- exact the denitions. Shor t-term nance This is money therefore one to year be term needed provides or paid less. with nance its for the needed External 12 short-term months include day-to-day working bank of a running capital. sources trading overdrafts, or of This of a business nance nance nancial trade is credit are year. and and that lasts usually Examples debt for expected of short- TOK discussion factoring. What role does intuition play in nancial decision making? Medium-term nance Is there a moral obligation for This is money mostly used to purchase assets such as equipment or nancial institutions to lend to vehicles that have useful lifespans for a specic period of time. This every star t-up business? source ve nance years. term 168 of bank has Examples loans and a of duration period medium-term grants. of between sources one include year and leasing, about medium- 3 . 1 S O U R C E S O F F I N A N C E Long-term nance This is assets funding or nance term other may obtained be nance for expansion anywhere sources the purpose requirements from include more of of purchasing a than long-term business. ve bank to long-term The around loans and xed duration 30 of years. share the Long- capital. Student workpoint 3.4 Be knowledgeable Prepare and nance into complete short, ● debt ● retained ● trade ● leasing ● sale ● venture ● share ● overdrafts ● loan ● subsidies. a table medium that or classies long the following sources of term: factoring stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 prot credit of assets capital capital capital Fr g h h f r f In determining for a given inuence the appropriateness situation, their rms decision. need Some to of of using consider these a a particular number factors are source of of factors explored nance which can below. Purpose or use of funds Businesses specic it be term be will need used for the day-to-day appropriate suitable to requirements. if raw match What purchase running when of of the are will long-term the of the a xed needed nance carefully nance xed business? purchasing materials source exactly assets be or Long-term asset, urgently while in the used for loan trade to their for? the Will short- capital credit may may be business. Cost Businesses obtaining a will administration the need source costs, opportunity choosing when one of on consider nance. and cost source deciding to over the costs (the most costs associated next the thoroughly Such best other) all the include with a alternative is also appropriate an source costs interest share that with payments, issue. is In addition, forgone important of associated after consideration nance. 169 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Status and size INNOVATION Public limited companies can obtain nance from various sources, Read the summary from the whereas sole traders less known will not be able to. This is because sole traders are Finance for Innovation (http:// well and smaller in size than public limited companies. For www.awt.nl/upload/documents/ example, the issue of shares is a source of nance that is only possible publicaties/tekst/as36.pdf) for public limited companies and not sole traders. In addition, large What in your opinion would you organizations have added collateral that they can use to negotiate for consider to be the best source lower interest rates from nancial institutions. of nance for innovation? What factors may inuence Amount required your decision on this source of nance? Carry out research on For small amounts, rms may consider mostly short-term sources of how various global businesses are nance such as bank overdrafts while, for larger amounts, long-term funding their innovations. bank loans sources or will the be issue used of shares depending are on available the options. amount Therefore varying required. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Flexibility This one looks into sour ce additional which to sources could demand the be that availability at wi th In p a r ticula r r e q ui r e such how whi ch s ome inue nce d may of determines ease anothe r. by, bu si n es s p oi n t s for it of can bu si n e ss e s d ur in g e x am pl e, shor t- te r m s o urce s e x i b l e a ca se s in t he i r of su c h a fr om need tra d in g s e a so na l so urc e s fundi ng s w it c h wi ll p er io d c h a n ge s fu n di n g. sh o rt in T he pe r iod a l so i s. State of the external environment This involves increases prices both in in an factors interest economy) consumers businesses rising and make interest increased that rates cost in the or will greatly producers. sourcing rates business ination may not no control affect the nance. the best of. this Taking choice For increases purchasing Consequently, their be has (persistent for will up a a example, in average decisions affect bank rm the loan because of choices with of the involved. Gearing This refers If a is said company to smaller there total may are a large of while loan companies, and share capital Company is high A geared. institutions These (see is way section of US$40 therefore of 3.6). they will share A and A will capital capital that million, are reluctant need gearing to is to B, each loan to lend a of B US$20 company as risky money alternative calculating a assume company of it has with capital capital viewed seek by capital geared while share capital. example, compared businesses therefore a loan share low For have and and to company geared be is capital. may US$50 low measuring loan million High-geared and businesses One to Company capital of of share company company million loan a capital million. a between proportion geared , $60 nance. ratio has of nancial rms. relationship high two have which the proportion million. 170 be capital US$10 of to the to B by such sources gearing 3 . 1 S O U R C E S O F F I N A N C E grwh r wrkg wh Fm MTN Uganda’s MobileMoney The power of the MTN Fundamo service achieved one of the most remarkable and rapid par tnership growth rates ever witnessed MTN MobileMoney was launched as a way to allow the in the mobile nancial consumers to send and receive money, top up airtime services industry. In a year and perform many other services using a mobile phone. after launching, the service MTN Uganda saw the pressing need to oer services to a had registered more than population desperate for nancial inclusion, and it turned one million users, 16% of its to Fundamo to help roll out the ambitious national project. subscriber base. Today, it MTN MobileMoney makes use of the basic Fundamo remains one of the world’s most platform with an additional layer of services designed successful MFS deployments. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 yduts esaC Mtn ug hv f h m rmrkbl mbl my specically for the Ugandan environment and to meet The success of the service, however, has gone far fur ther regulatory requirements. than simply connecting the previously unbanked. MTN and Fundamo spent over a year in Africa before the The introduction of mobile payments has led to a launch of Mobile Money, interviewing potential users of fundamental shift in the rural and peri-urban economies. the service from all age-groups and business sectors. This market research allowed Fundamo to rene aspects of the About MTN Uganda service to make sure that it would be well received and met In October 21 1998, MTN Uganda launched commercial the needs and aspirations of the Ugandan communities. services in Uganda. MTN has since grown to be the MTN MobileMoney is an electronic wallet service that leading mobile operator in the country. enables you to send and receive money anywhere in MTN adopted a wireless approach to providing Uganda using your phone. MTN MobileMoney users are telecommunications services to the Ugandan market, able to: which proved to be a convenient and fast method of ● Send money to any MTN mobile phone user; rolling out services. Despite insucient infrastructure registered or not. (power, roads etc.) MTN now covers the majority of ● Send money to mobile phone users on other local both the urban and rural population networks using the MTN agent network . ● Withdraw cash at any authorised MTN Uganda’s nancial position – the MobileMoney agent. oppor tunity for MTN ● There are over 30 banks in Uganda, but a banking Pay bills such as DStv, anywhere conveniently with immediate results. penetration rate of no more than 10%. ● Buy air time for themselves and others on the MTN network directly and conveniently. The traditional banking model involves taking branches to various locations, an option that is not compatible with ● Manage their MTN MobileMoney accounts. poor countries such as Uganda that cannot aord to make The go-to-market strategy was designed to ensure rapid the investment required for such a complex infrastructure. uptake of the services. However, even the highest hopes Furthermore, some traditional banking branches were of the par tners were exceeded by the response. It was unable to support the number of customers they can testament to the robust Fudamo platform that MTN was generate in an area. The advent of mobile money provided able to continue to sign up new customers onto the everyone with the opportunity to access nancial inclusion. system, relying on the integrity of the Fundamo solution. This presented an oppor tunity for MTN Uganda to The system was designed at the outset to handle provide banking services using mobile. complex transactions as the long-term view was to migrate the users onto newer services like international remittances and mobile insurance. 171 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts MTN Uganda’s success has been referenced in a number MTN Uganda continues to be one of the most successful of articles looking at mobile money implementations in Mobile Money deployments globally to date. It continues to the developing world. The reason for the success has innovate introducing new, useful services on a regular basis been the non-traditional, below the line methods used such as paying government pensions through the system. by MTN. The distribution model of “by the people, for the Due to the success of the project, Western Union people” has relied on empowering the local population announced that it had chosen Uganda as the rst through education and solid entrepreneurial opportunity. country to roll out its international remittance service Over 2500 MobileMoney ‘foot soldiers’ were trained on in par tnership with MTN. the system. Equipped with basic infrastructure such as Once the new international remittance service was photocopiers, marquees, relevant marketing material activated, MTN subscribers registered for MobileMoney and transpor t, the foot soldiers canvassed new users were able to receive Western Union Money Transfer across the country. transactions in their mobile accounts. In addition, stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Fundamo invested an enormous amount of time MobileMoney users in cer tain countries are now able ensuring that the sign-up process was both simple to send Western Union Money Transfer transactions and logical, while complying with all regulatory directly from their mobile phones for pay-out at one of requirements. The service menu was also designed Western Union’s agent locations in territories around to work with even the most rudimentary handsets to the world. ensure the service is as inclusive as possible. Adapted from : http://www.fundamo.com/PDF/Case%20 Service agents are incentivised using a commission- study/MTN%20Uganda%20Case%20Study.pdf based system which rewards them immediately upon the sign-up of new user, and on transactions levels. Exam-style questions This was a signicant boost to local communities 1. Outline the main activities of MTN Uganda and was warmly welcomed by governments who are in the nancial services sector. [ 4 marks] looking for SMME job creation. More impor tantly, it 2. Explain how three dierent stakeholders has meant that agents are driven to ensure customer have been aected by the introduction of satisfaction and are always on the lookout for ways to MTN Mobile money. [6 marks] make the user-experience more rewarding. 3. Results To what extent have MTN and Fundamo reached their strategic objectives in Uganda? [10 marks] In just over a year MTN Uganda registered 1 million MobileMoney service users - 16% of its subscriber base. Rv hkl ✓ Capital xed expenditure assets in machinery, a business wages, ✓ Internal within ✓ External outside capital, debt 172 of sources of day that of ✓ and include and are that are share credit, venture less lasts of rent, as a thirty obtained of mostly years, obtained capital, grants, loan subsidies, capitalists and In nance the the to and state to more funding use the size, of the the year its xed of a amount external that about assets ve ve such nance years for assets the or to purpose other business. appropriate funds, year nance to obtained term one needed Long-term than businesses of for with purchase vehicles. of long on purpose status used one requirements deciding lasts Medium-term or is purchasing which business than duration expansion ✓ more equipment with loans, is a capital. from years nance provides working is fuel. personal Short-term or assets. include trade acquire running which include leasing, angels. to nance business factoring, vehicles insurance sale to include expenditure nance, and overdrafts, business day expenses business, prots the the spent which revenue materials, sources the retained on with raw money buildings, while spent is business, land, equipment, money a need cost, source to of consider; exibility, required, gearing environment. their and 3 . 1 S O U R C E S O F F I N A N C E Pr q Three Hills Hills interested 18 to 25 is Her her Driving in owned by sell increased loan a) or to a licence mostly Maria driving to students who business she Therefore, fund bank this. set was expenditure her demand instructors. nance are provides a expenditure revenue to School drive who instructions a car. have They to people target nished high people school was she ve on will is up half after plans She it about two years $90,000 that buying debating to as a more seek using the amount years need ago in in rst the going cars while same year. and taking Due employing up sources a long Comment c) between capital expenditure and help d) Evaluate term [4 on two her more of revenue two benets and two drawbacks of raising [6 medium expand the her view preferable option expansion plans. term sources of nance available to than taking a bank [6 up a long overdraft term for loan would Maria’s be using marks] Maria business that marks] money savings Explain She to overdraft. Differentiate ones or savings. concern. alternative between her year expenditure b) aged and/ students. capital plans School obtaining who university It Driving stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Three to marks] a business [9 marks] 173 3.2 C osts and revenues By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ explain the dierent types of costs, using examples ➔ comment on the meaning of the term revenue and, using examples, suggest various revenue streams available to organizations. ir Costs and success of revenues any stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 information Cost run refers its the Businesses them total important for factors therefore effective expenditure need decision incurred that determine accurate the and reliable making. by a business in order to operations. Revenue and very business. about to are is a measure of the money generated from the sale of goods services. Prot costs. is A calculated high by positive nding out difference the is a difference good between indicator of revenues business and success. typ f Fixed costs These are services costs any business and are They of include if a is at goods rent, rm week’s usually therefore in the in pays a in run. factor does rent of will to the per of with that have note short per to xed to are run paid mostly is costs do and time or or of related per as year. a xed For period to costs instance, decides despite not goods needed of payments. paid of regardless dened (resource month be amount be Examples interest need the bi-annually, short change. $5,000 that They production and still in. quarter, The not salaries, rent vary engages short one important output rm the or expenses month, services) this change are per least or not insurance, holiday, change paid xed when produce do They activity usually remain time that produced. the change to take a holiday. due to It a run. Variable costs These are costs produced. activity. long are leads to costs, 174 These run They variable are Variable produced. the that They (a also an sales costs are pegged are or are costs period increase costs vary change expenses of to in that volume that time sales, can in commissions, the related be when variable incurred. with change costs. Examples packaging, as number they factors an If of units energy goods to paid in the in sales per usage services quantity short or are run include costs. or in variable). output produced costs or business production are variable and are both increase no of of proportion incurred all that in then raw sold no material 3 . 2 All xed costs) costs gives (TFC) + (total us total the xed total variable costs) costs. costs added Hence, to all total variable costs costs (TC) = C O S T S (total total A N D R E V E N U E S variable xed costs (TVC). Semi-variable costs are costs comprising Semi-variable costs consumption, after exceeded. costs. The however, Labour be the while greater costs the phone call are extra also are hours. for is known (number of level variable as levels the the the such example which calls as would make costs be incurs costs. for the will still The regular be a a or its or level the xed total cost would for rental variable costs; costs. worked, made xed is mixed xed monthly rm’s up set hours overtime constitutes made) production when higher rm worker payment components. of semi-xed semi-variable to Another variable given become of any charge) and a produced month cost (standing charges they example per xed xed production units an paid are the no variable line which costs when salary working the Such both remain cost, for a stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 These while cost. Direct costs These the can are directly (known of costs that production our as used in in can a restaurant be specic traced cost production food be of to a centres). making identied goods Some bread only with a of bakery, rm, chicken and clearly They product, examples in or services. particular manufacturing selling or expenses department, direct the the attributed are cost cost products. costs of of or labour Generally, that Rent on business premises is process include chicken to the used in direct a an indirect cost cost in car fast- costs Key terms include raw materials, direct labour, and packaging costs. Fixed costs Indirect costs These of are costs specic traceable that goods to a costs that do not change or are not clearly services. given cost They centre identied are such with expenses as the that product, with the amount of goods or production are not activity, or directly services produced department. Variable costs As a result, They are include they also rent, advertising are difcult known ofce as staff expenditure, to assign overheads salaries, or audit security, to particular overhead fees, interest legal on cost centres. costs. loans, and costs that change with the Examples expenses, insurance, warehouse costs. number of goods or services produced Semi-variable costs costs comprising both xed and variable components Direct cost costs that can be identied with the production of specic goods or services Indirect cost costs that are not clearly identied with the production of specic goods or services Raw materials are a direct cost 175 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Student workpoint 3.5 Exam tip Be a researcher In most cases indirect costs are usually xed costs while Research the following organizations and identify the various costs direct costs are usually they incur: variable costs. However, both ● An airline ● A mobile ● A high ● A hospital ● A bank indirect and direct costs can phone be either xed or variable company depending on the specic school nature of business activity. Classify of the these costs costs into can either also be xed, variable categorized as or semi-variable. direct or Which indirect? stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Total revenue This is the total calculated Total by revenue Abbreviated where For TR is amount = as price TR total example, if a (US$8 200,000) revenue, per P × month, = also a price unit × rm per receives unit quantity by from the its sales. number of It is units sold: sold Q P is price toy-producing toys Total a = money the revenue, 200,000 × of multiplying then its rm total US$1,600,000 known as per sales unit and charges US$8 revenue or for US$1.6 revenue Q is the per the quantity toy and month sold. sells will be million. or turnover, should not be Key terms confused account. the with In goods earnings addition, or services or prots, total which revenue were sold on take includes credit or costs all or expenses income cash. into received, However, a whether Revenue rm’s a measure of the money revenue is obtained not only from its trading activities. Other revenue generated from the sale of streams include the following: goods and services ● Rental income – a business could receive income from rent it collects Total revenue from out property its ofce products is it or has invested factory space in. A seasonal during times business when could demand also for hire its low. the total amount of money a rm receives from the sale of goods or services, found by ● Sale of xed assets – this could be from the sale of unused or multiplying the price per unit underutilized assets in Dividends business a business. by the number of units sold ● and ● is – a entitled Interest on to a could share deposits – of be the holding a shareholder prots, also substantial in other known amounts as of businesses dividends. cash in the TOK discussion bank can interest lead on to the a business money if earning the good interest rates levels are of accumulated favourable. To what extent is mathematics ● Donations – organization these could targeting be a mostly cash gift made charitable by an individual organizations. or a vital input in knowing the costs and revenues of a business? ● 176 Grants and subsidies – see section 3.1. 3 . 2 C O S T S A N D R E V E N U E S Rv hkl ✓ Fixed costs services rm are engages goods costs produced or in. that and Variable services do are not paid costs produced or change with regardless are costs that of that change the any amount business vary in with of the proportion goods activity number to or the of business activity. Total cost is the ✓ Semi-variable components ✓ Direct costs product, clearly ✓ Total and are revenue xed are are It is is with the also xed that that the have as can as be centres streams gained sales to and both xed directly while of businesses on costs the or or traced mixed to a costs of costs particular are or not services. goods and turnover include deposits, variable goods sale sales costs and indirect specic from revenue interests variable semi-xed production income dividends, all known cost known revenue assets, also or of costs expenses department Available of costs identied services. ✓ summation stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 ✓ rental income, donations, sale grants and subsidies. 177 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Pr q TAK TAK is a sole providing a good down on prot stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 178 of the his by Dene had (ii) (iii) and close his and of his in next him on for up variable his was He the In He that set his focuses up grew quite as costs he aware rst approached performance of a so his semi-variable year therefore streams on included ran of he insignicant has revenue has Tom The became costing. more year. by costs Tom economy. improve following set tourists. revenue the seek to business impact because help the xed an business services costs downturn the (i) xed costs to travel operated prot consultant a) he also any following a As that make and amount business. costs proprietorship tour did resorted as not especially to to cut guarantee nancial his business. terms costs [2 marks] revenue [2 marks] prot [2 marks] [5 marks] [9 marks] b) Using examples c) Explain three Tom how on explain ways to the the term nancial improve his “semi-variable consultant revenue may streams costs” advise 3.3 Break-even analysis By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ distinguish between contribution per unit and total contribution ➔ draw a break-even char t and calculate the break-even quantity, prot and margin of safety ➔ calculate target prot output, target prot and target price ➔ analyse the eects of changes in price or cost on break-even quantity, prot and margin of safety, using graphical and quantitative methods stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 examine the benets and limitations of break-even analysis. ➔ crb Contribution protability vital to note calculating costs. and It is that prot unit how after and example, per table towards is per if a $60, unit Total from of xed is the $150 will Alternatively, contribution contribution using Total the = sells above the business. sold in order contributes to overall However, can to its be cover xed it used a is in rm’s costs costs. per unit for – $150 makes total a when variable a between the variable cost each its and contribution example, variable = $9,000 × – the of the can number of contribution than from total of selling per price unit variable $90 rm’s be per × sells table, per cost table is sold. sales It is revenue: cost 100 tables at the then: 100) total xed calculated units unit total variable per ($60 one the business $60 100) towards the if cost contribution by more costs revenue ($150 = be a Contribution difference tables = total the price total above unit to in unit: calculated and prot. variable business contribute the per = as product to determining costs. the contribution $9,000 Total the contribution price per when products need a refers cost subtracting Following the business its same much unit then given products how per concept by the deducting paying by Total Still not contribution found This is variable For same it about many Contribution Total important determines Contribution per an brought by costs and prot. multiplying the sold: unit × number of units sold examples: contribution = $90 × 100 = $9,000 179 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Contribution and prot Key terms After establishing Here we will business. also Using what need this, the to the contribution know the formula is, total for prot xed prot is can costs be calculated. incurred by Contribution per unit the therefore: the dierence between the selling price per unit and Prot = total contribution - total xed costs variable cost per unit If the business prot will described above incurs a total xed cost of $5,000 then its Total contribution be: the dierence between the Prot = $9,000 = $4,000 total sales revenue and the $5,000 total variable costs Prot Clearly we can contribution in see only calculating that contribution removes prot rms the is not variable must also the costs subtract same from the as prot, sales xed as revenue, while costs. obtained by subtracting total xed costs from the total stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 contribution Student workpoint 3.6 Be knowledgeable A mobile each sell month of Model and phone for B while January phones Model mobile company $250 B’s 2012, were was phone per company the contribution b) the total c) the prot 1,000 sold. $70 a) sells per the B phone phones Model Model unit. that A ’s If for for mobile A for phones total Model $180 were cost xed amounted each each models. sell variable the month unit contribution for two Model to A each. sold per costs phones In the while unit was incurred $10,000, 1,500 $90 by the calculate: model model phone company that month. Breaking even After a gathering rm needs total to to At Breaking businesses of to calculate cover equal point. number information need sell costs even loss. will the this even all total products how costs. a in This new level will to sell of is xed or output also for so as to cover to and what of occurs make start-up establish all variable level known neither important ventures need and units which business especially they pricing many revenue, point is engaging its about their as a costs, output where the break- prot nor businesses the it the a or minimum costs. Break-even char t This is a graphical revenues against identied The When axis given axis the a that level total measures measures drawing carefully a plotting horizontal vertical 180 by method the (See of output. cost the costs break-even considered. measures and chart, Figure The total output and the or value of a rm’s break-even revenue units of costs point gures can on production a the following points need be graph. while revenues. 3.3.1.) and to be the 3 . 3 Fixed ● costs (FC) need to be paid no matter what B R E A K - E V E N level A N A LY S I S costs/ TR of output they are and, because represented they by a are constant horizontal at these continuous levels, revenue($) TC line. prot With ● no units of output there will be no variable VC break-even costs point (VC). The the Therefore higher the variable found by the VC line number costs will multiplying of be. starts units The the from zero produced total number variable of (origin). the units higher costs R = C are produced loss by the may variable not be cost per included unit. in the In most cases break-even the VC FC line chart. 0 xed produced, cost same trend no The the as of units line. break-even The ● sold left of whereas At the the the point level is will this be no no Q (break-even quantity) output/sales output where it Figure 3.3.1. A break-even char t the follows revenue. origin the point the output of with begins the greater break-even right line from the point of paid Importantly, there sold be the line. begins this to (TC) starts. VC line break-even TR have cost line the (TR) number still total (FC) output revenue ● the xed With ● costs total where be point point read shows shows The revenue the break-even can Therefore (zero). TC will line the the the loss intersects as well with as the graph. made prot total the be. revenue/costs from the greater stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Since ● by a rm, obtained. Margin of safety Businesses produce or sales could between level It is of the in to know is of the its a outp ut the gr e a te r l os s l ev el k no wn prot how b r e a k- e ve n before betwee n levels, be the brea k - e v e n range difference will need fall output the sales may beyond as is of the o ve r the as no t e d. o ut pu t whi ch s afe ty ( Se e ou t p ut we l l A of pr o t net or they ho w the is the n ee d much of the a ct u al safety q u an t i t y F ig u r e as m e as u r e and margin br e ak -e ve n e a r ning s . much p oi nt or m ad e. and to ou t pu t d if fe r en c e ( c u r re n t ) safety Th e margin . g re a t e r the the safer a rm 3. 3. 2.) costs/ TR revenue($) Margin of safety = current output - break-even prot output TC break-even For example, if the break-even quantity is 2,500 units and point actual safety or is current 1,500 quantity. As a output units or positive is 60 4,000 per value units cent this is then above a the the margin of break-even favourable R = C position safety for a rm. margin loss FC However, or a making rm a producing loss will be below the experiencing break-even a negative point margin 0 of safety position. For example, if the Q Q1 output/sales break-even Figure 3.3.2. A break-even char t with margin quantity is 2,500 units and the current output is 1,800 of safety units the negative the margin sign of safety denoting break-even level of will that be 700 current output. units, output with level is the below Note: Q denotes break-even output and Q1 denotes current output. 181 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Student workpoint 3.7 Exam tip It is very impor tant to label Be knowledgeable the break-even char t fully, The following information was provided by David, a candle producer, including the axes and based on his monthly production and sales. lines, and to provide an appropriate title or caption. In addition, you should be able to interpret and modify the break-even char t when required. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Table 3.3.1 Quantity Price per Revenue Fixed Variable Total Prot/ of candle candle from costs costs costs (Loss) boxes box candle (US$) (US$) (US$) sold (US$) box sold [Total] [Total] (US$) (US$) 0 $10 0 2,000 0 2,000 200 $10 2,000 2,000 1,200 3,200 400 $10 4,000 2,000 2,400 4,400 600 $10 6,000 2,000 3,600 5,600 800 $10 8,000 2,000 4,800 6,800 1,000 $10 10 000 2,000 6,000 8,000 1,200 $10 12 000 2,000 7,200 9,200 Referrring to Table 1. Complete 2. Calculate 3. Draw a show the 4. Show the the 3.3.1, prot/(loss) variable break-even on graph the per candle using quantity the questions 1200 below. column. cost graph break-even the answer (2,000) margin the on of box. information your safety in the table and graph. at 1,200 candle boxes sold. Calculating break-even quantity 1. Using contribution per unit Break-even quantity can be calculated using the following xed costs ___ Break-even quantity = contribution 182 per unit formula: 3 . 3 For example, month. shirt is The a shirt retailer variable $22. Using cost the incurs per above shirt xed is costs $12 and amounting the selling to B R E A K - E V E N $3,000 price for A N A LY S I S a each formula: $3,000 _ Break-even quantity = = $22 300 shirts $12 2. Using the total costs = total revenue method saw total costs where Using can P (TC) the be section TVC is = above Q = as + Q = 3,000 10 × Q = 3,000 Both 300 (TFC) unit the (TR) + (VC) shirt = total × P × Q and variable costs (TVC) Q. retailer, the break-even quantity below: total costs (TC) + (12 × Q) shirts methods retailer of = costs per shown revenue TVC × = cost (TR) TFC total xed example 22 Q that variable revenue × 3.2 total calculated Total the in stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 We shown needs to above sell in give order a break-even to break quantity of 300 shirts that even. Prot or loss The break-even quantity break-even Prot chart generate can quantity be Moreover, showed prot lead calculated prot or for to any sales business, that while exceed sales that the are break-even less than the losses using loss that a can contribution also be as seen calculated earlier using the above. following formula: Prot = Assuming month The total the would revenue shirt be retailer = TR Prot = [P = [22 = $22,000 = $7,000 shirt What would were sold, a as - total 1,000 costs shirts a (TC) month, the prot per follows: TC × Q] × retailer shirts sold calculated Prot 1,000 (TR) [TFC 1,000] + TVC] [3,000 + (12 × 1,000)] $15,000 would therefore be making a prot of $7,000 on selling month. be the prot assuming the or loss price if and in another other costs month remain only 200 shirts constant? 183 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Target prot Target prot output The is break-even needed as target As to prot shown $8,100) in the chart earn a can given output Figure bicycle be used level and 3.3.3, the to of to expected attain producer determine prot. will a prot target need the Output to is 80 of of this known prot sell level found as output way is target $1,500 that known prot. ($9,600 bicycles. costs/ revenue($) TR prot TC 9600 8100 stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 6000 loss 2500 FC 0 50 80 output/sales The producer needs to sell 80 bicycles Figure 3.3.3. The break-even char t of a bicycle producer to reach the target prot An alternative following method formula, of getting which is a target prot modication xed costs + of output the target is by using break-even the formula: prot ___ Target prot output = contribution Using the amount and as the information to $2,500, target for the variable prot is bicycle cost $1,500, per the per producer, unit is target where $70, prot unit price xed per output costs bicycle can be is follows: 2,500 + 1,500 __ Target prot output = The result obtained The above target obtained using the using the can also = 70 be 80 bicycles 50 calculation break-even formula 4,000 _ = 120 chart method conrms what was method. used in calculating target prot and price. Calculating target prot Assuming that contribution 100 184 $120, calculated bicycles, the per bicycle unit what is is producer’s $50 the and target the xed target prot? costs prot remain output at is $2,500, now 3 . 3 This is found as follows by incorporating the target prot B R E A K - E V E N A N A LY S I S output Key terms formula: Break-even char t $2,500 + target prot __ = 100 a graphical method that $50 measures the value of a rm’s $2,500 + target prot = 100 × $50 costs and revenues against a Target prot = $5,000 Target prot = $2,500 $2,500 given level of output Break-even quantity a measure of output where Calculating target price total revenue equals total costs Target price can also be calculated using the formula above. If the xed Prot are $6,500 be $2,500, and the calculated the variable target as prot cost per output bicycle is 200 is $50, bicycles, the the target target prot price is can the positive dierence follows: between total revenue and stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 costs total costs $2,500 + $6,500 __ 200 = target price $50 Margin of safety 200 (target price $50) = $9,000 the output amount that exceeds the break-even 200 (target price) $10,000 = $9,000 quantity $19,000 _ Target price Target prot output = = $95 per bicycle 200 the level of output that is Therefore the to bicycle target a producer prot will of $6,500 need to sell at a target each prot bicycle for output of 200bicycles, $95. needed to earn a specied amount of prot Break-even revenue The break-even seen of in 50 Figure bicycles. point where required break even It to even. revenue 3.3.3, It is the At clear total cover be that the point determined establishes the revenue both this can which the to and the using be break-even equals xed it break-even revenue total variable break-even a $6,000 costs, costs revenue is an chart, output obtained i.e. in is at it is order equal the for to at as level the revenue a the rm to break- costs. can also be calculated using the following formula: xed costs ___ Break-even revenue = × contribution Using the $120, variable the above previous example costs formula are we $70 of a and bicycle xed per producer, costs price per unit unit are if price $2,500, per then bicycle is applying get: $2,500 _ Break-even revenue = × $120 = $6,000 50 This as calculation that shown shows in that Figure the break-even revenue is $6,000 the same 3.3.3. 185 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Student workpoint 3.8 Be a thinker XYZ Ltd has per month. the variable is the The capacity xed costs to costs are $15 produce amount per unit. 180,000 to units $600,000 The selling of per its key month, price for each product while product $20. 1. Calculate 2. the: a) monthly b) break-even quantity c) break-even revenue. The prots company Calculate has at a maximum prot target capacity of $250,000 per month. the: stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 a) output level b) price will it capacity of needed need to 150,000 to reach charge the to target achieve prot the prot target at a units. Eects of changes in price or costs The it break-even can show safety the as a the result changes future chart can impact can of any then direction in on used as a break-even changes be the be in helpful price compared decision-making quantity, or with prot, cost. the The and new previous tool margin position position to as of after provide business. 1. Changes in price Figure shift of 3.3.4 the shows total the effect revenue of line an from increase TR to 1 sales revenue break even every output of at has a increased lower level. level This at of can all also lead . price. This of and to output. there an The will increase safety. costs/ TR revenue($) 2 TR 1 TC R 1 R 2 = C 1 = C 2 0 BEQ2 BEQ1 output/sales Figure 3.3.4. Break-even char t showing an increase in price 186 This leads indicates to that a the 2 levels output in TR be in rm will higher a rm’s also prots at margin 3 . 3 B R E A K - E V E N A N A LY S I S 2. Changes in costs a) Increase Figure in xed 3.3.5 costs shows the effect of an increase in xed costs (FC to 1 FC ), leading to an upward parallel shift of the total cost line from 2 TC to TC 1 . An increase in xed costs leads to an increase in total 2 costs by the quantity This same also also amount increases decreases the at and every prots margin of level of output. decrease at all Break-even levels of output. safety. costs/ revenue($) TR TC 2 TC 1 = C 2 R 2 stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 R = C 1 1 FC 2 FC 1 0 BEQ1 BEQ2 output/sales Figure 3.3.5. Break-even char t showing an increase in xed costs b) Increase Figure in variable 3.3.6 Increases in line. is This shows costs the variable shown effect costs by the of an increase shift of increase the the in variable gradient total cost of the line costs. total from cost TC to 1 TC . This leads to a rise in the break-even quantity and reduces the 2 margin of safety. costs/ revenue($) TR TC 2 TC 1 R 2 R 1 = C 2 = C 1 0 BEQ1 BEQ2 output/sales Figure 3.3.6. Break-even char t showing an increase in variable costs 187 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Student workpoint 3.9 Student workpoint 3.10 Be a thinker Be knowledgeable A chocolate prices to business charge its is considering customers per which of the following three 1. chocolate: JTS Ltd and A $1.50 B $2.00 C produces sells following information is useful in its decision making: of globally. costs: $100 a countries The monthly xed ● clocks to $2.50 number The them following information is 000 provided. variable ● cost per chocolate: $1 Maximum current ● 1. For output: each price, 300 000 chocolates. capacity: 200,000 clocks Current output and calculate: sales: stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 a) the break-even b) the margin c) the prot 160,000 quantity Selling of or clocks safety Fixed price: costs: Variable loss $12 $900,000 cost: $ 4 per clock d) break-even quantity as a percentage of the current output. The 2. If the variable costs per chocolate increase to $1.20, management recalculate propose parts (a) to (d) that reduction 3. Comment on a possible above. your observations from questions 1 and 2. unit to $10 lead to an sales and reach Benets of break-even analysis in price per would increase help their in them maximum capacity. ● Break-even rm’s charts nancial provide position at an easy various and visual levels of means of analysing a a) output. Construct even ● At a glance, by using the charts, the management of a business to determine quantity, and the prot break-even or loss, revenue margin or of safety, Formulae can calculating also the be used to give Changes even or ● in current output Use chart by more accurate results when the such as should and and costs margin of and their safety can impact be on prot compared by or loss, using the quantity charts (ii) The analysis deciding relocate on or Break-even sold many can key be used as a investment merge with analysis no with demand. assumes possibility businesses Stocks strategic projects another decision-making or whether a (iii) tool may may of hold also that all rm. stocks stocks build being to up the It assumes c) built cater for because produced up any goods or held. sudden cannot by In be straight that all lines. revenue This is not and cost always lines the are case. linear, i.e. Offering current calculation check your after in the the a in second chart to situation price reduction. sold. method answers. Construct show reality, Repeat part (b) the above represented price the new chart. reductions d) Recommend the which proposals should 188 at break-even rms changes the using by of output Use output Prot business tasks ● margin safety to is Break-even break- Limitations of break-even analysis ● to determine: calculation. Break-even level above. prices point, the and break-even (i) ● price cost. b) ● break- using is original able a chart JTS pursue. of Ltd 3 . 3 or discounts will inuence the slope of the revenue line. B R E A K - E V E N The slope A N A LY S I S of Exam tip the in variable an effort cost to line will increase also change output. This if a rm change pays will overtime then wages inuence the Most IB examination slope of the total cost line. questions require te use of ● Apart are from not makes ● A showing represented the process break-even business xed on the more chart and break-even costs, semi-variable chart. If these are costs models wit straigt revenue included it and cost lines. complex. may environments. variable not For be very useful example, the in changing break-even or dynamic chart may not TOK discussion cope with sudden changes in prices, costs, or technology. “ Wat you measure is wat ● The accuracy and quality of the cost and revenue data used you get.” Wat, if anyting, determine the effectiveness inaccurate data of break-even analysis. Unreliable or does tis tell you about te may inuence the conclusions reached in the overall role of measurable objectives analysis. Fixed costs may change at different levels of activity. It would stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 in business decision making? ● be Do results obtained from preferable to represent these xed costs as a “stepped” line. For quantitative metods always example, in order to increase output a rm may need to double outweig qualitative ones? its capacity. This complicating may lead break-even to sharp rises in xed costs, thereby analysis. Revision checklist ✓ Contribution per unit and difference ✓ Prot can ✓ A a break rm’s in ✓ ✓ the be total even costs is the the chart the Margin of level output safety is total by a to obtain measures the costs contribution a and total difference or by a selling is between the the the cost. total total costs value. that given price variable subtracting positive difference (current) calculated per the the contribution measures level of the output value and of helps point. the be total method against actual can the cost graphical quantity the xed between while revenue break-even and unit getting revenues Break-even by difference per total revenue and the cost obtained and identifying of unit between contribution from per variable between level by of the break-even output dividing the in a total business. xed unit. Fixed costs + target prot ___ ✓ Target prot output formula is Contribution per unit Fixed costs __ ✓ Break-even revenue formula × is Contribution per Price per unit unit 189 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Pr q Dan Dan He Electro Bowen owns the is an business located Dan sole name together started amount of collateral* The a online for the are an from who Electro’s customers money. Repeat stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 for the Dan and is ow in now an to very have worried in difculties order are Dan He cameras are ofce, storage ago by used directly processed desirable years about the prevent has place city to consumers. electronically and centre borrowing his from high to pay and their the in see a call under centre are location. a residential considerable property cash the is would the rise Dan He for percentage and and as good in of good Dan pay a may value Electro’s he rates, face and Dan higher service considering ow cameras cameras. as interest Electro reliable quality purchase they forecasted years. good their that competition. reputable for advance large quality possible a price indicated coming such a comprise of online in shipped loyal even because increase digital sales and bank. and purchases cameras The three a charges transportation. customers all loan. prompt Some sells and expensive bought supplier who Electro. business money cameras overseas Dan in the trader business for sales. price provides. ination some various cash strategies difculties. Financial information for 2010 (all gures in US$) Fixed costs per year Rent Marketing Administration Interest payments 20 000 4000 5000 1000 Camera Transpor tation Direct labour 135 45 20 Variable costs per camera Dan a) is expected (i) (ii) Dene b) the Identify sole (i) 2010. (show order all to Calculate IB, * 190 Nov fully safety the in 2010. costs. for Explain Dan of operating as tool and and break-even indicate the the projected chart for Dan break-even prot at 700 the price sales of per of possible Dan possible difculties. all Electro point, the cameras marks] needs in must to order be to sell in charged double working). of the for Dan the [2 break-even model Electro. strategies marks] (show all your working). [2 that limitations [2 marks] cameras) your marks] [7 Dan Electro prot camera 700 (show for cameras projected [2 a working). prot two two ow labelled number the expected Examine cash a double decision c) variable advantages your projected (iv) cameras Calculate of Calculate (at 700 term two margin (iii) sell 250 trader. Construct for (ii) to Price per camera Electro to marks] as a [4 marks] [6 marks] prevent 2010 collateral: the borrower ’s proper ty is oered to the lender as security if the loan is not paid back 3.4 Final accounts By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ discuss the purpose of accounts to dierent stakeholders ➔ examine the principles and ethics of accounting practice ➔ prepare and interpret nal accounts, namely the prot and loss account and the balance sheet ➔ describe the dierent types of intangible assets ➔ calculate and distinguish between the straight-line and reducing- stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 balance depreciation methods (HL only) explain the strengths and weaknesses of the straight-line and ➔ reducing-balance methods (HL only). Prp f r khlr Final end accounts of a trading and the year. nancial expenses examples of to of inform and period internal shareholders, stakeholders competitors, to and of at these by the an of a and the employees, or revenues, about while the community. is the Internal suppliers, local stakeholders at scal stakeholders organization. customers, and businesses end transactions, external of managers, are nanciers, each as including performance include accounts compiled such accounts external government, of help records position stakeholders statements accounting These nancial purpose are particular explored The below. Shareholders Shareholders is becoming how will protable investment. capital in the They order performance whether be interested throughout of they its business check to on make the need a is be in the knowing year. order is to efciency worthwhile directors to in nancial also motivated of how They assess of or be safety their to the keen business on interest further the the return valuable will of in business to establish their investing investment. them: they The want to see replaced. Managers Final accounts judge or and number then help of in the used in by their years. Knowing strategic managers to performance These monitoring departments. managers are compare will and the help set them controlling nancial planning for targets, within in which particular setting will they decision use in to year which patterns therefore effective can nancial budgets, expenditure records more a will various greatly making assist in businesses. 191 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Employees A protable secure. This for business job security does not involve business may growth and could also to to to that pay employees they help increases. lead unions signal indicate salary necessarily trade could also to could increases further an for their pay strengthen However, negotiate that get these increase their will The two in employees, on jobs rises. be potential aspects of protability leading them to behalf. Customers Customers constant how a will be supply dependent rm lacks elsewhere interested of a rm’s they should security, where in be perhaps supply knowing products is on due in the to reliable whether the future. business low and there This and will will how protability, be a determine secure it customers is. will If go guaranteed. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Suppliers Suppliers with can rms. immediate ability to use They cash pay nal can accounts either payments. off its debts to negotiate extend The will the security be a better trade key of cash credit the business concern or period for credit or and terms demand thus its suppliers. The government The is government abiding A authorities law in the protability loss-making because tax the interested pays. and by it could detrimental to regarding mean a of business an the will check of in on whether regulations. business be increase country’s will accounting to grave see how concern unemployment, the They much to the business will be tax it government which could be economy. Competitors Businesses of other look for Are ● ● will rms the want to see answers their to compare how to well key competitors’ protability struggling How competitors’ the nancial are statements performing with nancially. those They will questions: competitors do their they levels higher than theirs or are the nancially? sales revenues compare with theirs? Financiers These to include establish on the gearing problems Banks banks how of the soliciting will condent that much it will check business funding thoroughly that will money able on the to the can because from assess be they a creditworthiness lend it. This will high-geared institutions accounts of back its a (see business loan with in the business depend business nancial pay of also will have section order 3.1). to be interest. The local community Residents living protability 192 and around a particular expansion business potential. This is will want because it to know may its create job 3 . 4 opportunities the residents for will environmentally as air or noise them also and be lead to growth concerned friendly and about whether in the community. whether their the accounts F I N A L A C C O U N T S However, businesses consider will costs be such pollution. Prpl h f g pr They not should accountants only have observe and Ethics in in accounting the usually based and study is the process. the need respective principles case on that have satisfy comply accounting standards with to be study ethics the are needs a of code core moral of A applied in of is code of Chartered public or and set of the “rules” but conduct. judgments a interest. client as on for the behaviour understanding practice, Certied read applied principles, accountants out deeper accounting the ethics and guide a in therefore spells For act employer values that code to their ethics warnings. Association of particular values, upheld. pre-emptive about responsibility with A rm’s to a the the of how following Accountants yduts esaC stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Professional (ACCA). acca f h The Association of Chartered Certied Accountants Code of Ethics for Professional Accountants (the (ACCA) is a global body for professional accountants that IESBA Code). Whenever the IESBA Code is revised, the oers business-relevant qualications to people seeking ACCA Rulebook is reviewed, and updated as necessary, careers in accountancy, nance and management. to ensure that it remains aligned with the IESBA Code. The Code of Ethics and Conduct (the Code) is binding The fundamental principles set out the obligations on all members of ACCA , and any par tner (or director) placed on all members, whether or not they are in in an ACCA practice. However, it is also binding on the practice. The ve principles are set out below. sta of such a practice, regardless of whether or not ● Integrity – members shall be “straightforward they are members of ACCA or any other professional and honest in all professional and business body. The Code is divided into three par ts. Par t A relationships”. The ACCA Rulebook (and the IESBA sets out the fundamental principles of professional Code) goes on to state that integrity implies not ethics for professional accountants and provides a merely honesty, but fair dealing and truthfulness. conceptual framework for applying those principles. ● Objectivity – members shall not allow bias, Par ts B and C illustrate how the conceptual framework conicts of interest or the undue inuence of is to be applied in specic situations. These par ts others to compromise their professional or provide examples of safeguards that may be business judgment. appropriate to address threats to compliance with the fundamental principles and also provide examples ● of situations where safeguards are not available to Professional competence and due care – members have a continuing duty “to maintain address those threats. professional knowledge and skill at a level required to ensure that clients or employers Some of the most impor tant areas of the Code, from the receive competent professional service”. Members point of view of a practitioner, are discussed below and shall “act diligently in accordance with applicable in other available fact sheets. technical and professional standards when providing professional services”. The fundamental principles ● Condentiality – members shall respect the Within the Code, as noted above, the fundamental condentiality of information “acquired as a result principles are set out in Par t A . As a member body of professional and business relationships”, and of the International Federation of Accountants shall not disclose any such information to third (IFAC), ACCA is required to apply ethical standards par ties “without proper and specic authority or that are at least as stringent as those stated in the unless there is a legal or professional right or duty International Ethics Standards Board for Accountants 193 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts to disclose”. Similarly, condential information Exam-style questions acquired as a result of professional and business 1. Outline the objectives of the ACCA Code of Ethics relationships shall not be used to the personal and Conduct. [4 marks] advantage of members or third par ties. 2. Apply three principles of the ACCA Code of Professional behaviour – members shall comply ● Ethics and Conduct to an organisation of with relevant laws and regulations and shall avoid your choice. [6 marks] any action that may discredit the profession. 3. The ACCA Rulebook goes fur ther, and states Discuss the benets and the limitations of a Code of Ethics and Conduct such as the that members shall “behave with cour tesy and one produced by the ACCA . consideration” towards all with whom they come [10 marks] into contact in a professional capacity. Source: http://www.accaglobal.com/content/dam/acca/ global/PDF-members/2012/2012c/CofEC.pdf stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 th m l TOK discussion The prot and loss account Many businesses are This is also income It and therefore and how three the to the statement Gross Sales of whether trading account that a a at statement business business the account, end the and over has of a given made that prot shows a It loss records time prot period. and the is of period. or divided account , prot producing formula of social or ethical performance into and then during = is or information. How can we social variables? a of the is + revenue part business is of the (see and the income Table 3.4.1). used: sales sold goods or (COGS) were purchases beginning stock with the sales top sold services is the during over direct that a cost period. follows: stock more that the the selling goods goods as of from of of as formula cost earned sales period prot - cost between shown following or the bought this gross is of a trading during stock - this valued at closing period period $200. stock had $500 valued What is at its worth $800. COGS period? $500 COGS = $1,100 Gross sales at It revenue opening rm = Sales cost = COGS What the the income of difference sales. purchasing then closed the the for sales It sales would its revenue prot + $800 gross = $10 $200 prot × = $4,000 = $2,900 together with other nancial eectively measure these the those prot Cost example, stock. shows of introducing statements about their environmental, loss account establishes gross period. Cost 194 ows distributed business revenue given It the calculating For was income The trading account trading of establishes parts: cost The the expenditure this The of as appropriation (a) In known be 400 = if it sold $4,000 $1,100 400 units of a product at $10 each? 3 . 4 (b) A C C O U N T S The prot and loss account This is before and To F I N A L the interest tax nd from (see out the and net and of tax, the net income prot statement before tax, that and shows net the prot net after prot interest 3.4.1). prot prot indirect sold. rent, part Table gross comprise units second before shown costs Examples insurance or interest in the and overheads include costs. tax, trading which advertising expenses account. are costs, not are These subtracted expenses directly linked administration to the charges, Key terms Therefore: Prot and loss account Net prot before interest and tax = gross prot - expenses also known as the income Net prot loans before from the tax net is calculated prot before by subtracting interest and interest payable statement, shows the records on of income and expenditure tax: stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 ows of a business over a given time period Net prot before tax = net prot before interest and tax - interest Cost of goods sold (COGS) Then, the net corporation prot tax after (tax on interest and company tax prots) is found from by net deducting prot before the direct cost of producing tax: or purchasing the goods that Net prot after interest and tax = net prot before tax were sold during that period - corporation tax Gross prot found by deducting cost of (c) The appropriation account goods sold from sales revenue This is the company’s This net part prot following Retained of prot distribution retained the nal is in the after two prot and interest forms, (ploughed-back loss and tax either prot). account as is that shows distributed dividends Retained to prot (see how Table the 3.4.1). shareholders is calculated or using formula: prot = net as Net prot before interest and tax the dierence between gross prot and expenses prot after interest and tax - dividends Net prot before tax found by subtracting interest from net prot before interest Table 3.4.1 Prot and loss account for XYZ Ltd and tax X YZ Ltd Net prot after interest Prot and loss account for the year ended 30 June 2012 and tax US$ million Sales revenue Cost of goods sold 800 Trading account equal to net prot before tax less tax 250 ___ Gross prot 550 Dividends Expenses 300 ___ Net prot before interest and tax Interest 250 Prot and loss a sum of money paid to shareholders decided by 20 ___ account the board of directors of a Net prot before tax Tax 230 company 40 ___ Net prot after interest and tax 190 Retained prot Dividends 50 ___ Appropriation the amount of earnings left Retained prot 140 account after dividends and other deductions have been made 195 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Student workpoint 3.11 Be a thinker Prot and loss account for BTW Ltd for the year ended 31 December 2012 $000 Sales revenue 950 Cost of goods sold ? Gross prot 650 Expenses ? Net prot before interest and tax 350 Interest 10 Net prot before tax ? Tax 40 stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Net prot after interest and tax ? Dividends 50 Retained prot a) Complete missing b) four loss Explain in this the above numbers Identify and c) ? prot stakeholders account how the and (indicated for who BTW above loss by account question would by lling in the marks). be interested in the prot Ltd. stakeholders would use the information account. The balance sheet Also known assets, the liabilities, snapshot rm’s as of net including the requirement and It gives much of equity nancial worth. how statement a of of a nancial rm position of the an rm shareholders balance sheet is at a position, a rm idea have that specic and of what a outlines point is used what invested this it in in to time. and The business It is calculate owns it. the a a owes, In 2002, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act was passed to deter unethical accounting. basic owns ETHICS (total The Act was passed in response to high-prole scandals including Enron and WorldCom. assets) must equal what it owes (total liabilities) plus how the assets (http://www.sox-online.com/act. are nanced (equity). This is what makes the balance sheet balance. html) The three explored main components of assets, liabilities, and equity are Are there any other global below. examples of unethical behaviour in accounting that come to mind? a How did the rms concerned handle the situation? These are include Fixed 12 xed assets months. buildings, 196 resources assets are of value and that that vehicles, owns or are owed to it. They assets. assets examples equipment, business current long-term Tangible a and are last in a physical machinery. business in for nature Some of more than include these assets, 3 . 4 such case as machinery, depreciation Intangible value. Current 12 the from bank or that have also known and nished by bought from at later short-term sale the of cash, assets on inventory, and credit that last and are owe raw over get time. net tend to In xed be A C C O U N T S this assets. difcult to unit.) in a stock. services and to nature the Debtors includes value) assets in in debtors, goods business. goods (lose xed non-physical looked include the as are be are They depreciate deducted that will assets months. received at assets (These usually is F I N A L business Cash which could individuals the is be or business materials, for up to money held other either rms money. Stock, semi-nished goods, goods. Lbl or are a rm’s individuals. are usually term a 12 source liabilities Long-term months legal They and debts arise of funding current liabilities by the or what during the for it owes course the to of rm. other rms, business They are institutions, operation classied stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 These and into long- liabilities. are long-term business. They debts include or borrowings long-term bank payable loans after and mortgages. Current the liabilities business suppliers (see within who sold section 3.1), corporation tax). When its we know working capital whether the shown below. efciency of Working To get total deduct Total It a on is can also a credit to has pay off known measure is as of of its that the a the the bank are, assets. current overdraft it bills assets short-term we The because day-to-day net a by (unpaid government business net payable creditors rm), to important its are include owed liabilities establish business is debts These (money the and business capital tax what a short-term months. goods and capital working Working are 12 such can as calculate amount of indicates or running and is nancial costs. calculated health as and business. capital assets current = less total current current assets liabilities, we - total rst add current all the liabilities assets and liabilities: assets less current liabilities = (f ixed assets less current liabilities = f ixed assets + current assets) - current liabilities or Total assets + working capital 197 3 F i n a n c e Then as to get a n d net a c c o u n ts assets, we subtract long-term liabilities from the above, shown: Net assets Having out = (total calculated how they the were assets net less assets current of the liabilities) business, we - then long-term need to liabilities nd nanced. eqy Also known includes as two shareholder’s aspects, equity namely share or shareholder’s capital and funds, retained equity prots. Share capital This refers stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 shares and to the bought does not exchange original by capital shareholders. include market or the the daily invested It is a buying current into the permanent and market selling value of business source of of shares through capital in a stock shares. Retained prot As noted obtained as is it purchase From the Equity the been prot to above, = helps sheet 3.4.2 is = this the then but the note + nance prot ploughed account. business in capital to the loss owners assets to is and has which It is made has back also in into known previous been the as business reserves years. reinvested so This as to business. that: retained the net prot assets of the business and enables balance: equity an discussed that the we share assets 3.1, prot necessary equity Table the owed balance Net 198 section includes money This in from example above and of a balance uses the sheet required that IB incorporates format. what has 3 . 4 F I N A L A C C O U N T S Table 3.4.2 A statement of nancial position Key terms X YZ Ltd Balance sheet Balance sheet as at 30 June 2012 $m $m a nancial statement that Fixed assets outlines the assets, liabilities Fixed assets 600 and equity of a rm at a Accumulated depreciation 30 specic point in time ______ Net xed assets 570 Assets Current assets resources of value that a Cash 20 Debtors 15 business owns or that are owed to it Stock 55 ____ Total current assets Liabilities 90 stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 a rm’s legal debts or what Current liabilities it owes to other rms, Overdraft 10 Creditors 20 institutions or individuals Shor t-term loans 15 Working capital ____ Total current liabilities 45 also known as net current assets, helps establish ______ Net current assets (working capital) 45 whether a rm can pay its day- Total assets less current liabilities 615 to-day running costs Long-term liabilities (debt) 250 Net assets found by subtracting long-term ______ Net assets 365 liabilities from total assets less Financed by: current liabilities share capital 220 retained prot 145 Equity equity 365 also known as shareholders’ equity, shows how the net assets are nanced using Student workpoint 3.12 shareholders’ capital and retained prot Be a thinker 1. Using ended Table 30 3.4.2, June ● Cash ● Creditors ● Stock ● A ● Debtors ● Retained ● The ● Net xed the same. prepare 2013 increased rose after by by decreased another the US$10 US$15 by balance following sheet for adjustments the year occurred: million. million. US$5 million. TOK discussion long-term loan increased by 10 % Do nancial statements rose by US$5 million. reect the “truth” about a prot bank fell overdraft by US$26 reduced business? million. by US$4 What role does interpretation million. play in accounting? For assets, share capital and short-term loans remained example, how can we compare businesses just by looking at 2. Explain two uses and two limitations of the balance sheet. their nancial statements? 199 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts igbl These are nature. can xed prove Some assets However, of to be them that even very are lack physical though valuable explained they to a substance do not rm’s have or a are non-physical physical long-term success value or in they failure. below. Patents These sell, provide or with control legal Anyone a fee is to the wishing stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 kidneys to granted 20 years; patent. others their and can with that use of the at: to this for rights product. others it. period also a to manufacture, inventors copying ideas The include horses’ The from holder’s use patents shoes found a patent however, rubber exclusive prevents permission Interesting be the invention protection be about of inventors must legal life depends pen health. More apply for on with are their a provided ideas. and most the pay patents useful scanner, details use, on life steel these and http://www.prv.se/en/Patents/Why-apply-for-a- patent/Examples-of-patents/. Goodwill This to refers a to the business. brand name, reputation one rm valued book a is as It value includes highly rm value a enjoys the good favourable customer its by being the base attributes and desirable clients. another. paid rm or employees, with by amount of positive skilled purchased the of During an relations, location Goodwill rm over relate strong and usually acquisition, purchasing that the arises good when goodwill and above is the bought. Copyright laws These the are laws musicians, if that production the lasts a for patents, a sale of authors, and lm original novel, provide and ideas music album between anyone permission are 50 put or to them or producers. to use such the as in computer use copyright do the the laws of the holder’s to protect Creators will creation software. death right work. Copyright after a exclusive literary years to to with artistic developed 100 wishing from creator their of only a Most published copyright creator. works include apply As must with seek so. Trademarks These are registered help to a recognizable and the Trademarks be depending Coca-Cola, symbol, KFC, and one sold on the Donald a rm’s trademarks can symbol, identies distinguish infringes period, that of for their Nike word, product products others a fee use. can and from be design last of by the for a popular “You’re is Anyone ofcially also who trademark 15-year McDonald’s catchphrase that Trademarks another’s. sued most the or business. Examples “swoosh”, Trump’s phrase or owners. renewable trademarks golden include arch red”. ‘ You’re red!’ Intangible and in value 200 assets many can are cases difcult they uctuate will over to value, not time be and due to their shown in the simple subjective balance changes in the nature sheet. Their reputation of American businessman Donald Trump has attempted to trademark his famous catchphrase 3 . 4 an organization can either inate or deate a rm’s value. As a F I N A L A C C O U N T S result, Key terms intangible value of assets a rm can just be used before a to “window purchase. dress” The or setting articially of specic increase the parameters Intangible assets to be used to complexity quantify and an intangible inaccuracy of asset including just it in serves the to increase balance the xed assets that lack physical sheet. substance or are non- physical in nature Depreciation (HL only) Patents This is cash the decrease expense that in is determine the net depreciate include the value recorded prot the of in before a xed the asset prot interest and and over loss tax. time. It account Two is in reasons a non- order why provide inventors with the to assets exclusive rights to manufacture, use, sell or control their following: invention of a product Wear ● and tear machinery maintain – the causes repeated them to use fall in of xed value assets and such more as cars money is or needed to Goodwill them. improved “old” – existing versions assets are become xed assets introduced obsolete or fall in out in the of value when market. date and With are new time or stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 the value of positive or Obsolescence ● favourable attributes that these relate to a business eventually Copyright laws withdrawn. laws that provide creators with The IB expects you to know two methods for calculating depreciation, the exclusive right to protect the straight-line method and the reducing-balance method , as the production and sale of described below. their ar tistic or literary work Straight-line method This is a equally commonly over depreciation elements in its of its used lifetime the Trademark method by asset’s that deducting value per spreads a given annum. out the cost constant It of an amount requires the asset of a recognizable symbol, word, phrase or design that following calculation: is ocially registered and that identies a product or business the ● to expected be used before ● the original ● the residual or value useful cost or over Incorporating of the asset, i.e. the length of time it intends replacement of the scrap its the life asset, value useful above, i.e. of its the purchase asset, i.e. or an historical estimation cost of its worth life. the annual depreciation original cost - can residual be calculated as: value ___ Annual depreciation = expected Example costing 1: four years. year ended First, the it 1 is January It is Calculate 31 apply value the is to 2012 expected the December important residual Then On $30,000. ABC life Company have depreciation a value expense of asset purchased of $6,000 on the at a vehicle the vehicle end for of the 2012. identify $6,000 annual to useful the and key the elements: expected depreciation the useful original life is cost four is $30,000, years. formula: $30,000 $6,000 __ Annual depreciation = = 4 $6,000 years 201 3 F i n a n c e The above value a n d a c c o u n ts information over four can be shown in a table to show the net book years. Table 3.4.3 Straight-line depreciation at $6,000 per annum Year Annual depreciation Net book value on expense ($) vehicle ($) 0 (present) 0 30,000 1 6,000 24,000 2 6,000 18,000 3 6,000 12,000 4 6,000 6,000 Example stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 was In 2: Calculate purchased such year as a case on 1 we the July will depreciation 2012 be with required the to expense year of the ending charge above on 31 vehicle if December depreciation for half it 2012. the follows: ($30,000 6 months _ Depreciation expense = ( ) 12 × [ $6,000) __ ] = $3,000 4 months Advantages of straight-line depreciation It ● is simple over It ● is a to mostly can calculate number be of suitable written as it is a predictable expense that is spread years. off for less within expensive the asset’s items, such estimated as furniture, useful that life. Disadvantages of straight-line depreciation It ● is as not it suitable does expenses It ● is the known It for cater over to greatest motor ● not the expensive for the useful inate amount the of assets loss life in of the value value of in such as efciency plant or and increase machinery in repair asset. some their assets rst or which second may have years, such lost as vehicles. does not take environment into that account may the render fast-changing certain xed technological assets obsolete very quickly. Reducing-balance method This the method asset. applies adopts a percentage depreciation rate an accelerated depreciation technique depreciation amount depreciation is charged in Year Net 202 It at 1 the may book charged charged end. be value at Under Year 1 an asset beginning the calculated in to the declines of an over over asset’s reducing-balance the useful life whereby the time, i.e. lifetime method net of higher and less book is value as: = Cost of original asset - (cost of original asset × rate of depreciation [%]) 3 . 4 This ● is net book the depreciation its A C C O U N T S where: rate ● F I N A L of value annual an 3: rate asset’s from depreciation useful Example is is net value of and the cost the the percentage is calculated by deducting asset fall in the value of an asset over life. Using of example 33%* (see 1 above, the vehicle was depreciating at an below). Table 3.4.4 Reducing-balance depreciation Depreciation ($) 0 0 1 20 100 13 467 6,633 (20 100 × 33%) 3 9,022.89 4444,11 (13 467 × 33%) 4 net 30 000 9,900 (30 000 × 33%) 2 The Net book value ($) 6,045.34 2,977.55 (9,022.89 × 33%) book value at the end of four years stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Year using this method is about $6,045. *33% the is an approximation depreciation shown rate. The obtained exact using rate is the about calculation 33.126 %. formula The for formula is as below: ________________ residual value __ N Depreciation rate = 1- √ cost Where N Residual end of represents value its is useful the the expected estimated of xed useful scrap or life asset of the salvage asset. value of an asset of the at the life. Advantages of reducing-balance depreciation ● It more This the is realistically because early years generated the ● ● It new by the is the provides a cost and of against the matched increased more straight-line the years. increases income the amount revenue depreciation larger production amount brought business. provided of about in revenue by the use of asset. the it matches higher tax accurate method, non-cash expense measure especially expenses in the of in depreciation the valuation immediately, early years, which thereby compared of assets lowers improving to over the cash ow. Disadvantages of reducing-balance depreciation ● It is the ● It a more complex straight-line charges may not high be method of calculating depreciation compared to method. amounts realistic for of depreciation some less in the expensive early years, which assets. 203 3 F i n a n c e ● The a n d formula a c c o u n ts used to obtain the rate of depreciation may be subjective Key terms because without residual value it cannot be used. Depreciation ● It that lowers company is prots, publicly which traded some on a stakeholders, stock especially exchange, might if the object to. the decrease in the value of a xed asset over time ● It defers tax payments for later years. This is not a problem if the Straight-line depreciation company keeps company experiences and the company income ow growing tax has burden pressures to will from and increasing difculty, delay future increase slowed or in growth just prots. and capital as the declining However, prots slow or expenditures, company sales and is if go a down the facing operating a method that spreads out the cost of an asset equally cash prots. over its lifetime by deducting a given constant amount of depreciation of the asset’s value per annum Student workpoint 3.13 Residual value stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Be knowledgeable an estimation of an asset’s Suppose a business has an asset with $2,000 original cost, $200 scrap wor th or value over its useful value, and ve years of useful life. life, also known as scrap or 1. Use the straight-line method to determine its annual depreciation salvage value charge. Net book value 2. Using the formula, calculate its rate of depreciation in the an asset’s net value at the reducing-balance method. beginning of an accounting 3. In questions book values 1 and over 2 draw the and complete the table to show the net years. period, calculated by deducting the accumulated (total) depreciation from the cost of the xed asset Rv hkl ✓ Final the accounts end of an stakeholders accounting the Internal employees customers, Reducing-balance nancial about organisation. and are while suppliers, statements period that nancial inform position stakeholders examples compiled of external government, businesses internal and include by and external performance shareholders, stakeholders competitors, at of an managers are nanciers ✓ Ethics in accounting as applied in of principles on A loss prot and known as A balance is used what to it than 204 a is based of local a last a of moral process. on A the rm’s that need shows the business values code core to a judgements is a that set guide upheld. of given and ethics values be records over of income time and period and is also statement. snapshot a (assets) have assets year. study standards income sheet the account calculate owns Current the ows an shareholders ✓ is accounting usually accountants expenditure ✓ the rm’s and owes invested to up of net to in a the nancial worth. It (liabilities) it position gives the of rm including a an how rm idea and of much (equity). year while xed assets last for a method where a predetermined percentage depreciation rate is used and subtracted from the net book and community. ✓ depreciation more value of the previous year 3 . 4 ✓ Long term liabilities ✓ For a liabilities are are payable balance sheet payable within to a balance after a year while short F I N A L A C C O U N T S term year. a rm’s net assets should equal its equity. ✓ Intangible assets non- physical term success. in are xed nature These assets and include that can be lack very patents, physical valuable copyrights, substance to a rm’s trademarks or are long and goodwill. Straight equally of line over depreciation its depreciation lifetime of the depreciation method depreciation tecÚique asset declines over method by asset’s on the value other whereby time spreads deducting based per out given the useful of an life asset balance accelerated amount of an amount Reducing adopts depreciation the cost constant annum. hand the on a the charged asset. (HL to an only) stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 ✓ 205 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Pr q BBT BBT is a online Mark well-established education, Davis, freedom in full-time BBT has recently owns with in the a maintain to or raise a 100% been years the with of to the the shares for point the develop market in his and for the several online new However, rival bank three years. of online software, the which copyright companies education His complete six provision in founder, employs over educational position. and enjoys patented (USP). specializing owner business business Moreover, in company The The expansion selling presence his of limited States. company. copyright future. nance improve United the unique near established has of have private the owns many Mark him expire Mark who small in running enjoyed provides will currently the staff education. based have market. software manager Ex tract from the balance sheet for BBT for the year ended 31 October 2010 to has US$ refused stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Capital employed to lend funds software. balance He for the said sheet research “software has and has a development short product (R&D) life of cycle, the and Cash your accountant has just presented the following nancial BBT as liquidity a) (i) (ii) of 31 (i) 2010, which raised some working capital Dene the Identify term two the balance the copyright for BBT of operating as Depreciation 1500 Fixed assets 30 000 missing for [2 gures X, information BBT for Y, Z and provided, with those construct marks] Loan capital 0 Net assets Z a company. nancial sheet [2 disadvantages limited Calculate from marks] gures a and Retained prot 8500 Share capital 2000 complete 2010. [7 marks] Shor t-term (ii) 28 000 and issues. private b) October Y information Debtors for 2000 deteriorated”. Creditors Mark’s X new BBT’s net prot before interest and tax as at 31 October 0 2010 borrowing was US$27 and corporation paid and 695. total If interest tax was payments 30% corporation were Calculate 10% the of value this of value interest tax. [2 Stock Total (current (iii) Using the nancial bank educational c) Examine use IB, 206 Nov to two fund 2010 and manager to factors, nance the explain R&D of R&D the new [6 alternative of new sources of educational nance that software. 30 000 assets) why the software. possible the non-nancial refused 0 marks] Mark [6 Total (current marks] might marks] liabilities) 48 000 3.5 Protability and liquidity ratio analysis By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ calculate and interpret the protability and eciency ratios: gross prot margin (GPM), net prot margin (NPM), and return on capital employed (ROCE) ➔ examine possible strategies to improve the above protability and eciency ratios ➔ calculate and interpret the liquidity ratios: current ratio and ➔ stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 acid test ratio discuss possible strategies to improve the above liquidity ratios R ly This of a is a nancial rm’s performance strengths The by and meaningful ratios analysis nancial and determining weaknesses. historical ratios following efciency tool of and other types ratios, used statements. of It in certain aids in be liquidity in interpretation evaluating trends and decision inter-rm will the helps businesses ratio and It the making same explored and rm’s exposing comparisons in a by its analysing different below: nancial various making through or assessment past industries. protability ratios, ratios Prbly r These ratios generating assess ability. protability. (GPM) and Two net the performance Other types prot variables of of a rm in are used in protability ratio are margin terms of its interpreting gross prot- this prot margin (NPM) Gross prot margin (GPM) This as a is found by percentage. dividing As gross the shown gross prot by the sales revenue, expressed below: prot __ GPM = × sales Example: prot of A 100 revenue business US$70 has million. sales revenue Calculate its of US$100 GPM, using million the and above gross formula: US$70 million __ GPM = × US$100 The for business every every will $1 aim generates $100 of for of sales sales a GPM the revenue higher 100 = 70% million gross of 70 %. business brings prots in to This makes 70 cents help is interpreted $70 as them as its gross pay to gross prot. their mean prot, that i.e. Businesses expenses. 207 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Possible strategies to improve GPM A ● rm or might markets Raising case just A ● of on sales stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 rm will A will the its goods should, the very damage less with the as or competitive to revenue few this in sensitive signicantly cheaper to could the to costs. increase not need price changes even lack the in quantity prices. In substitutes. of the a of “ripping way markets changes. because image the to lead to more ensure aim to more produced. however, remaining GPM. to buy that business The with them off” materials in business the so reducing will quality of as to the need the cut cost to be materials resentment. promotional its they of help The on customer products do not use strategies (see that section expensive 4.5). campaigns costs. reduce direct productive or Unproductive be will aggressive increased are suppliers This compromise customers might staff less sales perceive source adopt lead business that of help might could they are have purchase which Businesses ● might persuade that if though, bought, may this products prots. these and careful, A that for increase change market higher business may not consumers for down ● is prices consumers here may the drawback loyal where prices purchased this increase taken not to labour are able staff costs to may need demotivate by sell or ensuring more to be units shed. decrease the of Care morale staff. Net prot margin (NPM) This the is a measure sales and tax of revenue. by the net It sales the is prot revenue, prot that calculated before remains by after dividing expressed interest as a and deducting the prot all before costs from interest percentage: tax ____ NPM = × sales Example: before A rm interest shown has and sales tax of 100 revenue revenue US$75 of US$150 million. million Calculate its and a NPM. net This prot is here: US$75 million __ NPM × = US$150 The rm $100 of every that $1 a NPM therefore sales of rm could should is indicate performance. 208 can In to its 50 NPM the = 50% addition to in expenses for ways to boost of 50 %. business cents difculties look help an made, leads meeting therefore following makes revenue sales 100 million NPM. very This A well; in controlling to improve the strategies NPM. means generates high on its their used that an NPM the NPM to i.e. a low Businesses better increase $50, mean hand, costs. for every of could other overall for NPM nancial GPM, the 3 . 5 P R O F I T A B I L I T Y A N D L I Q U I D I T Y R A T I O A N A LY S I S Additional strategies to improve NPM rm can carefully unnecessary expenditure could, A ● rm costs, for to with It is could for a a be may expensive the be indirect avoided, holiday demoralize negotiate example moving poorer the costs for to see example packages managers note key for where reduce senior who stakeholders landlords However, to customer to used with with discounts. rm important should on have managers. been used This to holidays. product lead expenses on however, expensive check that another cheaper location rent for the or aim with cheaper which may to suppliers rent not cut be could ideal, image. measures collectively for negotiating with in an to effort increase to raise revenues both and GPM and cut costs NPM. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 A ● Eciency ratios These ratios liabilities. example assess They of how also such well help ratios is to a rm internally analyse the the return utilizes performance on capital its of assets a and rm. employed One (ROCE). Return on capital employed (ROCE) This ratio invested measures capital. employed. liabilities as noted is Capital (loan both the assesses efciency the employed capital) to is its returns found share and a by protability rm is making adding capital and a of rm’s also to a rm’s from its capital long-term its retained prot, below: Capital This It employed then used in = long-term calculating liabilities the return + on share capital capital + employed retained as prot shown below: net prot before interest and tax ____ ROCE = × capital Example: prot net of prot First, the Capital Suppose US$0.5 before capital a business million and interest employed tax will = US$1 = US$3.5 has loan and employed 100 employed share capital of of US$2 US$700,000. need million capital of + to be US$1 It Calculate calculated US$0.5 million, million. million as + retained generated its a ROCE. follows: US$2 million million 209 3 F i n a n c e Then, ROCE a n d is a c c o u n ts calculated as follows: Key terms US$0.7 million __ ROCE = × US$3.5 The business $100 of is capital interest and businesses business get making an owners to 20% Gross prot margin (GPM) ROCE the Generally, from = million invested, tax. 100 their the 20 %. more This generates higher capital inject of rm the as ROCE employed. money means $20 This into the acts their that its net for greater as every prot an calculated by dividing the before the returns incentive businesses for for gross prot by the sales revenue, expressed as a percentage higher Net prot margin (NPM) returns. well a It is rm an is able Comparisons with of a those important to generate should of other ratio also be rms, because prot made to get a it analyses from on the better its key ROCE and judges sources of past assessment of nance. years, on how the calculated by dividing the together performance rm. net prot before interest and tax by the sales revenue, expressed as a percentage Additional possible strategies to improve ROCE Return on capital employed stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 In addition following to the could above be strategies used to on improve improving GPM and NPM, the capital while still (ROCE) ROCE: assesses the returns a rm ● A rm should ensuring problem that rm This raising of might will reduce prot is the such as decrease. The less ploughed-back prot be capital sold is for the prot that or may be will remains fall. aid to to in more dividends retained not needed generate reducing future does which to additional net loan unchanged reducing drawback of machinery, pay of assuming not amount loan could and effect ROCE, the that declare the remains that assets goods have the to this xed production A net with essential ● try is making from its capital employed The purchase the further prot. shareholders. prot, and unchanged retained hence or prot does leads to investment. Lqy r These ratios obligations. meeting measure their asset can such as be ability need day-to-day converted stock important the Businesses and bills. into debtors liquidity ratios of a rm sufcient Liquidity cash. that are Liquid can the be to pay levels is a of its measure assets quickly current off liquid of include turned ratio and short-term assets to how cash into the debt help in quickly and cash. acid others Two test ratio Current ratio This ratio makes liabilities. It is a comparison calculated using of a the rm’s current following assets to its current formula: current assets __ Current ratio = current Example: current A business liabilities has amount liabilities current to $250 $500 000 _ Current ratio = = $250 210 000 2 assets 000. totalling What is $500 its 000 current an while ratio? its 3 . 5 above This is rm has rm’s $2 of range This will range off means could the put a high mean the of is ● There ● Too ratio the are of number are $1 of of also be expressed sufcient than industry be current as liabilities differ recommend business. less also of accountants many difculties the should but the can every L I Q U I D I T Y a working the of A current ratio the current liabilities, when the it rm avoided. A comes to operates high 1.5:2. to below 1:1 which paying in. current 2:1. capital of A N A LY S I S the on range R A T I O its Moreover, ratio could following: cash converting many much on which availability nancial much by the assets depends too example in A 2 for ratio debts current rm current There ● assets. for is that current allow the This any of ratio mean short-term that creditors. to current acceptable pay current interpreted A N D being to debtors, stock is being held and not non-current increasing held, the leading being invested, for assets. to possibility high of bad warehouse debts. storage stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 The P R O F I T A B I L I T Y costs. Possible strategies to improve current ratio A ● rm might long-term hence loans ● reduce loans. improve could the (see liquidity position. Another strategy disadvantage business will the section increases is be if the ratio. the to sell existing the its efciency assets for are the seek and long-term gearing long-term capital to liabilities increasing and affecting leasing instead current However, working of choose the payable long-term cost and reduce thereby available that face to interest 3.6), would the overdrafts helps current increase business This bank This ratio and assets for business. needed back of the future cash. The the them. Acid test (quick) ratio This is a more short-term current stringent obligations. assets. It is indicator This is calculated of how because using it the well a rm removes following is able stock as to meet part of its the formula: current assets - stock ___ Acid test ratio = current Example: US$ 150 Suppose 000. in What is the its liabilities example acid test above the business has stock worth ratio? US$500 000 US$150 000 ___ Acid test ratio = = US$250 In the $1.4 of In above of the least some leading a mean a for assets liquid cases to rm’s notice. case, current of there obsolete short-term As that liquidity therefore with the $1 is no (the assets This can current is be not with liabilities removing to ratio an focus that by stock in sound to pay its extreme test the can to selling acid the stock on indicates met ratio, inability scrutinized current By guarantee items. debts of stock. current business crisis be the every less 1.4 000 its be liquid sold, liquid of by at may and nancial gets rid them. much than it debts) of eventually how assets less health; short-term caution most has business creditors ratio nancial business the of short 1:1 could be facing should institutions. 211 3 F i n a n c e However, as a n d with a c c o u n ts the current ratio, the variation of acid test ratios in Key terms different same industries implications needs as a to high be considered. current ratio A high except acid that test there ratio is no has the stock to Current ratio be considered. a ratio that compares a rm’s Additional possible strategies to improve acid test ratio current assets to its current In addition can help to the strategies with the acid test to improve the current ratio, the following liabilities ratio: Acid test ratio ● A rm could sell off stock at a discount for cash. This will help a stringent ratio that subtracts improve the liquidity working capital position of the business and avail more stock from the current assets to pay off its short-term debts. However, selling stock and compares this to the at a discount may reduce the revenue generated from the sold stock, rm’s current liabilities thereby ● A rm reducing might stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 stock on debts in rm’s increase credit. the the The the prots. credit problem period here is for that it debtors may to lead purchase to more increased bad TOK discussion business. Often nancial information is presented to the wider Student workpoint 3.14 audience in statistical, Be a thinker 1. Referring graphical or another form to Tables 3.4.1 and 3.4.2, calculate and of quantitative summary. interpret: Do such simplifying a) two protability b) ROCE c) two ratios. presentations limit our 2. Which knowledge of accounts? liquidity of the ratios improvement? those ratios. from Evaluate (a) to (c) possible are in need strategies to of further improve each of ratios. yduts esaC c-cl içk (cci) – trky interest in Turkmenistan Coca-Cola Bottlers Ltd., the Coca-Cola bottler in Turkmenistan. In addition, CCI is a par ty to joint venture agreements that have the exclusive distribution rights for brands of The Coca-Cola Company in Iraq and Syria. CCI oers a wide range of beverages, including sparkling beverages as well as an expanding por tfolio of still beverages (juices, waters, spor ts drinks, iced tea and hot tea). The core brands in all markets are Coca-Cola, Coca-Cola Light, Fanta and Sprite. Coca-Cola içecek (CCI) has a vision to be one of the Dening the Problem leading bottlers of alcohol-free beverages in Southern CCI needed a protability system with channel, brand, Eurasia and the Middle East. They currently distribute in customer and SKU repor ting that was accurate, scalable Turkey, Kazakhstan, Azerbaijan, Jordan and and had fast turnaround. All managerial levels needed Kyrgyzstan. CCI also has over a 33% the right information to make good decisions quickly. 212 3 . 5 P R O F I T A B I L I T Y For Example: A N D L I Q U I D I T Y R A T I O A N A LY S I S Each ASM can now see the top and bottom 20 outlets in their area and act on that information. They can ● Marketing wanted to see net protability by understand the impact of promotions and discounts channel, brand, and SKU so they could focus on the protability of each outlet by SKU and direct the marketing eor ts and budget direct marketing sales developers under their responsibility to push for expenses accordingly. protable SKU sales via the right mix and amount of ● Sales wanted to analyze net protability by promotions and discounts. channel and SKU to segment customers based on growth potential, size of business, and protability. Product Protability ● Supply Chain wanted accurate costing information Previously, CCI regional nance teams had to for each SKU regarding warehouse and delivery perform independent, manual analysis to generate expenses. Executive Management wanted to track net very accurate and it was dicult to compare SKU protability at various dimensions to set company protability across regions and sales centers. In strategy. addition, they could not analyze SKU protability stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 SKU protability. That analysis took days, was not ● by trade channels. The Acorn solution allows all Goals for an Innovative Solution depar tments of CCI to use one model that provides very accurate information overnight, using minimal ● Make net protability for customers, channels, resources. CCI can also analyze SKU protability by SKUs and brands more transparent, standard, and trade channels. easy to access. Analysis of net SKU protability by trade channels for ● Facilitate growth through market segmentation each region and sales center provides tremendous and enable CCI to institutionalize revenue growth benet and some surprises. For example, the same management. SKU for the same channel can be protable in one ● Identify protable and unprotable customers, channels, SKUs, brands etc. and understand the drivers of protability. region or sales center but unprotable in another due to local ways of doing business. CCI can now capture these dierences within regions and sales centers and take action to improve protability. Pricing decisions ● Help create sales and promotion strategies by are managed through promotions and discounts by channel and product based on net protability. trade channel and SKU. Prior to implementing Acorn, ● Track actual customer net protability and the sales team did this manually, at a high level and compare it with estimated contract protability. with no trade channel detail available. CCI can now ● Provide suppor t to channel-based marketing decisions (i.e. direct marketing expense). produce very accurate and detailed information, enabling more accurate pricing decisions. CCI has analyzed the net protability of SKUs and ● Make it easier to drill down protability information package sizes by channel and brand. For instance, the through repor ting layers (channel à customer à protability of Pet 2 liter vs. Pet 2.5 liter has historically SKU or brand à SKU à customer). been a point of discussion within the CCI management Business Value Realized team. CCI can now compare the protability of these As a result of the protability system implemented package sizes within any dimension such as trade with Acorn and Batuman Consulting, CCI has accurate channel (i.e. traditional, on-premise and modern information they did not have before. channels) and brand (i.e. Coca-Cola, Fanta, Sprite, etc.) within each region and sales center. Outlet Protability For the rst time, CCI can see the net protability for Customer Protability each outlet (i.e. customer sales location) under each CCI has a system called Customer Investment Analysis Area Sales Manager. (CIA) to measure the value of a customer at the time of signing the contract. The system is widely used 213 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts internally and is created based on contract terms. ● Mix and amount of promotions and discounts applied ● Level of sales and marketing organization suppor t ● Direct marketing expenses ● Delivery and warehouse expenses CCI now has the capability to compare CIA and Acorn results side by side so that they can track whether the customer is generating the value CCI anticipated before signing the contract. The nance team has completed the protability analysis of National Key Adapted from http://www.acornsys.com/ Accounts and National Cold Drink customers, and the Por tals/76901/docs/coca-cola-case-study.pdf results have been shared with the sales team. CCI also plans to analyze the protability of customers by Area Sales Manager and grow additional relationships by Exam-style questions understanding protable customer proles. Customer 1. Dene the following terms: proles show NET protability and can be created (a) Revenue [2 marks] (b) Net prot [2 marks] based on segment, sub-trade channel, income level, SKU mix, etc. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Operating results used to create these proles include: 2. ● Gross revenue per unit case ● Number of unit cases sold Examine how the new data could help CCI increase its protability (per outlet, per customer, per product). Rv hkl ✓ Ratio analysis nancial meaningful past is a nancial statements ratios and historical and ratios and of analysis aids its tool inter-rm other that decision assesses making by comparisons businesses in the a rm’s making through same or analysing different industries. ✓ Protability include ✓ ✓ An example that prot of an utilizes employed (ROCE). Liquidity ratios ratio. its assets measure obligations (quick) assess margin with rm’s ratio and the two a (GPM) efciency internally debt 214 ratios gross ability and that net assesses liabilities ability examples of to a is to prot margin how return rm being generate prot pay current well on (NPM). a rm capital off ratio its short and term acid test [10 marks] 3 . 5 P R O F I T A B I L I T Y A N D L I Q U I D I T Y R A T I O A N A LY S I S Pr q Woolman Woolman The Windows windows WW’s a Windows are windows special glue (WW) sold have that energy-efcient. the two pieces of suppliers two In glass, windows. construction manufactures to pieces prevents are efcient (WW) industry of any a in from is in passing to widely a Table 1. selected items from WW’s houses. in wooden appears many frame The with (all gures in $ thousands) windows Cash 150 Creditors 515 Debtors 850 between other recognized balance sheet as at 31 May 2009 Canada. through. never common brand for materials sealed moisture problem WW windows building glass air addition, The of in energy- the residential Canada. Loan capital Because and its of the housing nancial crisis position in North America, WW has seen its sales Shor t-term borrowing deteriorate. Retained prot WW manufactures only standard-sized windows using ow X fall 285 1300 production. WW offers trade considering that of are not windows production. order with “special per special point). For and Doing order WW special the payment orders”, standard-sized. (break-even the credit taking were would orders, remainder in that so a 30 is, days. to might be minimum manufacture the upon buyer protable of 100 special would delivery. However, manufacture is the 300 Stock 400 number Total (net xed assets) windows 50% Share capital windows orders pay The if WW stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 * using upon disadvantage is 1800 batch placing that an Table 2. selected items from WW’s additional employee would have to be employed to plan the production prot and loss account for the year process for each special order. WW is uncertain if special-order sales will ended 31 May 2009 (all gures in be sufcient to cover the cost of the recruitment and training of the $ thousands) new a) b) employee. Dene the following (i) share (ii) debtors (i) capital Using sheet the for capital (ii) Using acid (iii) the (iv) Using c) the Nov, May interest relevant nancial and start 1, 2009 information ratio (show information construct and a calculate from all Table your from 1, 4700 1, and marks] Expenses 2150 [2 marks] Gross prot 2195 Sales revenue 6895 balance the loan calculate [5 marks] [2 marks] the working). Table [2 calculate [1 information margin. to 31 Table ratio. prot Using at in X). relevant Using decision IB, as (quick) gearing before (v) WW relevant test Using information (gure Cost of goods sold terms: in tax Table ( show information all 2, calculate your from the net prot working). Table 2, calculate [2 the marks] gross [1 non-nancial producing information, special-order examine mark] mark] WW’s windows. [5 marks] 2012 * trade credit: credit extended to a business from its suppliers. Trade credit is usually listed on the balance sheet of a business as “creditors” or, in some countries, “accounts payable”. 215 3.6 Eciency ratio analysis (HL only) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: calculate and interpret the eciency ratios: stock (inventory) turnover, ➔ debtor (trade receivable) days, creditor days and gearing ratio evaluate possible strategies to improve the above ratio ➔ Eciency ratios As indicated stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 resources efciency days, in in section terms ratios creditor of will 3.5, its be days these assets ratios and explored, and assess liabilities. namely, gearing the In utilization this stock section of a rm’s further turnover, debtor ratio Stock turnover ratio This over ratio a measures given replenished. One It approach year) a rm how period. can It be looks sells its quickly considers calculated at how stock. a rm’s the using many The stock number two times formula in is of sold and times replaced stock is sold and approaches. a given period (usually a is: cost of goods sold __ Stock turnover ratio (number of times) = average Average the stock beginning is calculated of the year by and (opening nding at the stock the end + average of the closing value of stock the stock at year: stock) ___ Average stock = 2 Example: Supposing started year the with $50,000 worth of Average stock is Average stock = a rm goods goods. rst has a worth Calculate cost of sales $150,000, its stock totalling and $400,000. closed turnover the year It with ratio. calculated: $150,000 + $50,000 __ $200,000 _ = = 2 $100,000 2 $400,000 _ Stock turnover ratio = = 4 times $100,000 Another number be approach of days it in calculating takes to sell stock the turnover stock. The is to consider following the formula can used: average stock _ _ Stock turnover ratio (number of days) = × cost 216 of goods sold 365 3 . 6 Using the number above of days example, is stock calculated turnover E F F I C I E N C Y ratio in R A T I O A N A LY S I S ( H L O N LY ) the as: $100 000 _ turnover ratio = × $400 = The or above every (number stock the a high This days, of also quickly and to stock that its stock – of or means earning goods do lower goods do times gures In that year, for considering the of rm prot from become not a turnover (number more not four stock days). turnover ratio perishable days Higher preferred thereby means over (number turnover quickly, 91.25 average. is ratio approach stock turns on times) turnover rst stock business 91 365 000 times), sells its sales. obsolete expire, showing stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Stock A supermarket has a high stock that the rm has good control over its purchasing turnover ratio decisions. It is signicantly companies stock ratio between such turnover is not “tangible” stock therefore level the faster a important gross than as an car to their business this service of stock turnover example, have such industries item of ratio working over done or For may businesses turnover turns is margins industries. that as that on differs manufacturing average lower supermarkets. do not quite This hold stock. important stock though, producers retail effectiveness that prot is note, different relevant the to luxury times very and assessing as products The the important its still at a a good capital stocks protably, worse working is the rather capital in a business instrument management. better; than for Generally, however, selling it stocks is at low loss. This luxury car dealer is likely to have a low stock turnover ratio Possible strategies to improve stock turnover ratio ● Slow-moving reduce losses the due or obsolete rm’s to lost level sales of goods stock. revenue should The that be disposed downside these is goods of. that This it could will could have help lead to generated. 217 3 F i n a n c e Firms ● a n d with a wide better-selling minimize Keeping ● costs for of rms method, are delays stock able to stocks (see affect to the the raw 5.3). delivery production the to benet low are major raw is a narrower, that this may of reducing increases levels of in stock the demand may not market. just-in-time and offer consumers. sudden with the materials The of to added during sustain adopt need disadvantage offered businesses of section the has will The However, amounts are products products customers, in negatively of of of products. stock. where needed any levels holding by of variety sufcient Some ● low range range the goods have a c c o u n ts (JIT) ordered drawback materials eventually to production only is when that if they there producers it are could sales. Debtor days stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 This to ratio collect measures its customers ratio is the who also efcient a debts the owe referred business following number from the to is of customers business as in the its days it takes sold money debt credit it has are average to known collection control on goods on as It is a debtors period . systems. for credit. It rm These and assesses calculated the how using formula: debtors __ Debtor days ratio (number of days) = × total Example: while the debtor A rm’s total days total number sales of revenue debtors amounts equals US$2 sales to 365 revenue US$16 million. million What is its ratio? US$2 million __ Debtor days ratio × US$16 It therefore The takes shorter because the operations period the and to range from credit period leading to the 30 a can days will also as could invest many land liquidity an the have customers to = 45.625 average of 46 a days million business debtor business given 365 = better working this varies as it in days the to run to However, into serious to collect business. other business days. business for capital money from 120 is its debts. This is day-to-day projects. business allowing cash-ow The and too credit could long a problems crisis. Possible strategies to improve debtor days ratio ● A rm can debtors to business A rm may, ● A might their 218 their debts less impose might with goods. chase stop payment though, discounts or other earlier. income The from incentives drawback these to encourage here customers is that than the was agreed. however, rm until pay receives originally ● provide is stiff penalties away any further nalized. some late loyal transactions This debtors for long-time still opting does to payers with not seek such as nes. This customers. overdue guarantee alternative debtors payment, suppliers for 3 . 6 A ● business may consistently in dealing have late with to resort payers. This to legal may E F F I C I E N C Y means harm the such as R A T I O court reputation a A N A LY S I S action business ( H L O N LY ) for has customers. Creditor days This its ratio measures creditors. able to pay following It its the assess average how suppliers, number quickly, for of usually example. The days a within ratio is rm a takes year, a to pay rm calculated is using the formula: creditors __ days ratio (number of days) = × cost Example: of US$7 A business million. owes Calculate its its creditors creditor of goods US$700,000 days with a 365 sold cost of sales ratio. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Creditor US$700,000 __ Creditor days ratio = × US$7 This means creditor short-term long may leading as to rm the future has enables obligations. investors rm’s the ratio strain reconsider a that days investing in The its as days use = 36.5 with, a In rm creditor suppliers to pay days this for period period other to to high its too suppliers, stakeholders trouble will A full extend its other nancial days creditors. cash example, addition, in or its available allowing problems. this it. with to relations perceive relationship 37 rm However, rm’s nancial may about the 365 million and vary such may according to creditors. Possible strategies to improve creditor days ratio ● Having enable some the ● good a rm to suppliers business Effective will relationships to long they easy task business in should and at – control assess the will in depend creditors an to when risks delay will that for object future credit need negotiate could with extended the it might on the in period. refuse need days creditors their suppliers and dire creditor paying making be as credit extension improve of such payment. cash-ow However, to of ratio. early may support assistance. Managers versus This position may and how not needs be of an the time. Gearing ratio This measures nanced from the extent loan business while retained prots. to capital. capital The which Loan employed commonly loan the capital capital is includes used a employed long-term loan gearing capital, ratio by a rm liability share formula in is the capital and is: capital __ Gearing ratio = × capital Example: employed A of business US$25 has 100 employed a million. loan of What US$10 is its million gearing with a capital ratio? US$10 million __ Gearing ratio × = $25 100 = 40% million 219 3 F i n a n c e The business a n d has a c c o u n ts a gearing ratio of 40 per cent, which means that two Key terms fths of loans. the A capital gearing requirements ratio can help of the assess business the level come of from debt a long-term business is Stock turnover ratio burdened ratio of above gearing ratio reluctant debt with. to A 50 per could lend burden. business cent be to is seen and low viewed as businesses Shareholders as geared risky in and high by such a geared if if below has this nanciers, situation potential it to will gearing gure. who due investors a A may the be high measures how quickly a rm’s stock is sold and replaced be over a given period large concerned Debtor days ratio about high-geared dividend their will payments long-term worsen other businesses hand, because loans. the loan In because of these addition, repayment low-geared they rms’ any that not main sudden position businesses may of obligation interest such might foresee any to rate viewed measures on average, the pay increases businesses. be future as On the “safe” number of days it takes for a rm to collect its debts may Creditor days ratio in fact not be initiatives. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 offering with borrowing Shareholders minimal good enough may returns growth fund therefore and strategies to may see even promising future growth low-geared prefer higher and businesses high-geared future expansion as businesses returns measures the average number of days a rm takes to pay its creditors on investment. Gearing ratio Possible strategies to improve gearing ratio Businesses in a difcult following ● that A are very nancial highly position. geared This can ratio measures the extent to which generally could be place themselves reduced using the capital employed by a rm is nanced from loan capital the measures: business related”, may for the seek alternative example are that issuing the objective preferring of shares sources to may issue take a of funding more long that shares. time are The and go not “loan drawbacks TOK discussion against What role does today’s of any existing shareholders who do not want to lose nancial evidence play in ownership of the business. making judgments about ● A rm might decrease or not declare and issue dividends to an organization’s future shareholders so as to increase the amount of retained prot. This performance? may the however, reasons lead for to doing resentment so are not among well shareholders, especially explained. Student workpoint 3.15 Be a thinker 1. 2. Referring to Tables interpret the a) stock turnover b) debtor c) creditor d) gearing Which of 220 and 3.4.2 in section 3.4, calculate and ratios: days days ratio. the ratios improvement? these 3.4.1 following ratios. from Evaluate (a) to (d) possible are in need strategies to of further improve each of if 3 . 6 E F F I C I E N C Y R A T I O A N A LY S I S ( H L O N LY ) Rv hkl Other in days, ✓ efciency terms of creditor Stock stock to ✓ it sell its ✓ days collect Creditor rm ✓ is by a it many utilize stock their turnover resources ratio, debtor ratios how period. It fast can times considers measures days to ratio rm geared how rm’s in the a rm’s be a stock measured given number period of days is in a it sold two rm and ways. sells takes for its a rm money the average from its number debtors. It is of days also it takes known as for a debt period able Gearing measures how include stock. rm collection assess gearing given secondly, Debtor to a that liabilities and ratio over assesses and and days turnover replenished Firstly, ratios assets or is assesses pay its fast in number of days within a year a creditors. measures nanced low how the from percentage loan capital to to which the establish capital whether stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 ✓ employed it is high geared. 221 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Practice question CU CU Ltd Ltd started computers. quality initial and of consistent recent salary prot stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 given sales and the CU by been the at growth months of At up looking loss of has has to company the boom. it at a on account CU Ltd Unlike the faced grew was many to to of Stock other at solutions sheet cash to for a it staff 2003 to The new and nancial the capital. 2004 are Balance sheet as at 31 December $0 0 0 20 03 20 04 Fixed assets 1500 1400 Current assets 910 1220 Debtors 550 650 10 5 Cas Total current assets 1470 1875 Current liabilities Creditors 300 250 Overdraft 350 475 Total current liabilities 650 725 2320 2550 Sare capital 250 250 Prot and loss account 320 350 Loan capital 1750 1950 Capital employed 2320 2550 Net assets Prot and loss account for the year ended 31 December $0 0 0 20 03 20 04 Turnover 5750 6100 Cost of goods sold 4175 4750 Gross prot 1575 1350 Marketing and admin expenses 1250 1300 325 50 Interest 175 225 Taxation 100 10 Net prot before interest and tax 222 the but since. below: Stock an the delay suggesting inject of at survived slow for high result million ow. is for problems with and cameras despite nancial with As $75 rms, However, Exchange web customers rapidly. negotiate help balance its valued signicant had range and producing amongst century. weeks the ago company even two years reputation capital start Ltd seven a rst venture technology crash has otation business developed of payments director in reliability. the technology The up has injection height In It Prot after interest and tax 50 (185) Dividends 20 0 Retained prots 30 (185) 3 . 6 a) Calculate b) Assess the Internet d) Using IB, a Nov working impact the of value CU on CU capital Ltd of for 2003 and increasing 2004. the of liquidity, nancial potential these accounts to the efciency position investor. of CU and Ltd marks] [4 marks] [4 marks] [10 marks] ( H L O N LY ) worldwide board of protability from A N A LY S I S [2 Ltd appropriate analyse of likely of access. Examine directors level R A T I O the ratios perspective 2005 stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 c) the E F F I C I E N C Y 223 3.7 Cash flow By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ distinguish between prot and cash ow ➔ explain the working capital cycle ➔ construct and interpret cash-ow forecasts ➔ comment on the relationship between investment, prot, and cash ow ➔ evaluate possible strategies for dealing with cash-ow problems stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 th r bw pr h w Cash is goods money or shareholders. current assets running of a given business a period nancial It gets the the of cash will and is the enable ow A asset in This a of the time. lack money Cash is a to cash is ows are ow meet in the of a their found to the out out rm’s by its of a a failure or business by business ability by under received inows day-to-day of smooth business and cash sale investment is monies paid (where in the or and essential result monies Cash is generated by selling goods or services 224 business indicator cash either institutions, could that the key businesses it a inows are positive through nancial sheet. outows Cash business from liquid balance obligations. outows) most ow period time. into borrowing business Cash while of is in any bankruptcy. over that services, to meet exceed running a over its cash costs. 3 . 7 Prot is obtained by subtracting total costs from total revenue. It C A S H F L O W is Key terms prot great if the difference indicator of the is positive nancial and a success loss of a if it is negative. rm’s core Prot is a operations. Cash ow Prot and cash ow are different. When buying goods or services, money that ows in and out of customers can either use cash or buy on credit. If either of the two a business over a given period methods are used, this will still count as part of the sales revenue of of time a business. business will purchases point Moreover, in be said were time if to credit for the the sales have revenue earned purchases business a prot. then will exceeds the differ the total However, cash-ow with its if costs, most position of at a Prot the that the positive dierence protability. between sales revenue and total costs Example: goods, During incurring a a particular total cost month of a $4,000. business The sold business $10,000 offered worth of customers Insolvency one month’s credit of 50 per cent of sales. What was the prot and cash a situation where a business ow for that month? stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 runs out of cash but may still be protable Prot = Prot Net the bringing sold, the sold Two a) is 50 ow the lower per as ● business long can paying ● purchasing b) A of during positive between in the gure sales $4,000 was two revenue for but be funds, have brought possibly $1,000 month ow of even the that business clearly cash-ow the goods month. were However, month. or about by the $1,000, The though in between little that only concepts. received differentiating may the cash because not = no prot cash. and This cash is ow. known by: allowing customers a very too capital early and leaving equipment or little many or no cash non-current for operations assets at the time servicing business a it see outow period overtrading achieve a protable suppliers eventually ● be cash can but prot as and $6,000 10,000) money arise collection ● ● the the can credit same we difference insolvency poor of $6,000 of = costs inow (50% counted possibilities A of than cent goods cash = total $4,000 example prot out = ow above a revenue $10,000 cash incurred gure = cash Net From sales – purchasing tied loans can sourced from ● gained ● obtained from a the the too much stock with cash that is business cash. positive cash bank from in with have positive ● up ow in cash the ow but following be unprotable. ways. Cash It could can be: loans sale of a rm’s shareholders’ xed assets funds. 225 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts th wrkg pl yl Key terms Working costs raw of a is the business. materials, capital, by capital also These and as for the current needed costs paying known subtracting money could to pay include electricity net current liabilities for from and the day-to-day paying gas, assets current wages, among of a running Working capital purchasing others. business, is Working calculated assets: the dierence between current assets and current liabilities Liquidation Working capital = current assets current liabilities a situation where all a rm’s assets are sold o to pay any Current assets debtors, and are the liquid assets of the business and include cash, funds owing need to be stock. paid in Current the liabilities short term, are such the as monies creditors the and business bank owes that overdrafts. Working capital cycle To have sufcient working capital, businesses need to ensure that their the period of time between current assets exceed their current liabilities. If the opposite is the case, the payment for goods supplied to business could run into working capital problems and face insolvency or a stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 a business and the business serious liquidity crisis. An illiquid business (one that is not able to pay its receiving cash from their sale short-term assets are sold Working assets A the sale. the in net order raw to are (see working to to asking for by cycle or and the is cash The the payments – effectively the to keep the as way of as these cash in capital the in as gains for their out of possible cases stocks of nished greater cycle, to the assets. many extending credit for from short selling is, current and purchasing example, rm’s payment assets However, extending the maximize levels after a important to cycle interval working (suppliers capital is all closure). receiving debtors For its between between this business. (when the It liquid capital. from so time other occur longer of to of optimal business and the leading assessment working that liquidated administered. period desirable lengthens working an capital cash the of is and lags 3.7.1). needs owing being the of receiving customers later on time be maintaining business usually Figure shorten working assets maximize capital period a is delays funds are movements materials goods any liabilities capital It eventually management current shows also pay manage business. there to to supplied It to current working goods off could capital and businesses from debts) while are the the credit suppliers businesses) help cycle. purchase of materials, etc. from suppliers cash received production from debtors of goods goods sold on credit Figure 3.7 .1. A simple working capital cycle Therefore having 226 businesses enough to levels of working assets providing need run capital no to their control daily could returns, their working operations. mean creating that great On funds capital the are other tied opportunity well by hand, up in costs. high current 3 . 7 C A S H F L O W Cash-ow forecasts These a are given that future period shows business include banks. cash, have sales cash Cash cash repaying time. expected that cash debtors, predictions of This yet from outows and rm’s the occurred. selling investments loans, a in cash form month-by-month not expenses of is include such as making a receipts or purchasing rent, wages dividend and of business shareholders, payments or to over of a inows payments borrowing salaries, payments cash assets, and outows document likely materials and and nancial Examples goods from inows of xed assets paying from from for creditors, shareholders. Constructing cash-ow forecasts is ● constructing Opening month. ● Total It cash Total Net and ● forecast, knowledge of the following terms a end of Table 3.7.1 – – this by this is a is the cash business a at that the summation a business start of of all a starts trading cash with every year. inows during a is It is opening shows this is a summation of all the cash outows the difference between the total cash inows outows. balance month. the – month. this cash cash to – held outows ow the month cash inows total Closing balance particular cash the the month. cash during ● cash-ow cash is particular ● a important: stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 In how – this found is balance the above the by estimated adding of the terms the same are cash net available cash ow of at the one month. applied. Table 3.7 .1. Cash-ow forecast for XYZ Ltd company for the rst ve months of trading All gures in $ Opening balance January 2,000 February March April May 4,500 5,600 4,650 3,250 9,000 8,000 9,500 7,500 Cash inows Cash sales revenue 10 ,000 Payment from debtors 6,000 5,000 4,500 4,000 4,750 Rental income 4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000 4,000 20,000 18,000 16,500 17,500 16,250 Electricity 1,500 1,800 1,750 2,000 1,900 Raw materials 5,000 4,000 4,500 5,500 6,000 Rent 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 3,000 Wages 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 5,000 500 600 700 900 450 2,500 2,500 2,500 2,500 2,500 17,500 16,900 17,450 18,900 18,850 Net cash ow 2,500 1,100 Closing balance 4,500 5,600 Total cash inows Cash outows Telephone Loan repayments Total cash outows (950) 4,650 (1,400) 3,250 (2,600) 650 227 3 F i n a n c e In the above a n d a c c o u n ts example, XYZ Ltd shows a positive closing balance at the Key term end be of May, but attributed this to the amount negative has net been cash on a decline ows in from March, March. April and This can May. Cash ow forecast Can you identify the specic reasons for this? Assuming the cash sales the future prediction of a rm’s revenue in December of the previous year was $12 000, what does this cash inows and outows tell you about the credit period offered to customers? over a given period of time It is important and accuracy predict its to of note the future that cash-ow gures cash depends inows and forecasts on how are well based the on estimates, business is able to outows. Benets of cash-ow forecasts Some of A ● the advantages cash-ow to start a business and stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Cash-ow ● intending is forecast business. provides apply they Predicting the A ● cash business By gures where and its the can to clarify for support to follows: document helps from as future base nancial check for anyone the for the of the performance. businesses institutions. on wishing purpose This solvency and business. help cash can actual are projections banks managers and gures, lies and identify therefore assist comparisons problem it good funding the need a forecasts planning because provide forecast making the of useful is estimated for ow may cash-ow ow. a enable creditworthiness ● is cash-ow This forecasts to because of in the business seek the in advance accordingly monitoring between a plan and should be cash able to solutions where source managing estimated respective periods to it. cash ow assess to solve it. th rlhp bw vm, pr, h w Investment or the property. about by of hoping Examples The investing expectation including to generally business, of All that forms of unexpected different is the the act earnings. bought investment changes of in state asset the a of investing. purchasing involves appreciates include come in on Investing buying with market investment, growth or money investments between stages to spending future nancial relationship the refers in value prot, and business. cash This is in over an ow noted with creation, stocks, especially conditions nance asset wealth bonds, risks, In an time. or risks brought economy. can in be linked Table 3.7.2. Table 3.7 .2. The relationship between investment, prot, and cash ow, using various stages in a business Business stage Star t-up Investment (owner ’s funds) Prot Cash ow This involves very high investment There is no prot because Cash ow is negative – cash outow is due to the purchase of initial costs are not yet met signicantly higher than cash inow assets or set-up costs Growing Investment could still be high There is a small prot, as Cash ow may be positive (i.e. cash because the business is not yet more revenue star ts to be inow is higher than cash outow) fully established generated to cover costs but low until cash inows increase especially from sales revenue 228 Established – Investment may be minimal as the thriving business can plough back prots High prot is achieved Cash ow is positive – cash inow is higher than cash outow 3 . 7 Table 3.7.2 provides a simplied model of how investment in terms C A S H F L O W of Key term the owner’s cash ow. injection However, of it capital is into the important to business note that relates the to prot above and features could Investment be affected by qualitative attributes that are beyond the control of the the act of spending money on business. (A more detailed explanation of the difference between prot purchasing an asset with the and cash ow has been covered earlier. expectation of future earnings Strategies to deal with cash-ow problems As it noted is its said earlier, to be working that there major business capital can causes following a facing be are a to run various lack strategies can be liquidity of can its and day-to-day causes of effective be protable crisis used is deal insolvent, We problems and with which difculties operations. cash-ow planning to yet facing poor these in have in a credit means sustaining already business. control. seen The The problems. The a ● following methods aim to decrease the amount of cash stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Reducing cash outow leaving business: A business payment. will This short-term be time future negotiate helps needs. the The consuming suppliers to drawbacks and relationships, with business delaying including or have with this payment their creditors working are to refusal so as that delay for CHANGE its negotiations suppliers to to capital supply could in may affect The cash ow statement will only change if the inows and outows impact on cash and cash future. equivalents. The net change in ● Purchases of xed assets can be delayed. Assets such as machinery cash position is the dierence and equipment may take up a lot of cash helps to avail for the business and between the total amount of delaying purchases However, if the outdated, a efciency and of them machines lack of or equipment purchasing higher costs in cash are replacements the long in the business. becoming may lead money brought in by the business obsolete to or decreased and the total amount that it expended over the repor ting period. term. The cash ow statement ● A business may decrease specic expenses such as advertising costs therefore provides information that will not affect production capacity. If not well checked, though, on an organization’s liquidity this may reduce future demand of a business’s products. and solvency and its ability to ● It might costs A on be possible materials possible danger to or of source cheaper essential this is stock, that the suppliers. decreasing quality of This the the will help outow nished of reduce funds. product change cash ows in future circumstances. In addition, it provides additional information for evaluating changes in assets, may be compromised, affecting future customer relationships. liabilities and equity. Improving cash inows Using the internet, do some ● A business may purchased. debtors, may This which lose insist that avoids tie the down customers customers problem cash. who The prefer to pay of cash only delayed goods goods payments disadvantage buy for on is that research on the various cash from the ow statements of dierent business organizations? How do the changes in the other nancial credit. documents inuence their cash ● Offering discounts or incentives can encourage debtors to pay early. ow statements? This will than reduce earlier businesses ● A of It rm is and debt The receive diversify on worth with agreed. will may goods the offer for its clear on limitation less cash product sale remembering no burden to debtors here than guarantee that, earlier offering. customers, that is they after will the pay less discount, expected. This will help potentially diversication of as comes avail increasing with a variety sales. higher costs sales. 229 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Looking for additional nance sources Reference to these sources is as seen in unit 3.1 and they include the following: ● Sale to of assets generate reduced ● allows during Sale a bank of on and assets stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 ● be denies Debt the be that on are selling still obsolete needed xed could assets lead to loan is that cash which – by business a also short-term accounts. be sold prove use of to there helps are interest high. use asset facility greatly generate for costly the loan It However, usually business can the is their setbacks. can the leasing this are assets back – from in as in cash and these production. the long run collateral in The and this seeking loans. factoring bills owed business affecting Grants and immediate hired the immediate ● overdraw leaseback can future should assets overdraft to the disadvantage also focus Selling rms times payments ● the production. Arranging that – cash. cash does its to not the get debt-collecting in a business. the subsidies subsidies specic external customers full business, The companies thereby major amount drawback owed by its can purchase providing is that the customers, protability. and inows. – by The from the – businesses government to is sources drawback conditions struggling that that have these to be help met can apply increase of before for their nance money cash come is grants with guaranteed. Limitations of cash-ow forecasting Prediction generally are to bound causes ● of these impact Poor poor may ● ● market in change affecting negatively affect the machine is difcult position a include forecast and effectiveness. the economy by improperly can cash cash machinery inaccuracies Some of the following: – for rms example and have uctuating a negative a sales negative forecasts effect on due future to cash inows. competitors’ often actions ow or to have done of and and a it struggling and hard compete equipment predict, behaviour make it with competitors other them. This can business. failure can – for – breakdown drastically affect of the cash business. Demotivated employees productivity cash – their Unforeseen less the strategies predict cash-ow borrowing predicting their a forecast’s needs. research to in in predictions thereby the could affect cash-ow businesses the 230 its Difculty limit changes could demand sales, ● rates on characterizes that inaccuracies Unexpected interest ● occur inow. of workers, – being demotivated reducing output or can sales negatively and affect leading to 3 . 7 C A S H F L O W Student workpoint 3.16 TOK discussion Be knowledgeable Is it morally right for businesses to insist on early Juma plans to open a restaurant next year beginning in January. Use payments from debtors while the following information to answer the questions that follow: they delay payments to ● He has $4,000 of ● He has secured his own money to inject into the business. creditors? a bank loan of $6,000 to add to his capital requirements. estimates trading to Material ● paid in ● Wages ● Total in cash and A loan ● Rent 1. Using are every salaries and $6,000 the forecast 50 % are costs the a of for the $4,000, cash constant of is in $500 sales rst ve $5,000, months $5,500, revenue per of $6,000. month and gure are of paid $5,000 in two every month. installments, one April. each month. month. shown Juma’s $6,000 other every format for revenue $2,000, month. repayment is sales follows; advertising ● 2. as expenses cash February of the be stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 He ● in Table restaurant 3.7.1, construct business for the a rst cash-ow ve months trading. Comment on recommend the a cash-ow way forward position for faced by Juma’s business and him. Rv hkl ✓ Prot is when the other only ✓ The the both hand considers working goods sale. Cash outows) include; of ✓ and ✓ wages When a cash strategies some purchases to reduce in and the revenue and considered. and out of the total Cash costs ow business and and reduce to for on and improve cash their capital the it is cash expected payments Cash assets, outow cash cash to shows and occurred. the from for possible. business inows expenses to (cash payments examples from include; such as shareholders. following inows, need total to be cash balance. include; delaying incentives that cash, outow and as payment cash working payments total closing cash payment or forecasts balance, ows offering assets yet Cash dividend ow short inows) not banks. xed the document goods between receiving on as (cash have from cash interval nally cycle selling cash time maximise that or strategies and the receipts salaries net money nancial from materials opening while a borrowing outows, to keep is constructing creditors is business business included; Some cycle cash sales and of total are transactions. to forecast purchasing rent, a ow between transactions effectively month cash credit the to to desirable by debtors is capital order ow month difference and cash supplied In usually ✓ positive cash to negotiating purchase inow include; encourage xed with assets, insisting debtors to pay on cash early. 231 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Pr q New Philanthropy Steve Dawes was an set up online children and in in the online In 2010, web NPF current NPF stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Steve has is the are allowed. has concert, Steve cash has (NPF) retired educational been reserves climate, a 2005. It businessman. It opportunities looking are NPF’s being main in at his used nancial up source is for quickly of nance – but also for regularly of all social web site to no fee over xed for updating the networking All and web the to aims are as Donations (millions of US$) them 40 July 30 August 30 September 20 October 20 November 10 with educational become June An communication to Forecast well organization. nance e-mail as site. connects funds NPF outgoings computers NPF sites only statement, NPF’s and running web administrator. vision the world electronically its assets. servers the is rst charity. been which volunteers on spent educational watching Foundation from nancing economic debt transferred asked will generate money NPF’s from According paperless countries. maintenance fee chief donation falling. no fee, volunteers as would – (NPF) Philanthropy* organization poor community projects New generous concern. designer’s online the very developing with usage has Steve a donations Internet a founded with non-prot statements Foundation by be a the NPF the connections become too are be rock over not or be They if sponsor Internet. convinced. children. to possibilities, should frustrated slow band the relations concert for may only public forums sponsoring concert popular broadcast substantial opportunities the very They used also global to The but a opportunity some argue that provide believe Internet reunion that the further many people broadband Millions fail. of US$ Steve (all is preparing gures refer a to cash-ow 2010) forecast based on for the the next following six months Opening balance gures: 1 in June 2010 Donations ● after the are transferred money has to been the educational projects one month Donations received. 50 received in ● Educational a) Dene projects receive 95% of all donations. May 2010 the following terms: Internet usage fee (i) vision (ii) xed statement [2 marks] [2 marks] 1 to be paid in June and assets September b) (i) Using NPF and Steve’s from forecast June closing to gures, November monthly prepare 2010, cash-ow a cash-ow clearly forecast forecast showing balances. the for Maintenance fee 0.25 per for servers and month opening [6 marks] computers (ii) Comment (iii) Explain on two highlighted c) Analyse sponsor IB, * May the the your possible in impact parts of concert. from solutions (i) two and part to (i). the [3 liquidity problems (ii). external [6 threats on marks] NPF’s decision to [6 Web designer ’s 0.5 per fee month Concer t 5 to be sponsoring fee paid in marks] marks] 2010 Philanthropy: voluntary action for the public good. An activity performed with the goal of promoting the well-being of fellow man. 232 results November 3.8 Investment appraisal By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ calculate and evaluate the payback period as an investment appraisal method ➔ calculate and examine the average rate of return as an investment appraisal method ➔ calculate and discuss the net present value method as an stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 investment appraisal method (HL only) Introduction Investment evaluating It attempts particular business appraisal the to assess project. venture is to justify worth investment projects. investment appraisal also In quantitative the of capital aims to pursuing assists this – the attractiveness therefore appraisal present or and It Investment net refers viability an expenditure establish and section we in look period, it will a at three in a protable. different methods rate to particular be comparing average used proposal. allocated whether whether businesses payback techniques investment of of return , and value The payback period This method project will to take ows. It estimates pay to back its recover can be the length initial its cost principal calculated of time outlay. required It looks investment using the at for amount following an how investment long from its a business net cash formula: initial investment cost ____ Payback period = annual Example new 1: A construction cement-mixing $50,000 in annual ow engineer machine cash cash ow. and from plans on estimates Calculate the investment investing that it will payback $200 000 generate period for in a about the machine. $200,000 _ Payback period = = 4 years $50,000 Hence the Example a new 2: period Another timber-cutting following and payback cash ows for the new construction machine. in the rst machine engineer The aims machine four years: would is to be invest expected $60,000, four to years. $300,000 generate $80,000, in the $100,000 $120,000. 233 3 F i n a n c e Its payback ows over a n d period the a c c o u n ts can four be years, identied as by shown calculating in the table the cumulative cash below: Table 3.8.1. Expected cash ows of a new machine Year Annual net cash ows ($) Cumulative cash ows ($) 0 (300,000) (300,000) 1 60,000 (240,000) 2 80,000 (160,000) 3 100,000 (60,000) 4 120,000 60,000 The but initial in investment which month outlay exactly? will be This paid can back be sometime calculated in using year the four – following stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 formula: Extra cash inow required ___ × Annual The in extra year year is 4 3 to cash cash it $120,000. in inow has pay ow been off year shown in calculated the initial Therefore 12 months 4 Table that 3.8.1 only investment. applying this to is $60,000. $60,000 The the This needs annual formula cash we to is because be paid ow in in year 4 get: $60,000 _ × 12 months = 6 months $120,000 It therefore investment The results other in projects payback The takes of to aid of may “cut-off” that years. example the In one in years examples period business three and six months to pay back the initial $300,000. an 1 and decision the project also have investment 1 example the 2 is 2 can be making. the better decided on should investment better off compared As a it is an not six for the internal go below, project by with general just results rule, the investing payback for meets from shorter period example this the business. or four criterion while months. Advantages of the payback period ● It is simple ● It is a and useful technology. will be fast to method It helps recovered calculate. in to rapidly changing estimate before how another fast industries the machine, initial for such as investment example, can be purchased. ● ● It helps cash-ow Since short-term it is prone Business a to the that can problems pay measure inaccuracies managers obtained. 234 with projects less ● rms investment can easily of back of because more quick they quickly returns long-term comprehend on can choose than investment, forecasting. and use the the others. results it is 3 . 8 I N V E S T M E N T A P P R A I S A L Disadvantages of the payback period It ● does could It ● not inuence ignores focusing The ● consider the in major overall only annual changes the on cash earned investment protability how fast ows demand cash it will could which be after payback period which decisions. of an pay investment project by back. affected could the by unexpected negatively affect the external payback period. The average rate of return method percentage generated measures of by accounting its a the capital project rate of annual cost. over return. It a It net return assesses period can be the of on an investment protability time. It calculated (total is also using returns per known the as a annum as the following capital formula: stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 This cost) _____________________ years of usage ___ Average rate of return (ARR) = × capital Example: A photocopier streams for $100,000 Total business at a the cost next considers of ve respectively. returns purchasing $150,000. years; = $30,000 $345,000 + its a expects $30,000, Calculate = It new the commercial following $50,000, 100 cost revenue $75,000, $90,000 and ARR. $50,000 + $75,000 ($345,000 + $90,000 + $100,000 $150,000) ___ Net return per annum = = $39,000 5 $39,000 _ ARR = × 100 = 26% $150,000 The business can compare project if this showing interest case therefore rates banks on expects gure the highest loans, offer with an to an the rate. assess interest ARR ARR The the rate of of ARR level of 26% other can of 15%, on its investment. projects also risk. be For and compared example, businesses may A choose in nd it business the with the banks’ above Key terms worthwhile Investment appraisal to pursue lending investment rate. investment the project criterion rate and Other rate would projects businesses should was still 20% be with set return criterion not go for the considered a below if above a it of 11% rates is to desirable or be business, higher a than minimum selected. the project ARR to the For is base rate that example, 6% above The ARR given shows period of the the quantitative techniques if used in evaluating the viability this or attractiveness of an investment proposal pursue. Advantages of the ARR ● an Payback period protability of an investment project over a time. the length of time required for an investment project to pay back its initial cost outlay ● Unlike the payback period, it makes use of all the cash ows in a business. Average rate of return (ARR) ● It allows better for easy allocation comparisons of with investment other competing projects, for funds. measures the annual net return on an investment as a percentage of its capital cost ● A business ARR for a can use project, its to own assess criterion the rate viability and of check the this with the venture. 235 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Disadvantages of the ARR ● Since it there are the It ● likely accuracy does have The ● considers not the a to of longer be effects on period forecasting or errors. useful life Long-term of the project, forecasts decrease results. consider same time the ARR the timing but time one of cash could value of pay inows. back money are Two more not projects quickly might despite this. considered. Net present value (hL only) This is future value dened cash is as today’s example, offering $100 10 the inows difference or value returns of an invested per cent at in the and amount the interest summation the of original money beginning would be of present of year $110 in at values investment. available the worth of cost in a the future. bank end of Present For account of the year: stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 10 _ × ( $100 ) + $100 100 Hence, $100 is $110 the another you grows than future is present To year it observe? years less in do This a of future worth less of future than ows to calculated xed a their a $100 year’s in a bank i.e. a the uses present interest further over xed a interest discount rates at at 10 of other to is per cent money per do This affect that over three in get be the the interest? method . the present converts discount do will paid we cent for What period cash-ow rates words, invested $133. How 10 factor today. and year today. years In $110 three-year discounted value If amount paid three how a today. time. account amount over called It in received considers ows. using worth and in $100 today, a is that cash $121 invested what is $110 invested then $100 use time of to received technique cash usually $100 $133, $100 we year’s value amounts If to value this is value a one present these factor is time. Table 3.8.2. Discount factors Years Discount rate Exam tip 4% 6% 8% 10% 20% 1 0.9615 0.9434 0.9259 0.9091 0.8333 2 0.9246 0.8900 0.8573 0.8264 0.6944 3 0.8890 0.8396 0.7938 0.7513 0.5787 4 0.8548 0.7921 0.7350 0.6830 0.4823 5 0.8219 0.7473 0.6806 0.6209 0.4019 6 0.7903 0.7050 0.6302 0.5645 0.3349 7 0.7599 0.6651 0.5835 0.5132 0.2791 8 0.7307 0.6271 0.5403 0.4665 0.2326 9 0.7026 0.5919 0.5002 0.4241 0.1938 10 0.6756 0.5584 0.4632 0.3855 0.1615 Discount factors, as sown in Table 3.8.2 are provided in te Business management guide Source: IB Business management guide p. 78 236 3 . 8 To get the present value of future cash ows, the appropriate I N V E S T M E N T discount A P P R A I S A L factor Key terms is multiplied the present by the value net of cash $100 ow in invested the given over year. three In years at the 10 earlier per example, cent will be: Discounted cash ow Present value = 0.7513 (taken from Table 3.8.2) × $100 = $75.13. This uses a discount factor that means that $100 received in three years’ time is worth only $75.13 today. conver ts future cash ows to Example: produces Consider net cash an investment ows over the project next that four costs years as $500,000 their present value and follows: Net present value (NP V) Year 1: $100,000 the dierence in the Year 2: $200,000 Year 3: $300,000 summation of present values of future returns and the original cost of investment 4: $250,000 Calculate The the working net is present shown value in the (NVP) at following a discount factor of 8 per cent. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Year table: Table 3.8.3 Calculating net present value Year Net cash ow ($) 0 (500,000) 1 100,000 0.9259 92,590 2 200,000 0.8573 171,460 3 300,000 0.7938 238,140 4 250,000 0.7350 183,750 NPV = NPV The a total = NPV viable the Present value in $ Discount factor at 8% this project viability pursued. future present $685,940 in of An cash 1 values the ows is a should project increase will original $500,000 example that in be be value less If in discount worth cost $185,940 ahead. would the = positive go (500,000) of the $185,940, value question rate when was and reduces it the discounted signifying negative should NPV at then not be because higher rates. Advantages of NPV ● The opportunity consideration ● All cash ● The ows discount economic in cost its and including rate can variables time value of money is put into calculation. their be such timing changed as to interest are included suit rate any in its expected computation. changes in variations. Disadvantages of NPV ● It is more ● It can initial ● The complicated only cost be to calculate compare than the investment payback projects period with or the ARR. same outlay. discount which used to may rate be greatly affected inuences by the inaccurate nal interest NPV rate result obtained, predictions. 237 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Student workpoint 3.17 TOK discussion Be knowledgeable How certain is the information we get from nancial accounts? A large retail business has the following forecasted net cash ows for Can we, for example, know in a major project: advance if an investment will Year be successful? Net cash ows ($) 0 (40,000) 1 15,000 2 30,000 3 10,000 4 5,000 Does the accounting process allow for imagination? stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 1. Calculate the payback 2. Calculate the ARR. 3. Calculate the NPV discount factors at in period. a discount Table 3.8.2). rate of [HL 6 per cent (use the only] Revision checklist ✓ Investment an appraisal investment venture in is ✓ return Payback to ✓ Average by of a ✓ does project It the Net a of does an not of present value is of future calculation. It It complex projects to different useful viability particular as of business cash the time the in businesses projects. period, earned of and is also ows project timing average after over per the rate given cash It cost difference inows use all and and same of or the cash time can initial in the returns project. generated accounting and rate shows period inows summation and discounted ows value only cost in of be the cash its of and time. effects used to cost as However, compare (HL present method computation money. outlay. of original ow only) is industries. annum as its ows. payback business a recover cash investment known a to net changing an in of take its rapid protability cash the will from protability investment includes of business assisting investment payback outlay method the assesses all a cash overall the cash the a well the money. calculate with as include long consider makes opportunity how of whether of value. period use value other initial a assessment protable consider the return over investment. 238 not makes it at or and time values the of protability However, on looks ignores rate return. the it and establishes or with present calculate quantitative techniques investment However, period net period principal simple appraisal and It pursuing comparisons Investment of the proposal. worth making is in of its well it is as more investment 3 . 8 I N V E S T M E N T A P P R A I S A L Practice question Easy E E stable Booking Booking online motivated for their director, Maia Reach” two A: is a small, reservation take great quality greater software Option and Maia, has Option (EEB) hotel high demand, (EEB) pride customer competition has decided well-known, service. in their Due changes upgrade reputable employees work. service. and to EEB EEB to in EEB’s an has and are nancially highly received increase technology, computers in recognition global the nance and/or software. options: purchase only a new software called “Book-Fast” from a local designer. B: purchase from a new computers manufacturer with installed software called “Global abroad. Option A Cost Option B $20,000 Technical suppor t stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 Easy $40,000 24 hours onsite at EEB 24 hours online Fur ther payments payable: Employees No change At the end of their contract 15% of employees to be made redundant, cost: $15,000 in year 2 Training cost On-the-job: free Maintenance cost Insurance cost The average rate of return (ARR) Intensive: $12,000 in year 1 Free $1000 per year $500 per year $1000 per year of Option A is 46.25%. The Maia is considering using a straight line method of estimated revenue EEB employees favour Option A, even though return/total depreciation. some of their in $ per year is shown competitors below: using “Book-Fast” security more It a) also give global b) your c) Calculate For IB, problems has and competitive of hotel method the your chosen secure with the Option software, B, which reservation advantage and an system ability average to one weakness of EEB using depreciation. period rate A and discount advantage method Maia’s of for of Option return Option rate and of of B, handle [4 A ( show (ARR) for calculate 4% one investment choice provide ( show all the disadvantage appraisal. Option B. Option B Year 1 10,000 14,000 Year 2 12,000 16,800 Year 3 17,000 23,800 Year 4 20,000 28,000 a marks] all Option net your Option A software. a present working). for [2 marks] [4 marks] B working). a including will reservations. and of payback Option one NPV Examine Nov a strength the using Explain the f) all both (NPV) e) line Maia working). (show d) EEB one Calculate reported sophisticated volume Describe straight have However, up-to-date, will large issues. EEB of value [5 marks] using [4 marks] [6 marks] 2012 239 3.9 Budgets (HL only) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ explain the impor tance of budgets for organizations ➔ state the dierence bet ween cost centres and prot centres ➔ analyse the role of cost centres and prot centres ➔ calculate and interpret variances ➔ analyse the role of budgets and variances in strategic planning. stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 ir A budget is a expenditure for individuals, Budgets of the and help for in the holder is being the specied of future targets and enable time period. a plan time government, They responsible met. nancial specied setting achievement cost a organization. within are quantitative over budget for is for are the any person known used estimates aligned efcient The ensuring Commonly or that period. as that the budgets type with of specied are sales be main allocation budget can and prepared organization. the involved the revenue Budgets of in resources the formulation holder. budget revenue objectives The budget allocations budgets and budgets. th mpr f bg fr rgz ● Planning: provide as a a planning problems ● by and Motivation: control trusted, involved as part of be ● in effective 240 line also who assist are that budgets organizations. in anticipating responsible ensure actual their in for A help to budget future solutions. that with boosts the that the the In budgetary team, which for feel empowered addition, process could budgetary budgeted performance) morale. be purposes budgets help organization. very available departments all holders taken organizational Coordination: helps in should participate could that specied budget ensure purpose possible allocation: used resources ensure devising managers or staff feel even who are recognized lead to productivity. Resource will document is the targets, direction which and increased ● of (modalities performance and setting sense high, budgets resources based budgets on help to to work departments to reach of are prioritize the set not designated together achievement to Since the bring for a certain resources for nancial boundaries overstretched but that used for needs. people common uniform set how demands targets. from different purpose. budget Coordination agreements for more 3 . 9 Control: ● budgets act as monitoring and evaluation tools to B U D G E T S ( H L O N LY ) check Key terms how to funds ensure are that being they spent are in each within department. the budget in Budget their holders spending need patterns Budget and especially ensure that they do not exceed the budget as this a quantitative nancial plan could lead to serious nancial debt problems in the organization. that estimates the revenue and expenditure over a c pr r To be able to account for the specied future time period revenues generated and costs incurred, Budget holder different parts of a business are divided into cost centres or prot a person involved in the centres formulation and achievement of a budget Cost centres is a part recorded. effectively. include or Cost section centres Examples electricity, Businesses can be of a can of business help costs wages, where managers collected advertising, divided into cost costs to and and are collect incurred and recorded in insurance, centres in some use these among of the and cost data stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 This sections others. following ways: By ● department and By ● HR, where product that each mobile Each By phones, of these in world cost is or and include department a is a producing cost centre. televisions, products geographical the examples business their Corporation as a product measured ● – – each nance, specic several For be cost and could Samsung many centres marketing, centre. products example, computers, could production, cost more because ensure produces products. costs are production. location Coca-Cola each of the of a – businesses Company areas they are such as located are the in located McDonald’s different in could parts be of treated centres. Prot centres This is a part identied much made For prot to which by section recorded. each judge example, market comparing prot makes. can prot location centres can location Prot in identify the is be as where sections performance Toyota geographical business These centre the geographical centres, or or and each most as, protable product makes addition to to revenues to calculate comparisons of car or the by to be in the comparing just product, cost, are how business. models Therefore, according in and sections protable. divided long enable various most costs businesses centres the the both allow as in is world – each geographical area could be treated as a cost centre cost department revenue McDonald’s has outlets all over the Key terms also Cost centre generated. a section of a business where The role of cost and prot centres costs are incurred and recorded ● Aiding decision managers business with and making: nancial this cost and information information can prot centres about assist the them help in different in providing parts deciding of a whether Prot centre to a section of a business where continue or discontinue producing a particular product. Production both costs and revenues are of high-cost and the least protable products will be stopped to pave identied and recorded the way for new products. 241 3 F i n a n c e Better ● their sections in their problem store problem of of a staff to in stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 and areas: lot of centres example, be of prot to help to managers identied such targets to as helps centres and held to least efciency. help improve in This a quick staff hold who specic perform accountable and the monitoring overall efciency resulting this can of in be for or in to individual the in within the and to them cost and managers motivation. the check one by enable control improving help in high sought. to morale delegating a managers bonuses their in particular if checked being performances can enable example, departmental helps business For solutions increase also centres complaints promotion comparing centres prot detected. providing Empowering these and be replacements, leading motivation: set cost customer product centre, centres. charge a Benchmarking: ● prot For can business incentives achieve prot a costly cost with in are Increasing ● and accountable. department areas there number use cost inefciency. Tracking ● a c c o u n ts accountability: business poorly a n d various areas parts of of a cost most or business can business. Problems of cost and prot centres Indirect ● or cost insurance centres. They business as competition negatively Centre in may their be factors: Competition ● difcult indirect to costs allocate allocated such as specically unfairly, advertising, to particular distorting the rent cost overall performance. External ● allocation: are Factors may in one affect conicts: organization. the centres for a be control cost be and higher managers superior could rm’s the performance and to This may the staff centres the specic centre inuencing own beyond lead resources to to prot than of the may the of a centres in of such differently. another, consider overall lack business centres unhealthy and the thereby there. the performance performance competition sharing of of between vital information. Staff ● be stress: very could high lead the for to pressure some staff of staff, managing especially a if cost they and lack prot the centre right may skills. This demotivation. Vr ly In budgeting, the actual period budgetary sales A and actual revenue This the actual was is of is in usually are This can when one then calculated the analysis the rm can be to was has at a budgeted the Variance be end the $30 between done between rm. 000 of For and favourable gure a analysis for favourable difference month the differences either benecial the between determined. assessing nancially 000, is amount. revenue $40 difference Variances variance gure the amounts process budgets. sales is variance actual control revenue budgeted 242 the favourable and variance gure. once amount a or the budget is the both a budgeted cost and adverse budgeted example, the and actual variance of if the sales $10 000. 3 . 9 If the budgeted marketing costs were $80,000 in a month and B U D G E T S turned ( H L O N LY ) out Key terms to be An $65,000, adverse and actual then the variance amounts is rm has occurs a favourable when nancially the variance difference costly to the lower than of $15,000. between rm. For the budgeted example, if Variance the the dierence between the actual sales revenue actual costs were amount was the budgeted gure or the budgeted gure and the actual higher than the budgeted costs, then the rm has an gure adverse or unfavourable variance. Favourable variance Example: Table 3.9.1 shows some of the budgeted and actual amounts when the dierence between taken from Mr Kamau’s business. the budgeted and actual gure Required is nancially benecial to Complete obtained the – missing write (F) gures for and state favourable or the (A) nature for of the the rm variance adverse. Ad verse variance stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 when the dierence between Table 3.9.1 Calculating variance the budgeted and actual Par ticulars Budgeted gure ($) Actual gure ($) Variance amounts is nancially costly to the rm Sales of televisions 10,000 12,500 4,000 3,800 15,000 13,900 Cost of labour 5,000 5,700 Cost of rent 3,000 3,000 Cost of materials Sales of laptops Strategic planning an organization’s systematic process of dening its future direction and deciding on how to allocate its resources accordingly to full this vision Solution: Par ticulars Budgeted gure ($) Sales of televisions Actual gure ($) Variance ($) 10,000 12,500 2,500 (F) 4 ,000 3,800 200 (F) 15,000 13,900 1,100 (A) Cost of labour 5,000 5,700 700 (A) Cost of rent 3,000 3,000 Cost of materials Sales of laptops From ● the above Favourable and the cost and Adverse of variances materials. business, $2,500 ● of example the which declined by can were a noted both higher with were be actual reduced nancially $1,100, while in the presented experienced proved that: experienced Here, with other variances labour, sales one it the 0 sales actual in the costly cost a gure costs sales to of sale of televisions nancial the of of $200 to expected of respectively. laptops rm. labour benet than and Expected increased by the cost laptop $700. The role of budgets and variances in strategic planning Strategic its future planning direction is and an organization’s deciding on how systematic process to its allocate of dening resources 243 3 F i n a n c e accordingly, needs are to to before a c c o u n ts fulll know involves and a n d its this pursuing its formulating putting carrying in out important following place a in In position desired key or of analysis strategic dening and course goals series variance role vision. current of its to one planning. future available action. objectives steps is the those This course derived achieve of The from them. steps role position, is it rst opportunities of the action vision Budgeting and both further there and play explored an in the points: Advantages of using budgets and variances in strategic planning ● Budgets money ● help is Budgets spent stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 help of should measurable, the ● minimize the be in set the ow expenditure and that the coordination agreed, analysis budgeted and losses targets aid working organization’s Variance to improving people Budgets revenue realistic in departments, ● to stakeholders Budgets sense control provide internal ● to wastage are clearly attainment of the of by of regulating resources. understood of an various how by all organization’s goals. business communication and ensuring a together. based on realistic the and SMART criteria time-bound – and – being all in performance to specic, line with objectives. aims to performance, compare thereby actual helping to assess organizational performance. ● Variance in the rectify ● so assists that in detecting corrective the causes measures can of be any deviations taken to them. Variance holders However, analysis budget analysis provides responsible in an organization, for attempt budgeting to an objective their various full the brings with way appraising budget departments. strategic it of some objectives of the of an following limitations. Limitations of budgets in strategic planning ● Inexible the may ● be too Signicant make ● Since gains the such Highly in ● difcult lose budgets as do not be underspent and the the towards involving their unforeseen in as a short due at and term, to results long-term the could tool. unexpected of in costs, unrealistic. actual current end changes material future increases budgeted year in amount. could result managers. some motivation be planning the the by raw therefore budgeted only expenditure without affect and potential looking budgets wasteful budgets sales on any increases importance based by as within between its are lost consider such stay increased could resentment 244 to differences unjustied Setting that environment, budget most demand ● budgets external people levels. could result in their 3 . 9 Despite the above limitations, budgets do play an important role B U D G E T S ( H L O N LY ) in TOK discussion strategic to planning. monitor and They control are vital income nancial and planning expenditure so documents that the that help specied Accounting practices such as organizational objectives are attained. budgeting vary from country to country. Is this necessary Student workpoint 3.18 or could we have the same accounting practices Be a thinker everywhere? following information Par ticulars refers to XA V Ltd: Budgeted gure ($) Material costs Actual gure ($) 12,000 18,500 9,000 7,800 Sales of radios 25,000 25,600 Sales of the Apple iPod® 15,000 12,750 6,000 7,100 Direct labour costs Adver tising costs 1. Calculate whether 2. Interpret for 3. your What do the the missing gures variance the is material from the favourable costs table (F) variance or and above adverse suggest and Variance stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 The note (A). possible reasons answer. the overall variance gures tell you about the business? Revision checklist ✓ A budget the a revenue time ✓ is and Budgets Cost are centres much are centres the other each of a centre centres and and of is a in target business setting over a the if which by estimating specied future resource allocation, are rm important tracking it are cost costs businesses is the is in aiding However, indirect the control budgeted incurred data, and to while and prot revenues calculate as a between known as decision areas, some costs are how and the of and actual actual variance. budgeted adverse faced cost assessing the favourable an particular control. process gure making, increasing challenges to rm’s amount budgeted known difference costly costs use both problem beyond budgetary it where allow allocating the where effectively makes. between the nancially motivation, business and business factors a between difference hand in external to a benchmarking. analysis benecial are of planning, collect accountability, differences If to recorded, difculties Variance for sections help prot motivation include are and improving ✓ helps control. sections prot and and and identied Cost that expenditure important centres recorded ✓ plan period. coordination ✓ nancial and the amount. gure On is the actual gure variance 245 3 F i n a n c e a n d a c c o u n ts Pr q KJC KJC it a Ltd Ltd has specialises developed a well-developed the rst sales have of half of their been the tasked The stnuoccA dna ecnaniF 3 for table this year shows for both the Some over a shapes. year. half budgeted while budget He may Mr Budgeted gures Sales revenue and to to Direct labour costs 50 45 Direct material costs 80 90 Gross prot 370 265 Overheads 100 95 Net prot 270 170 Dene the following (i) Budget (ii) Variance b) Explain increased out has how strict centre gures sales Juma ascertain carry the the for closely. KJC Ltd c) Complete terms analysis importance the the Comment Variance holder the whether variance results on the of budgets column obtained in are performance of to the KJC table adverse KJC Ltd Ltd above or and using the Evaluate the role of cost and prot centres to KJC [2 marks] [2 marks] [4 marks] establish favourable [6 marks] [4 marks] [7 marks] variance results 246 that Actual gures 400 e) their to JoÚ prot actual 500 d) as this For in year. $0 0 0 a) year feel have and the attribute so years have overseas. others centre gures of the They growth holder analysis cost and signicant stakeholders each Over products. nationally second variance the monitor and quality experienced company’s out the sizes high experiencing The carrying performed is all for network drastically. and of have However, cause. controls below they country the with company budgetary the is pots reputation distribution this down that competition making products. slowed recession in good Ltd 4 M a r k e t i n g 4.1 The role of marketing By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ dene marketing and understand its relationship with other business functions ➔ explain the dierence between the marketing of goods and the marketing of ser vices ➔ distinguish between market orientation and product orientation ➔ explain the dierence between commercial marketing , social marketing and social media marketing ➔ describe the elements that characterize the market in which an organization operates calculate market share ➔ discuss the impor tance of market share and market leadership ➔ compare and contrast the marketing objectives of for-prot gnitekraM 4 ➔ organizations and non-prot organizations ➔ evaluate how marketing strategies evolve as a response to changes in customer preferences ➔ examine how the concepts of innovation, ethics and culture inuence marketing practices and strategies. Marketing is not more about just is essential about than that: satisfying acceptable to selling it is the or more consumer denitions of success of advertising, of a any as business needs or marketing. business. many philosophy demands. Some However, people of There common think. how are best many ones marketing It is much to think globally include the following. “Marketing is the management process involved in identifying, anticipating and satisfying consumer needs protably.” The Chartered Institute of Marketing “Marketing is the activity, set of institutions, and processes for creating, communicating, delivering, and exchanging oerings that have value for customers, clients, par tners, and society at large.” American Marketing Association 247 4 M A R K E T I N G Kotler (1994) summarized it well when he said “Marketing is meeting 1 the needs getting right that on to of the right time. every the your This customer product means marketing consumer. products, business at to the that prot.” right department all Ultimately, customers marketing However, pricing, a should aim marketing distribution, or at involves a to marketing the right number satisfy, decisions, promotion, are price of all is about at the activities centred whether affected related by other functions. Fc d m Since have marketing to work department the costs may want requirements department This will money, together may cause a of a the in setting to spend that it than is in marketing sticks departmental and appropriate more demanding advise marketing the to its nance its plan, given department budgets. The budget but to the marketing meet nance budgetary allocations. conict. Hum souc mm (HrM) d m Marketing in the information HRM labour in an gnitekraM 4 product as of staff extra this a result from with of enable This organization. demand. those can department. For can example, improved the sales Ensuring innovative the minds effective an marketing and that more inuence and a workforce demand increase may production right the in and the require of in salespeople competitive spirit – supply demand the departments quality planning will of for a recruitment order are to meet hired also aid – in Key terms meeting the marketing department’s objectives. Marketing the management process of Opos mm d m getting the right product to the The production and marketing departments will need to work together right customer at the right price to ensure that the products developed meet the specications of the to the right place and time customers. the needs Market and research wants of the will help the consumers. marketers However, in determining both departments Marketing of goods need to balance the time needed to test, develop, and launch products, the use of the 4 Ps of product, to avoid any loss in sales or reputation and any arousal of potential price, place, and promotion in stakeholder conict. the marketing mix Marketing of ser vices th m of oods d svcs the use of the 7Ps of product, In deciding how to distinguish to market their products, businesses rst need price, place, promotion, between goods, such as cars, and services, such as process, people, and physical insurance. This is because goods and services differ in a number evidence in the marketing mix of ways. 1 Kotler, P . 1994. Marketing Management: Analysis, planning, implementation and control . Englewood Clis, NJ, Prentice Hall. 248 4 . 1 T H E R O L E O F M A R K E T I N G Table 4.1.1. Dierences between goods and services Goods Ser vices are tangible, i.e. can be touched are intangible, i.e. cannot be touched can be returned if you did not like what you bought cannot be taken back , e.g. a bad haircut can be stored and consumed later, e.g. yoghur t. cannot be stored and will need to be consumed immediately, e.g. your consultant’s time. There is ownership of the product. There is no ownership of the product. Goods are easier to compare because of the similar Services are more dicult to compare because of dierent nature of some products, e.g. one TV can easily be experiences a customer may get from a given service, e.g. a compared to another. hotel may treat a customer dierently each time he or she visits. selling appeal choose have in a goods, to the one over over the mostly and type about customer remain clothing service globally a their line in very on day-to-day Therefore In help the by in to of the in both goods this buy characteristics cellphone, elaborate as but of a hotel their features may to one may about angle ensure can Managers talk marketing service that customers applications. or It as form varied their of that the is the a of goods to elements physical to based the three These note or but free guard the the four promotion, many For will may receive foods. their who example, an passengers at airline. “Ps” of place . aspects be a of explored products example, maintenance popular increasingly and additional aspects that them. product warranty on are greeting marketing product, evidence . important a is the meat). cultural For it country employees image. staff specic However, to from (roast their a example, country always and smiling further price, sell must quality for franchises) to are For Europe. choma approachable and in in cuisines, (mostly today costs. manufacture from nyama localities includes physical is help can living country and lower customers; travel services product can services to at USA their Kenyan namely service iPad the – the to people offering their plane in restaurants in companies producing customers well-groomed and unit. to well-trained mix of it closer sampling cafés multinational based many marketing and an in be customers the processes, later service the such has, sumptuous with marketing may specic number countries ship to for enhancing marketing people, and having industry Essentially, The on new customer company basis the to organizations entrance the a on the it good need different reputation airline to closer addition, will rooms difcult curry drawing as competitive, Asia businesses be a focus company goods clothing may Indian of based such offering can buying returns. outsourcing example, In another other, service-providing number To businesses consumer. gnitekraM 4 In now have customer after-sales for a year. Market orientation verses product orientation There are products. two distinct They can market-orientated table approaches either use a that businesses can product-orientated approach . These two use to market approach approaches are or shown their a in the below. 249 4 M A R K E T I N G Table 4.1.2. Dierences between a product-orientated approach and a market-orientated approach Product-orientated approach inward looking and focused on making the product rst outward looking and focused on carrying out market and then trying to sell it research rst and then making products that can sell product-led and assuming that supply creates its own market-led and focused on establishing consumer demand (Say’s law). Here businesses produce innovative demand so as to supply products that meet consumers’ products and tempt the customers to buy them needs and wants Organizations their Sony, are As a of Access to Firms will be gnitekraM 4 heavily on in a rm’s to meet It rather is approach Apple. to Many including Ford, market-orientated: have increased reducing means will position the market about that and are the risk rms also condence of can able respond to that failure. more anticipate by have associated changing have can be the result challenge of regular of new feedback from research. some costly the consumer consumer’s future limitations: and therefore weigh tastes, needs could also rms with have its a may nd available negative it resources. inuence on on their these with put a lot potential of emphasis customers. A on the production product-orientated Key terms advantages: the Dyson takes a product-orientated approach to marketing strategy. businesses than meet a market does research to as budget. every about Product-orientated ● and businesses, being rms market orientation market-planning business the strong market a Uncertainty process in of therefore information frequently difcult ● business research, entering market to a sell, brought Conducting Due to changes consumers ● Dyson, changes. competitors However, product-orientated Ferrari, market-orientated will market to market a Nokia. market products quickly ● now and adopted Microsoft, benets result their ● are the have include Samsung, These ● that products organizations ● Market-orientated approach production of high-quality products such as Product orientation luxury sports cars and safety products such as crash helmets. a business approach that ● It can the succeed rm has in industries already built a where good the speed of change is slow and reputation. focuses on making the product rst before attempting to sell it ● It has will control purchase over its its activities, with a strong belief that consumers products. Market orientation However, the major limitations such a rm faces include the following: a business approach of rst establishing consumer ● Since the rm ignores the needs of the market, failure or closure. it takes risks that may demand through market lead to eventual business research before producing ● Spending money on research and development without considering and selling a product consumer 250 needs could be costly and not yield any promising results. 4 . 1 T H E R O L E O F M A R K E T I N G Commercial marketing This involves that customers out to making specic put in to to media) or emails). to possible, be is the to habits appropriate The of to will the of into type the or minds in of of as a carried what is involve Once to be commercial product a traditional local Google adopting advertisements not need used include (using either does customers. advertisements, campaign services is supply strategies may or research and strategies strategies option targeted value-free specically These product use is goods market businesses buying television the exchanging case, and product. marketing also get or the tailored selling. online There on the billboards, an campaign, is and this demand identied, market need (using is In marketing judgments commercial focus want. consumer product place marketing developing, and Commercial moral the as need establish demanded. the creating, print Ad Sense or mass-marketing many aimed at consumers specic demographics. Social marketing This involves changes in Marketing the use of behaviour Institute marketing that approaches ultimately (SMI) denes it benet that help society. bring The about Social as: “the use of commercial marketing concepts and tools in gnitekraM 4 programmes designed to inuence individuals’ behaviour to improve their well-being and that of society.” Social marketing ensures that consumers’ society’s wants public centred on and also concept make the and smoking, welfare. overeating include for or public poor but also of the dietary based on social on benets habits. campaigns on and marketing dangers eating Social to only campaigns the of It not consumers’ anti-smoking information on environmental stakeholders. decisions Examples example providing the other marketing requirements campaigns, educating involving good rm’s interests health discourage programmes wide and reducing drink-driving, to a long-term include food is businesses of healthy marketing promote recycling, Key terms clean air, and marketing water also as looks well into as other areas such measures as of human conservation. rights and Today family social planning. Commercial marketing Some advantages of social marketing include the following: marketing activities that determine consumer needs ● It gives rms a competitive advantage as consumers may perceive such and wants before using rms to be socially responsible and therefore buy products from them. appropriate strategies to ● Firms can charge premium prices for providing goods that society is market the product deriving benets from. Social marketing However, getting people to change their habitual behaviour poses a a marketing approach aimed major challenge to social marketers. As a result, an effort a number of non-prot at inuencing a positive organizations (NPOs) have set up in to help people change their change in individual behaviour behaviour, for example Alcoholic Anonymous (AA). and improvements in societal The Social Marketing Institute encourages the use of a wide range of well-being marketing tools by going beyond just “Promotion” in the marketing 251 4 M A R K E T I N G mix and well in fully the marketing incorporating effort mix to in bring the other social sections 4.2 elements change. and (See of the more marketing on mix promotion in as the 4.5) Social media marketing (SMM) SMM is a marketing networking is a approach websites marketing tool concepts and different media. from that the adopted by Internet to incorporates techniques with the the aim businesses market use of of its that uses products. social SMM technological growing a business through Social media can be a powerful SMM has increased in popularity with the development of websites such way to reach lots of customers as Facebook, Twitter, LinkedIn, and YouTube. very quickly These It ● are the benets enables a rm of to SMM: get direct feedback from its customers while TOK discussion still appealing that and ● them personally, customers their with complaints. relationship management. It low-cost provides For in It ● provide voice to a example, April can enhance gnitekraM 4 have exposure However, by will and a to join a to stand rm’s opportunity is known interactive to as ask social sections questions In marketing, what role does customer language play in the dierent areas of knowledge? for of rms users simply S MM use it brand. to of out joining is as a a reach a large Facebook the these ve ry fo r target stood at audience. 1.11 billion the m. he nce social networking communities, rms websites can gain websites. usefu l we bs ite , cr owd , many online s up pl eme nt ne tw o r k i ng from Since established replace me nt social marketing a large while businesses as number its 2013. already not the way the This through m a r ke t in g to ot h e r S i nc e it it can th e is be t o ol , ea s y fo r dif c u lt n ee d m o st ma r ke t in g a ls o to m e t h ods any fo r re l y bus i ne s s a bu si n es s on ot h e r techniq ue s . Student workpoint 4.1 Be a thinker Key terms 1. Distinguish 2. Using between marketing a good and marketing a service. Social media marketing specic organizational examples, comment on the benets the use of the Internet through of market orientation. social networking websites 3. Explain how social marketing differs from SMM. to market a rm’s product or service Characteristics of the market in which an organization operates A market and of a the 252 is an services. product It arrangement includes whose exchange needs process. where actual or as buyers well wants as are and sellers potential satised by exchange buyers sellers or or goods customers suppliers in 4 . 1 elements operates ● are Market given characterize size – this It By value total dollars growth ● Market a given value from or indicates on the for – volume. sale a the gadget. the high changes, in which an M A R K E T I N G organization of this time, For the This has factors, such changes in a as e.g. in goods in bought units spent It by is sold a by by customers the total shillings on the revenue (Kshs), US (ZAR). identifying change This their the many However, in market of and on the revenue of patterns, over market resulting smartphones uses product are for because inuenced income, size million multiple the is market US$80 Sales growth growth tastes, to nding suppliers the based sales market. this in be million consumers economic can increase US$50 in many consumer businesses the Kenyan rands year. an from attracted of of businesses. percentage growth potential. all share. example, with number amount by of maize. rms usually televisions globally, prot is of African assists sales ways: measure terms, market 60-per-cent rise external size – the the sold South calculating of bags measures goods or total two measures monetary growth in quantitative example of market in a this in period the this (US$), of and market the measured is number expressed Knowledge – It businesses, represents is volume customers. ■ the O F follows: market. By ■ that as R O L E by of several technological among gnitekraM 4 The T H E others. Student workpoint 4.2 Be a thinker Coca-Cola published 2013 highlights on its website: http://www. coca-colacompany.com The company were As up well by as ● be a do in share the – that still think tool this market. for is It had sales of its increased information that for publishing sparkling by investors sales drinks 6%. gures and in this way businesses? the is volume drinks nancial you marketing Market sales whilst providing stakeholders, can announced 3%, percentage calculated by of one using rm’s the share following of the total formula: rm’s sales ___ Market share % = × total sales in the 100 market 253 4 M A R K E T I N G Market share can be measured by value (revenue) or volume (units), Key terms just like market business is size. An successful increase against its in market share competitors and could has mean adopted that a effective Market size marketing strategies as a result. This could be associated with increased the total sales of all rms prots and result in the business being the key player in the industry. in a market Measuring rm or is a market market competitors share leader. to is A follow important market it. Its because leader status as can it could indicate inuence market leader other can that the Market growth businesses also affect its the percentage change in the future strategy and objectives. total market size over a period The benets of being ● The market ● The business in the a leader will average market will be costs have able of leader to include increased gain sales, economies production as a the translating of result scale, of of time following: to (i.e. higher a increasing prots. the percentage of one rm’s decrease its scale share of the total sales in of the market operation). ● Since the product Market share market with the leader could highest also market be the share), brand the leader leading (providing brand can act the Market leader as a rm with the highest market a good promotional tool for consumers who would like to associate share in a given market with popular However, is ● when interpreting the market share, careful thought needed: Since market gnitekraM 4 volume, ● brands. share different Changes in the can be results time measured may period be and in different obtained market in can the ways, same inuence by value time and period. market share results. ● The type market of products included may also inuence the calculation of share. Student workpoint 4.3 Be knowledgeable Table 4.1.3. Dierent sales volumes and values from dierent companies Company X YZ Year Sales of toys (million units) 254 Table 4.1.3 above to a) Market share of XYZ b) Market share of ABC c) Market share of PQR d) Market growth for 2011 2012 2011 2012 550 580 700 740 620 650 25 28 45 48 32 30 calculate the Company Company Company the PQR 2012 Sales of toys ($ million) Use ABC 2011 whole following: by by by volume value in volume industry in by 2011 2012 in 2011 value from 2011 to 2012 4 . 1 T H E R O L E O F M A R K E T I N G Marketing objectives of for-prot organizations and non-prot organizations (NPOs) achieve the objectives through organization’s marketing to satisfy This market-led wants of marketers orphaned are which using major affects and be drawback to receive Internet As number a in global such as NPOs money have to responsibility other or private be organizations Lee are such to includes a users, public to marketing money helping Increasingly, achieve nancing, therefore on their are aims, also change. the which seek This “customers” as of needs. donate at They public and wants those in the use social clothing. relations. gain of and and the needs to aimed endorsements, For dangers of in the case seriously to in raise an funding and competitive social number a that all to of funds effort is also therefore public sector advantages times as the and of With charities PayPal, over Swaziland, raise practise beneting a public a lot Other increased from, by supermarkets. high from raised have money most also growing example. in in is the have for to till maintaining marketing, NPOs. using seek at continue well of home they containers at media number made children’s outlets as public able donations ethical they limited potential among collection if their to habits. number and design behavioural the aim sole sector. Internet retail drinking is cases, reputation. certain the needs engage such and educate the identifying the many should elements on the strategies and seminars are which online to A In to with organizations schools food noted, protable the to of aim line identify, be campaigns with donations, they Sandra of NPOs attract popularity from number having the to way some inuence seek to purely encourage image budgets. improve result, in of money the to ability marketing, increasing NPOs, and their rivals most events, sponsorships colleges. of of and may a marketing their is applying is in Therefore For-prot reasons. to responsible marketing fundraising heard linked adopting and children inform as example complex government and for earlier ultimately focus are businesses responsive research campaigns enhancing to their very marketing cause, more will charities, vulnerable using a run As that protably. objective. are businesses which organizations that where that objectives. notion appropriately They social targets wants this market certain their through their for marketing smoking to a include example, A involve churches, would support NPOs as more and achieve use the for-prot approach, and such activities or to of or department, strategic strategies consumers. consumers NPOs will mix goals include needs objective marketing marketing a overall consumer business. the marketing denitions marketing develop are their gnitekraM 4 Marketing degree free interest of social publicity in their from causes. How marketing strategies evolve as a response to changes in customer preferences Due to a variety signicantly various over ways strategies of to have factors, the meet been past customers’ two these decades new adapted preferences to and demands. suit these have businesses The new ways changed have in responded which preferences are in marketing discussed 255 4 M A R K E T I N G yduts esaC BMW ’s m sy BMW operates across the globe in a highly competitive industry – the automotive industry. As a result, BMW invests heavily in its marketing mix to maintain its customer base and brand loyalty. However, competitors Mercedes-Benz and Jaguar are similarly well invested in marketing campaigns to increase their market shares while maintaining their brand loyalties. Previously, BMW used its unique selling point or proposition (USP) of building high-performance, high- quality spor ts cars with unique handling characteristics to gain customers’ attention and loyalty. Slogans such as “Pure driving pleasure” and “Perfection perfected” punctuated BMW’s marketing campaign around the world. Whereas BMW, in the context of the Anso’s previously neglected to publicize) and products Matrix (see Unit 1.3 on Organizational objectives), had such as the BMW X-series cars were rebranded by begun with a market-extension strategy into markets taking par t in the gruelling Dakar rally. Considered a such as China and India, it later switched to product race that requires par ticipants to have vehicles with development as its key strategy. extraordinary fuel eciencies, the Dakar rally also allowed BMW to challenge one of its main competitors This shift in marketing strategies came about because in the luxury SUV market – Volkswagen. a market segment became the largest single market gnitekraM 4 in which BMW operated. Customers have developed a However, BMW’s shift in market strategy has not been a new preference in the last two decades that continues complete success. In an attempt to please the majority to grow in strength and popularity – high fuel of customers who desire fuel-ecient cars, BMW has eciency. Due to dramatic increases in oil prices, in all lost some of its most loyal customers to competitors. but the OPEC nations (a PEST factor), customers have This has largely been a result of changes to the product sought out vehicles that use less fuel to travel fur ther. element of its marketing mix. In order to increase fuel For example, the Toyota Prius and Tesla car company eciency and to lower carbon emissions, BMW ceased have thrived because of their environmentally friendly, using V10 engines in its M-Power 5 Series cars in low fuel consumption features – a result of focused favour of twin-turbo charged V8 engines that use less dierentiation. In response to this development, BMW fuel. As a result, BMW lost many loyal, high-income instituted a raft of changes to its marketing strategy. customers who preferred the more powerful V10. In shor t, BMW’s pivot towards a new customer preference First, as par t of product changes in the marketing caused its protability to be damaged to some extent. mix, BMW began designing and showcasing “vision” However, with increased market shares in Africa, concept cars at the largest automotive expos in Nor th America, and Asia, BMW’s medium-risk strategy the world. None was more denitive than the BMW appears to have paid o. i8, which was branded the “ecient dynamics” concept car. Essentially, it showcased BMW’s latest fuel-eciency technology to the world’s media and Exam-style questions immediately positioned BMW towards consumers’ new 1. Dene the following terms: preferences. BMW also changed many of its promotion (a) Marketing mix [2 marks] (b) Market share [2 marks] techniques to t this new brand image. Below-the- line methods including slogans such as “Exhilaration without excess” became BMW’s new focus and 2. Analyse how BMW can be customer- ecient dynamics became its USP and major productfocused. [4 marks] dierentiation tool. The institution of new products in BMW’s marketing strategy was paired with new promotion strategies. BMW began to emphasize the fuel eciency of its existing models (which it had 256 3. Evaluate the success of BMW’s marketing strategy. [10 marks] 4 . 1 below the in the television its context automotive of two rms industry and second, broadcasting marketing penetrating strategy new industry. to or by its industries: the Each improve markets, and of rst, Multichoice these BMW Group businesses protability by T H E O F M A R K E T I N G and and has R O L E the adapted rebranding and diversifying. The Multichoice Group has also shifted its marketing premium customers (those most likely to purchase mix and strategy to meet customers’ preferences. these products) before reaching other customers In par ticular, the arrival of high-denition (HD) via television adver tisements (a result of market technology in a variety of elds, ranging from segmentation). cellphones to cameras and televisions, has drawn a However, the implementation of this strategy has great deal of the customers’ attention. However, unlike not come without some drawbacks – the largest BMW, it is apparent that Multichoice does not operate of which is the increased cost to customers. As a in a highly competitive market. In fact, DSTV (owned result of expensive technological upgrades to DSTV’s by the Multichoice Group) could be considered a broadcasting system to suppor t HD television, monopoly as it beneted heavily from the rst mover customers have suered a price increase to pay for advantage. However, Multichoice has still changed to both the new systems and the marketing campaign meet customer preferences to ensure that there is no to promote it. This increase in price also priced out market gap for new entrants to exploit. prospective customers who could have increased Multichoice’s marketing mix has refocused in terms DSTV’s market share. This demonstrates how of techniques to reach customers rather than using a responding to customer preferences can have negative shift in focus like BMW’s. For example, DSTV’s premium eects on the customers themselves. gnitekraM 4 yduts esaC Mulchoc’s m sy subscribers (those who pay the highest rates) form par t of the demographic in Southern Africa that has Exam-style questions the highest income. As a result, they are the most 1. Describe two forms of market segmentation technologically aware demographic in Southern relevant for Multichoice. [4 marks] Africa and because of this DSTV has placed a greater emphasis on online adver tising on social media and 2. Analyse how eectively Mulitichoice’s unique websites. DSTV now has Twitter and Facebook marketing strategy has responded to pages for customers to follow and prospective customer preferences. [6 marks] customers to view that provide the latest information 3. With reference to Multichoice and to one other on new products brought to market. For example, the organisation that you have studied, discuss the arrival of HD channels such as HD Discovery Showcase impact of changing technology on promotional and M-Net HD were rst promoted online to their strategies. When compared Multichoice’s However, both maintaining response to these example have In a Ford to protability and that DSTV have market has and huge adapt are BMW’s in dire what just customer some their of failure, the over much Failure as many marketing to in Each wanted. certain make share strategies, total and marketing the the like the of a to ve changes, of for and strategies, in a Hummer. around respond years. result because in direct companies, business can vital was Failure other past case businesses strategies was shift necessary all adapt strategy, inconsequential. strategy positions. to in seems marketing failed relevant. even changed the market marketing remain in and consequences in change methods shift share Chevrolet, drops or complete marketing change needs seen in companies’ their conclusion, must of to with shift [10 marks] the loss BMW world changing 257 4 M A R K E T I N G customer preferences. reconguration adapt to of changing Whether the it marketing customer is a change mix, in marketing marketing methods, strategies can and or must preferences. How innovation, ethical considerations and cultural dierences inuence marketing In an increasingly markets are marketing strategies assessment global rms’ of how marketing responses include globalized integrating, Nokia, more these than where and changes Chevron, in Using will be factors. now specic and companies, and to in an inuence including companies Apple, and affect continue explored, The Petroleum, economies culture inuenced strategy these world’s and before. have British the ethics ever factors practices to world, innovation, the question Rolls-Royce. Innovation First, in it is important innovation There is no great threat the last consider of of new all six their more technology achievements For to terms industry competitive a in exposed industry. entrants the more years, the gnitekraM 4 of such Ansoff’s mostly has to because Nokia has and the new This channels has best of a new up introduced a Lumia and on its , highly is one making is main as Nokia most strategies of marketing on Nokia two with Apple’s market of for being with levels: markets and a cellphones Apple and dynamic technology. challenged, in part competitors. to reinvigorate the in has product Samsung. young, itself. First, framework objectives), main strategy two the innovative its elements. range Within penetration tools increasingly which new rivals and occurred these technology . market marketing Nokia’s terms built to of beat its mix new its slogan, products, Apple ® . The Lumia range has a physical ® iPhone the iPhone Organizational newest global has through sums competition, the changes products. ® , products marketing shift than industry involving its the ® called 1.3 dominance adopted share. “#Switch” Nokia the Unit strategies need innovation erce to their technology dominated iPad out-compete Apple’s of has market in for to ® , branded businesses impressive. Apple iPod (see on mostly demographic However, the Matrix focused development Apple as by strategies The and ® products responses marketing design similar to the ® yet more styled than the iPhone . It is sold in a variety of vibrant ® colours to suit different tastes, unlike the uniform iPhone . In terms of ® performance, the Lumia range has higher processing speeds ® vivid HD touchscreens than the iPhone and more ® . In short, the Lumia phones are ® designed to be superior versions of the iPhone . This is mirrored by the ® promotional uses to campaign motivate Furthermore, world When to the consumers #Switch follow for to customers is a receive use the Lumia to range. purchase Twitter address real-time hashtag its for updates on #Switch cellphones Twitter is the customers about it slogan instead new of around Nokia automatically Nokia Apple’s. the products. spreads the ® message range. used 258 to all Along their with YouTube to a followers greater brand – indirectly emphasis itself as the on new advertising social Nokia’s networking, innovative business Lumia Nokia in the has 4 . 1 market. young, In terms of energetic customers. place, Samsung business with range cellphones. of unique Nokia employees has to also tried state-of-the-art features of Its its has also operate to products stores rebrand products advertising mimicked its such itself as campaign rather than iStores and the a a M A R K E T I N G ETHICS innovative Galaxy™ showcasing brand O F hiring highly on R O L E with Samsung centres selling by interact as T H E like The primary concern of most businesses is to make a prot. A the business’ marketing strategy is therefore designed to make the Apple. service or product on oer seem However, the shift to online advertising has come at a great cost to Nokia– as attractive as possible. the loss of customers in developing nations. Nokia and many other However, businesses companies, such as Sony and Microsoft, have failed to respond to the large should consider their ethical customer base that has either no Internet access or access at poor speeds. responsibility to promote their Markets in China, Sub-Saharan Africa and Latin America have been left products accurately. Many largely untapped as a result of this. Compared with the Coca-Cola Company countries have a regulating body and PepsiCo, penetration. is failing to these As a companies result, exploit it. In the are lagging capacity turn, for revenues behind growth and in is terms of major immense; prots are not market however, being to monitor adver tising (such Nokia maximized. as the Adver tising Standards Authority in the UK and South Africa). Ethical adver tising is not only a a moral choice but also a Ethical considerations pragmatic business decision – the Ethical considerations businesses resource brand have also themselves exploitation had and industry a major their impact products. provides a clear on The the way energy example of reputation and sales of a business and can be severely aected if this. adver tising methods are found to be Two major events have reshaped the consumer’s perception of misleading or oensive. oil In 2011, the Coco-Cola company companies in the last 40 years. These are the Exxon Valdes oil spill was forced to amend an 1989 and the BP Deep Water Horizon spill in 2010. Each incident gnitekraM 4 in adver t which claimed that it’s caused a great deal of damage to the corporate images of not only BP Vitaminwater drink was ‘delicious and Exxon but all oil companies around the world. As a result, most and nutritious’. A number of people have rebranded themselves to enhance their corporate images and complained on the basis that the improve their stakeholder relations –without which they could Texaco) now has not be drink contained high levels of sugar protable. the For example, environment” as Chevron one of its (formerly core values and “protecting “sustainability” as and so was not ‘nutritious’. one Examples such as this can be of its visions. In terms of its marketing mix, particularly promotional rectied fairly easily and, for a techniques, Chevron has branded itself as a socially responsible company the size of Coca Cola, at organization interested in the well-being of ordinary people and relatively little cost. For a smaller innovating BP the has oil new energy similarly spill safety possible to on technologies rebranded Twitter and regulations avoid solve social promoting other and major by to social policies its issues as compensation media. online such to It has reach also as poverty. efforts promoted many company, or where the adver tising after decision has more signicant implications, the eects of its customers as unethical or misleading adver tising can be extremely damaging. losses. Do some internet research to nd This shift in marketing techniques paid off. A year after reporting a examples of unethical advertising. loss, BP declared a US$3.3 billion net prot in 2012 and has recorded Can you nd wide-spread press strong results in the rst quarter of 2013. Similarly, Nike has dropped coverage? What sort of criticisms are many of its sponsorship deals with athletes who have fallen from grace made, and how might these aect in the public’s eye. Lance Armstrong and Oscar Pistorius were once the reputation of the businesses? among of Nike’s their strongest transgressions. representatives In short, Nike, but BP , have and been dropped Chevron all because recognize TOK discussion the value that their of their image corporate is not image damaged and by have incidents attempted and to ensure sponsorship deals To what extent are marketing alike. If consumers dislike an organization, they often boycott that practices a reection of the organization, causing it to lose protability and possibly even causing it values of a given time and to close down. culture? 259 4 M A R K E T I N G However, many and strategies and other Chevron such as addition, because of oil been they This fear continue of largely helped of to are such as legislation the mitigate Royal in their would effects of Shell in share such as groups socially extraction prices. long-term new public and pressure enormously of the themselves their adoption the Dutch by practices from environment about that the marketing market uctuations uncertain in opposition standards” they damage However, to shifts erce “double while regular new more Companies because, causes production. in accused shareholders of companies’ resulted Greenpeace processes. has the stakeholders. have responsible, costs of have increase marketing market In protability the strategies uncertainties. Cultural dierences Finally, cultural strategies Martin an used are example, increases to an and in by gnitekraM 4 America. Gotham its In the to cater have on a huge regular Martin the The and globe. many the and strategies if of to meet to Aston such than in its Aston from Aston has among marketing and strategy North and the customers Rolls-Royce that led Martin desirable young and large This franchise new Martin as Europe Bond products and base. and changed enticing latest have KFC faith. been were have initially a large China globally; changes Nokia, above must a cultural result they of in but adapt revenues practices with the Apple, are do a and few strategies of on across of the grounding for practices ethics, a has Aston Samsung marketing prots to customers examples innovation, and around appears cases provide their foods differences marketing as Halal increased practices directly directly, however, as in to exploited. and marketing interact led and and change and businesses maximize to more discussed in introduced has lled strategies change media have This considerations, market in and marketing Similarly, youth rms are and beneted growth modern James at Muslim social conclusion: they both their common businesses competing overall the aimed gaps on Rolls-Royce The one culture use basis. target the ethical impacts most have consumer brands more Martin McDonald’s of market innovation, marketing markets. sector, more on Rolls-Royce that economic customers with showcase Chinese as Aston all impact world. young European seen deals are the massive younger club to increased to result, customers as world. been 260 for had the a for are heavy manufacturers relatively Furthermore, pages for Overall, As car fast-food revenues which a differences. seen a demand Sponsorship products. designed be in has for have around vehicle cultural targeting City Facebook the China Chinese. China of income increase also businesses luxury Rolls-Royce, young to by two understanding For in differences and global scale. 4 . 1 T H E R O L E O F M A R K E T I N G rvso chcls Marketing is customers at with ✓ ✓ other business of goods services Product while Commercial focuses marketing before using Social marketing and marketing focuses on websites Market size looks Market share main identify, the for at the 4 and use the total a of the a the sales of of the the the right working customer. mix while marketing product rst out mix before market product. consumer to market needs the change well-being. in individual Social through and product. media social product. all one to carrying internet rm’s to involves of positive societal product marketing Ps determine strategies in percentage the the It needs involves selling market of producing inuencing the to the additional activities at Ps right time. rms rm’s in a share market of the while total sales in market. The to is 3 on improvement networking satisfy the appropriate aims behaviour to the right orientation producing wants the involves market before getting at concerns orientation it about price functions of the ✓ right marketing research ✓ the Marketing selling ✓ essentially marketing design business. prot and On objective develop the organisations of for-prot marketing other hand, (NPOs) is the organizations strategies that marketing mostly for social is are to protable objective for marketing Not reasons. gnitekraM 4 ✓ 261 4 M A R K E T I N G Pcc quso Bajaj In a India, 34% For the some target satisfy a the has year, In an and safety remote the other was of the its Bajaj years is that each One proposal is international primary the strategic continued to their are and network This in even in Other as better models remote through about to the either gained a in of the quality, to is marketing to rst share of This long-term markets. determined needs in Tajikistan. company’s local focus repairthem. signicant and Twice reliability important international Bajaj areas. surveys, serviceor Colombia satises media with motorbikes. such different particularly One India, motorbike social is also alliances. 12 Bajaj, factor. features, research garages has is for proles. penetration as important customers few segments extra offers Philippines, markets use for market company of most more motorbikes. there model the manufacturing market consumer with the international sure is pay orientated including this many distribution out where 10 to various interviews through objectives For of carries markets, done market motorbike are price willing extensive areas last is in There markets, are needs Bajaj groups and target Bajaj leader share. markets styling*. Bajaj market market and to make preferences. appeal to markets. [Source: adapted from Globality: Competing With Everyone From Everywhere For gnitekraM 4 Everything New York and Boston: Business Plus, 2008] a) Outline briey andproduct b) Comment on leadershipfor c) Analyse the d) Evaluate strategies IB, * 262 May difference the between market orientation importance of market share and Bajaj of might response to social have media to customer marketing change its [2 marks] [6 marks] [5 marks] [7 marks] market Bajaj. usefulness how in the orientation. for Bajaj. marketing preferences 2010 styling: the various features of style or design that consumers may prefer 4.2 Marketing planning (including introduction to the four “Ps”) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ state the elements of a marketing plan ➔ explain the role of market planning ➔ comment on the four Ps of the marketing mix ➔ prepare and analyse an appropriate marketing mix for a par ticular product or business ➔ discuss the eectiveness of a marketing mix in achieving marketing objectives ➔ distinguish between target markets and market segments ➔ identify possible target markets and market segments in a given ➔ distinguish between niche market and mass market ➔ analyse how organizations target and segment their market and gnitekraM 4 situation create consumer proles ➔ draw a product position map/perception map and comment on it ➔ explain the importance of having a unique selling point/proposition (USP) ➔ evaluate how organizations can dierentiate themselves and their products from competitors. th lms of m pl A marketing that are objectives. prepare plan marketing increasing ● key the how to pricing order likely sell to by or 6 that cent which products activities be are are plan in the to of the next be that measurable, example provide for an overview example of plans on markets carried how including The year achieved, providing be and market. components: time-specic),for steps and following (specic, strategies marketing to SMART will marketing adequately and the the organization’s competition existing used budget , marketing in actions that will in the some are about an need face objectives marketing strategies to realistic, per plans, new document achieve include objectives relevant sales to departments in marketing overall detailed order marketing detailed the is strategic how marketing ● a in Marketing achievable, ● is themselves marketing ● plan developed information out, the the for the example products nance on will which be required specic to distributed fund the strategy. 263 4 M A R K E T I N G th ol of m pl Key term Essentially, marketing organization’s effective in facilitate this, planning decision attaining about its is a process which overall that marketing corporate or involves an strategies strategic would be objectives. To Marketing planning the process of formulating a detailed marketing plan is drawn up. marketing objectives and devising appropriate The benets of marketing planning marketing strategies to meet those objectives Marketing ● and seeking Setting ● planning Sharing ● on A ● marketing a or clearly in identifying improves plan and sense marketing unprotable inspire rm potential problems them. objectives coordination picture Devising ● to a the chances of success of a rm’s strategy. the improves clearer solutions SMART marketing helps of with other provides where budget it business the is whole departments organization with a heading. ensures that resources are not wasted activities. spelled-out condence plan in could them improve about the employees’ organization’s motivation and future. The limitations of marketing planning Marketing ● gnitekraM 4 to The ● ● may changes process may and Failure prioritize be to to tell effective, where money They business in considerable are to do this if the organizations are not quick resources objectives they may to and are terms of time, make it difcult for them. needs review in plans. meeting planning constantly if conditions. designing they marketing need outdated market marketing whether organizations policies. become in consume expertise, rms To plans consider to be a reective evaluate survive their in exercise marketing today’s competitive environment. th fou “Ps” of h m mx Central mix. the to to This market is a successful as the four promotion, ● planning collective marketing “Ps” and of – such television is as a this intangible. is of the place. Product is the term the a includes product. These are or should the These mix, while aim to that a of a key rm’s elements is satisfy the ensure referred price, below. offered such are that product, briey service marketing elements namely: explained service tangible Products development marketing good is that in as needs the market. health and A good insurance wants of Key term consumers. to ensure So, that whether the providing consumer’s a new interests or are existing taken product, into rms need consideration if Marketing mix they are to create a unique selling point or proposition (USP). the key elements of a ● Price – this is the amount consumers are charged for a product. It marketing strategy that indicates the value consumers perceive the product to have. For ensure the successful ® example, when the Apple iPad 1 was rst introduced, consumers marketing of a product paid 264 a high price for it because of its perceived good quality. On 4 . 2 the other new an M A R K E T I N G hand, ones internal and are – product this promotion order to Place ● – to get or over and For a are promotion the very as refers product the agents, are number of that the used to also a to promotions, product’s buy consumer. used to get outlets to rm or a in such as of the various consumers consumer or “ P S ” ) brand- the product. may F O U R behaviours. which a T H E Setting because and T O use to The buy above-the- below-the-line combination of both, in product. or who products many the channels Products distributed as ways the location supermarkets these than value. behaviour purchase A lower lower advertising Intermediaries, available to here. to a I N T R O D U C T I O N businesses attract television the for various important as priced inuence persuaded sales to large retail are to are having purchasing consumers Internet. example, products and as difcult factors refers ( I N C L U D I N G clothes seen be methods convince this can such such are consumer about communication line of external informed the they price nature Promotion ● second-hand because appropriate sensitive P L A N N I N G can be include to where countrywide as distribution purchased in wholesalers, Shoprite consumers of consumers or to shops retailers, need Nakumatt ensure used them. have that their possible. An appropriate marketing mix appropriate wants right are marketing adequately product, the marketing loss in not sales, identify mix which advertising ● selling ● a To be ● well each will right clear affect expensive in order mix coordinated so a a will right If could protability. colourful stall to a where sell achieve that rm not and produce the channels. a therefore in in for to at needs the risk the place and message Consumers buy it. of potential may Examples of include: car to focused, long-term attempting marketing available promotion and perfume agent and its consumers’ businesses price, and mixes that requires right product exclusive effective be the not the an real-estate appropriate is ensures This the marketing ● an at through with inappropriate met. charged communicated mix gnitekraM 4 An its in a marketing will elements magazine second-hand houses business the children’s need clothes vegetable are sold market. objectives, an to: consistently complement other ● be clear, ● consider ● look ● target focused, the into the and market the degree right not it is of abstract aiming or to ambiguous sell competition the that product its to product faces consumer. Student workpoint 4.4 Be a thinker 1. Using an organization marketing as 2. most Explain its mix that of you your think choice, your discuss the organization elements would in the prioritize important. the desired factors that marketing limit an organization’s ability to achieve objectives. 265 4 M A R K E T I N G M smo, d cosum pols Market segmentation A in segment a the given refers market specically Markets ● to market. into to may be age ■ gender ■ – will need is a religion – businesses to no kids) no kids gnitekraM 4 Geographic in – demand nd – here, their characteristics dividing in an effort ways: in a the for varying market, teenagers it which will personal difcult radio languages young to sell – businesses are this sectors for singles young stations that geographical some markets; targets segmentation different consumers considers while of want care include: cellphones products for pork products in a Muslims targets yet) grouping this similar process wants. population will by segment income, of and following – with the men characteristics ethnic the diapers to is groups needs higher dominated income, into in human compared broadcast ● the there acronyms ■ distinct desired women family consumers segmentation of babies country ■ or their of segmentation segmented characteristics ■ sub-group smaller meet Demographic – a Market in while married many geared is may used OINK DINKY creative (one (double couples African towards where and have example, the countries a particular market consider is tribe. divided factors including: ■ regions in a businesses consumers ■ climatic demand hot ● country could in the same conditions in Tibet throughout where segment – for example, to segmentation people’s choices ■ social and economic individuals not ■ of a values for – belong certain animal or heavy Botswana, – this for to example, urban and sweaters will which usually – some particular rural is be in high quite the market characteristics, based such on as: high-income-earning luxury clubs that exclude people status morals customer divides personality status to wealth people’s example – year. Psychographic lifestyle reside differently country compared the consumers products and beliefs values need regarding to be considered recycling of here, products or testing. The advantages of segmentation ● Segmentation opportunities ● Designing sales 266 and, helps in businesses domestic products through for a this, as identify well specic as group protability. existing gaps international of and new markets. consumers can increase 4 . 2 Segmentation ● identifying By ● However, and their right risks market segment waste their in actual market and ( I N C L U D I N G resources for products, the production, of of consumers segmentation development, large P L A N N I N G minimizes the differentiating spread a M A R K E T I N G their can be so could increase expensive promotion potential businesses T O T H E F O U R “ P S ” ) through products. businesses and and by I N T R O D U C T I O N as in a diversify market terms rm and share. of research attempts to reach consumers. Targeting After segmenting market. A common its target needs market, market or wants a rm consists that a must of a now decide group business of on its target consumers decides to serve with or sell to. Key terms Targeting segment. is therefore Targeting can Undifferentiated ● this strategy segments a be or of carried ignores targets needs process marketing rm and common the the wants – out also the using known market. consumers to the a mass in the Here in specic following as differences entire of marketing market marketing, specic market a sub-group of consumers in with similar characteristics in market businesses the Market segment strategies: consider and aim to the a given market sell Market segmentation their products their sales. LG, Dell, to a large Examples HP , and of Coca number of companies customers that do in this order are to maximize Samsung, Nokia, the process of dividing the market into distinct groups of Cola. consumers so as to meet their Differentiated ● marketing – a differentiated or segmented strategy appropriate targets marketing example, Toyota of in several mixes designs cars market for each for the of segments these different and segments. gnitekraM 4 desired needs and wants marketing develops For Target market socio-economic status a group of consumers with people the world. With segmented marketing, rms hope to common needs or wants that gain a stronger position in each of their segments and so increase a business decides to serve their sales and the market share of their brands. or sell to Concentrated ● marketing or niche marketing – this is a strategy that Targeting appeals to strategy may smaller for serve advantage and smaller market of more rms specic that niches may where opportunities that market have there may segments. limited are few have It is resources. competitors been a good These and overlooked by rms the process of marketing to a specic market segment take larger Niche market rms. Products provided by businesses that operate in niche markets ® include Apple’s strategy can targeting iTunes market and their consumers it Rolls-Royce products can serve more best cars. Businesses efciently and most and using a narrow, smaller or more this effectively by specic market segment protably. Mass market a large or broad market that Consumer proles ignores specic market Consumer proles consist of information provided about the characteristics of segments consumers include also of a gender, consist of particular age, product social details of status, the in different and spending income patterns markets. levels. in These characteristics Consumer terms of the proles number may Consumer prole and the characteristics of frequency of products bought by consumers. For segmentation and targeting consumers of a par ticular to be successful, it is very important that rms have good knowledge target their products of who product in dierent markets their consumers are. This will enable them to effectively based on their gender, age, to the right consumers, using appropriate marketing strategies. In addition, and income levels, among a rm aware of its target market has a cost-effective method of selling its other characteristics products as it will make savings on promotion costs. 267 4 M A R K E T I N G yduts esaC nch M – toyo Once Toyota took the plunge, it pursued an eective niche marketing plan. It didn’t promote the Prius in just any media. It focused on media outlets that were watched, read or listened to by people concerned about the environment. For example, it heavily promoted the car through environmental groups and their publications. As the only game in town at that time, Toyota not only dominated the niche – it was the niche. Today, with increased competition in this niche market, the Toyota Prius is still highly regarded as the niche leading brand. Simply identifying holes in the market and lling them, is, often times not enough. It takes extensive research, careful planning, execution and extreme adversion to risk Toyota, a huge company with a global focus on the to successfully develop, introduce, execute and dominate auto business, is an excellent niche marketer. They a niche market with a specic product or service. were one of the rst companies to realize there was Adapted from http://www.smar tmarketingllc. a group of car buyers who would be very interested com/2012/05/07/successful-niche-marketing/ in environmentally friendly cars. Toyota answered this need with development of the legendary Prius, the rst mass production hybrid car. Where other car Exam-style questions manufacturers saw Toyota taking a huge risk, Toyota 1. Dene the term “niche market”. [2 marks] gnitekraM 4 saw it as an oppor tunity to identify a new niche and 2. Explain the statement “ Toyota not only establish its brand in that niche. In marketing, it is often dominated the niche – it was the niche”. [4 marks] the rst brand to market, if executed successfully, that can own the niche market with their brand. 3. Discuss the likely reasons for the success of the Toyota Prius. Student workpoint 4.5 Be a thinker Suggest for 268 the possible someone a) Louis b) Yamaha c) Nintendo who Vuitton consumer buys the prole following: handbag motorbike Wii game console. [10 marks] 4 . 2 M A R K E T I N G P L A N N I N G ( I N C L U D I N G I N T R O D U C T I O N T O T H E F O U R “ P S ” ) of cosums Beverage and snacks maker PepsiCo India is gunning for split its go-to-market (distribution) model into three the bottom-of-the-pyramid consumer for the rst time divisions. There’s a premium arm for distributing in the country, as its chairman, Manu Anand, drives the Tropicana juices, Gatorade spor ts drinks and Quaker New York-based $60 billion parent’s target to reach the oats; a mid-rung one for aerated drinks like Pepsi and ‘next one billion’ consumers in the value segment. Slice and snacks like Kurkure and Lays; and a division catering to mass products like Lehar Iron Chusti. In his rst media interaction since he succeeded Sanjeev Chadha in January this year, Anand tells ET “Had we put, for example, Iron Chusti in the Kurkure that PepsiCo is creating ver ticals to cater to dierent system, it would have been another product, hence the segments of consumers, across functions like sales, decision to set up dedicated sales teams. Communication operations, distribution and marketing. and marketing for these products will be dierent too,” says Anand. Lehar Chusti packs, for example, are labelled PepsiCo’s low-priced products will be aimed at in Telugu. “We need to act like local players, but oer 330 million consumers graduating from the bottom-ofproducts that don’t compromise on taste or quality.” pyramid to the socio-economic B and C classes. The move is in line with global chairman Indra Nooyi’s CHEAPER PRICE POINTS target to generate $30 billion in revenues from ‘healthier ’ Low-margin products like Iron Chusti will obviously not products-internally called better-for-you and good-forbe protable in the beginning, but PepsiCo is hoping you products-by 2020, up from the existing $10 billion. that the products will achieve scale in about 24 months. India will be the rst country in the PepsiCo system to target the value segment with multiple products. Anand says even in PepsiCo’s core business of snacks, such as Kurkure and Cheetos, the rm is stepping up gnitekraM 4 yduts esaC PpsCo mss m wll c o d sms “It’s a big transformation for us; we are targeting the focus on 5 and 3 packs. These packs are growing the next tier of consumers. We are looking at everything fastest among PepsiCo’s foods arm and contribute dierently and doing this in a very structured way. But 45-50% to the division’s foods sales. While in aerated it’s not as if we are under-investing in our core business; drinks, selling bottles and car tons for 5 amounts to it’s more about creating new consumption spaces,” says sacricing protability, PepsiCo will look at products at Anand, who has been with PepsiCo for the past 17 years. 5 through its joint venture with Tata Global Beverages. VERTICAL MOVEMENT Anand says three-four ths of PepsiCo consumers are common to foods and beverages. But beverages are NourishCo, PepsiCo’s ver tical in par tnership with Tata more asset intensive while the foods business is more Global Beverages, has just rolled out its rst product, systems-driven. a lemon-avoured glucose-based drink , called Gluco Plus, in Maharashtra. It is priced at 5. This new strategy comes at a time when food ination is running high. Anand says he’s using all global and Lehar Foods, another ver tical, is a separate operating local resources to minimise costs, including stepping entity, which will launch value snacks priced at 5 and up conversion eciencies, using cheaper sources of lower. Its other two businesses are core aerated drinks energy and better commodity procurement. and snacks. Adapted from http://ar ticles.economictimes.indiatimes. An innovation ver tical has launched biscuits and com/2011-06-06/news/29625847_1_sanjeev-chadha- snacks priced at 2 under the Lehar Iron Chusti brand in manu-anand-pepsico-india Andhra Pradesh initially. This line-up of healthy foods is targeted at women under ‘Project Asha’, PepsiCo’s Exam-style questions codename for Nooyi-commissioned plan to develop low-priced nutritional foods for the poor. 1. Describe two forms of market segmentation relevant for Pepsico in India. [4 marks] Anand, back in India after ‘07 when he was heading the foods division, says what has changed most at the rm in the past four years is its “sheer scale of operations”. While separate operations, sales and marketing teams 2. Analyse how PepsiCo caters for dierent segments of consumers in India. 3. Justify PepsiCo’s new strategy in India. [6 marks] [8 marks] have been set up for the ver ticals, PepsiCo has fur ther 269 4 M A R K E T I N G Poso Product a positioning product sometimes their faced will effective a tool position The that rst step the in to in will need target to must This for customers a the the with effort position in to plan the positions price, on of its of An is how products. product and aspects image. which communicate support them strategies identify are simplify market. competing features perceive to representation quality, should the and other key an or consumers positioning marketers rm dene As therefore visual to example choose Finally, is in advantage their relation requires important, strategy. products planning in market. information, marketers map. consumers the competitive product positioning nd rm its a a use of how in categorize mind, perception positioning position they in could products overload products perceive consumers Second, its they or consumers an this their analysing other process With give to with purchasing accordingly. that involves compared to its develop desired marketing mix. The impor tance of a position map Prestigious to own A ● position map could competitors or It identify help threats in a rm the to establish which are its High close market. Mercedes-Benz ● also It ● is the a rm simple research gnitekraM 4 It ● helps could and important ll by quick gaps creating way of or or opportunities offering presenting new usually in the market products. sophisticated data. a rm consumer in needs targeting and specic market segments to best satisfy wants. Jaguar ssenevitcee laicnaniF that helps Mitsubishi BMW Motors Toyota Ford High Low Audi Honda Volvo th uqu sll po o poposo (USP) This is a feature products unique in the and of a product market. helps to The explain that differentiates differentiating why it from factor consumers is other what choose one Proton competing makes a product Low product over Figure 4.2.1. A position map for cars another. Source: http://www.12manage.com The impor tance of having a USP A USP: Key terms helps ● to offering leads ● to about establish a and, result, as a customer the increased rm’s helps loyalty product in competitive as to advantage attract customers comparison to more can rival in its product customers identify products, Product position map/ something resulting special in perception map a visual representation of how sales. consumers perceive a product in relation to other competing By appropriately using the elements of the marketing mix, businesses products can effectively competitors. differentiate Here are some themselves and their products from examples: Unique selling point/ proposition (USP) ● Product: Apple ® its iPad , is world renowned ® iPod , for its unique product quality in a product’s feature that ® and Mac computer products. dierentiates it from other ● Price: Cellphone affordable 270 prices subscriber to its Safaricom consumers in has the always Kenyan managed market to offer despite the competing products in the market 4 . 2 existing high ● M A R K E T I N G competition, after-tax Place: Coca having a P L A N N I N G and the ( I N C L U D I N G company has still I N T R O D U C T I O N managed to T O post T H E F O U R “ P S ” ) very prots. Cola wide has range managed of retail to differentiate outlets itself providing its well globally product close by to its consumers. Promotion: for an the effective Nike’s Nike’s company “Just do because strategy in it it” slogan is a emphasizes encouraging powerful the action customers to promotional element, go ahead tool which and is buy products. seiduts esaC Uqu sll pos- som xmpls Successful businesses usually have a unique feature which dierentiate them from their competitors. Here are three examples of businesses which have thought creatively about their USPs: 1. Love With Food (LoveWithFood.com) Love with Food sells organic snack-boxes which are delivered directly to customers for $10 a month. For every box sold, the company donates a meal to a food bank to feed hungry children. This creates a unique buying experience for their customers that they gnitekraM 4 ● wouldn’t get anywhere else. Love with Food oers something dierent, while still selling exactly what their customers want. 2. Flinja (Flinja.com) Flinja aims to solve a huge problem that college students and alumni have; nding a job. Their unique Exam-style questions selling proposition is clear, and most impor tantly, 1. benet-driven. “Flinja helps college students and alumni With reference to Hear & Play, describe two aspects of a USP (Unique Selling Point). nd jobs.” They have dened their target market and [4 marks] stated how they’re going to help them solve a problem. 2. With reference to Flinja, explain the link 3. Hear and Play between target market and USP . Many websites and businesses help people learn 3. [4 marks] Discuss whether Love With Food’s USP is music. Hear and Play focusses specically on learning entirely ethical. [8 marks] to play the piano by ear, making it ideal for people who don’t want to or can’t read sheet music. Student workpoint 4.6 Be an inquirer 1. Draw the 2. a position products Using the or map of brands information organizations offering an on in industry of your choice and identify offer. question those 1, products why and is it important brands to have for a the USP? 271 4 M A R K E T I N G rvso chcls ✓ A marketing plan development ✓ of is an essential marketing organization’s marketing The the four Ps of document strategies that that aid in concerns the achieving an objectives. marketing mix are product, price, promotion andplace. ✓ An appropriate needs and product, A target wants isa are charged communicated ✓ marketing wants a the through market that at is a of right the group business sub-group mix for sufciently price, right of decides consumers a business met by available promotion consumers to sell with to ensures producing at similar consumers’ right right place and channels. with while the that the common a market needs or segment characteristics in a givenmarket. ✓ A mass market segments while is a a broad niche market market that ignores focuses on a specic narrow market market TOK discussion segment To what extent does marketing ✓ The primary focus of product positioning is to analyse how respond to, or change, the consumers perceive a rm’s product compared to other products perceptions of individuals and in the market in an effort for these rms to gain a competitive societies? advantage gnitekraM 4 272 in the market. 4 . 2 M A R K E T I N G P L A N N I N G ( I N C L U D I N G I N T R O D U C T I O N T O T H E F O U R “ P S ” ) Practice question Marketing in Second an Life the is Millions sell vehicles, 2006 Many or store On Rates such island” The Dell computer island the Life. to corporate virtual that The to than can its to as a residents in a exists create, life, estate. buy and clothes, resident buying, only second real designer millionth million Life that lead career include one US$1 market be the to be in few US delivered 12 the bands is at Week, into in selling, virtual rock biggest US$10,000 their real late and and news early homes. vice and Life versa. stable order pay Life an retail fairly also Second have has a Second and can market customers virtual ofcial home agency, an and remained within to instance, dollars have their news to the Life younger factory Customers islands frequently the US Second for Dell dollars, Musicians Reuters use target Dell, the years to to delivered dollar. simulations. between be converted the which Business to of Linden last Kmart and segments. replica PCs pay and audience purchased and new IBM, virtual order (L$) BBC, clients world may registered Dell, can and BBC debut According a over recently training including Second but dollars IBM online which world subscribers nightclub daily more niche aware with Linden Linden business a customers uctuate, dollars. as to customers 250 Life a Second property. island, currency. hands generated) character, visiting services, Second services where the from environment, (computer virtual making technologically “in-world 3D and user companies or virtual a change casinos. one virtual products and dollars products with renting Using everything of virtual technological online, Internet. mimicking new in for a as real US virtual organizations, a presence adopter, uses within gnitekraM 4 on a the festivals. Second and Life design US$200,000 shops to charge establish a presence. [Source: adapted from http://secondlife.reuters.com and http://whatis.techtarget.com] a) Dene b) Explain of c) the the market Discuss IB, May of niche market. advantages to segmentation how marketing growth term rms mixes Second may to major and corporations, consumer adapt changes Life. [2 their in like Dell and IBM, targeting. marketing technology strategies such as marks] [8 marks] [ 10 marks] and the 2008 273 4.3 Sales forecasting (HL only) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ calculate up to a four-par t moving average ➔ plot the sales trend lines and explain the relationship between the trend and the actual sales revenue gures prepare a forecast (including seasonal, cyclical and random ➔ variation) using given data examine the benets and limitations of sales forecasting. ➔ Sales forecasting will be. and trends future ow, It uses over reduces and decisions. may the process a specied better information However, be affected predicting period helps assist to of in planning to making by of methods uncertainty, ensures forecasting and is quantitative time. a for accurate sales is a sales levels predicting stock and the cash need intelligent predictions external of Businesses making future future Accurately growth. in rm’s the management them numerous what estimate sales business complex process factors. gnitekraM 4 tm ss lyss This is a quantitative sales levels sales information it occurred. predict time ● from the series The The sales forecasting sales that data. It businesses businesses future. There then are method relies have rely certain on kept on that time over this aspects predicts series a past that given data which period in need future data, an to is since attempt be to identied in data: trend sales past data. – this This is a may visible pattern indicate the noted rise and after fall of inputting sales the over a past given period. ● Seasonal the is varying when the middle of within Cyclical in an a the one can extend Random stand phase for year. year in any time. but more from increase day winter. year. year – in but these For example increase in variations demand of in experiences a because seasonal sales of in usually of variation clothing decline are variations example, – one sales at in repeated and sales during a tied could be to the on recession. business the rise Cyclical during variations year. these given the An are declining Random changes less. than a are an Seasonal or uctuations out these the new economy. growth sudden of in – experiences uctuations the that 274 seasons business beginning cycle ● a the occur ● uctuations are trend. demand for variations notable For changes example, ice-cream are or there during unpredictable a uctuations may rare and be a warm can occur at 4 . 3 S A L E S F O R E C A S T I N G ( H L O N LY ) Moving averages Key terms This is a useful emphasizing method than because it indicator the in direction simply sales of a forecasting trend. predicting It future is a sales for identifying more from accurate actual and and sales complex data. This Sales forecasting is the process of predicting the helps to smooth out any uctuations from sales data. future sales of a rm Table 4.3.1. Yearly sales of a calculator manufacturer Time series analysis Year a quantitative sales 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 400 600 800 650 700 850 950 1,200 forecasting method that Sales (US$000) predicts future sales levels from past sales data Calculating a three-year moving average Using year 1. table 4.3.1, moving Calculate the following steps can be used to calculate the three- average: the mean sales for the rst three (400,000 years. + For 600,000 + example, the 800,000) ______________________ mean from years 1, 2 and 3 is US$ = 600,000. 3 2. Do the same (600,000 for + the 800,000 next + three sets of data: 650,000) ______________________ US$ = 683,333 for years 2, 3 and 4. 3 3. The same process should (800,000 + be 650,000 used + for the following sets of threes: 700,000) ______________________ 3, 4, 5: US$ = 716,667 = 733,333 (650,000 + 700,000 + gnitekraM 4 3 850,000) ______________________ 4, 5, 6: US$ 3 (850,000 + 950,000 + 1 200,000) _______________________ 6, 7, 8: US$ = 1,000,000 3 The above data is summarized in table 4.3.2 and gure 4.3.1. Table 4.3.2. Sales revenue with three-year moving average (trend) Year Sales (US$000) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 400 600 800 650 700 850 950 1,200 600 683.333 716.667 733.333 1,000 Trend (three-year moving average) (US$000) 1400 1200 1000 selaS 800 600 400 sales (US$000) trend (three-year moving 200 average) (US$000) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Years Figure 4.3.1. Actual sales and the three-year moving average trend for the calculator manufacturer 275 4 M A R K E T I N G Calculating a four-year moving average Calculating calculating centring. total to This involves Summation Calculation (ii) + of 800,000 Calculating of the + sales next of use For in + (ii) four-year bit four-year example, more this and the complex case, an it than makes eight-year calculation of use of moving the rst 1, 2, 3 and 4 (US$): 400,000 + 600,000 + 2,450,000 years moving 2, 3, 700,000) eight-year and a a In follows: years = is average. of four-year sales rst (i) as of 650,000 in rst is average moving mid-point. total the the summations moving the 650,000) Summation get a moving 800,000 To four-year three-year establish four-year (i) the the 4 = moving (US$): centred total and 5 is: (US$): (600,000 + 2,750,000 total 2,450,000 moving involves + adding 2,750,000 average, the = the 5,200,000 eight-year moving 5,200,000 _______ total is divided by 8 where this as follows (US$): = 650,000. It is important 8 to note line where Using the four-year year same 3 value is is in the table. It will be placed in the positioned. approach moving placed as averages above, are the next summarized eight-year in table moving 4.3.3 and totals gure and 4.3.2. gnitekraM 4 Table 4.3.3. Sales revenue with four-year moving average (trend) Year Sales ($000) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 400 600 800 650 700 850 950 1,200 5,200 5,750 6,150 6,850 Eight-year moving total ($000) Trend (four-year moving 650 718.75 768.75 average) ($000) 1400 1200 1000 selaS 800 600 400 sales (US$000) trend (four-year moving 200 average) (US$000) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Years Figure 4.3.2. Actual sales plotted against the four-year moving average (trend) Extrapolation Once “line 276 the of trend best line t”, has shown been by a drawn, dotted this line, line to can be predict extended future using sales. This a is 856.25 4 . 3 known as extrapolation. The trend lines from S A L E S gures 4.3.1 F O R E C A S T I N G and ( H L O N LY ) 4.3.2 Key terms can be extrapolated Figure 4.3.3 shows to provide how a an trend estimated line can be sales value for future years. extrapolated. Moving average sales forecasting method that erusaem identies and emphasizes the direction of a trend ytilauq ataD Ex trapolation an extension of a trend line to predict future sales Variation dierence between actual 2007 2008 2009 2010 2011 sales and trend values Time (year) Figure 4.3.3. Example of an extrapolated trend line Source: ops.fhwa.dot.gov Calculating variations Variation the is trend calculated values. This by is getting shown the in difference table between actual sales and 4.3.4. Year Sales (US$000) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 400 600 800 650 700 850 950 1,200 Trend (four-year moving average) 650 718.75 768.75 gnitekraM 4 Table 4.3.4. Sales revenue with variations in each year 856.25 (US$000) Variation in each year (US$000) The average calculated number of (US$: cyclical as the variation sum years 150 of within 150,000 using variations the the over above the table period can 68.75 68.75 6.25 be divided by the period: 68,750 68,750 6,250) ____ = 1,562.5 4 If, for year of example, 9, then 1,401,562.5 Seasonal then years ( the is the For 25,500 for extrapolated 1562.5 year variations calculating period). the adding example, and the average 25,500 also if in seasonal as give seasonal the variation calculated value (in US$) was 1,400,000 a more accurate predicted future a more accurate prediction for value 9. can average trend gives in variation rst the in quarter rst variation each of quarter for the quarter year of rst 5 the year 6 quarter by (three-month variation was in was 40,300, those two follows: 40,300) __ = -32,900 2 277 4 M A R K E T I N G Assuming was that US$350 accurate the 000, sales predicted then sales revenue subtracting prediction gure of for 32,900 year from 317,100 for 7 in its 350,000 the rst rst gives quarter a quarter more of year 7. The benets of sales forecasting ● Better and cash improve ● ow seasonal the Increased ● Better in for the number of Improved strategies – staff of sales future of of in in the consideration can better cyclical plan to greatly of assists goods required to in sales the the and in future. forecasting succession production produce planning can help regarding the the future. – and an into managers business. accurate planning in a stock – trends accordingly taking number department required by nancial forecasting the planning marketing awareness position amount resources – factors, knowing workforce human ● liquidity efciency department planning management variation marketers be effort able to to will gain adjust increase greater their their marketing market share. TOK discussion The limitations of sales forecasting To what extent does knowing ● Sales forecasting is time-consuming – it takes a long time to calculate assist us in predicting? because of its complex nature, especially when considering the How do we know that our calculation of average seasonal variations in each quarter over a gnitekraM 4 predictions are reliable? number ● Sales of years. forecasting ofpolitical, ofsales forecast changesin ignores social, and qualitative economic predictions, consumer tastes for and external factors can example factors. A inuence political preferences, and number the accuracy instability, exchange rate uctuations. Student workpoint 4.7 Be knowledgeable Table 4.3.5 shows the yearly sales gures of a paper manufacturer over a period of eight years. Table 4.3.5. Paper manufacturer ’s sales 2004–11 Year Sales revenue (US$000) 278 a) Calculate b) Plot c) Comment d) Extrapolate e) Calculate both the lines the the the 20 05 20 0 6 20 07 20 08 20 09 200 350 400 600 500 750 three-year trend on 20 04 and and the four-year actual relationships four-year average sales between moving cyclical moving trend variation line over 900 averages. revenue the 2010 on actual and the graph sales predict period. paper. revenue the and likely the sales trends revenue noted. for 2012. 2011 1,000 4 . 3 S A L E S F O R E C A S T I N G ( H L O N LY ) rvso chcls Sales sales ✓ forecasting levels Seasonal varying tied to ✓ Moving smooth ✓ ✓ in out is any a involves a a cycle greatly an out assist complex use mid-point the of a from of from a sales of of of a rm’s future time. demand while given on the due the other random hand variations are are trend. trend lines that help to data. calculating and calculating line in developing method a estimating variations economy in of period changes four-year when use by Cyclical in stand process specied caused year. uctuations the is over are that more Extrapolation quantitative the business averages establish a variations changes Centring that is trends seasons the notable and an four best t moving eight-year year moving drawn to averages moving total to averages. predict futuresales. gnitekraM 4 ✓ 279 4 M A R K E T I N G Pcc quso Fun-Games Fun-Games prides A is itself recession economy, into showed that its known for are also of The coming preferred rate of a had accepting markets; about nancial of expansion years, to the need linguistic director is help intend make a a option are to and of years is in the Area*, which workforce. domestic expansion expansion Trade into nearby although signicantly Dene b) Using the term three social Calculate the in research the Construct a and to use (Show Discuss all the forecasting Nov it trend of funds best data be for option from the games sales record: last in director overseas encountered. expansion. for The external previous seven 200–2007 Sales 2002 5500 units 2003 4500 units 2004 8600 units 2005 9100 units 2006 9300 units 2007 11 000 units limited moving sales company” (Show using the all your the the yearly and and trend trend limitations their marks] [5 marks] [3 marks] the working) sales sales variation gures gure for from (i) 2009. working) aiding [2 average: trend, forecast benets in the may 5000 units graph your lack marketing operating 2001 cyclicalvariation. (ii) the of difculties about sales computer “private years strategy, experience considering use gnitekraM 4 a) (i) decision to to Fun-Games expand of using overseas sales [ 10 marks] 2008 Free Trade Area: a group of countries that have eliminated tarrif restrictions in order to trade together more easily. 280 company, dedicated considering uctuated Financial year * are and decision. Fun-Games IB, three Free growth lack worried Fun-Games and for Fun-Games’ cultural, managers c) limited games Fun-Games members exchange private computer the managers markets. the national innovative predicted the that worried The well years. While is is so overseas countries few a on 4.4 Market research By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ explain why and how organizations carry out market research ➔ analyse the primary market research methods ➔ comment on the secondary market research methods ➔ discuss the ethical considerations of market research ➔ distinguish between qualitati ve and quantitati ve research ➔ explain the various sampling methods ➔ interpret results from given data. Market data of research related goods to and businesses a is the services use process particular and market of collecting, market, on competitors’ research analysing, including data on behaviour. information to make and reporting consumption Importantly, decisions. ● To identify consumer consumers’ For of needs satisfaction example, a customers beverage buying and levels wants and company their sodas as well patterns may and in want the sales as aim to purchase to nd understand behaviour. out trends gnitekraM 4 th puposs of m sch the over a type given period. ● To assist For for To business decreases decline ● a example, in reduce ● To of the by ● To by offering the product out is likely may patterns to signal happen rms because of to a in be future. prepared possible levels. failure market effectiveness its or (especially research or example, and the mix a that marketing how in latest most development rst-mover of evaluating marketing current For research spending income of what recession of new products) establishes the likes by and consumers. provide market. risk assessing required predicting overall carrying measure done in in upcoming consumer effectively dislikes an a rm specic market information large strategy. so that be activities activity companies they can the segments. regarding technological budgets This implements keep up in have to date the huge in advantages. M sch mhods Market research secondary can broadly be carried out in two ways: primary and research. 281 4 M A R K E T I N G Primary market research This is hand this also research attempt a known information given to period advantage will rivals. that or of be For a is nd of seek rst example, particular to possibly specialized to a hotel attract for is a it, that may it this agency. an primary and time key over the its research use many eld and over collects can for However, takes A that It rst- research advantage waiting ights. process of conduct behaviour out through be will consumers cancellations. may connecting research collection organization gives ight who carry research discover to of spending to the which customers the patterns decide the organizations their market is prone their because of access airline days expensive help in may research involves Most buying changes Firms the and market. specic any time. research the out primary the information and eld anticipate themselves data to as from this hours research requires researchers. Secondary market research This Also is the known exists in primary to gnitekraM 4 is of specic of get cheaper out data desk an a of the not eld be picture However, been rst measure. research researching and and for the data carry Desk the collected from analysing should background than have information involves gap-lling available. and it Organizations overall as readily needs second-hand research, method date may of form. research involved be as some research and collection of the information purposes In is a quicker information collected other some already secondary conduct research most organization. that out then market. than cases may the the source reliable. Pmy m sch mhods d chqus Surveys These are enable may or questionnaires the researcher contain “no” survey answers, may to different sent gather types multiple focus on out of a useful particular target information. question, choice, getting to for audience The example to questionnaire those needing or open-ended questions. specic information from A “yes” consumer consumers Key terms by Market research seeking their opinion implemented in a on a number particular of product different or issue. Surveys can be the process of collecting, ways. analysing, and repor ting data Some of the most common ways to administer surveys include: related to a par ticular market ● by mail – an example would be an alumni survey distributed Primary research via direct opinions mail from by the past development students about ofce an in a school seeking the the collection of rst-hand issue information from the market ● by telephone – an example would be a researcher calling consumers Secondary research to elicit their opinion on using a certain product or service the collection of second-hand ● online – for example, workshop leaders may use online surveys as an information from the market evaluation 282 tool to seek participants’ opinions of the workshop. 4 . 4 They enable amount of researchers data in a to collect relatively a short large Surveys ● period of If intended designed and well, completed surveys easily by can the be administered The ● respondents. can be used to collect information wide range preferences, of aspects and including poorly can constructed undermine and otherwise well- may they provided not truly be an feel, by respondents accurate with some on reection results a of also on being a are research. answers survey how Surveys ● that administered time. ● R E S E A R C H Disadvantages Advantages ● M A R K E T biased. attitudes, opinions. As ● large prove samples to be construction sampling response is are costly and usually and used, up a can used bias the to surveys lot administration. generally rates use of time While select results can in their random participants, of a survey . Interviews An interview is a conversation during which the interviewer asks the TOK discussion interviewee conducted questions one on in one, order face to to gain face or information. by Interviews can be telephone. How does the language used in questionnaires inuence Disadvantages Advantages consumers and businesses’ conclusions when doing can provide detailed The ● whole process can gnitekraM 4 They ● market research? information perceptions consumers about and the be opinions through of as in-depth very it the questioning. time-consuming involves out, usually achieve a up carrying analysing gathering They ● setting interview, it responses, feedback, and high reporting. response rate one-on-one Precise to the because attention wording can respondent precise meaning claried during the provided. be and of of Some ● tailored be the may therefore inuencing questions the interviewers biased, interviewees’ responses. interview process. Focus groups Focus to groups discuss who are segment new consist specic of of customers. prepared opinions, product. researchers small of In by ideas, or the the all the number idea. of The customers discussion, market and Usually, predict a product representative questions their a their of They responses reaction of the brought comprises the business participants researchers. reactions. people group also or of respond Participants may together individuals be freely asked a specic to share to try are viewed and studied larger market population. a to help 283 4 M A R K E T I N G Disadvantages Advantages As ● focus groups individuals, way of They ● gathering can be customers rm’s consist using a a small is a cheap market used to of them to and of The ● easy new the or to reect it. There is of ● strategies. help the identify key product the group well as other needs not and its addressed by They provide the rm’s and number it of about could be the that individuals do the not possibility not opinions that express on the some their members honest discussion of and be hesitant to express topic. their own especially when their opinions oppose competitors. insights on the current competitors in the of another participant. position Focus ● of information the those ● small may may views, business seek segment requirements They as a or of the personal They ● may market opinions reaction product business entire research. measure rm’s group mind of groups are more costly to carry out than the surveys as each participant usually has to be customer. compensated in cash or in kind. Observation Observation by carefully is a fundamental watching and and trying to behaviour. Some observations are follow trend. Observation can how this quickly consumers gnitekraM 4 spend queuing trafc department provide as they to notice wait to observe recommendations method understand scientic be their pay. the for basic used in by displays It can ow of getting certain nature; It is a how be trafc long used in or by certain to all check they a people’s not may government’s areas and help improvement. Disadvantages direct information behaviour, how things however, Advantages ● information supermarkets or also of method when as people the of collecting studying researcher behave in a data actual can given or ● human see Complete cannot exactly so situation. be market this with answers to obtained any by researchers other problem or observation need methods to such issue alone, combine as issuing questionanaires. ● A in large a number short space of individuals of can be surveyed time. ● Observation or ● Observation is usually a cost-effective way opinions a verbal data. Scody m sch mhods o chqus Academic journals These are articles publications should information students, or Academic well given. others journals distributing 284 be of The experts with are scholarly referenced knowledge will rst-hand written and for not articles to as written provide usually the a sole by in experts. exact include experience the be used individuals to study because attitudes this usually of requires gathering cannot of a purpose source The of the professors,graduate particular of money-making subject. providing and opportunity. response from the participant. 4 . 4 Academic where journals they experts. R E S E A R C H Disadvantages Advantages ● M A R K E T are This undergo checked increases by the a peer-review academics reliability process and of Since ● other they specic the the contain academic best source information interest, for they of very may general-interest not be topics. information. The ● ● Most academic current ● journals research, They are need of They take less reports, andtopic-specic therefore original include good sources research time to on a reviews of information. when a rm is peer-review consuming, provision in processcan which of the may latest also or betime- affect current the event information. topic. publish than books. Media ar ticles A include newspaper newspapers is a advertisements, means of printed and since magazines. publication containing correspondence. communicating readership and the rise world of Once events, television news, viewed newspapers and the have than via a newspaper communicating is It ● via declined is As television. Most serious newspaper articles have researched, sources, not ● the They and case are found in written edited for widely many for some with that communicate of the producing nished were events paper written in content, may is real-time. printing, and time-consuming, be out of date by been time they are delivered to the customer. reliable accuracy, Internet available retail to process distributing the well in difcult the articles ● articles, dominant Disadvantages Communicating cheaper feature the Internet. Advantages ● as gnitekraM 4 These and which is Newspapers ● resources. can of be The ● stores. can organization process considered of a be biased, that owns producing waste of depending on the type them. newspapers paper and could energy be resources. Government publications These are topics. articles They produced could provide population census surveys consumer on in a by the government businesses country, with statistics expenditure on useful on social a wide variety information trends, or on of the even patterns. Market analyses These that include gather reports They quite are can and a b o ut usually be costly. Mintel comme r cia l data ca r r ie d source d at p ubl icati ons pa r ti cula r out by va ri ous Orga ni za ti ons tha t or mar ke t s . m a rk et Th e sp ec i a li st loca l m a r ke t bu s in e ss pr ov i de int e ll i ge n c e h i gh l y such r e se a r ch l i br a ri e s, r e por t s r e por ts de t a il e d bu t a ge n t s . they i nc lu de are D un , Verdict. 285 4 M A R K E T I N G ETHICS Marketing research has experienced a resurgence with the Breaches of condentiality widespread use of the Internet and the popularity of social Another signicant ethical consideration involved in market networking. It is easier than ever before for companies to connect research involves breaches of condentiality. Companies directly with customers and collect individual information. regularly share information about customers with par tners The way a company conducts its market research these days and aliates, requiring the customer to opt-out of the sharing can have serious ethical repercussions, impacting the lives of if he [or she] doesn’t want to be involved. Some companies consumers in ways that have yet to be fully understood. Fur ther, sell information they have gathered on customers to outside companies can be faced with a public backlash if its market companies. Ethically, any unauthorized disclosure of customer research practices are perceived as unethical. information is problematic. Deceptive practices Objectivity The ease with which a company can access and gather data Marketing and adver tising have a signicant impact on public about its customers can lead to deceptive practices and perceptions. Market researchers have an ethical obligation to dishonesty in the company’s research methods. The type of conduct research objectively, so data is available that allows for ethical problems could range from not telling customers that the development of the varying issues noted. Researchers who information is being collected when they visit a website to allow their own opinions to bias their work tend to contribute to misrepresenting research numbers by changing database the continuation of stereotypes in adver tising. For example, a numbers. Any action that uses lies and deception to nd out or market researcher with a one-dimensional view of minorities establish information about consumers falls under this category. could do a fair amount of harm if allowed to shape an adver tising campaign based on biased data collection. Invasion of privacy One of the most serious ethical considerations involved in Source: http://smallbusiness.chron.com/ethical-considerations- market research is invasion of privacy. Companies have an marketing-research- 43621.html unprecedented ability to collect, store and match information Exam-style questions relating to customers that can infringe on a customer ’s right gnitekraM 4 1. Describe two forms of marketing research. [4 marks] to privacy. In many instances, the customer does not know or understand the extent of the company’s inltration into his 2. [or her] life. The company uses this information to reach the Discuss how and why ethics and globalisation impact upon marketing research. [10 marks] customer with targeted adver tising, but the process of targeting can have a chilling eect on personal freedom. th dcs bw qulv d quv sch Primary research quantitative Table 4.4.1 in or secondary research can be either qualitative or nature. shows the differences between qualitative and quantitative research. Table 4.4.1. Dierences between qualitative and quantitative research Qualitative research 286 Quantitative research This involves the collection of data about opinions, This involves the collection of numerical data or data that attitudes or beliefs. can be measured. Information is open to a high degree of interpretation. Information is open to less interpretation. It is subjective. It is objective. Key research questions would include “ Why?” Key research questions would include “How many?” The researcher is par t of the process. The researcher is separate. It provides multiple realities, i.e. the focus is complex It provides one reality, i.e. the focus is concise and broad. and narrow. 4 . 4 Generally, data by research refers to things. use of qualitative observing refers the are Quantitative customers counts and bought like used say. seek things, collecting used to sports seek sports and Surveys the interpreting research descriptions qualitative collect to and R E S E A R C H quantitative qualitative characteristics, answers may company’s of analysing, Whereas interviews. company’s research the in usually may the and measures in-depth methods research Qualitative customers and collecting, do denitions, methods groups publications 2013? to is people meanings, Common focus research what M A R K E T data and the government quantitative question: of include data. How shoes in the month answers to the question: many of May Why do shoes? Smpl mhods reality there or equipment population an of effort or to to is target carry gather a market of a be Below number a and survey of a research. out Sampling of of the For of of a in the to large used money, market. still population small number the sampling is a clear in idea required. the A population group of process The However, have represent a labour, population. a and example, simply commonly of whole selected is energy, research sample people disadvantages time, consumers primary selected product. sample. are a enough potential taking under appropriate advantages out all group could not adequate views, small consumers buyers simply comprises consumers’ sample is of potential of selecting methods and the gnitekraM 4 In the each. Quota sampling This involves that share such who of as age must 500 may segme nti ng certain or be gen d e r. perception 15 of of fe r i ng ma l e s the gi ve n Ta rg e ts inter v i e w e d students target a cha r a cte ri s ti cs in the a nd 20 are e ach IB This is a di pl o m a and where proportions groups in to of the cost- ● method, fo r the For the Results different population obtained reliable random g r ou ps p eo ple a sc h oo l r es e ar c h e r obtained always t h e ir are sampling than sampling. are as (see done; are statistically population statistical more a of in r eg a rd in g representative not Findings nu m be r pr og ra mm e , of s ub- g ro up s) e xa m pl e, i nt e r vie w not the known. ● nu m be r Disadvantages sampling especially s et a p r o g r a mme . quick effective the n in t o e xc l u si ve s e gm e nt . fe mal es Advantages ● p opu l a t ion ( mut u a ll y this of the random below) also is leads to errors. usually those of ● The interviewer biased in the interviewees those most who in and will the may be selection of choose cooperate process. 287 4 M A R K E T I N G Random sampling CHANGE In this case every member in the population has an equal chance of Technological innovation being selected as part of the sample. The sample of respondents has is transformed the way market selected randomly. With technology, a list of random numbers can research is done. be generated from a target population by the use of a computer. An Social media has expanded the example of selecting a random sample may be choosing any 50 people landscape from a telephone directory containing the names of 1,000 is transforming it in peo exciting new ways. Social media allows unltered feedback abut Advantages Random ● bias as Disadvantages sampling everyone chance of being reduces has an The ● equal be chosen. sample too not chosen small consist requires new researching skills. may and/or of the it With new technology, researchers can be much more targeted in may what they measure and who they target target. Using the most recent population: It ● is a relatively easy way a larger, more of social media and online survey representative obtaining a sample may sample. products, businesses are able have to be selected. to collect data about all sor ts of things. They can do it faster, better and cheaper than ever. Stratied sampling What do you think are some of In this method the target population is made up of many different the major drawbacks inherent groups who are subdivided into segments or strata that share similar in conducting market research characteristics. Members are then chosen from each stratum to form using the recent changes a representative sample. For example, a secondary school may be in technology? How do you deciding to introduce a new school uniform. It may divide the school think these drawbacks can be gnitekraM 4 population based on the different forms, from Form 1 to Form 5. A addressed? random sample the same the above in a is then proportions example, telephone randomly chosen of for the a directory, selected to from sample sample 10 make each in size students up the sample 50 from these forms, category people each is ensuring maintained. whose form that names (10 × 5) As in appear would be sample. Disadvantages selected representative target each of required Advantages The of of a is more It particular is not strata population. easy from similar to a select relevant population of very characteristics. Cluster sampling This is an appropriate dispersed. then taking wishing few This to a will random set up geographical selected will method involve be a sample plant areas to in a from to It is a of research and cheap carrying from populations. out widely geographically clusters. town may the and whole dispersed ● Results each For carry the is geographically region example, out (cluster) a of and multinational research opinions on the just a clusters population. obtained representative population especially obtained share 288 population from Disadvantage quick method the group location represent Advantage ● the when a the certain around assumed use selecting of and if the from similar may the may not be cluster areas be whole biased, sample where is people characteristics. 4 . 4 M A R K E T R E S E A R C H Snowballing This is a process individual who participate, refer be to the so on. of that suggests ARVs they customers is of quite the It is a or initial hence sensitive group the rst use for their contacts example It where or could effect. individuals. products group who snowball research, sophisticated the individuals HIV-positive is It a survey also the to may used range of limited. Advantage ● surveying groups know, among expensive involves other Members that conducting use researching potential sampling people when on when and other used done of then Disadvantage cost-effective obtaining method information of There ● through a referrals. is potential biased sharing sample, similar for getting since friends lifestyles may Exam tip refer of each the other same and be part sample. In determining the best sampling method to use, it Convenience sampling is easy a sampling access doing research physically from be the rst proximity on present canteen when the and technique the at ten names to the school and the are researcher. could or in patient hospital, list to a students a a on by of each method. A key example consideration is the level of being purchasing the strengths and weaknesses their teacher study Another when select based example, conduct lunchtime. a selected For interviewing time research in groups canteen directly break conducting where items would researcher may use bias in the sample and how cost-eective the method is. gnitekraM 4 This is impor tant to analyse the This could also be inuenced by factors such as nancial sample. resources, business size, and Advantage It ● is a fast, method the rationale of the research. Disadvantage easy of and cheap sampling research groups ● because are readily The sample and not the be entire may be biased representative of population. Key terms available. Quantitative research the collection, analysis and rsuls fom d collco interpretation of numerical data Businesses are interested in the range of results they get from carrying out or data that can be measured research. It is therefore of prime importance that they ensure that their Qualitative research data collection Whether both, the for it methods using is either essential appropriate their correct Benets of to data use are appropriate quantitative maintain collection reduces properly in the instruments likelihood data offer qualitative integrity the collected or and high data, or research and of a degree a sampling accuracy. combination process. providing of clear errors of Selecting instructions occurring. the collection, analysis, and interpretation of data about consumer opinions, attitudes, or beliefs Sample include: a group of people selected to ● the ability ● the ● increased of research to answer accurately the research questions posed represent the population or ability to repeat and validate a particular study where needed target market under research accuracy of ndings resulting in efcient use of resources Sampling ● good opportunities further for investigation. other researchers to pursue areas needing the process of selecting an appropriate sample 289 4 M A R K E T I N G The heart of research is gathering reliable information about an issue or TOK discussion intervention results. and analysing Collecting and it to determine analysing the quantitative signicance data can help of the sample highlight To what extent is market connections (correlations) among variables and also address other research information reliable? factors the qualitative researcher data experiences, gaining a the even should better not provide including required researcher obtain can may what have insight may knowledge continue results in considered.Collecting into need from the evaluating the next the to varying be the research or changed. information whole analysing participant improved research and process in On provided, an effort to round. yduts esaC M sch – a cs sudy of Sfcom Safaricom is the leading telecommunications company Safaricom subscribers can par ticipate. The second operating in Kenya. It provides a host of products and solution Safaricom can have a charity event were the services for telephony, GPRS, 3G, EDGE and data and fax. money they make goes to a special cause for example food aid, tree planting etc this would aect the market It has been faced with a number of problems with socially. And the nal solution would be Supremacy to time, one of which is the entry of many other control the telephony industry by outmatching other telecommunication companies into the market over operators to be the rst to launch Apple’s iPhone 3G. To the years. The companies include, Telkom Orange, do all this they have to carry out extensive research to Yu and Zain. So far the main rival is Zain. The problem help in a decision. caused by the entry of other companies is that they gnitekraM 4 bring about unwanted competition (decrease in market Safaricom decided to be the rst to launch the Apple’s share). This problem can be solved by conducting iPhone 3G increasing the competitor advantage. The marketing research. third step would be to market research to enable the rm to make an appropriate decision on all the The rst step in the marketing research process is elements of the marketing mix as well as reduce the identifying and dening your problem. Dening the risk of investing in an unprotable marketing venture. problem would mean expanding on it and explaining Since Safaricom is a long established rm and has why it should be seen as a problem. In this case a network running across Kenya they decided to Safaricom has identied a number of competitors as launch the product in a limited geographical area the threat of losing customers and reducing the market where demand is observed. The price was high as it share, which will lead to lower prot margins and growth was a unique product to capture non price sensitive at the end of the year is contrary to what they want. consumers who see new products as a novelty and as Step two is to develop your approach, generally the product would grow older the price is reduced to speaking the approach should be developed almost capture the more price sensitive consumer. It will be exclusively around a dened set of objectives. Clearer launched in Westland’s Nairobi next to two shopping objectives developed in step one will lend them to malls and excessive adver tisements will be done to a better approach development. Developing your ensure consumers receive information about the new approach should consist of an honest assessment and exciting product. of your team’s market research skills, establishing Step four is called data collection or survey elding. a budget, understanding your environment and its Generally data analysis is concerned with editing, inuencing factors and formulating hypotheses. coding and presenting collected raw materials into Safaricom has to nd an approach to counter the a form suitable for solving the research problem and problem they are facing, which is competition. A making decisions. The data collected from the test chosen team at Safaricom came up with a number of marketing research would include diagrams, sales, possible solutions and chose one that was eective. etc this would enable us to evaluate it and make the The rst solution would be to introduce lower call rates decision on whether to launch the product ocially in for subscribers and introduce a competition which only the whole of Kenya. 290 4 . 4 M A R K E T R E S E A R C H Step ve is the analysis of the collected information. threats of launching the product. In this case Safaricom Data presentations methods chosen should allow launched the iphone 3G as their research in this for easy interpretation of the research ndings by area was positive, however this was a test on a small the analyst. Use of char ts and diagrams make this group that may not eectively represent the whole possible as they can plot the data to show trends market behaviors. and relationships between variables. Test marketing Adapted from http://www.123helpme.com/marketing- provides rst hand information about the market and research--view.asp?id=166275 also revenues are collected during collection of data. For example the analyst can use a graph that shows Exam-style questions the trend of the sales to help in making decisions. 1. Outline two challenges that companies such Step six involves the market research repor t. The as Safaricom may face when carrying out repor t must provide the readers (sponsor) with the market research. [4 marks] information they require in a format they are able to understand and appreciate. Vocabulary, presentations, 2. Evaluate Safaricom’s strategies to overcome analysis methods used should match the readers competition. [8 marks] levels and demands. Also the repor t should contain Student workpoint 4.8 Be an inquirer out carries an out investigation market 1. What are 2. Does 3. Comment it the use primary qualitative on on research. the and or any In organization the process, secondary research quantitative sampling method of or your consider choice the following: methods research, methods or it that gnitekraM 4 Carry it uses? both? uses. rvso chcls ✓ Market research analysing ✓ Primary are ✓ the ✓ In in business data decision related research) which and market methods research to a making by particular secondary research include methods government Quantitative numerical analyses ✓ (eld ways research Secondary of in can surveys, collecting, market. research be (desk carried interviews, research) out. focus groups observations. articles, ✓ aids reporting research two Primary and and and research data as concerns compared interprets conducting market methods businesses accuracy while include publications data the to are maintaining market collection, qualitative about research use academic and it consumer is analysis research integrity in and the that offer and that opinions, important appropriate journals, media analyses. attitudes the a interpretation collects, data high research or beliefs. collection degree of process. 291 4 M A R K E T I N G Pcc quso Global In Brand 1984, which Professor consumer should market companies single global the is bank HSBC, tool Amazon in and advertising. decreasing to 50% of through gnitekraM 4 in the at a biggest variety at brand to brand brands is no a a 2005 by that in the operate consistent value world businesses accident in such in global as as impact. 20% by The using of the cable have mass media channels, replaced traditional advertising generation brands, value little with Coca-Cola, cut and TV and mass-market as just including traditional McDonalds, advertising are from 80% 2004. advertising The Korean brand gadgets the and into video electronics value sponsored Samsung use New McDonalds in through groups plan. huge online and It created successful value create hundreds increasingly budget gainer of into smaller children. entertainment which building gained to products. in had that worldwide. spending. shifted aimed and increased brands, marketing has often Samsung, have older technology world marketing traditional its Promotion lms, e-Bay, the split brands overall Even of have aimed Today, an in example, approach magazines increase message networks publications. one for that converging standardized biggest advertising TV specialist the argued were everywhere traditional over. Leavitt tastes globally with brands same The Values in 2005, movie, played a games and manufacturer, promoted “The its Fantastic brand Four”, part. [Source: adapted from Global Brands Business Week, July 2005 and Should Global Brands Trash Local Favourites? brandchannel.com] a) Examine the bankHSBC b) Evaluate advantages operating possible thatcompanies, toensurenew Using examples, explain media 292 2007 secondary of are can like of new the world. [ 6marks] research conduct effective in customers. marketing large rms the market McDonalds, impact the of around approaches the on brand and potential promotionalstrategies May and Coca-Cola and disadvantages single promotional andadvertising IB, and a primary like targetingexisting c) as [8 marks] [6 marks] technologies objectives corporations. and 4.5 The four Ps (product, price, promotion, place) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ draw a product life cycle and identify its various stages ➔ analyse the relationship between the product life cycle and the marketing mix ➔ examine and recommend various ex tension strategies that could be used by rms ➔ comment on the relationship between the product life cycle, investment, prot and cash ow ➔ evaluate an organization’s products using the Boston Consulting ➔ explain aspects of branding ➔ discuss the impor tance of branding ➔ examine the impor tance of packaging ➔ justify the appropriateness of using par ticular pricing strategies ➔ evaluate the impact of new technology on promotional strategies ➔ discuss guerrilla marketing and its eectiveness as an innovative gnitekraM 4 Group (BCG) Matrix. promotional method ➔ comment on the impor tance of place in the marketing mix ➔ examine the eectiveness of dierent types of distribution channel A product that or is is any offered to good the (tangible market item) with the or aim service of (intangible satisfying offering) consumer needs wants. th poduc lf cycl A product life development stages in their saturation, cycle to its life and shows decline cycle: in the the course that market. development, a product Most takes products introduction, go from its through growth, six maturity, decline. Stage 1: Development In 1. this stage the Generating of product ideas stakeholders help satisfy include others. – are employees, gaps that designed, this is a consulted consumer Conducting potential is needs may to come and in up wants. These the also series session with managers, research exist this brainstorming department market following steps: where anything a that stakeholders and helps of customers, in number may may among identifying any market. 293 4 M A R K E T I N G 2. Screening (poor product too 3. and ideas product a Carrying changes the A costing so the that test a the all At of this not rm are no the sales yet are well is rst the of a developed. product, ideas to (good while could give It or leave ideas). others trial allows especially customers sell to out Some may be could feedback by also that form for the be of a visualization production provided would help with if any and and after of making the representative or sales well, it of the can be the developed part of product. changed the At or necessary product market this are to stage, removed assess if the without much. the of – samples but – after a market the research money, sell prototype marketing too elements stage time, a of product, small product the – they demand does or which further necessary. the in deciding research practical group Commercialization of be others select out potential product not to produce. which are to launched 5. to prototype alterations 4. involves ones examination department. the this prototype from physical – which may expensive Creating or ideas ideas) successful takes marketing and effort is development no marketing, This will a full involve launch the use of mix. invested therefore test place. in prot costs are developing is very the experienced. high as product. Cash a lot There ow is also negative. gnitekraM 4 Stage 2: Introduction This is the because Costs that as the or is an used. be to is still may the yet are used Where increase and than it the there are low is could of the be cash especially is be likely prices or products, where there for are penetration charged long informative restricted low negative High competitors, could in highly ow inow. are existence. technological product, sold Sales product’s therefore the many prices market. the cash cellphones, or the of brand-new awareness products to Moreover, for or on aware high greater be strategy, high-income product not computers Expensive targeting the are protable. competitors. might effort of launch not outow personal no pricing In the is skimming example few in product cash stage consumers incurred the price launch most retail term. advertising outlets consumers. Key terms Price skimming Stage 3: Growth setting a high price when Once the product is well received by the market, the sales volumes introducing a new product to and so revenues start to increase signicantly. This translates to rising the market prots, of unit prices especially costs. that with Cash were the ow possibility now initially low of becomes economies positive. (through of After penetration scale a or lowering successful pricing) launch, can Penetration pricing now setting a low initial price for be increased to maximize prots. On the other hand, products that a product with the aim of started at high prices (through price skimming) can have their prices attracting a large number reduced slightly because of increased competition attracted by the prots. of customers quickly and Advertising becomes persuasive so as to convince consumers to buy more gaining a high market share products 294 and establish brand loyalty. A larger number of distribution 4 . 5 outlets are used to locations. To regarding product push maintain the T H E product consumer F O U R to and ( P R O D U C T, different demand, improvements P S P R I C E , consumers discussions in begin P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) various on issues developments. Stage 4: Maturity At this well stage positive little of sales established, cash growth these continue with ow. as role to maintain as range Plans on of new or competitors sales distribution product rms introducing (This is at do its entered at bay. growth so the and and market are strategies product at to an to is a brand has the high, take life but a with advantage are loyalty. A very established. stage, of is in reminding been advanced extend product resulting strategies assumes emphasize the The share prot pricing Promotion for slowly. market peak promotional developments further they signicant is outlets extension discussed but and have Competitive keep rise revenue competitors prots. to so to stable Sales preferred wide a with their some products. below.) Stage 5: Saturation Sales still of many are at competitors their positive. the stiff pricing market is Many and also use in consumers. Prots levels effort high have to has and market to to of fall. out extension outlets are the begin forced will use high an distribution and are Prices rms advertising geographical entered point businesses competition. share aggressive to Some used. have highest of be and the reduced, to promotional maintain mostly cash market strategies been saturated However, sales. so as a competitive activities established to is result stabilize The it. ow their such widest get the gnitekraM 4 Here, as range of products stable. Stage 6: Decline This of a stage signies product. product models sales may of a Promotional that are in have too steady lost drop cash its have appeal been in product activities are reduced protable to sell are sales begins the off is kept through fall of to slowly and any and, to eyes introduced the cases in ow low, most not the addition, product become lowered In but is consumers replace the withdrawn at existing this, still a prots because old from minimum. stock. the positive. model. the If market. Prices Distribution The new are outlets closed. selaS introduction growth maturity saturation decline Time Figure 4.5.1. The product life cycle. 295 4 M A R K E T I N G exso ss Extension by strategies lengthening at the Here maturity are some products’ They ● life sell They was nd They They For gnitekraM 4 in to of a As this determine on be sales demand life mere a the money on falling done cycle. extend They and/or example, of their might export the device uses, This and sell them. cellphone but including could colour persuade washing of now the offering helped include the them detergent has a be opened package to buy OMO® sustain to the has been demand for it to accounts a example based is on banks their customers for “Sheria” them – account s tr a teg i es . campa ig n s pr oducts, are ther e Fo r to by to its in may to having income with for various example appeal e xa m p le , e n c ou r ag e he lp in g have to to rm s c o n su m er s r e vi ve know efcient a where – it its one as videotape since well as of drop. product easy to businesses forecasting is based sales. on as part of its therefore its lie in be the resources. product would recorders Some success to always effects products declining mature always is. not begin external would example a future negative management terminally resources may introduced situation of long-term sales not product any products the and is However, on to life it unexpected have existing a obtained inuence this to cycle this. Moreover, the However, life results saturated extend starts. in may important becomes assist the marketing One open faith. better sales In on may accommodated special strategies strong it rm more of the i r rm’s that also p r o mo ti ona l exactly a segments. customers have recession money waste markets. For and which market market trends, for for Spending is p r o d uct. in strategy. for cycle the would products extension life to from This selaS the critical their have example, use country packaging. a d v e r tis ing using accurate. For sales services. the bank new forecasting may p r o d u c t ’s variety interest Muslim new where entirely new the decline predicting factors 296 as it a stop cycle. communication wider have and extension result, before use for business a of continue Essentially, a appearance, that Barclays create demand new product. basic times, banks beliefs develop could a example, different Some Kenya, They of to life time. customers ● into p r o d u c t ’s design, accounts religious firms businesses within online many target different stages the as consumers’ long levels. for much the the repackaged ● a other change stimulate a by p r o d u c t ’s methods regions uses has and product. the products other new changing for saturation common smartphone ● or introduced banking attempt cycles: in rst an extending existing products ● are or be today. is Time a spending Figure 4.5.2. Extension strategies in a product life cycle 4 . 5 T H E F O U R P S ( P R O D U C T, P R I C E , P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) Table 4.5.1. Summary of the relationship between the product life cycle and marketing mix strategies Strategies Introduction Product Growth Maturity Saturation Decline The basic product Product New product Extension Weak products are is marketed. improvements development is strategies are withdrawn from or new product at an advanced critical to maintain the market. development stage. Extension sales. plans star t. strategies are introduced in some cases. Price Cost-plus, Penetration prices Competitive or Competitive Price cuts are skimming or slightly increase. promotional pricing is used. made. penetration pricing is used. pricing is used. Promotion Informative Persuasive There is extensive Aggressive Adver tising is adver tising is adver tising is adver tising to adver tising is reduced to a used. used. remind customers carried out to minimum. of the product. emphasize the brand’s benets Selective or Intensive There is more The widest range There is selective restricted distribution or intensive of geographical distribution and distribution takes more distribution distribution or distribution unprotable place. outlets are used. a wide range outlets is used. outlets are of distribution gnitekraM 4 and dierences. Place eliminated. outlets. Table 4.5.2. Summary of the relationship between the product life cycle, investment, prot, and cash ow Product life Development Introduction Growth Maturity Saturation Decline Investment High research High costs on Average Lower costs Cost focus is Very low level and development promotion to high on promotion on extension costs on strategies promotion cycle stage costs costs on promotion Prot None Cash ow Negative None or Some prot High prot; High and Decreasing negative and rising reaches its mostly stable prot peak prot Positive Positive Negative but Positive Positive but improves with decreasing sales cash ow th Boso Cosul goup (BCg) Mx Product up a portfolio business. protable product A analysis business products portfolio and is a will phase analysis process want out method that to the evaluates invest more weaker was products resources ones. developed the A by very the into making its common management 297 4 M A R K E T I N G consulting rm Matrix the Matrix on the is has a captured high – the These of easily Cash in a mature to hold on gnitekraM 4 should as is in the growth and and However, rapid growth market a tha t a product matrix is new high need status slows high in competing customers. growth market generate they and where ha ve co mpr is e r e sult, g ener a te ha ve the rms With down, a a low mar ke t time, they gr owt h wel l -e s t abl is h ed bus i ne s se s The pr oduc t g ood wil l of pr e se n c e hi gh e r pr i c es p ro du c t s i nve s t sa l es a mo u nt stro n g sl ig htl y for prospects ar e l es s h i gh c as h f or and the in the to in c r ea s e mar ke t , th e ir to are to succeed. could be market Businesses problem should to increase growth children eliminated. Market share high or and little rm and Stars replaced. many may of be cash-ow if to competitive which ones with concern needed market ercely about which a wol with high a products are money they selective and share business. with faced very if in are They low markets the products strategy of the operating stars future be these sustaining be amount Moreover, These share. products markets the large are into marks. market growth. in low Businesses problems and growing for need the market. generate offer of low htworg tekraM income question and market market not or marketing are operate therefore they continue them. Figure 4.5.3. The BCG Matrix 298 rate axis. market, market growth–share market market sha r e . cha r ge products hard low declining may the attracting their The y a nd , develop These are the good think low They growth horizontal the BCG hgih in a have They that in the should Dogs. and The cows. ma r k et growth because that need that by and p r o d ucts children share mean ● of market business. their products the y market the product This in fast-growing are ev e n the share a much Boston margins. businesses they the can market their so high products for s ha r e . thei r how the on the Matrix . categories: sustain a share market. with cash mark e t As Problem and into protable high in These to businesses to mature market business. ● income market turn cows. prot products of gain four at as (BCG) measures attractive the successful products high in known Group that looks following are Group, market how share strength are and very shows especially these matrix relative investment eventually ● its They market, as rate amounts levels and market into share. can axis growth Stars. Consulting Consulting growth–share relative classied ● Boston Boston vertical Market while or Question marks 4 . 5 T H E F O U R P S ( P R O D U C T, P R I C E , P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) BCG Matrix strategies an the ● effort Holding market in ● to following the support strategy share, market. Some strategy products necessary portfolio be the – focus that this the here they so as which to be children, products needed be increase here be their turning ow. could on could focus cash is on cows the positive problem maintain will centres cash – cows, and dogs, used: on in a high position ensure problem invested These used to market is with current in sustained children into promoting or share. milking the products investing benets provide in the the other products. strategy or well sold in – this off. The boosting is where the resources the poor-performing freed performance up of from the this other dogs will are need products to in portfolio. product (nance (high a cash be investment strategy with out used the product nance, Divesting phased from the Harvesting of A – Building Money stars, could ensure demand. distributing ● to consumer stars. ● the strategies portfol i o tha t generator s ) market However, seriously a wi ll grow th) relativ e l y drain an y ha s a go od n u m ber e ffe cti ve ly pr od ucts , l a r ge for ca sh a ble to e xa m p le numb er p o s i ti ve be of of o w do gs s t a rs i n ves t in p ro bl e m and fr om and the c a sh the cows oth er c h il dr en . pr oble m b u s in e ss c h i ld re n if this is gnitekraM 4 In c an no t Key terms well checked. Product The limitations of the Boston Matrix any good or service that is oered to the market with the ● It focuses on the current market position of the rm’s products, with aim of satisfying consumer little advice or information for future planning. needs or wants ● It may be a time-consuming and complex exercise for businesses Product life cycle to dene market or classify their products according to market share and the course a product passes growth. from its development to its ● High market share does not necessarily equate to high prots. This is decline in the market because may sales have a revenue could downward be effect gained on a using rm’s competitive pricing that Ex tension strategies protability. plans by rms to stop sales from falling by lengthening Student workpoint 4.9 the product’s life cycle Be a thinker 1. Draw 2. Why 3. Discuss Boston Consulting Group the product life cycle and explain each of its Matrix stages. an analysis method of a rm’s are extension strategies important to a business? product por tfolio regarding BCG the signicance Matrix for a large of the varying business. product portfolio in the its market share and market growth 299 4 M A R K E T I N G Bd A brand may differentiates process add of value to consumers global brands among dened rm’s a a name, one view or from a product can or design a is another strong Examples Coca-Cola, that Branding from have product. Samsung, sign, competitors. Branding perceive Nike, symbol, its business’s product. include many as product distinguishing great how be a of the and can inuence on well-known Google, and KFC, others. Aspects of branding Brand awareness This refers to availability creating is it is awareness beverage ability rm’s awareness very will sell the showing awareness competitors more of a a major than to its very it of businesses related between the competitors’ is soft easily in sales market should rm’s with the their share by serve a A as product and product, take. product For and its brand example, in most high a In because available minds. can a greatest products. drinks recognized and existence promote products one product many the effectively step portrays higher amount recognize To promoting result, are image leads the is to service. Coca-Cola® the often or difference As there name consumers when little products. industry However, of good important usually competitors’ clearly a brand addition, there the of the in the market. consumers, level strong of brand indicator to commands. gnitekraM 4 Brand development This is any market. It plan is increasing a to improve way the of or strengthen enhancing power of its the name, the brand symbol, image of awareness or sign, a product of a in product ultimately the by leading Key terms to higher sales and in promotional to persuade market campaigns consumers to share. such Businesses as sales purchase may have promotions their products to and and invest more advertising Brand therefore a name, symbol, sign, or further develop their brands. Offering free samples is a common way design that dierentiates businesses producing consumables, such as Cadbury’s, use to provide an a rm’s product from its opportunity for consumers to taste or try their products in an effort to competitors, woo them to buy their brands. Branding Brand loyalty the process of distinguishing This is when consumers become committed to a rm’s brand and are willing one rm’s product from to make repeat purchases over time. Brand loyalty is a result of brand another preference, with brand brands, where loyalty despite consumers will the prefer consistently high prices of one brand purchase some over products products, another. from because Customers their they preferred feel Brand awareness the the ability of consumers to added value the brand carries justies its price. Successful businesses will recognize the existence and often employ a variety of marketing strategies to cultivate loyal customers. availability of a rm’s good or In so doing, these businesses develop brand ambassadors. These are service consumers it among who their will market colleagues, marketing by image reputation word of a particular friends, mouth, or which brand relatives. is very by talking They help effective in positively provide about free enhancing Brand loyalty the when consumers become and of a business. Samsung is a name that is establishing committed to a rm’s brand strong brand loyalty in the electronics industry and beneting signicantly and are willing to make repeat from consumer recommendations or marketing by word of mouth. purchases over time 300 4 . 5 T H E F O U R P S ( P R O D U C T, P R I C E , P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) Brand value This refers potential business have This is a coffee high One at much and make because brands. brand’s brand value its are would value value. of a a a Brand as value pay consumer coffee act as terms at a of of is its a high the another by reputation, extra assets café. values which to to a a a Brands business. obtain such higher-priced Such are a money name. price purchasing Brand code its brand considerable to business. and in because willing be of “personality” worth products are instead overall is regarded consumers example the a market from Starbucks increase a how income, can that of to brands an also expression particular brand The values associated with lives. Brand values are also those things that cause customers to buy Starbucks keep many customers a rm’s product rather than its competitor’s product. They help in coming back , even though differentiating a business and making it seem in some way special and cheaper alternatives are available better than at heart the its competitors. of successful Emphasizing a rm’s brand value is therefore branding. The impor tance of branding heavy known from For one and the work that to can audience be Businesses high the with minds for of consistently earn and high by most simple impact men to of its and not in As can because on a consistently provided been any is type the widely of business – companies. a clear business and the Despite brand try to it image grows, with it establish is critical expectations expectations of can its brand that of its the the target target sales. use the will the regular have of a for Initially, the decreased enabling the meets meet Consumers quality, marketers. that customers image, brands products of factor immediately. result brands giving business. does margins their essential market consumers. high tasks ensuring price skimming image associate businesses basis. For the such to as charge has brands make example, good-quality viewed or brand cars in with good sales Mercedes to the representing and Benz global good quality consumers. Moreover, services the in well-established about the well-known have and is that their prot BMW market an recognized bound prices is large, perceptions Branding is it the important required associate brandcomplements audience. most branding can customer it the recognized, start-up they on of investment start-ups, which so is initial gnitekraM 4 Branding customers based as on the choosing on may the not way make way the it judgments they right is are colour perceived particularly like for by their about presented a the gym certain to rm’s brand general being products them. can public. painted and Something have For a as massive example, pink. Key term A rm’s features provides brand to name prevent the can the product provide product with a legal being unique protection copied name by that to a product’s competitors. makes it specic Branding different Brand value from how much a brand is wor th its competitors, therefore enabling the business to have a sense of in terms of its reputation, ownership of its products. For example, companies such as Nike, Nestlé, potential income, and market and Toyota have been able to distinguish themselves well in their value respective industries. 301 4 M A R K E T I N G Effective branding can enable a sense of personal identication and TOK discussion emotional branding connection leaves on among potential consumers. customers. The If key the is the impression impression is that positive, the Is it possible to measure chances of having repeat customers are high. Good brands communicate brand loyalty? messages There is that a saying: Therefore, a good ensure to that “The succeed, brand their rst target customers impression businesses need is the to respond lasting use positively. impression.” enough resources to build reputation. The impor tance of packaging Key term Packaging container refers or marketing Together getting with important ● It It can right of a the in also spoilt production Packaging distinguishing other is critical. of the plays one elements of a signicant product the physical from marketing Packaging has the an role in other. mix right, following or provide protection. good concerns the design and production of the physical product damaged, a Packaging container or wrapper of a marketing: physical getting and product. in packaging functions must designing help getting provides from the wrapper and the to Packaging especially cover against protects during dust, a product transportation. direct light, or high temperatures. ● It offers the gnitekraM 4 ● It convenience. ability to provides relay reuse, ● item. It and regarding the can help Packages reduce ● It to the aids the is a great best 302 of impact for on their be used containers how companies on for product. can Food easy to to may use producing packages products. features product. can These help features deter can also help pilferage. package colour and the a brand graphic important in good should shape rm’s purchases where the it eye-catching the image product designs by be of of the from can potential supermarkets packaging package can is product. its appeal in This can competitors’. encourage buyers that and key impulse of a product. stock a wide create instant variety recognition product. the deal way majority product the of packages warnings risks The on make information tamper-proof attractive a contain security The dispose requirement with should consumer. these unplanned of labels the of projecting consumables, to easily provide differentiating especially rm’s to with of of that the and with or Considering the reduce risks in may legal alcohol promotion. help buying a package and The consumption consumer. Packages This be tampering reinforcing also products designed intentional recycle, information may cigarettes It good information . important Technological the A of the important of time designing packages packaging money and consumers their role and to is producing their have on plays spent a today, rms package products. the by Firms it is on that will should environment not surprising researching and attract also heed the consider growing Packaging fulls a variety of roles. Here it not only protects the product, but also provides nutritional information 4 . 5 environmental are under goods for concerns. pressure to consumers responsible For F O U R example, reduce and T H E the use instead go in of P S ( P R O D U C T, many plastic “green” countries bags by P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) supermarkets when using P R I C E , packing environmentally packaging. Price Price “P” of plays that the a marketing customers effort signicant generates to pay meet appropriate mix or role revenue are give their up in a marketing business. associated for with having marketing pricing the for strategies or new mix because essence, costs. using objectives, for In a Price good existing it is the other refers or businesses and the to the service. need to only aspects money In set an the products. Cost-plus pricing (mark-up pricing) the of the packets each it of it biscuits it as wishes cost it is sell would the For selling gain for or the out would It is a selling It ● is a that costs of price cost, the the product cost total a cost is of mark-up percentage it to to The number 10,000 calculate mark-up pricing to the producing method. how on First, (20,000/10,000). which cost sells. by wants US$2 prot, average that a a 50-per-cent cost-plus which is divided business get mark-up adding is the $1 (50 per mark-up to cent get price. and of a way business and the following add quick calculating good a the to mark-up Disadvantages simple method total and Advantages ● if and for The every the example, average refers product. unit packet use the it pricing) a US$20,000, work Finally, to per each would calculate US$2). US$3 the (mark-up producing produced. packet, Second, of rm is would would of a cost products much cost prot average of pricing average gnitekraM 4 Cost-plus It ● the product. to makes a to consider customer market value when needs setting prices. ensure covers fails or Since ● its competitors’ considered, prot. sales is if it higher a sets rm a than prices could selling its are not lose price that competitors’. Penetration pricing Setting large a low initial number of price for customers a product quickly with and the gaining aim of attracting a high market be used by a share Key term is known either new as penetration introducing markets with a new pricing. product existing This in an products. could existing This is a market strategy businesses or entering used in Cost-plus pricing mass refers to adding a mark-up to marketing. As a rm slowly. example, gains market share it also can start to raise its price the average cost of producing For IKEA is known to have entered the Chinese market a product by using this strategy. 303 4 M A R K E T I N G Disadvantages Advantages As ● the prices encouraged leads for to the are to high low, buy sales consumers the products volume and are Gaining ● and this market mean share the in high the sales costs of volume can production lead and to prices are Customers decreases increases low volume high too does prots, not necessarily especially where low. may quality if perceive the price is the product kept too to be of low. in Penetration ● stock sales business. ● The ● high achieving pricing is only suitable for use in turnover. markets as that are businesses very increase they risk losing seek lower-priced price their potential sensitive. prices over customers, products from Therefore, time who rival may rms. Price skimming Price new skimming products period high rm with prices can the are when gnitekraM 4 their and when rms market. objective of at such as as so as when usually high prot are products its that the as for high to a limited possible. the research use market, These where produce known in introducing used segments recoup companies and and sell price skimming before lowering time. Disadvantage Advantages Consumers ● is market to Apple, their prices a various prots introducing high strategy gaining Technological computers, over set This aimed short-run costs. initially prices is the usually obtain development phones to associate the high The ● high prices may Key terms price with a high-quality high-value product or and discourage an from some buying the consumers product. Psychological pricing enhanced brand image. when rms consider how Firms ● high are able revenues recovering to that their development obtain help initial pricing aects consumers’ in research perception of the value of their and products costs. Loss leader charging a low price for a product, usually below Psychological pricing its average cost, to attract Psychological pricing refers to when rms consider how pricing affects consumers to buy other consumers’ perception of the value of their products. It considers the higher-priced products psychological a high-priced On the other effect of product hand, pricing with rms on high may consumers. quality, reduce for their Consumers example prices may associate designer clothing. slightly to Price discrimination persuade charging dierent prices to consumers who may be looking for value for money. For example, they dierent groups of consumers may charge US$9.95 instead of US$10 for a given product – a strategy for the same product common 304 in most supermarkets that sell frequently purchased products. 4 . 5 T H E F O U R P S ( P R O D U C T, P R I C E , P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) Advantages and disadvantage of psychological pricing Disadvantages Advantages The ● psychological selling can for at a obtain a rm effect slightly large of lower Using ● price revenues selling in be large it numbers looks at such as US$9.99 inconvenient for Since or businesses quantities. ● prices US$199 that in for require their example may some whole transactions, transport consumers’ businesses. perceptions, that can many be it is a strategy suitably market applied in segments. The loss leader that average cost, strategy is strategy by will also charge refer to to attract selling buy compensate the for a some price product many other any low that for as customers. products at a higher-priced losses The below aim supermarkets with the view of use that products its this this customers and therefore Disadvantages selling number frequently of purchased a large products many benet Large loss usually leader. made. Businesses attract product, loss (protable) Advantages ● a a from Firms ● be may customers higher using accused this by undercutting and unfair strategy may competitors them business by gnitekraM 4 Businesses of using practices. overall prots. Businesses ● leaders as strategy may a to loss encourage consumers brand use promotional to instead competitors’ switch of to their buying the brands. Price discrimination Charging product different is referred discrimination has to to have charge the patterns in price This are a very should is a to we a of in a how changes that have This than in of be is consumers price price in have price. of First, rm very a the can in elastic same the business vary its prices Second, or elasticities in their product. other the price competitive. respond change price On a for effective sensitivities consumers the For satised. that not proportional consumers changes to means that different of groups discrimination. market have greater to different ability. measure say sensitive to price conditions prices result leads demanded, as certain higher as to price-setting consumers demand. prices If the the change quantity demand, hand, of buying if a i.e. they change 305 4 M A R K E T I N G in price leads to a less than proportional change in demand, we say Key terms that to consumers changes in have price. price For inelastic example, demand, sellers i.e. will they lower are the less prices sensitive of their Competitive pricing products if the demand is elastic as there is a possibility of getting separated to ensure higher charging a price that is in total revenue. Finally, the markets should be that the line with or just below the product is not easily traded. For example, the prices for children’s and competitors’ prices adults’ tickets may differ for the same music Disadvantages Advantages Time-based ● price discrimination benet or to prices During revenues, off-peak benet so times about For as high to a lower charge prices elastic charged. their producing products extra rms that with could lower lead and does were price they the of higher revenue. market, ensure certain consumers. market if be elasticity charging sales a to of demand addition, consumers lower of in elastic higher need type example, prices charge during the the demand peak generate while from of such companies and be consumers businesses phone Businesses ● can either producers. times concert. in to the should extra cost selling not In still of more exceed the revenue. gnitekraM 4 Competitive pricing Competitive consideration It involves of Charging driving also them known opposition, average the commonly the as a a It is of could lower the market in or and is If saturation successful, stages in prices, benet from especially competitive After using aims to prices prices. This product gain revenue higher 306 as the similar aim pricing , eliminate than any their subsequently strategy the is products are cycle. in the very markets. ● Predatory pricing is illegal in destroyer form competitive destroyer dominant or a higher a prices anti- many and countries pricing, it is used rms sales result of behaviour competition. could with can life the selling lower where because remaining product. below predatory businesses is ● it markets the just businesses as charging higher or competitors known competitive into their Disadvantages Consumers low the to takes for with because rms Advantages ● line than charge highly in is that charging applicable pricing include strategy are market production. used maturity that mostly destroyer of pricing price prices out and costs dominate in prices. is competitors charging competitors’ products. pricing what of charged. the to restrict 4 . 5 T H E F O U R P S ( P R O D U C T, P R I C E , P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) Student workpoint 4.10 Be knowledgeable 1. Analyse the 2. Examine importance the introducing most a of branding appropriate new product to for pricing the a start-up strategies business. needed when market. Pomoo products is to customers concerned consumers. or to communicated enable Some ● them creating of ● or its reminding existing of Promotion and a or of information promotion Promotional and provide is to about obtain activities useful a rm’s new should be information to product. include: informing consumers of a new or improved market persuading consumers the can ones. rm’s consumers competitors’ the aim consumers objectives customers enhancing image to purchase the communicating main existing awareness in convincing instead ● to promotional product ● retain clearly with The or brand of to purchase a rm’s products products the gain existence new image of of a customers the product for product as a in order to retain product well as the gnitekraM 4 Promotion corporate business. be categorized below-the-line into two forms: above-the-line promotion promotion. Above-the-line promotion This is a media paid to television, In this radio, case another form promote the of a or communication rm’s products. newspapers control or so that It as uses includes to responsibility reach of independent advertising a wide target advertising is mass through the audience. passed on to organization. Adver tising Advertising about a media for to a It as is the to It is market. be to – the price, focus or of want a information the successful right promotional follows: here is to provide specications of decisions introduce informative on Choosing awareness to and as other rational newspapers passing ensuring consumers’ make businesses in in in audience. categorized features, Examples advertisements discourage can them when globally target important increases enable useful role advertising product’s consumers. so central particular Advertising Informative about a a advertising campaign. ● plays product a advertising government a rm’s about new information to product what to product include buy. to classied campaigns to drink-driving. 307 4 M A R K E T I N G ● Persuasive advertising – this aims at convincing customers to buy TOK discussion one rm’s product consumers to instead think that of a they competitor’s really need product. the It product persuades and should buy Many adver tisements use it. It makes consumers make unplanned purchases for a product – an scientic knowledge. Why act known as impulse buying. It helps in enhancing a product’s do they do this and what brand image. For example, when advertising a slimming product, does this tell us about the rms may use pictures of how people looked before they took the hierarchy of dierent areas of product and how they look after they consumed the product – in this knowledge? ● case they that most show people Reassuring remind they chose examples main would that to of they buy it. the of of – very to the made rm’s t look like focus the is right product individual based on and on the idea that. existing purchasing promotional that customers, decisions they campaigns should are to when continue well-known strategy. advertising cinema, a want Coca-Cola’s this forms magazines, picture advertising them purchasing The the radio, media posters, include television, billboards, and the newspapers, Internet. Below-the-line promotion This is over a its form not depend can focus gnitekraM 4 those ● of the activities. use of interested below-the-line the marketing consumers. therefore of communication direct can save activities in this business to business media. on has direct Below-the-line consumers control promotion, they it does promotion know or on include: ensures refers the above-the-line products. eliminates the marketing, their promotion – It where Unlike independent promotional are Direct at on the who Forms of promotional that the the use of money. sending product is aimed intermediaries Direct mail, information which about directly and a is a form product Key terms through the method post include developers or via email. restaurants sending out Businesses sending their out that their catalogues. A commonly use this menus or property limitation of this Above-the-line promotion method a paid form of communication is that most consumers can regard the information as junk and not that uses independent mass pay any particular attention to it. media to promote a rm’s ● Personal through selling personal – this involves co nta ct. It the ma ke s sale u se of of a r m’s s al e s products pr od uc t re p re s en t a t ive s Below-the-line promotion and can be commonly done used or technically In these making personal this method whe n face the the s uch nee d pr od uc t s as to atte ntio n . i nvo lv ed r ea s su r e d Th e y A as can m aj or it It is su c h s pe c i a li z ed be de cis ion . co st te le ph on e . e xp e nsi ve wi ll p ur cha s ing be over pr od ucts indi v i d ua l ize d may or se l li ng cus to me r s right and to com p l e x cases, the fa ce as c ar s ma c hi n e ry. that th e n be t he y d is a dva nt a g e m ay be are g i ve n ex pe n si ve of a form of communication that gives a business direct control over its promotional activities so that it is not dependent on the use of independent media to Promotional mix retain a sales repr e s e nta ti ve te a m for this type of se l li n g, es pe c i al ly a balance of both aboveif they are also pa i d by co mmis si on. the-line and below-the-line ● Public relations – these are promotional activities aimed at methods used by a rm to enhancing the image of the business and its products. It includes suppor t its marketing goals the 308 use of publicity or sponsorships. For publicity purposes a 4 . 5 business would its a like event. club in rugby Sales may gain UK with the display sells the Free or food to an the P R O M O T I O N , could showcase Chelsea the it sponsorship, organization, sponsoring P L A C E ) media project Through sponsoring draw competition. to “BOGOF” can be excess a short-term or team football Kenya national or incentives boosting its provided sales. by a Examples to stock. It other can get is found when in offered draw stand a a to It is attention of commonly products also product, chance number of free) used such as is the such samples help and win used a a sales. can prize during free as offering encourage customers to as such in the festive customers. a promotional customers in free supermarkets can commonly used business the customers Giving outside one to arrangement the snacks. be is attractive buying. products new often life customers confectionary purchasing large one to often where is cellphone. they attract for impulse method a used selling a are location objective sessions after This (buy be the particular where product’s at and provided coupons magazines. can gifts taste – The when attract used discounts buying for Competitions seasons – encourage free when sachets a are increasing main chocolates, through of The and offers enter of displays items. charger free these products supermarkets sweets, ■ – aim leaets, of consumers ■ invites business them. support Samsung it P R I C E , responsibility the for Airways purchased. Point-of-sale ■ process, nancial where social publicity Kenya coupons is newspapers, by a ( P R O D U C T, following: product or the include and the Money-off ■ In conference about free provide promotions include a press launch. and Examples the a P S team. business ■ hold information to products business or ● could provides F O U R gnitekraM 4 and T H E or assist maturity in or strategy that eliminating saturation stages cycle. The promotional mix A successful the-line using and an selling, appropriate of ● Cost: a product certain Legal Does the ● Target aimed involve advertising, public will good sales relations customers factors a or need balance methods. This promotions, when supporting to be of both could above- involve personal communicating a rm’s considered the marketing for an effective marketing on budget support the use of a particular method? framework: deciding of and to will promotional mix: promotional ● mix marketing, However, promotional mix below-the-line direct advantages goals. promotional the Has various market: What the law been promotional specic taken into methods segment of the to account when use? market is the product at? 309 4 M A R K E T I N G ● Stage be ● in most Type of of the will to product product: product Businesses when the appropriate will to succeed be in and cycle: Which the different Has the promotional how therefore designing need and life at it would need to developing exible and achieving life cycle method the necessary marketing sold above promotional methods to tweak the nature customers? questions mix. carefully Moreover, the will stages? considered successfully consider their where their be promotional product they promotional mix objectives. th mpc of w choloy o pomool ss In the or tools marketing context, required technology has to sell changed incorporating it terminologies being media Social Social gnitekraM 4 include of social social service today and explored dened dened as service. Over marketers strategy. include viral the the are information the last technological networking, marketing. decade, increasingly Important social technology shared the is or The social impact of these on below. as is sharing, social and marketing content or places where where discovering, networks networking relations or include her consists social of services Internet. Social media build a links, over the service among backgrounds, network to rapidly used are good that connects individuals social people. interactions advertising Facebook, It is any chat. happen, information. Twitter, LinkedIn, MySpace. activities, or is technology rm’s (SMM), be where Examples or their networks which A will media medium and in marketing promotion a is people or a platform who, real-life are a variety of web-based marketing relationships, of repeat each build provide refers A user additional and (SMM) drive to example, connections. representation and for to social (often services. means the business, social share way and a networks interests, network prole), Most for users to technology attract new his social interact is used Key terms customers Social media marketing through of individuals gaining programs attention A usually and corporate because to website the it trafc centre or message or with efforts readers spreads to come company other attention on encourages appears brand sharing from from itself. to to through create share user a individuals. to it Basically, social content with user trusted, SMM media that their and is the process sites. SMM networks. source, promotion resonates as the use of technology to build relationships, drive repeat attracts social presumably third-party SMM is opposed business, and attract new customers by individuals sharing with other individuals through Viral marketing word of mouth powered by technology. a form of peer-to-peer Viral marketing is a form of peer-to-peer communication where communication where individuals are encouraged their networks. to pass on promotional messages within individuals are encouraged social Not so long ago, advertisements were mostly seen to pass on promotional in newspapers, of the magazines, or television. However, with the advent messages within their social Internet things have changed. Today, advertisements appear as networks banners, 310 pop-up advertisements, social media, and YouTube videos. 4 . 5 Advertisements ads”, is especially known The as main through viral is Often, more of or Another a of viral the videos millions marketing is process, videos in P S of ( P R O D U C T, are often views, and P R I C E , called are P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) “viral part of what campaign. promotion comes F O U R YouTube gather viral-like viral like often form they marketing objective therefore images, the replicating computers. which a in when T H E are to spread through form of increase like the through word of videos, brand spread of sharing mouth. but awareness a also virus by Viral in in viewers, marketing games, software, messages. key that appeal that can goal to of their easily viral marketing target spread market through is to with create high infectious, social viral networking messages potential individuals. The benets of new technology on promotional strategies general marketing ● Wide more advantages are as reach sites such social ● a as media rm in can like Brand not like can and it – and viral buying – less more to social useful the and out level. social where other This customers rm’s to A large networking time a are than sense networking, spent in kind what Engaging of paid community. SMM, opinion, that and offerings. any of stakeholders means facing and measurable public key also product valuable valuable feedback, uses and viewers. create reach email. customers about to interactive YouTube, on challenges be – and passive helps rms and population spent cases, than what viral data brand on trends, activity, and habits. using social expensive recognition due enhanced wide out total time most interaction, awareness a SMM, networking, than using SMM and traditional viral marketing methods such as advertising. especially Speed in rather do savings television ● – enabled Twitter, exceeds dialogue relatively networking, personal Internet’s provide customers’ social has more information consumer ● far and marketing Cost a Facebook, research Market using Internet at the nd ongoing market is the participants they ● of Engagement are ● – consumers percentage of follows: gnitekraM 4 The of to – the repeat particular brand brands, and can spreading increase leading to of information, consumers’ brand loyalty and an image. coupled audience sharing exposure, with in a high short Internet space of speed, advertisements can reach time. The limitations of new technology on promotional strategies Despite have ● their the benets, following Accessibility areas with networking, Internet campaign SMM, and viral marketing drawbacks: problems poor promotional social general – regions with connectivity, that uses these no will computers miss out on or Internet, any ongoing tools. 311 4 M A R K E T I N G Distraction ● – time-wasting other – these information. of social not Despite not pop-ups by in advertising customers and in negative the individuals lurkers, online helping in these who TopRank effects benets attract to are their active importantly, business are users honed be these marketing, most of According media quite may use annoying who can be want viewed to focus as on issues. Lurkers ● the and while social a of new tight are These absorb Blog, 34 newcomers are its per who individuals cent have who product. networking, outweigh provide and Marketing promote ways technologies sit others skills. rm social many just Online SMM, the great and viral drawbacks ways to and, drive repeat customers. gull m Levinson and marketing that help market, uses Lautenslager form which companies even with weaken limited unconventional promotional marketing strategies term guerrilla gnitekraM 4 terminology. by Mao-Tse Guerrilla highly The It in differences summarized in the where marketing efcient the “hit you activities capturing between table is guerrilla of rivals half and the and that successfully marketing have budget from run” if are stay an spent as a activities on the therefore innovative on and “traditional” objective. coined hit marketing “untraditional” Guerrilla strategies at same marketing adapts Tung, their use resources. effect for dene the marketing signicant The (2009) involves you military guerrilla can win eye-catching customers’ traditional and and warfare-related warfare but and run tactics if you surprising used cannot. and so attention. guerrilla marketing are 4.5.3. Table 4.5.3. Dierences between traditional and guerrilla marketing Traditional marketing Guerilla marketing The primary investment is money. The primary investments are time, eor t, and creativity. It forms a model for big businesses. It focuses on small businesses. Success is measured by sales. Success is measured by prots. What can I take from the customer? What can I give to the customer? Mass media (direct mail, radio, television, newspapers) are Marketing weapons are numerous and most are free. used. Adver tising works. Types of non-traditional marketing succeed. How much money do you have at the end? How many relationships do you have at the end? Source: Based on Levinson, J.C. and Lautenslager, A. (2009) Guerilla Marketing in 30 Days, second edition. Entrepreneur Press. Irvine, CA . Key term Principles of guerrilla marketing Guerrilla marketing The following principles characterize guerrilla marketing. They can be a low-cost unconventional remembered using the acronym “APENS”. marketing strategy that has ● Activity – rms opportunities should 312 seek need that ways to exist of have to doing an make this awareness their when of products an the an innovative and signicant available known opportunity and they presents itself. promotional eect ● Presence known – to discussion ● Energy day is – an rms the boards, businesses Networks and ● focus Smart – used – for ways could be magazine, need to businesses building rms the look F O U R to note market P S to ( P R O D U C T, make through street that their their email, posters, every P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) business forums, grafti, contact company. P R I C E , This and is and so on. every known as marketing. on However, T H E This radio, opportunity 360-degrees ● should market. 4 . 5 should some should ensure businesses controversy be on the lookout for new contacts relationships. to that have create they do not deliberately offend customers. offended customers and awareness. Methods used in guerrilla marketing Peer marketing together ● Product ● SMS ● Roach as texting and baiting normal bringing up Intrigue ● Live – as with the free similar interests or ages product demonstrations and consultations messaging buzz to marketing create – where interest, actors are controversy, used or to behave curiosity in a service the process commercials such in including video and people interest customers or ● Bill – build give-aways product ● to clubs stickers and – an – of generating using people to mystery do live to engage customers commercials in key gnitekraM 4 ● places pubs approach used to promote DJs and club events The benets of guerrilla marketing ● Low cost nancial ● – Flexibility a result, the – the it Simplicity to ● Identied is – can of is be activities a very changed can involved low-cost easily respond to do way not of because require large marketing. it changing is small scale. conditions As and quickly. many target most efciency likely guerrilla of the customers. consumers “Speed Nike Mob”, with the tool For pairs via – the marketing activities product methods provides example, instant of Nike are simple progressed In campaign – 2005, to new it to were the can Burger increase ways In the and easy of at the market improves the returns. communicating communicate questions with called about participant to new answer the round. used in This competition sent King sales to a rst nal be targeted improves sought messages; be service. and messaging. participants can or campaign it opportunity audience. marketing – instant correctly Interaction buy marketing through products questions market to Communication with ● it implement. that ● so campaign circumstances ● types outlay, as a platform implemented Asian a countries. to interact guerrilla The 313 4 M A R K E T I N G campaign, designed consumers into by Ogilvy Burger RedCard, King’s aimed restaurants. For to attract more example, the company ™ printed “I BK” McDonald, and it put it signs Accessibility ● as on accessible customer ING metropolitan on – to large empty most For and placed footprints benches guerrilla customers base. solutions, T-shirts placed as Direct said guerrilla San statues “Gone to activities therefore promote Boston, on McDonald’s marketing to initiated of that possible, example, regions them from its Ronald Burger BK aim – marketing to be the online banking campaigns and King, Ronald”. increasing “Orange” Francisco, of to in the Washington DC. The negative eects of guerilla marketing Denting ● directed can is to evoke a the marketing Negative gnitekraM 4 to was a a – from a Despite by the – goal such to of some as fear highly are properly, they advertisements and anger, negative Overuse overall for places of a of attitudes fear-related effectiveness example, with high USA, from leaking was the of billboards trafc toilet the placed congestion in may from was the under it of threaten children, used toilet the the the in of clear movie. may It the that the Such psychology which used the cabin. door became date marketing public property, required. bus vandalism. irregular advertisement result of an in alone. guerrilla on an outside release to in image opened, necessarily problems or the shocking seen door not when of in giving stickers some For are addition action held not example, schedules In trespassing and in to to in private permission Singapore, indicate getting public on getting store locations permission places should from also be government. drawbacks, surprising, most in blood the the private act local their creative, use King an of does pitfalls owners, approved or theatre, cause owners Burger considered private to defacing property main lead strategies executed image. company. life movie, sticker may common placing the just inability property, marketing not emotions, example, when advertisement their the cause social Bill image was Other for Kill image it on movie realistic but brand may whole may highway However, adult, of a cabin. an the or accidents. the of since negative or guerrilla people decline. issues promote restroom is of – campaigns impact trafc Ethical ● of if of company’s attitudes brand to middle cause the range – group campaigns promotion the hurt marketing towards image wrong negative guerilla ● brand the seriously High ● the to and innovative the key characteristics efcient and make effective of guerrilla being untraditional, marketing promotional methods strategies one businesses TOK discussion can use. Instead marketing and marketing a of the talking traditional only about method the that concentrates business, through on “me” guerrilla What role do logic and emotion business encourages customers to consent willingly interaction to continue to play in marketing? Is there interact with it and aims for this over a period of room for both? time. 314 Gallagher (2004) summarizes it well by saying: “What matters in 4 . 5 guerrilla marketing is what the T H E rm F O U R does to P S ( P R O D U C T, differentiate P R I C E , itself P R O M O T I O N , from P L A C E ) its 1 rivals and its success in reaching a broader customer potential”. Student workpoint 4.11 Be a thinker 1. Distinguish between promotional 2. Using are a business having above-the-line and below-the-line strategies. an of your impact choice, on its evaluate promotional how new technologies strategies. Plc how is about the product distribution the right It ● is the is of refers any not of strategies includes Distribution in only the to reaches to make getting is a consumers. it the crucial available right It is to product element in concerned with consumers. The to place the the right marketing mix at for size. important location product distributed system time. businesses Place how the to marketing the location customers. get goods mix of for the Businesses from their the following business should present but reasons: also therefore location to to the develop the location of gnitekraM 4 Place consumers. It ● enables their The ● businesses products use of The ● to come and intermediaries businesses brand to efciently to store and up with the effectively such market as best to wholesalers their ways to distribute consumers. products and and retailers helps enhance their image. growing reach a global wide use range of of the Internet consumers is making directly it with easier their for businesses products. Types of distribution channel A distribution product make use agents, the from of and channel the or channel producer to intermediaries. retailers consumer. The that lie common the of distribution consumer. These are in product’s the middle distribution is Some the people path such from channels path taken distribution are as the by a channels wholesalers, producer described to below. Zero intermediary channel This is where consumer. method. Other e-commerce. made a For via this product is example, examples In the sold directly agricultural include service the sector, from the products use airline of producer can mail ticket be sold order to the through catalogues bookings can also this and be method. 1 Gallagher, B. (2004) Guerilla marketing and branding. CA: Marketing Turkiye Press. Hamel, G. and Prahalad, C.K . (1996) Competing for the future. Harvard Business School Press. 315 4 M A R K E T I N G One intermediary channel This to it involves sell is the used products jewellery such as travel in use products where are of one from the such distribution producer is In to sell as Harvey to operating Examples retailers. Nakumatt intermediary the retailer expensive. through agents this the various the on include addition, such a for a retailer an agent In most large or where using scale expensive large cases and bookings, the are the furniture supermarket products, ight or consumer. selling household World as use also or chains of common channel. Two intermediaries channel In this case retailers, The two are intermediaries, used wholesalers intermediary particularly by are producers important between useful the when which to in sell this producer selling usually the channel and goods the over producer to and wholesalers the act as consumer. long and consumer. an This additional channel geographical is distances. consumer producer gnitekraM 4 producer producer include product agent retailer consumer wholesaler retailer consumer wholesaler retailer consumer Figure 4.5.4. Channels of distribution Table 4.5.4. Advantages and disadvantages of dierent distribution channels Distribution channel Ad vantages Zero intermediary It is low cost. channel It is fast. It is ideal for perishable products. Disad vantages Promotion is done by the producer, which could be time-consuming and expensive. The producer incurs all storage and delivery costs. The producer is the key decision-maker in the distribution process. One intermediary Promotion and customer service are done by As the retailer ’s prot mark-up is included channel the retailer. in the selling price, the product may be The costs of holding stock are incurred by the retailer. The retailer assists in selling the product at convenient places to consumers. The producer may not be aware of the promotional strategy used by the retailer. Two intermediaries The wholesaler incurs storage costs, therefore Two prot mark-ups could lead to a more channel reducing these costs for the producer. expensive product oered to consumers. The wholesaler breaks the bulk for the retailer by providing large quantities in smaller batches. This is an appropriate channel when selling over long distances. 316 expensive for consumers. This channel fur ther reduces the producer ’s responsibility for promoting products. 4 . 5 T H E F O U R P S ( P R O D U C T, P R I C E , P R O M O T I O N , Key term Student workpoint 4.12 Channel of distribution Be an inquirer Examine for each which of P L A C E ) distribution these channels are likely to be most the path taken by a product effective from the producer or industries: manufacturer to the nal ● clothing ● jewellery ● bakery. consumer Explain your answer. rvso chcls A product passes ✓ from its illustrates the six life introduction, decline market. Extension strategies are implemented product’s life cycle of The a by product children, BCG the Matrix cows or in an by life (BCG) growth at classifying that stop a a product maturity, maturity to or saturation rm’s sales from cycle. Matrix rate stages growth, the effort product’s Group market portfolio cash the the Consulting measures rm’s in lengthening Boston that cycle development, and falling ✓ cycle saturation stages ✓ life and the is a growth-share relative products market as matrix share stars, of a gnitekraM 4 ✓ problem dogs. strategies include harvesting, holding, building and divesting. ✓ Branding from a ✓ Packaging Price as using a of and with a distinguishing strong inuence one on business’s how product consumers perceive by marketing and mix to producing differentiate the physical one product container or the marketing business or and mix refers elements to the is essential money in customers generating give up for service. pricing strategies pricing, include price cost plus skimming, pricing, penetration psychological pricing main aim is communicating It can be to obtain new information categorized as customers about either a or rm’s above retain existing products the line or to below line. Above the rm’s or the discrimination. consumers. the in designing competitive Promotion’s a has product. a good price ones by of for Appropriate pricing, ✓ and vital a one revenue ✓ is another wrapper ✓ concerned product. from ✓ is another line promotion products uses including independent advertising mass through media the to promote television, radio newspapers. 317 4 M A R K E T I N G ✓ Below the line independent promotional are ✓ relations their and are marketing strategy. is a attracting viral on ✓ in Marketers which way new of has sales great e.g. they the use of control know or marketing, within low innovative cost and technology include relationships, through messages a who on direct direct incorporating strategies peer-to-peer is their on those who personal selling, promotions. building uses depend consumers These marketing a to not focus products customers promotional that does rm’s increasingly marketing Guerrilla and activities interested public promotion media social Social driving media repeat sites. communication their social their In marketing business and addition, where people pass networks. unconventional signicant in media marketing promotional strategy effect on a business. ✓ Place to right ✓ is about consumers a rm’s getting product the right is distributed product at the to make right it place available at time. Distribution channels intermediary gnitekraM 4 318 how by channel include and zero two intermediary intermediaries channel, channel. one the 4 . 5 T H E F O U R P S ( P R O D U C T, P R I C E , P R O M O T I O N , P L A C E ) Pcc quso The Q-Drum: problem endure for solution: Hendriske. rights) Even 13 for a plastic long the the as Q-Drum, of Q-Drum daily, represents become entrepreneurs. do pair of innovators target the However, has only those Polak, and who a) b) to the that innovation (ii) distribution the in c) Analyse two research planet’s d) Discuss of the an worldwide heavy water Hans and Piet (intellectual property only in a 000 the doughnut-shaped recent km in in billion solar test, 20 one family months, it 10 At be can market a and poor the develop house. products importance rights) why for innovation, the found, price sales sponsored by development of issues of still obtaining the a Hendriske “innovators products per appropriate Q-Drum. need Why that is the more will the the Q-Drum too high cheaply remain United for and low. A Nations Q-Drum, but the remain. terms: develop 10 farmers world cent?”. US$50 marketing in that and target needs mix to [2 marks] [6 marks] [6 marks] [9 marks] only of cent”. marketing marks] patent designers the [2 brothers Q-Drum. reasons of providing innovation”, US$100 manufactured be (NGO) and and per life-saving far. can and helping customers light research and so thinking organization richest channels the In channels. the richest patent water 12 “A US$10 Until property and a signicant role producing of an added, hundred following (intellectual children water. runs organization (i) Explain and Innovation” unstable, brothers a ground. revolution simplicity with by travelling planet’s most. help know Dene He distribution offered brothers its it non-government has the several need approprate a litres the designers of despite open, obtained 50 who eyeglasses, needs sold to along Dr US$2 women and Q-Drum. up rolls claimed a of invented transportable Paul Thinking carrying have the pull it Q-Drum litres Millions labour brothers can in distances. producing child 000 “The obvious. The drum used 120 Revolution backbreaking containers The is “A gnitekraM 4 The increase the sales Source: http://ecoscraps.com/ IB, May 2010 les/2008/09/qdrum1.jpg, 20 October 2008 319 4.6 The ex tended marketing mix of seven Ps (HL only) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: discuss the impor tance of employee–customer relationships in ➔ the marketing mix of a ser vice and the cultural variation in these relationships evaluate the impor tance of deli very processes in the marketing mix ➔ of a ser vice and changes in these processes examine the impor tance of tangible physical evidence in the ➔ marketing mix of a ser vice apply the seven Ps model in a ser vice-based market . ➔ Popl Interestingly, of the gnitekraM 4 businesses basis. with A the who rm’s the wrong the skills think in to and was off of are they recruit, getting rst in the an on to and job, retain is right hiring people other people a the the to the crucial factor right carry the on regular people, aspect on the people of in specic any the bus they Successful out a best present people, bus”. elements in decision-making the on the the important “got seats right hard hire, do After right the to that bus”. the very attention involved found the in work little abilities that people terms pay select, (2001) people right and essentially Collins companies “got businesses mix ability right business. best many marketing and then businesses tasks and 1 responsibilities. People are are the produced customer it. waiters serving staff can waited also Behind to in as dress they buy staff assess be the example, how brief such to meet right to be an effective a hosting soccer’s good and to to smile feed is. have on an Cup when back if the they service important there are many Collins, J. (2001) Good to Great: Why Some Companies Make the Leap… and Others Don’t. 320 role relationships. 1 HarperBusiness. London. to Examples customers goers customer World person businesses encourage service asking the skills, and Services specic so should cinema People of like, attitude, customer ticket. the needs they opportunity maintaining business. and courteous, questioning book service the people questionnaires or and as any moment, restaurants customers served queue to from have of same appropriately, delivery events the changed For Offering to to service key their providing long be element at usually times. help banks too experience play that all customers. include to at can People ensure appearance their important consumed experience consuming should most and people, who for Another that the service and for a be order waiter money between the who what Therefore, the business management (CRM), service, customer relationship. they are behave others in in differing It is of the same its motivate customer treat a customers’ the needs deal the way to close will addition, of or in most cases takes pay the relationship to deliver good employee– settings perceive may of and or dominate having a cultural foster a gap. sense teamworking organization’s also be strengthening need the relationship improving customers deliver of then employees can link cultural cultures the O N LY ) guards, you trained gap ( H L contractual employees this P S customers. in she Customer various S E V E N people that the O F behalf long-term of marketers dimensions the customer achieve workforce further he formation help to on After some the to restaurant, are a groups to work motivated In the with This to paid vital. staff with leading customers, cultural is Undoubtedly, employees. a the developing responsibility relationship. understand to employees the in security example, arrival, that includes opinions, Consequently, employees need get to M I X transactional completing role ensures in a For requested. consumer organization, and among will goals. the the organization. beliefs you go on consumed, Culture organization’s unity and the they and delivered form you you people’s important with. i.e. M A R K E T I N G chefs, customers. When you organizations faced people its money, which customer However, is that what the and engineers, greets you E X T E N D E D appropriately and service. serves for is is collect waiter and transaction. factor they there your service organization organization will managers, the important between the example ensure T H E to to seen the in how the employee– learn be able to how gnitekraM 4 4 . 6 and to satisfy the fully. Pocsss This refers to the procedures and policies pertaining an Key terms organization’s customers on product “how is easy provided it is to and do delivered. business” It with should a inform particular People organization. Call and in products when product, are well the staff who supermarkets customers functioning centre ready and more need to with pay it is not answer barcodes are urgent important do examples attention. to that get the customers’ are of The not recognized processes more process questions that are intangible the human capital in terms of not the skills, attitudes, and abilities necessary in the production right. of goods or the provision of services Process DHL, also for involves example, is how the known product for its fast is delivered and to efcient the consumer. delivery of parcels Processes or documents to facilitate security This as this. check also form and It on ensures required throughout. In prides also itself ensures documents that by on the the that before product sender, addition, the having is the utmost they care are receives is sent delivered maintaining sender right in systems taken to its by doing state quality tracking processes the procedures and policies a per taining to how an recipient. exact optimal a the or organization’s product is and standards number they provided and delivered can Physical evidence use for tracking delivery if the document’s path and enquiring about any delay necessary. in the tangible or visible touch points that are observable to At the outset, businesses need to dene clearly the shape their customers in a business processes will take so that all stakeholders are fully aware of what to 321 4 M A R K E T I N G do. For marketing businesses need requirements, among These ● ● are these customer some of measure is of prime A business customers effective, customer are ways taken to and a well a they ensuring business speed are number processes complaints, tackled loyalty the there including up and can a processes long that customer orders, way towards customers. improve delivery of identifying handling go repeat can the for of on its processes: products to customers importance. needs such to as provide paying easy over and the varied payment Internet, paying methods cash, or for paying credit. Provision ● If Any on be consider, handling others. developing to to the time of a after-sales customer services has to such spend as technical solving support problems reduces when using a product. Informing ● a customers restaurant However, ensuring consuming, which adds may to that complex, lack the how long customer the and right their process expensive, experience meal will take to be prepared in service. and is in place especially capital may for that be time- start-up larger businesses, businesses may have. Physcl vdc gnitekraM 4 This to refers to customers where service or testimonials, to ensure must For evidence example, their out The the staff it nature difcult for especially regarding to addition, buy. with a In service focusing on business to Physical on ensure remain prior that product of are to the a of the it is of for of should lead the the an in businesses quality well-groomed ambient in a lighting clean tangible service pay more and and aspects marketing. attention spacious schools, service the for to ofces clearly element, service money, to bringing however, being before position intangible service nature. offering offered, deciding new products Effectively will enable the market. enable service customers to of evidence. business the therefore purchasing a their of in public value a area, located may evaluate difcult aspects in with and products purchasing result, include classrooms physical to a evidence experience, school quality because ofces before recommendations As reception differentiator managers competitive and evidence observable service. equipped products testimonials good the trust. are tangible product customers’ on that offering adequate and private and points the customer with consumers tangible evidence offer, good element element the a than differentiating on based providing important well-designed teaching depend restaurant create an smell good-quality delivered is or well-organized a managers intangible makes To in touch businesses usually are of a visible touch, are staff, be or Unlike usually they music location. providing for that therefore Physical try, Examples pleasant prime can which well-dressed with tangible business. businesses throughout. and the a consumers it, need 322 all in customers offering. pass enhanced on to image to “see” Businesses others and what should about is also their increased sales. 4 . 6 T H E E X T E N D E D M A R K E T I N G M I X O F S E V E N P S ( H L O N LY ) th sv Ps modl svc-bsd m Product • design • technology • perceived usefulness • convenience of use • quality • packaging Price • brand utility People • skimming • accessories • employees • penetration • warranties • management • value based • organization culture • cost plus • customer ser vices • cost leadership • orientation Marketing Place • retail mix • wholesale Physical evidence • mail order • facilities • Internet • infrastructure • direct sales • ser vice delivery • peer to peer gnitekraM 4 • multi-channel Promotion • special offers Process • adver tisements • uniformity of offering • endorsements • ser vice delivery • user trials • ser vice consumption • campaigns • joint ventures TOK discussion The four Ps and seven Ps Figure 4.6.1. Summary of the seven Ps relevant to a business in the service sector frameworks suggest that providing intangible products marketing has four or seven aspects, all of which can Student workpoint 4.13 be described with a word that star ts with a “P ”. How Be an inquirer helpful are such analytical Choose a service-based industry of your choice. Evaluate how important frameworks to you as a people, processes and physical evidence are in its marketing strategy. knowledge-seeker? 323 4 M A R K E T I N G rvso chcls ✓ People comprise businesses attitude, skills organisation. organization ✓ its people Processes are inform particular Physical their at also customers relationship the element that appearance customer They between procedures product is customers all the and any times form due of a to as their on the ease of includes the visible they vital business and business have and role the pertaining delivered doing the are transactional policies provided service employees to the link in evidence to differentiator customers in service in a business marketing. touch and is face an of the between the long to the how that an consumer. with are important a the term consumer. business points so right organization. observable gnitekraM 4 324 and and essential ensure These organization’s ✓ an should 4 . 6 T H E E X T E N D E D M A R K E T I N G M I X O F S E V E N P S ( H L O N LY ) Pcc quso Fast Fast Eater Eater, until a 2000 fast had company’s biggest information Date of food on restaurant always made market) Fast company prot. started Eater’s Product a current to went From public 2000, decline. in sales The 1975 in and Europe following (the table gives portfolio: Market information Other information launch 1975 burger rolls 1975 fried potatoes 1995 2002 high market share but very protable, core beginning to fall, very low product but protability is sales growth beginning to fall high market share but very protable, core beginning to fall, very low product but protability is sales growth falling rapidly toasted bacon high market share, low very successful product sandwich market growth chicken roll falling sales, low market not a commercial success share in a low growth market 2002 cheese and falling sales, low market tomato pizza share in a low growth not a commercial success During year. Fast the Eater was customers towards Fast the 1990s, However, is market. rivals. In food Newly Fast opened restaurants existing proposing competitors. Eater stores worldwide at the rate of 250 a 2004 closing into healthier Eater Fast by gnitekraM 4 market is concentrating the of a health-food caught economic analysts in a new downturn in of its attracting the are war major that to trend and cater becoming with more the chain product stores marketing on suggest popularity introduction established is and Industry affecting the Eater addition, outlets. so for major aggressive markets is affecting demand. a) Explain in b) (i) (ii) c) what Use the Fast Eater’s meant Ansoff Use the Fast Eater’s Suggest a Nov past Boston new marketing IB, is by the “company went public 1975”. mix Matrix and to identify current Consulting product product (7Ps) to and growth Group Fast Eater support Matrix and your marks] [4 marks] [6 marks] [8 marks] explain strategies. to analyse portfolio. for [2 devise chosen a product. 2005 325 4.7 International marketing (HL only) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ explain the methods of entry into international markets ➔ examine the oppor tunities and threats posed by entry into international markets ➔ discuss the strategic and operational implications of international marketing ➔ evaluate the role of cultural dierences in international marketing ➔ discuss the implications of globalization for international marketing. International across to another gnitekraM 4 in to approach also international known to the marketing products global market marketing marketing competition, Unlike approach international their refers boundaries: country. standardized in marketing national rms to as from one marketing, their have other goods where products the of country in globalization, rms other exibility countries. to the main services marketed use a countries, differ Increasing is and are in worldwide cause of the rise marketing. Mhods of y o ol ms A method through Firms can Some are ● The or of entry business employ Internet – businesses to market costs Internet, this also exporting own A the the are enter market is a international international known are in being marketing using as increasingly because increasingly current The other home common its by can the of its set their Internet marketing as channel market. markets. will using global up to an New advantage abroad. additional Trading be the reach. take products methods. e-commerce , be main form of and involves to indirect another home directly market here its is operations hiring market distribution overseas. both to advantage products hand, done commits country existing used product this country over already are – a behalf. control in an channel over explored the further in unit. Exporting on are products involved their into to businesses their businesses enhance international strategies many Internet low an entry below: to the into gains various considered Existing 326 a Internet of ● mode which the an that channels export is of indirectly. the abroad. domestic exporting country and product business Indirect business on trying to its exporting, or product domestic direct has intermediary rm’s piggybacking , one In abroad agent abroad. where business sell a new 4 . 7 ● Direct investment – which is also I N T E R N A T I O N A L known as foreign M A R K E T I N G ( H L O N LY ) direct Key terms investment, where One of benet a business investing in sets up production production plants in plants a abroad. foreign country International marketing is that a business gains access to the local market, making products the marketing of goods and easily available to customers. It also becomes well versed in local services across national market knowledge and is able to adapt its products accordingly to boundaries suit consumer route, needs including and wants. Coca-Cola, Many Nike, companies Samsung, and have followed this Toyota. Globalization ● Joint venture – this is a business arrangement where two or more the increasing worldwide parties agree to invest in a particular business project. These parties competition leading to a rise share their resources, with each being responsible for the costs, in international marketing prots, and losses independent incurred. business venture. For the venture However, interests example, in the the separate effort to participants from enter the have newly their formed international joint Piggybacking markets, the use of the existing joint Virgin Mobile India Limited, which is a cellphone distribution channels of one service provider company, was formed from Tata Tele service and domestic business by another Richard Branson’s Service Group. The company (joint venture) home country business trying makes use of Tata’s CDMA network to offer its services under the to sell a new product overseas ● Mobile brand International franchisor in another and country) and – one this exchange royalty. for to See a a use unit business grants its franchise Examples marketing Nandos. is country) permission as international Wimpy in in revenue an franchising business expertise sales as (a name. of for brand, fee and include more on franchisee a where (a trademark, businesses strategy 1 arrangement the concepts, percentage that have Ocean the business of used Basket, the this gnitekraM 4 Virgin Steers, franchising. Oppous of y o ol ms International for ● the A larger provides base. This in is the a greater enables also an a new reduces market case perceived domestic of to for to be its begin image more to its the means creates life which when in revenue global reach the than greater and an a benets new the market customer protability. existing the for countries. economic that or home product country is but afresh. opportunity an to increases sales cycle cycle other “successful” This products higher strategy sales such – gain an in opportunities following: company’s life gaining risks the products, provides on potential product investing key a extension of marketing market. its business this by brand international ● – dependence in Enhanced brand reach the market risks many include introducing stage Diversication their – offers These effective saturation spread ● owner. market This enters ● marketing business from just brought those to the home downturn. businesses brand businesses Diversication that about by involved operate prestige that can only can be in the drive loyalty. Gaining economies of scale – a operations through international abroad. a this As result, may business can marketing reduce the by increase selling average costs its scale more of of products production and 327 4 M A R K E T I N G so make the advantage ● Forming enable such a as new raw to who and can competitive. prot The mark-up new may provide compared therefore protability home can gaining prices for in can stakeholders, inputs, the opportunities take overseas various suppliers then higherprots. marketing with good to provide for – contacts business and relationships make materials, contacts its business suppliers efciency more increasing business example These business by for home for market. increased businesses. ths posd by y o ol ms There are source a of number major of external challenges for environmental businesses factors engaging in that can be a international marketing: ● Economic many market capita incomes to and buy Political gnitekraM 4 to the volatile and civil ● unrest example, the behaviour, marketers ● EU must of an of reap ● is this a disparity any benets. of gender factor to consider. Technological However, the to this countries. operate. in vital This, the for exist the of while – the can which is with have key anti-competitive protection or population in Europe African need of is the operate drastic a a aware are in a vital global a scale. number on in social has infrastructure impact to country Internet on lacking be they also for there countries to in present laws countries. population limited a that For consideration many still and International other use of terrorism East laws if the for risk examples. overseas. on threat due countries Middle accordingly growing coupled systems, a in global different Marketers businesses resource of countries markets of of demographic be great political consumer in a tendency the the market immigrants way easy some policies should the of have various composition the to exchange markets, threats are to population. of The standards. that population, in are number segment communication businesses a challenges in per- problems pose foreign awareness strict the countries number speed its to in Somalia they differences The planning instability product In lack Fluctuating increases countries rights younger or access developing – and and if adhere older growing increased 328 also may increased The for and property terms poor known marketers. increasing there by therefore arena. also heightened different different international is is challenges structures The with. abide advertising intellectual Social – to low regimes operate political Afghanistan need very pose political to regulations also trade challenges businesses and of the income wanting have marketed. also unstable willing of and of countries abroad. business. have should invasions Legal – change international businesses the nature to rates for countries power being market distribution problem developing interest to businesses governments inequitable major products challenges domestic the a purchasing the willing to doing or – pose Many differing businesses ● can overseas. income rates challenges countries of and how 4 . 7 I N T E R N A T I O N A L M A R K E T I N G ( H L O N LY ) th sc d opol mplcos fo ol m well-dened deciding on the the to vision, inspired cases to in changes. there the between a operating a rm’s as in necessary their in pursue to These a and and so Prahala d get on play A clear by motivated in some survive and arise. the major political For example, difference senior consider manager increasing manager operational the an needed key to may be down them cannot tactic. another an business to However, regarding international extent identify as in issue, the home which would the marketing aims important for various broader strategy expectations role strategy in and picture of providing its the implementation. stakeholder expectations a and groups evaluating of how to and their more businesses. ( 1 996 ) operati o ns , international given their their as laid economic may a priorities. resources carefully inuence global a it stakeholders and operate their as company while view and for need are keep stakeholders operational issue staff dream. rigid such crucial that will that managers an large understanding effectively Hamel to rms and may This very internal subsidiary clash support Successful on a in. environment issue is All objectives are between plan markets. fullling plans strategic depends stakeholders. power a and working between foreign ability effectively focus are headquarters result values, external strategic in operational towards conict share country clearly be and international strategic Conict may market they work long-term changes in mission, organization and A strategic operate gnitekraM 4 A sugg e s t the y env i r o nme nt ha ve a nd tha t , to for rms pe rc ei ve de v e lo p the to s u c c e ed ch a ng e s s t r at eg i es th a t in wi ll in the e n abl e 1 them to respond identication together marketing a management need need to so result is and required For rms (2000) in is a nd is to to r e mai n be three or n ee d ma r ke t s t ac t i c s . se r v ic e s n ot but Th e a to cl ea r Fo r h ave l e ar nin g . a re as a l so in as to a nd m a r ke t s I n no va t i on o nly Fi rm s dyna m ic a c h a l le n ge d is cip li n e ha ve i n du s t ri es , s u rvi va l . T he r efor e , a nd e a rl y in t e rn a t io n al o rg a ni z a t io n al v a ri a bl e , the a nd as terms d ri ve r pos e d c on du c t of of to t h or ou g h u n de r st a n di n g of wh a t co mpe t i t ive . successful key g l obal s tr ate g ie s . ha ve co nti nuous l y wanting for that re s pe c t ive b u si n e ss e s s tr a te g ie s g oo ds a r g ue e x ter n al e va l uat i on . compe titive they and the inte rnat i on a l ma rk eting to of emp ha si z e ma r k e ti ng ord e r mar ke t s imp or ta n t tha t mar k e te r s suggested the addition, a dva nta ge , imp r o v i ng research In a na ly si s and impo r ta nt internation a l market in mo ni to r i ng should international is fore s i g ht unde r s ta nd an developing better c ha ng e s tho r o ug h comp e ti ti ve constant change a a enviro nme nt, sustainable also of with a cco r di ng ly. in aspects international that rms markets, should Doole incorporate in to 2 their focus strategies. achieved markets, a First, they through strong a should have thorough competitive a clear knowledge positioning, and international of a the competitive international strategic perspective 1 Hamel, G and Prahalad, CK (1996) Competing for the Future. Harvard Business School Press. Boston, MA. 2 Doole, I. (2000) ‘How SMEs Learn to Compete Eectively on International Markets’, Ph.D. 329 4 M A R K E T I N G that is truly international. relationship a commitment customer a strategy to service well-managed of learning. levels of effective quality that are should and control to incorporate customer service and a and willing for Last but to learn their to a least, culture showed markets all effective not emphasize international procedures an relations, dedication markets. continuously innovative commitment monitoring and should strong international organization and they through products throughout Firms energy Second, achieved and high had international markets. The global business competitive external of the and factors environment only will remain opportunities is becoming organizations that that can competitive arise in more adapt and and to continue international more the changes taking in advantage markets. th ol of culul dcs ol m Culture that plays a recognize signicant the their products than businesses Language is meanings of a gnitekraM 4 words some cases audience. Koula” like “Kee Cola’s For model into it car against roles In United to Arab An Japan women tastes and consideration. chicken men more saw India, Businesses marketing advantage out of in women USA it in women by back as are invasion are another Hindu had to soap of to in use For “Nova” was go”. also be models would their be but in bodies showing France Pepsi was example, France a failed in privacy. important change religion sound because female this cover in “Kooke translated “no should countries. to name means However, successful an the brand society to Mist” “mist” in the translation. happiness”. “Silver and to like after Germany Grave.” expected Camay was and common conservative sounded however, wear. original offensive wax” the for translation, the even in Spanish is of priority pronunciation tastes Motors’ “nova” from or failed the understanding major process candle the “joyful McDonalds because on Pepsi” summer wife’s this work a initially of Rolls-Royce; the the Coca-Cola to and and in and be meanings confusing General preferences In burgers his in competitive globally mouthful Alive by advertisement washing are with because Emirates husband Local of a should because, means Alive advertise culture completely. as of is different had which Europe marketing. globally gaining culture China “dung”. Spain of contexts thirsty “Come means in bikinis the in later “Come meant differing wearing “a Keele” of words manufactured German considered. the means Company unsuccessful The example, Kou This totally translated campaign translated a the differences chance different given international not. component in in cultural better do marketers. are which Coca-Cola a that words international some stand key role varying does cultural their not beef allow burgers people to to The ‘Silver Mist’ was renamed consume beef. In Kenya, the Maasai are keen beef consumers. Serving ‘Silver Shadow’ to avoid an a Maasai household with sh would be considered inappropriate and awkward translation! might 330 even be offensive. 4 . 7 Ethics and banned in many but culture in other banned aged 21 anyone also Singapore in and 18 hand is countries. others. above aged go and the years hand. Smoking Alcohol in in viewed in For example, unethical; public is allowed is only however, above can in many consume M A R K E T I N G chewing however, consumption USA; and as I N T E R N A T I O N A L in it is African countries for O N LY ) is allowed some allowed gum ( H L adults CULTURE When businesses market their products and services across international boundaries, they need countries to understand each local market alcohol. individually. There are many other signicant cultural issues that businesses must Carry out more research on how consider, including symbols and colours used, that have a great impact culture inuences international on how they penetrate international markets. Awareness of all these marketing. Which cultural factors cultural elements is vital for success in international marketing. do you think have the strongest inuence on international marketing? Why? th mplcos of loblzo fo ol m international necessitated will need ● trade the to conducting mostly have the of it consider access had to larger one variety the and ● of other example they can wider of use and the the customer accused mostly of or the – low to rms local of the values, changing some labour. money to However, and As to a market some of especially of the inux of transferred are while the travelling, available as to consumer countries face anti- out UK, so to Yu, there. the While dish are in many provide demand. a On disappearing dishes. global signicant located had used ideas the appropriate have clothing have of an can Many in – once Safaricom Orange, have adapt westernized as businesses in growing this to that have as with liberalization such and Africa. cultural markets Firms public how popular South businesses businesses meet unethically, regard while compete the such had foods or Kenya, therefore choosing cost extra base. acting with has Businesses local to expectations their more Adidas, in foreign very in the market, giants beliefs, are in competition. driven is see operate advantages. Nike advantage by decisions produce marketing to to rms foreign campaigns domestic and widely have so members the curry traditional replaced of companies, globalization Deregulation cases another, products hand, of many provider) have are expect to subscriber among Indian led global the tastes which consumed food Location to has some unrest Businesses being which in that consumer is countries. in measures consumers importance marketing. implications marketing increased to growing multinational markets, power However, the marketing: cellphone country burger many of multinationals. also today. by international following domestic exports, operating US of aggressive causing Changing from to major Airtel. cultural growth use telecommunications with country, about globalization use has competitive ● – monopoly mobile and the foreign markets off the international enjoyed (a and increased Competition getting brought gnitekraM 4 Globalization, shoe companies, India result their these location and of in international China for to take their cost savings products and reach companies towards their have workers a been and overexploitation. 331 4 M A R K E T I N G ● Economies of scale – in the process of overseas expansion, TOK discussion businesses increased have been output. able This to has spread lowered their their xed costs average over costs of an production To what extent does the and increased the possibility of gaining higher prots. They have also Internet provide true value to gained better negotiation power with suppliers in their countries of the customer? operation. in the However, domestic government Undoubtedly, marketing. benets, A will to some context set that policies globalization rms in the of foreign they that has consideration assist of are act played the in a have even able their favour. major above making rms role factors, better to in grown inuence large the international including overseas so their marketing costs and decisions. Student workpoint 4.14 Be a thinker 1. Evaluate 2. Discuss the how benets culture and has problems inuenced of overseas current expansion. international marketing. rvso chcls ✓ International gnitekraM 4 one country differ the ✓ in their main Modes marketing to of It marketing causal entry exporting, is another. factor into direct the marketing provides approach to the rise to in international investment, of other and with and from exibility to Globalization is marketing. include ventures services the countries. international markets joint goods businesses the internet, international franchising. ✓ The opportunities share, the ✓ formation The threats social, ✓ Due to the external a a ✓ of in adapt will the their expectations, larger political, becoming strategies that role culture products the that location in suit of market scale and economic, the in do will competition, decisions changes to markets. cultural differences chance of gaining not. need changes and in take international better that businesses competitive, international varying a more continue plays stand businesses include to and arise recognize globalisation marketing include competitive than a economies challenges. opportunities signicant include image, relationships marketing their that marketing brand environment remain advantage of international 332 can marketing Implications and business businesses competitive business technological the of enhanced international and that result tastes international new global marketing, globally of factors advantage As of legal businesses ✓ of diversication, to in consider in consumer economies of scale. 4 . 7 I N T E R N A T I O N A L M A R K E T I N G ( H L O N LY ) Pcc quso In Blue 2007, market the between tickets were New respond Air New as also only 2 to the of for 11 the same Brett he Godfrey was before to also in offer the Air could New route . face accepted Australia and routes, Zealand Zealand that we By Blue have subject to the money Air has run pricing: in the government at A quick director these market . demand with Auckland New Zealand commented and uses that problems. a “we bank $29 Godfrey were Zealand satisfy utilization might $49 . between the crash”. sustain New could director penetration to ights of Brett leaders could contrast, capacity to on half executive prices day Zealand prices Almost market Blue enter per QANTAS Pacic about to New low website cutting company route . A our Pacic ights signicant condent more New popular Chief established strategy at Wellington . caused by the tickets hours . whether the entered 000 and the scheduled 7planes Blue 70 competitor whether most on almost long-run the Blue “It doubted questioned planes sell within QANTAS, new its Pacic to online Wellington, Pacic offer Christchurch and Zealand part airline surprise: Zealand of She cost initial booked his to prices an Auckland, expressed Air low with loss to approval initially, have done survive and the but this and hope support of public.” and QANTAS promised to remain competitive. gnitekraM 4 Pacic [Source: adapted from The Age, 4 September 2007] a) b) Dene following (i) market (ii) penetration Explain could c) the leader two have Examine pricing. other Evaluate which two two Pacic market IB, May marketing strategies that Pacic marks] [2 marks] [ 6marks] problems that Pacic Blue could face when pricing potential Blue [2 Blue used. usingpenetration d) terms: could [6marks] opportunities face when and two entering potential into a new threats international [9 marks] 2009 333 4.8 E-commerce By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ describe the features of e-commerce ➔ analyse the eects of changing technology and e-commerce on the marketing mix ➔ distinguish between the three types of e-commerce ➔ discuss the costs and benets of e-commerce to rms and consumers. E-commerce through involves electronic the buying networks, and selling commonly via of goods the and services Internet. th fus of -commc ● Ubiquity – accessible 7days gnitekraM 4 ● Customization how Global ● text – many Integration and – they reach traverses ● Internet home, at is widely work, or in available hotels at for any 24 time. hours It can each be day, aweek. decide ● the at – will also be the known as to the allows deliver standards personalize other their messages individuals worldwide web, or the and groups. Internet boundaries. Internet to can delivered national messages Universal individuals – a the combined marketing there is only use of audio, video, message. one set of Internet standards globally. th cs of ch choloy d -commc o h m mx Technological advancements smartphones, and business ● transactions Product. to a to stock With wider a wide to higher Dell online their needs ● of Price. the base range sales a of and is use businesses ever products product increased impact to to view This of on meet use can delivered as This Amazon also demand, to today which a greater according to in mix: can allows websites customize lead iPads®, marketing Interactive and of e-commerce the such before. protability. specications. the the growing great than customers sell them could such product as to customer the individual consumer. Consumers websites 334 as had as the e-commerce, allow own satisfaction such and have customer lead suit laptops, such as can now “Google make product easy price search” comparisons that can search using for price 4 . 8 information for competitive has also led to manufacturer costs for them. global the to They prices can increased c o n s u m e r, producers and therefore leading to use of which made good a get direct has access savings. affordable most approach reduce products the E-commerce selling helped to E - C O M M E R C E from distribution available to consumers. Promotion. ● businesses E-commerce using supplementing advertising. and of viral of promote of audio, their video, campaign is Feedback bound from businesses to be For has to more ways images, in the with spread promotional the can use consumer. further specic need retailer in the world the combined of Amazon is currently the largest online businesses a surveys the banners, a eyes customers’ reduced for for now online E-commerce, online their with are cost-effective through picture denitely methods multiple effective medium businesses advertisements, before. through products E-commerce or additional and example, more consumers faster ever messages, to tailor a pop-up provides products. text of to than tools, an Many promotional use led material technological to Place. has provided promotion. current increased marketing promotional help ● their The has traditional help needs. for gLOBaLiZatiOn intermediaries savings for in the chain manufacturers of of distribution. various This products. has led to However, cost the In 2013, the clothing retailer ASOS role launched new websites for Russia of these intermediaries in the marketing process should not be and China and eBay produced disregarded. For example, the personal appeal retailers provide to a new mobile app especially for is lost by trading over the Internet, which is impersonal. gnitekraM 4 consumers shoppers in Brazil. On the other hand, the Internet has made it more convenient Do research on how globalization for consumers to buy products – they no longer have to visit the is inuencing e-commerce today retail outlets. Customers searching for products from various and vice versa. Can you think of global locations will benet from the many language translation any limitations of e-commerce in applications available on websites, which they can download to their fostering globalization? technological tools to aid them in their purchasing decisions. typs of -commc E-commerce can be categorized Business-to-business trades sold with from another one transacting usually used. most cases, will the auto main Business business to to consumer. to B2B a volume be particular These Consumer transactions to a type Goods of and another. or following This component and e-commerce services wholesalers transactions are could with involved are parts purchased types. an where bought involve retailers in B2B example such separately as a producers in a chain businesses of how batteries, from business and other of is B2B tyres, is and dealers by manufacturer. consumer and is the manufacturers vehicle sourced (B2C) end is user transactions transactions. Priceline, of Automobile windows to wholesalers The large. In organization with distribution. (B2B) business. into are Successful e-commerce who is more B2C carried usually visible the to businesses out from customer the public include a or compared Amazon, eBay, Google. consumer from one (C2C) customer refers to to e-commerce another. C2C that businesses allows for provide 335 4 M A R K E T I N G opportunities for in addition selling individuals of businesses to interact and exchange with one another Key terms to that or t buying well into products these to or criteria from are each eBay other. and Examples Craigslist. E-commerce the buying and selling of The benets of e-commerce to rms goods and services through ● Firms can reach a wide target market in an effort to market and sell the internet. their products, resulting in an increased customer base. Business to business (B2B) ● It is a more product cost-effective compared to method other to means use such in as advertising television a rm’s a type of e-commerce where a advertising. business trades with another ● Social networking companies such as Facebook have beneted from business. high advertising revenue by selling their high-valued space. Business to consumer (B2C) ● Reduced wastage consumers instead of view on is noted instructions, waiting newspapers. paper This to be helps sent to by news, or relatively cut costs rms that insist information expensive for that on the a type of e-commerce carried web brochures out from a business to a or par ticular end user who is businesses. usually the customer or consumer. The benets of e-commerce to consumers ● It is in convenient the comfort for of consumers their because location they without can having trade to on visit a the Internet Consumer to consumer (C2C) shop a type of e-commerce that physically. allows for transactions from ● Increased gnitekraM 4 easily make deciding ● Good to make them deliver online to is also a comparisons online makes that choice a customer the service For documents the of advantage various for consumers. products on They offer one customer or consumer to can another. before purchase. happy. check key increases example, provide customers’ delivery tracking whereabouts of numbers their satisfaction companies to such as and Fedex customers to use documents. The costs of e-commerce to rms ● Concerns payment ● by process Businesses online consumers may spend fraud by about lower the signicant Internet Internet sales security and regarding growth sums trying to nd criminals trying to gain the potential measures access to for to rms. curb customers’ accounts. ● Firms may product ● Setting for be vulnerable details up many high-risk and and to competitors business maintaining businesses, who can gain access to their information. a website especially can start-ups, prove and to may be expensive turn out to be a venture. The costs of e-commerce to consumers ● Consumers before on ● a 336 buying chair Online major may not them. before pop-up have For buying the ability example, and try many or feel certain consumers products would like to sit it. advertisements distractions to and advertising time-wasters by spam consumers. are considered 4 . 8 ● In some countries, smartphones a ● problem When looking so consumers access the experienced sometimes and to for faced they to too lack using much using tools Poor consumers information with resort by may Internet. in a some search information other such Internet means of as computers connectivity E - C O M M E R C E or is also locations. engine, consumers (information getting the are overload) product. Student workpoint 4.15 Be an inquirer Examine how strategies of e-commerce is currently inuencing the marketing businesses. rvso chcls ✓ E-commerce is the buying and selling of goods and services via the internet. Common global ✓ reach, due the and place The categories where (B2C) ✓ on a in which consumer to try of is one mix in ubiquity, customisation, standards. technology elements e-commerce trades carried to or and security out universal advancements with from consumer customer e-commerce effectiveness and include of has product, had price, a great promotion businesses. Consumer internet to business of e-commerce marketing and Benets of integration E-commerce impact ✓ features include; another a business (C2C) to product include before to which a to business Business customer allows or to (B2B) consumer consumer transactions from another. convenience concerns, Business business, gnitekraM 4 ✓ a wider while increased purchasing market costs of reach, cost e-commerce competition and a are lack of ability it. 337 4 M A R K E T I N G Pcc quso Peace Peace that Frogs Frogs are and product a branded cycle, with products other its the the In The PF gnitekraM 4 A species “peace are Peace PF and accessories specializes to made in hats, meets multi-coloured the world. because peace reached the and, in frog other items, is some maturity or swimsuits, organic rigorous using refuses children of in the always frog”. without company for selling introduced cotton sale around Frogs shorts sweatshirts, The the from symbol the shifted and has its has had of among frogs PF b) Explain c) Analyse PF’s two nancial At of to that do cotton chemicals not stickers, organic purchase PF benets retail of theme using parks the is present, their and T-shirts to certication harmful clothing maintain in the a decline several to as 11 vans around van natural which from rigorous the retail in the species habitat several strengthens American that is of the two ethical methods PF’s the 2012 importance and role of country. Drivers store. number frogs main of face threat for committed [2 marks] [6 marks] [5 marks] [7 marks] distribution product. Discuss states. to brand. behaviour. of drive organizations e-commerce. practices of stores multi-coloured contributions protection, ways the own environmentalists features two and products, destruction makes Identify May concerts worldwide. The a) IB, As company environmental d) 338 the centres, extinction. of the employ PF-branded concern to clothes sign”. with ags name company The e-commerce 1998 sell them. the T-shirts that of 1985 Indian) company line. selling “peace standards. shopping then the luck. T-shirts, environment. uses Since good in national chose image 2007 manufacturers safety operations the the clothing. (American product company making various for include items. branded standards. to symbol life American frog Jones American cultures, a after Catesby Native an by started designed Founder PF is young-adult company shorts a (PF) branded teenage The (PF) branding for PF . 5 O p e r at i O n s m a n a g e m e n t 5.1 The role of operations management By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: ➔ dene operations and describe their relationship with other business functions ➔ comment on operations management in organizations producing goods and/or ser vices ➔ discuss operations management strategies and practices for ecological, social (human resource), and economic sustainability. Wh “oo”? they do services of imagine meet the they large can a production bakery, restaurant, a called The art of operations lines and we with variety as they and think oil are of of Every are all to the or plants, best is we machines, large-scale car the and processes, organizations get what goods organization sophisticated reneries also the production There production organizations: produce wants. of lines forms. school managing activities how long of such a i.e. needs When factory take intensive product. fundamental deliver, consumers’ something. a production to what that producer to refer and but with end a tend but capital- a small an end product tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 Operations is management. th fcoy In ancient China, imperial and private workshops, mills and small manufactories had been employed since the Eastern Zhou Dynasty (771– 221 BC), as noted in the historical text of the Zhou Li. In Europe, large mills and manufactories were established in ancient Rome. The Venice Arsenal provides one of the rst examples of a factory in the modern sense of the word. Founded in 1104 in Venice, Italy, several hundred years before the Industrial Revolution, it mass-produced ships on assembly lines using manufactured par ts. The Venice Arsenal apparently produced nearly one ship every day and, at its height, employed 16 000 people. Operations sector, with machines; may the be easier image however, ● in the primary ● in the secondary of to a understand large operations sector, factory are mining sector, in found or the with in case long all of the lines sectors, of secondary sophisticated for example: harvesting industrial manufacturing 339 5 O p e r at i O n s m a n a g e m e n t ● in the tertiary sector, ● in the quaternary open-heart sector, surgery business consultancy. Student workpoint 5.1 Be a thinker 1. List ten types organizations (e.g. sole quaternary), 2. Identify always The study products book, in your your go model or your as a your cellulose process Figure how the exported opportunity level. They extracted are all a range primary Are of and they A in your wood simple result product imported, investigate around you and of can then for how – school manufactured, from the to Look furniture are nished or cover (e.g. organizations. transformation. The to that? the operations 5.1.1). maybe car. pulp of those is concrete clothes, Try sectors 1.2. of Why very know. and unit provides a parents’ represent (see transported, sold at computer, (such can in operations operations – you charity) studied main made through process as that straightforward? house, materials that of are the trader, at using your this and raw book) input–output a transformational then be packaged, commercialized and bought. tcudorp dehsiniF slairetam waR tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 OPERATIONS: INPUT materials OUTPUT PROCESS, materials TRANSFORMATION Figure 5.1.1. Input–output model Student workpoint 5.2 Be a thinker 1. Apply the studied, 2. useful is Apply the to “the can 340 input–output for example that to an organization organization you chose that for you your have IA. How model? input–output input”, you model the draw “the from model process” this? to and your “the school; what output”? corresponds What conclusions 5 . 1 T H E R O L E O F O P E R A T I O N S M A N A G E M E N T Oo d h oh bu fuco Operations can Operations are closely linked Operations deliver the ● objectives (see someone’s or and Operations ● Unit are hairdresser, controls described as the to “what” 1), for “how the to” other question example of business management. functions: of an organization’s manufacturing cars or cutting hair. Operations ● be done by people indirectly in programmes need funding (see the the Unit case of 2), the directly car manufacturer’s (see Unit 3) and in factory the case worker of the who machines. all nancial aspects must In the hairdressing salon, be carefully budgeted and monitored, for example to pay the car operations are carried out directly factory worker’s salary or to ensure that the hairdresser breaks even. by employees Operations ● Unit so 4), that produce promoted both the goods and and sold at hairdressing services the that right salon must price and the to car be the marketed right (see audience, manufacturer are successful. is relationship easy As a to between understand: consequence, good position to the work recommendations. The ● or oor (Unit operations not or the may or likely help know of a business on large departments direct scale costs other depend one functions another. company and make is in a valuable examples: experience that may identify organization necessarily obsolescence the manager other has of and functions some manager 1.6), of the are diseconomies weaknesses would operations business with Here operations scale all (Unit about, of take some 1.3) for of of the that in economies on the of factory strengths other example maintenance the place and departments machinery the foreseeable tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 The future. The ● operations rewards not) for (such the appreciate good The ● as in the in turn however, a that an have just result about operations integral 4.5) manager part in it of in of may forms may can HR forms may of be non-nancial suitable manager motivation be on could the (Unit easily have which costs) advise important and the of know safety may may be (or not very cut which that have): 3.2), point product implemented of costs (Unit and (such which the 3.2). interesting organization production be break-even on ideas (or that extension not). The would, scale. you delivering” sometimes the 2.4): diseconomies is which teamwork) practice. impact may “doing may or (Unit some manager (Unit suggest energy an margin consequence, not not manager operations marketing is that but can rotation semi-variable strategies As fact theory, organization’s The job organization operations some would ● manager as understand (despite the operations and its that operations negative image management decision-making is process. 341 5 O p e r at i O n s m a n a g e m e n t Student workpoint 5.3 Be a thinker 1. Find an organizational relationships chains 2. On of that chart of an workers, organization with levels of showing hierarchy the and command. organizational workers the between responsible workers in the chart, for identify operations. other business the How department are functions? they and linked What can the to you conclude? Oo d h oduco of ood o vc Production or have of is usually non-physical used this production some it may can between denitions, as not be shown be two in the between as either the as creation (services). distinction products products dened products goods or extreme of and and and (such products as services, services, types, physical units fundamental goods Table Earlier 1.1 but clear-cut. there there is in (goods) 4.1) terms Although also can and be a range an of overlap in 5.1.1. Table 5.1.1. Range of goods and services Goods High physical content but High ser vice content with some ser vices but with some physical Ser vices products tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 Mobile phone, smar tphone Cosmetic surgery Consumer gets the product Consumer gets the “new” Customers travel from A to Assuming that consumers but there may also be after- nose, breasts or wrinkle- B but they may have a meal don’t buy the T-shir t or the sales service (for example free face but there is and watch a lm, all par t CD or even the sponsor ’s in cases of malfunction or extensive treatment before of the experience that the soft drink , they only pay for when updates are needed) and after the operation airline oers the pleasure of the music This may Figure also be represented through a Airline travel continuum, as shown in 5.1.2: Pure goods Combination of goods and services Pure services Figure 5.1.2. Continuum of goods and services. Student workpoint 5.4 Be a thinker 1. Consider services”. 2. How the the useful two continuum Locate do you extremes? management? 342 some And between examples nd Can this you maybe “pure of visual apply even goods” products on and “pure this continuum. representation it to to other other between areas areas of of business knowledge? Music concer t 5 . 1 There if in could the exactly where example the his not computer, he was Or what as he ultimately, essential, to operations his does the without wrote dog, In matter? in the you as For about the he be of In the plane goods must and operations of a of are of a easy book to he the alike, would the did write? And The best On when operations situation. provide for text? Or troposphere? the even Where ofce? M A N A G E M E N T identify author, about home chapters to O P E R A T I O N S operations, thought the O F reading). services still R O L E always his or adapted goods form not Think sentences? manufacturing examine is book mind, thinking notion it place. the his the some sector take of travelling: it the author place? he was but and which as business quaternary the take walking if a and the (such operations sector be tertiary T H E are secondary contexts in business. Oo d ubly our about stages raw the us typical of the materials of the product than not just These ● social ● ecological aim use protable to Social – be cut the taken is the most If where manager, correctly in is of defective), process however, other is reminds nished the planned several product 5.1.1) the it and appropriate nished (Figure example, identify take the is elements and factors is an wider executed; into account. categories: their Ecological for to a some is is to more also (or more local working to also that is (for called managers have on and not that are in to their as all to costs. their long This cases it The best term (as from a one organizations workers, external and affected case of as are internal stakeholders. employees acceptable, the some operate more negatively example in energy the further sustainability towards communities, social are fairly that by the the decisions expansion or sustainability factors understand the continue more ensure “environmental”) may to as respected; efciency. materials over economic conditions people raw protability likely greater such be possible, example, costs, responsibility seek For and must whenever through terms. called fact factors. budgets and, example resources the they that unnecessary towards is fact ensuring their local the minimum for organization This organization “environmental”) monetary This of and life the and in refer aware relocation). more to management different manager. (for operations have available next). that by to made, consequence, of refer ultimately stakeholders, quality to that model operations need the choosing ensuring production called kept be to factors treated, from required the three organization the becoming a to an will also into measured advantage year that (also should to of of operations input–output standard role factors possible is The factory, controlling factors must usually may and factors Economic savings The manager fall economic wastage the managers factors large equipment, ensuring ● As of occurred. a process, responsibilities is operations is and required. operations error of organizing, production standard the example planning, tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 In natural the refer to negative the fact impact environment, that that especially their different 343 5 O p e r at i O n s forms of m a n a g e m e n t pollution, such as air pollution (from carbon monoxide and Key terms CFCs), or water noise pollution pollution (industrial (industrial waste near can factories, noise that noisy environment also affect mills, the and mines), workers Economic sustainability themselves, for example in a such as ship building). the need to use available This is also called ecological sustainability (or environmental resources and raw materials sustainability). to their best advantage, Economic sustainability, social sustainability and ecological sustainability ultimately ensuring are also called “the three pillars of sustainable development”. Their protability and nancial combination is called the “triple bottom line”. It is often represented in a performance Venn diagram, as shown in Figure 5.1.3. Social sustainability the need to take human factors into account, both internally (e.g. workers) and externally (e.g. local communities), when making business decisions Ecological sustainability the need to take ecological factors into account when making business decisions (especially about nature and ecosystems) Figure 5.1.3. The triple bottom line Triple bottom line This “triple bottom line” stresses the fact that business decisions should the need to take economic, not only consider nancial aspects (i.e. breaking even and making social, and ecological factors money for shareholders), but also the well-being of local communities into account when making tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 and the natural environment. Although this is relevant for all business business decisions functions, it is particularly activities may nancial transactions. remains most an have ideal more In rather commercial relevant negative many than a for operations, impacts cases, than though, reality, as as manufacturing marketing the “triple economic campaigns bottom aspects or line” largely drive organizations. Student workpoint 5.5 Be a thinker 1. How can notions 2. you that and 344 have studied (CSR) Consider organization the one “triple managers? This you “sustainability” responsibility is 3. link Can bottom and in social line” that in think of examples types of sustainability example practices for 1, “triple such as bottom line” corporate to social you have studied. decisions made How by important senior Why? you an Unit the enterprise? the different is and of one small economic, of situations business social, of (economic, and conict social, organization ecological between and and ecological)? its strategies sustainability. 5 . 1 T H E R O L E O F O P E R A T I O N S M A N A G E M E N T yduts esaC th C Blc eco-lod The word “eco- ● Luis, why did you set up this business venture? ● Of course I realized that there was a market lodge” is used to describe a type of opportunity, but I also wanted to do something accommodation for the local community. You see, I grew up here (lodge) that is before I moved to Belize City where I worked in the environmentally hospitality industry. I am very attached to this area friendly (ecowhich has so much to oer. With the eco-lodge, we friendly). Ecowant to give tourists the chance to discover the lodges aim to beauty of the area, yet without destroying what we minimize their negative impacts on the environment have. We are totally embracing the principles of ecoand they make this very clear in all their promotional tourism and sustainable development. materials. They often receive ocial cer ticates Luis, can you give us some concrete examples of ● conrming that they fulll the criteria of sustainable what that means? development. For example, all our electricity is produced from ● The Casa Blanca Eco-lodge is located in the Mayan solar power, and all our water is supplied by a mountains of Belize in Central America. It targets three nearby mountain spring. We make sure that we types of visitor: rich tourists and jet-setters who seek stay in harmony with the natural environment. an exotic, nature-based holiday experience; young backpackers keen to see non-coastal par ts of Belize; So the eco-lodge is all about integrating the ● accommodation in its environment, is that correct? and environmental scientists working on research or conservation projects. Yes, this is true, although we go fur ther than that. ● The rainforest around the eco-lodge oers many We are fully integrated in the local economy; for opportunities for exploration and adventure. Visitors can go example we only employ local people and we only horseriding or hiking up the many canyon trails with a local use food produced from local suppliers. guide, or they may prefer to canoe down the nearby rivers. Questions The abundant bio-diversity of fauna and ora contributes 1. Which strategies and practices for economic, social, to the tourist appeal of the area, from its butteries to its tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 and ecological sustainability can you identify? jaguars, from its iguanas to its toucans, not to mention the rare black orchids unique to that environment. 2. Can you suggest to Luis Morillo Medina other strategies and practices to ensure the economic, Luis Morillo Medina opened The Casa Blanca Eco-lodge social, and ecological sustainability of the Casa in 2006. Here is an extract from an interview with Luis Blanca Eco-lodge? that was published in the magazine Eco-tourism Today in 2012: TOK discussion rvo chckl ✓ Operations are the fundamental ✓ Operations are done ✓ Operations need activities of ● organizations. Is operations management an ar t or a science? by people – human resources. ● to be funded – accounts and In terms of operations nance. and production, is there a ✓ ✓ Operations produce and the sold at Operations goods price management environmental three right areas. factors. and – is services marketing inuenced Operations which and by should need to be dierence between goods promoted and services? sales. economic, aim to be social ● and sustainable in all Are “good working conditions” universally the same all over the world, or could they vary by country or by culture? 345 5.2 Production methods By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: dene and explain the following production methods: ➔ ● job or customized production ● batch production ● mass production ● ow, line, or process production ● cellular manufacturing recommend the most appropriate method of production for a ➔ given situation. A business may are use a organization, range dened large, in of Table complex such as production 5.2.1, products which (cars) a factory methods. also and manufacturing The main provides smaller, some simpler cars methods typical ones or of cakes, production examples (cakes or for cookies). Table 5.2.1. The main methods of production Type Denition Example Job Production of a special “one-o” Custom-made cars with (customized) product made to a specic order individualized accessories. production (for one individual customer). A personalized wedding tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 cake following the bride and groom’s own design, favourite colours and required size. Batch Production of a group of identical Car models with diering production products (the word “batch” refers features for each model. to the fact that the items in each A series of cookies in group go together from one stage dierent avours: chocolate of production to the next). chip, peanut, and coconut. Mass Production of a high volume Cars that are made to a production (hence the word “mass”) of standard design. identical, standardized products. Identical, undierentiated Flow production, process cookies produced for a production, and line production mass market. are alternative terms that stress one par ticular aspect of the mass-production process. Cellular Cellular manufacturing (also production called “cell production”) is a form of mass production in which the ow is broken up by teams of workers who are responsible for cer tain par ts of the line. 346 5 . 2 P R O D U C T I O N M E T H O D S Job oduco Job the production highest is end originality, and a of the market-oriented, should the Job This is is cycle. there The the same the time and “blueprint” to be a clear longer after be produce normally the charge premium deciding on what production”, with quality and Production the is product which means that customer. objectives – and and expect product product, careful phase – has inappropriate the is prices. precisely development the associated emphasis “customized specic would to can require even where client called a may format taken for the requires may client process producer also method market, with made production means the be. order production the greater been there the which product life consultation created. another as planning, of time. may It is This not be during likely can a that add to successful use. Advantages ● The ● Clients ● This on ● It mark-up get is likely exactly production individual can be a to be what high. they method is want. likely to motivate skilled workers working projects. exible production method. Disadvantages ● This production non-standardized It likely is with ● the There is to This be client a time than of method the can can when that client. be be expensive, requiring skilled workers materials. consuming, possibility knowledge ● method and very using the as there other product This may labour is much production might reect intensive fail badly more methods. because on consultation the and reliant on the middle of of the lack of tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 ● business. skilled workers. Bch oduco Batch production where the market-oriented; range of have Market is as the be are options. will into can associated quality components taken research on customers consultation to normally standardized planning, Some is emphasis need for replace products made although that of with the need to be customers, market, are products, production exact the Products customized method the be with affordability. offered This to account, and still but using requires a careful interchangeable. as options their may needs be limited. consultation. Advantages ● Businesses can manufacturer of ● operators Batch more achieve makes pools production market economies savings on of its scale budget (for by example bulk when buying, or a a small group resources). allows customers more choice – and so captures share. 347 5 O p e r at i O n s Batch ● production through Batch ● m a n a g e m e n t smaller may be useful for trialling products, especially quantities. production may help deal with unexpected orders. Disadvantages Businesses ● and/or may Businesses ● The (or It sizes of should production need of batches is known to are allocated recognized, automation is hold time as as machines “down large are recalibrated time”). stocks of work (in case of orders). labour) be production (this may unexpected ● lose retooled now dependent to however, allowing on the capacity of the machinery them. that greater increasingly sophisticated customization, even in a mass- environment. m oduco As it names production products, assembly quality indicates, refers typically line. automization every For time the orders tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 high at The low term the of of “ow different stages line (i.e. a and an long the end the is likely large sometimes the fact conveyor is are the of be The may one not on the need standard careful large, “sunk recouped is an of for production large be be requires rely a do same the along argument product as the process. reliable cost” by In mass production, most process in selling therefore a sold a is stages a by “mass continuous image of a through the stressing step in for a product Likewise, too, created, uses common the pause). used, different synonym the terms the step) the idea and particular “line of of a order). Advantages ● Once ● The ● ● set business the system can cater economies Labour may costs and with a The business has fully be needs for considerable process 348 up, large of low can as respond been maintenance. orders, thereby achieving scale. automated already little the jobs process to set an required they increase up. are in are are automated. In this factory, bottles are transpor ted from one machine to another business routing gradually through to must (this any role machines must to materials good however, used belts without product progression (as mass standardized quantities. that line production” a of raw main is stages products. in of produce investment assembly production “process all and is to quantity: volume its there production standardized along of on There stresses so about ow production, this market all high production the product. with and (where Mass viable, term materials of relied production” this factory process be is a unskilled; functions, synchronize the of continuous usually set). be the of a method to to Taylorist a is method end production” using can are nal this production”; ow this and process up by production production robotic order volume the of they in for setting or breaks planning mass the Labour control regular to relatively even orders unskilled replaceable. very quickly, as the 5 . 2 P R O D U C T I O N M E T H O D S Disadvantages ● Set-up costs ● Breakdowns ● The The The is the system business ● of is may high. costly, very as the whole dependent on a assembly steady line may demand have from a to stop. large market. inexible: well production robotic be are business segment ● will be if left process there are holding can be sudden large changes stocks demotivating of for in demand, unwanted workers the products. doing activities. Comparison of the main production methods The three different main methods criteria (such of as production set-up time), may as be compared shown in Table according to 5.2.2. Table 5.2.2. Comparison of the three production methods Set-up time Job production Batch production Mass production There is a long set-up time as As set-up is usually a There is a very long set- there is a new set-up for every modication of an existing up as it takes time to new job. process, set-up time can be synchronize the whole reasonably fast. Otherwise it process. is as for mass production. High Capital (machinery) Labour Production time Medium Low This can be exible as it depends A mixture of machines is This can involve large on specic use. used, but this method is numbers of general-purpose based on general-purpose machines designed for a machines. specic function. Highly skilled workers are needed – Workers are semi-skilled Workers are unskilled and and may be craft workers. and need to be exible. need minimum training. This is likely to be long. Once set up, production can tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 Cost per unit Production is swift. be swift. Stock This involves low quantities of High quantities of raw There will be high quantities raw materials and nished stock materials are needed of raw materials and but a high amount of work in (buer stocks). There will be nished stock and a low progress. medium amounts of work in amount of work in progress. progress and nished stock . Cellular manufacturing Also called mass who “cell production”, production are attempt workers “pods”) them in which responsible to to improve operate with more for cellular the ow certain is parts mass-production as self-contained autonomy and manufacturing broken of the up line. techniques units by This by (called responsibility, is a is a of more or order of workers allowing “cells” in form teams recent teams of sometimes to motivate more. 349 5 O p e r at i O n s m a n a g e m e n t Student workpoint 5.6 Be a thinker 1. Can you have link “cellular studied, such project-based 2. Can you theories 3. Can link “cellular identify traditional method, as sector. is It advantage aims of of well nature improving of the responsible wastage a it cell can be each and their is repetitive elements to (Unit that 2.4) you or 2.2)? some motivation an with assembly Besides, given by greater nature as of can they It will is come of line, so working to a an and there is a costs directly lead halt to less production quality parts with in problem of close-knit compared assembly competitive three cooperative being a this reducing other of the the should to to quaternary greater from team part drawn achieve affecting as cellular production? the easier if responsibility on the This also without working been lead can of of in productivity, checking. rates. have industries members quality and methods businesses newer increasing quickly disadvantages other improvements own with with the with production rejection process. worker the cell quality, lower dealt production of production, compared explain manufacturers, Quality for and and that many production. other (Unit manufacturing” compared many believed for with empowerment structures manufacturing as and 2.4)? manufacturing, Many manufacturing” teamwork organizational (Unit you as the team, the robotic line. Ch oduco hod tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 Once a business method, may it can involve renancing to not the These ● ● are some are the the At the to most that Business method but the a so have least, resources but also was a this and could completely process, much production very business company re-engineering not would particular At human drastic, the production 1990s, a change. redeploying its means business. in the implications may roles would some choice perception 350 this have resources Production the of workers human managers ● system. production Rening These the implemented costly machines, changing tool and and decide reworks the entire fashionable now. implications for all the functions. Some so by of management business new itself: only organization Changing chosen difcult retooling re-engineer itself, has be of runs of of and redeployed, need careful implications can reect product the be HR: to be responsibilities require the to would for the available business may retrained, carefully of or even let go, managed. workers and middle planning. for marketing: orientation to the be of a business consumer, altered. so the as well image or as 5 . 2 Distribution ● channels may be affected, which may lead to P R O D U C T I O N M E T H O D S differing Key terms response times. Changes ● through in costs of changes production in price could (which be are passed likely to on to mean the an consumer increase, Job or customized production at production of a special “one-o” least in a short term, to pay for the transition costs). product made to a specic order These are some Changing ● which of the implications production affects method for (for one individual customer) nance: will have an impact on stock control, Batch production costs. production of a group of Changes ● causing may take delays in time the and could working interrupt capital current identical products (the word production, “batch” refers to the fact that cycle. the items in each group go Any ● change will need nancing, whether it is short term or for together from one stage of signicant developments that may require major long-term funding. production to the next) Mass production What is the most appropriate method of production of a high volume production for a given situation? (hence the word “mass”) The is most no ● one the appropriate correct target method method. market – will Factors for vary from affecting example, the business the to decision business may business – there include: be of identical, standardized products producing a Flow, line or process high volumes of a low-cost product for a very large market with little production disposable income alternative terms that stress ● the state of existing technology – this can limit how exible one par ticular aspect of the production can be mass-production process ● the availability of resources – xed capital, working capital, and Cellular manufacturing human capital a form of mass production in government regulations– for example, a business may have to meet tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 ● which the ow is broken up certain targets for recycling or waste emissions. by teams of workers who are Once not a business easy to However, change it Combining might but have $30 scale There is adopt a a the be In single particular to have of a be of a able the For food make its editions products, that method: a of and a for as green order on iPhones in the curry, Tom demand. and gold-plated economies satisfying the need a of for products. business always before of the line restaurant higher-market are contrasted result example achieve particular responsible for cer tain par ts is methods. making Thai special while there may a luxury it involved. and famous can place, different such dish, most business and model popular to suggesting compared combine example, staple in costs appropriate, customized production to different less limited way, more recipe be when efcient. supply method opportunity suitable mass-produce this for the each mass-produced demand disadvantages can also of and of even might production methods, batches would could no possible continuous models. in because productively and from changes be particular advantages Apple but 000 it, produce soup, Likewise, iPads, the more would Yam may a production integrating business has should advantages and recommendation made. 351 5 O p e r at i O n s m a n a g e m e n t rvo chckl TOK discussion ✓ Job (or customized) customer or production client of a production decides special, is what one-off market-oriented, the product meaning should be. This that is the often ● Is there always an ideal production method? Or product. does that depend on who ✓ Batch production creates a group of identical products, which can be decides? customized. ● ✓ Mass production creates a high volume of identical, What evidence and whose standardized experiences should products. business leaders consider ✓ Flow, line wherein a or process business production has a is constant an aspect ow of of mass materials when deciding on the production, in the production process. ✓ Cellular workers tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 352 manufacturing are responsible is a for form of certain manufacturing parts of the in which production teams process. of production method? 5.3 Lean production and quality management (HL only) By the end of this chapter, you should be able to: outline the following features of lean production: ➔ ● less waste ● greater eciency ● continuous improvement (kaizen) ● just-in-time (JIT) ● kanban ● andon ➔ explain the features of cradle-to-cradle design and manufacturing ➔ outline the features of quality control and quality assurance ➔ explain the following methods of managing quality: ● quality circle ● benchmarking ● total quality management (TQM) ➔ examine the impact of lean production and TQM on an organization ➔ explain the impor tance of national and international quality standards. tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 distinguish between the following methods of lean production: ➔ Wh “l oduco?” “Lean production” approach waste in greater to the in other fact are do in a the with studying too, from some care was this but they use the was only in in not be on The world, and all that lean other in applied as the (if you elements that manufacturing of cutting in one production lean task and in production automobile other construction such fat popular to management the to aim: companies, of an of rst refers the is types one was much idea principles and services lean in all became specialized especially from and (it Taylorist the “lean”) with “lean” of century applied adopted and rid workers just time) without idea: based or cutting origin word gets new on Toyota) the 20th sectors. the of a of conceptualizing might be agencies waste meat process late distribution principles focuses Japanese lean factory the other also as of already books around can to of is and writing all logistics This lines is Literally, piece approach and spread government now value. that (such production century started industries, industry; the manufacturing” manufacturer 1990s. healthy add It process the assembly how now in “lean production automobile a 20th 2.4). researchers have with directly Unit other the eater), early waste, (see as meat not by Lean countries that, called management production efciency. developed (also operations to education industries, retail. and Even health production. 353 5 O p e r at i O n s The starting desired by point the the “waste” of must time ● (for waiting in a products ● space materials energy ● full In the is just or Cutting of waste is organization’s and ● nancial Physical space tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 ● directly heating of Human resources holding cannot are stage a to the need of – can of stock the the stages This word waste or process reworked being of: location) half-constructed be is all for production, production to values include different movement much then eliminated. which from the possibilty or cars itself) scrapped) produced and a much and optimally of linked will the high before be to as be aspects greater better storage or of of skills and is such with very as efciently, and as waste, the deployed: of rent, broad: scrap resources, especially because such at process. less human employed, which knowledge). production resources, itself, raw power) “waste” the of used) machines, objects expensive, space are more efciency: used, more doubly some workers’ meaning physical used is using the of quantity they require substances other (such can too stored, without both the lighting, and warehouse). and can not be ties used deployed travel more times can up be used working elsewhere in for venues example (which is also friendly). more capital the efciently, between environmentally resources stock be next that life, manufacturing sense, under-utilization all unproductive expensive Financial and value proportionally (which stock the too disposal resources) a by not resources storage the anything with not about unused reducing ● but lean arrive production, the resources for to purchased lean about for defects example would of identifying connection), add broad in battery “overproduction”) example papers, add when example context not metal (for a example not not goal in consists long service do waiting called being (for key example is (for that elements (for may capacity talents ● a example this inventory ● after-sales is some (for (for stored; example interpreted example factory production (for process waste be for ● lean easy transportation ● it or production elimination for customer customization, of m a n a g e m e n t efciently, (which too means as, for that example, this money organization). Student workpoint 5.7 Be a thinker Can 1. you The link starting How 2. can What (Unit 3. How 4. Lean such 354 lean are production point this the of refer best lean to a to several lessons production marketing methods of from consists orientation market in other identifying that research parts to you the have identify of the course? values studied the values desired (Unit by the customer. 4.1)? desired by the customer 4.4.)? can a shbone production as the acid diagram aims test at (Unit greater (Unit 3.5) 1.6) help efciency; and stock identify how can turnover areas this ratio of waste appear (Unit in in a production ratios 3.6)? that you process? have studied, 5 . 3 L E A N P R O D U C T I O N A N D Q U A L I T Y M A N A G E M E N T ( H L O N LY ) mhod of l oduco CHange Over the years, several methods of lean production have been dened As we learnt in the section 5.2, and implemented. If the managers of an organization decide to adopt changing production methods can lean production, they will choose the method that suits best their be costly and time-consuming. context. The following four methods are particularly important: However, that has not deterred many ● continuous improvement ● just-in-time businesses from making the change ( kaizen) towards leaner production. Read (JIT) about the car manufacturer Jaguar (http://businesscasestudies.co.uk/ ● kanban ● andon. jaguar/lean-production/introduction. html#axzz2xeH59wx2) In what ways has the company Continuous improvement (kaizen) benetted from making the change to lean production? word Japanese lean The term In observe more It ● as is its to inclusive group of There should Systemic ● some Kaizen The the main require high employees. will the levels The or the with of in not process, kaizen over is a the of style: the is any to Toyota. occasional as on often what boxes the they however, fact problem to make consider on of the that period a (i.e. the philosophy, parts it of sense unlikely corporate by like can be whole not just a only). organization kaizen bureaucratic to not and Japan: suggestion Kaizen, hierarchy some long commitment culture the hesitate and a principles: order just just based oor. management may to is from developed involve ideas, key attached needed and momentum leadership leadership is may department employees on difculty one was opposed shop of originates improvements, good the levels that as for certain all kaizen process very improvement”) method of areas on blame process, focuses necessary or no thinking production ● be of adopt managers (otherwise have requiring must idea this directly this change, suitable may “continuous as the form, nd sophisticated, be used, whole, experience must means continuous themselves or organization ● a on simplest competitions workers (which commonly production emphasis changes. or “kaizen” to raised suggestions). the is whole product. difcult time. may issues it. end of or tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 The To loyalty under maintain so by inuence work to do would the this, an and so autocratic culture. Just-in-time (JIT) A business ensure may that it hold can “buffer stock”), Holding stock, also insurance stocks. is ● or JIC, costs stock which materials demand to to and stock control. means and (or a sudden, advantage may incur even the levels Stock is very control in of payroll products problem for many reasons, unexpected bulk several “just-in-case”: nished of (inventory) any take however, Controlling called stock reply purchasing costs: costs important is based case production of only staff for on holding in not of a a or example (this raw look business: of the to called materials. storage balance sudden in of who reserves a for demand costs, after this but the function between: both raw increase supply in chain) 355 5 O p e r at i O n s JIT: ● avoiding and The is and the contributes between optimal JIT to by only traditional production, storage stock produce difference control JIC to m a n a g e m e n t facilities) JIT stock two and able that and of JIC pillars be supplies less the factors further control; company of greater get and will stock the to only when necessary, ordered. levels method means the being when efciency however, will waste not (there (not affecting explored hold is no having in in stock unit terms buffer waste money 5.5. of lean stock, of which space tied up in in stock). Kanban “Kanban” the is another Japanese supports notes basic that Imagine may level, telling next JIT. the stage this steady is of of to control, that are of boxes, a tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 in similar to other read used are increasingly – of a for used, some are a aim or the the card is to is and a At of a a very message, to the operations could The not that sticky move ensure resources. from systems other. is terms labels with is help a a be xed regular rate tool electronic good the of of automotive basic sent to in their principle the can to of on and demand stock right). and be works best transferred tell expression bars an process own industry salespeople kanban; code example production innovative the of to In Kanban This to be emails form the example stock. the of stickers place for originates production. factory, contexts, one kanban computerized, also also to coloured time lean from example available of A production. may originates one next, such interpreted. in (which do shipments: all and manufacturing are how facilitate directly kanban areas products to from to idea coloured about. reorder waste rate cards products Although any the tool or is what or the refers with around, now as Kanban table kanban workers without kanban other large moved consider word, Toyota. production directly innovation a what control but Modern is items, ow, used be factory management, groups Japanese company them that “ekanban” is too. A kanban card Andon Another electric staff, 356 Japanese or even term, electronic) managers) andon, which of a refers informs problem to a signal workers (typically (usually visual (supervisors, a quality and maintenance problem or some 5 . 3 delay in system When with a a of will same will Andon has all levels on of time is involved The ● whole enables Originally, here”); a do chain not be of the kanban, and defect alert possible, when the the – again the an it will – ( H L O N LY ) andon anomaly and means in with should workers or system This dealing database kaizen chain to a the a that the spirit of problem. occur again promptly The (at the retrieve solution. provided specic to symbols, including time notied (workers at engineers). monitoring production: their solving. all learns were modern immediately teams (even the ones that did not get incident). (continuous alerts are spend problem organization or as command, need spent that andon text a product immediately. time one) causes production however, as another and M A N A G E M E N T from problems and mistakes, which improvement). simple systems with its (such can audio a red include alarms signal other meaning forms of “problem displays, too. tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 such help in a triggers quickly of kaizen Q U A L I T Y advantages: can in example and as Like A N D factories. worker logged the instead Feedback ● or the Supervisors ● (for the waste be about Toyota come less then other Workers in resolved workstation information ● be P R O D U C T I O N workstation). occurs production: problem a machinery), co-workers problem lean at developed problem the team process was L E A N An andon signal Cdl-o-cdl d d ufcu Cradle-to-cradle to design and development, The term product the been products of “cradle” such as clothes manufacturing At from ofce a the to or to should based on refers principles to of a recent approach sustainable recycling. refers book “cradle again. or a used, products and especially expression have design manufacturing the a production car. grave”: be it – but phase, “cradle recycled this number furniture term suggests entirely moment, small The of the is only that to the the creation cradle” products, create companies, current i.e. to case for the for a once same small example socio-cultural of comes a from they new number some momentum 357 5 O p e r at i O n s towards design environmental and entirely, To to the full ofcial several ● the reutilization ● the amount renewable of the amount ● the corporate about that fair topic infancy: Cradle of the and will more what car water social put pressure products that on are companies partly, if to not cradle (C2C) example itself necessary for certication”, products regarding: (recycling, the strictly recycling speaking) process, ideally needed and it design of the (CSR) recycling of the process company, will mean “Ford of what U”, using the more a for instance the 21st U to and exists as a cradle could do. its This Ford has oil to means rened century engine only in Cradle companies example, for still The 2012. many sunower-seed Ford cradle For car in dened development, is called launched practice. Model however, was become and in manufacturing organization Institute research could and non-prot features example part responsibility eco-friendliness, – as practices. their foam theoretical energy called and to for material Innovation of a seat the independent exploring recycling of cradle-to-cradle part concept “cradle criteria, labour criteria As based of Products the time. more energy ● The sustainability manufacture recycled. receive need m a n a g e m e n t over are proposed based and prototype on soy- and as a Student workpoint 5.8 Be a thinker How can other you parts of link the cradle-to-cradle course? design and manufacturing to Consider: tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 ● Unit 5.1 about the three ● Unit 1.3 about CSR ● Unit 1.4 about STEEPLE types of sustainability analysis. Quly cool d quly uc A key past component this quality a move came was W . products Quality of largely is still due increased ● repeat ● reduced ● premium has of quality sprung assurance. to the inuential for management matter Deming, important ● a that quality Edwards are operations much revolution towards about theorist very a work from This of whose the Japan issue man: about in the of but, since change one ideas is control 1945, quality US how quality. thanks to to there In the the has been management management produce quality today. producer as it can lead to: sales customers (brand loyalty) costs pricing. W. Edwards Deming 358 5 . 3 From a marketing product to bring perception tables hugely not is The term reliable ● safe ● durable ● innovative ● value the a it British a product rewards, then business need but that as can schools, businesses, not is – suggests going it is – not long often airlines, even if A N D the be as be or Q U A L I T Y a ( H L O N LY ) high-quality the consumer enough. MP3 product M A N A G E M E N T So league players voted can “the be best” is that to be GM Leyland to the get from the Ford never did is: down last gained and product break way what showed have a fail you benet not to to leading revolution may that going going money amount fact is could car quality, for not – quality huge it is for range Honda is – it these P R O D U C T I O N so! ● The of quality – of “top” important actually viewpoint, all one showing L E A N that in you by brand only work just of functionality or design for. businesses not good-quality producing are pay even producing same terms image as a to the BMW , good-quality, starting at top products. there cheaper realize, and end While is still cars. of a a This Rover and out. high price archos beosound iriver apple rio high low quality quality sharp tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 creative (muvo) oregon ministry of sound mpman low price Figure 5.3.4. A way of mapping products based on scales of quality and price Student workpoint 5.9 Be an inquirer An IB They of a the created quality. some did a a research survey magazine product They of to all for nd the an that best-quality external, positioning concluded the students, map, quality reliable with is then the not MP3 used player. the website judgment. two always axes of They price reected in price. Why The did professional then and class initially not move try from summarized between the the as same exercise “quality in two Table control” 5.3.1, for to a product “quality which shows of your choice? assurance” the major can be difference systems. 359 5 O p e r at i O n s m a n a g e m e n t Table 5.3.1. Quality control versus quality assurance Quality control Concept Quality is “controlled” by one person (the ● Costs Quality assurance manager) by inspection after the production overall control of quality; the whole business is run has been completed focused on ensuring quality production A cer tain % reject rate is set, for example 2% of ● Quality is “assured” because no one person is in ● Zero rejects are expected – every product is ● products are allowed to fail Processes expected to pass inspection ● Wasteful production ● Lean production ● It is rare to halt production as it is costly to do so ● The company expects to halt production to x ● Associated with assembly line, ow errors ● production ● Associated with cellular or modular production Quality stops with the job; the focus is only ● Quality includes suppliers and after-sales on the job at hand People servicing Quality is the responsibility of one person – a ● Quality is the responsibility of the team – ● quality inspector In order to embrace is for difcult benecial to “Role culture” ● Total quality culture ● Autocratic leadership ● Democratic consultative leadership ● Top-down, one-way communication ● 360-degree communication total and to manage ● quality a quality circles assurance quality costly the to achieve business quality; tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 ● quality ● benchmarking ● total the to work cultural in the in the long following effectively, shift; as with short run. three a term, Several are the whole kaizen but it may methods particularly business approach, well are has this prove possible important: circle quality management (TQM). Quly ccl A quality circle (employees who The in meet meetings market meet and several any times, topic issues. a of range will example, the as staff The be able when as a to on the improve and suggest team of circle, to discuss, in or principle of up they idea be of hierarchy) the a understand group needs they could on coming of the from quality company; for members enabling the (such trained focus working the thereby quality. be necessarily that, turnover, solutions to to ways: may quality of successful, members views, to with the the staff different be not different is overall needs comparable quality operate levels improving (who would issue come is volunteers all group organization, to ways leader This of from focus the an group and company, present learning turnover) a underlying may a a may want discussing circle by whereas to formal facilitation). circles they a and although perspectives quality company, discuss group as departments facilitated Quality specic circle 360 are dened to research, continuity. choose be different regularly leadership for can from problem as of the (such reducing safety 5 . 3 hazards and managers solutions As in a that tool Japan from giving doing of are about 1962. Japan after in and more the the A N D This Q U A L I T Y is focus not here the is M A N A G E M E N T same on ( H L O N LY ) as generating quality. Second countries not exibility). exercise: illustrates countries did P R O D U C T I O N enhancement, This some Anglo-Saxon spread workers consultation quality in common a L E A N prove World (such and quality again War. as the and Europe, were rst quality Quality Japan Western that circles how circles are China), where established revolution now though the came very less method so did in not successful. Student workpoint 5.10 Be a thinker 1. What their 2. skills may training Quality circles (such as could that facilitators of quality circles need? What could require? are South very East common Asia) but in not some others regions (such as of the world Europe). Why be? Bchk is about comparing Benchmarking is a that reference, can then some A of to stars used standard what as from they the classify a expect of their take and those follow copying processes several in in their specic innovation) the model done in to keep In all a to cases, and has want to its success “think not hotel follow way, of for those a the is to in their can company company competing quality who industry practices be done already have on and in existing a quality they Benchmarking businesses the much may that know managers, do. so communicating emulate. their number their not benchmarks a of the improve wish Benchmarking use is business leader It of different could they point businesses consumers, understanding another with they market about and is for practices”. standards); study a the with useful how the may hotel useful should quality. example then is very as and and identify can acting also as be together date. the to organization too, may collaborative up readiness new they products as (for This or – competitors. As benchmarking ve-star “best your use. standards of services, improve (such and also players to established identify companies issue and and rivals’ to Some industry is organizations’ the quality it them best a hotel. but help the order ways. – yourself businesses example hotels: products Businesses are practices three-star benchmarks quality about their well-known can many benchmarks compare competitors. tool tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 Benchmarking to carry may of benchmarking outside not on as the it box”, always necessarily relies trying has. work to on Besides, for the business’s introduce what another, so something works for one benchmarking, limits. 361 5 O p e r at i O n s m a n a g e m e n t tol quly (tQm) Key terms As indicated that by permeates TQM can kanban, they its the include and may name, whole quality andon. be TQM All an approach to quality enhancement Lean production organization. circles these combined is and and quality benchmarking, tools integrated in are a not wider as well mutually as kaizen, exclusive; framework of TQM. a Japanese approach to operations management focusing on less waste and greater eciency Some other possible features of TQM are outlined in Table 5.3.2. Kaizen Table 5.3.2. Other features of TQM a method of lean production Feature Purpose Quality chain As the quality of a business depends on the quality of its based on continuous improvement suppliers and after-sales service, all stages of the production JIT process must have concern for quality. A possible way to consider this is by imagining that the next par t of the chain “just-in-time”: a method of is the nal customer. stock control which means avoiding holding stock by Statistical process All stages of production are monitored and information control (SPC) is given to all par ties, usually in the form of easy-to- being able to get supplies only when necessary and to understand diagrams, char ts, and messages. produce just when ordered Mobilized All employees (at all levels of seniority and in all depar tments, workforce even the ones not directly in contact with products or JIC customers) are expected to embrace TQM. Everyone is “just-in-case”: holding reserve encouraged to feel pride in their work, given responsibilities of both raw materials and and recognition, for example through employee of the month nished products in case of a schemes – so everyone is included in the quality decision- sudden increase in demand making process. (or of a problem in production Market-oriented By focusing on what the customer wants, the business can production make sure that it is innovating and continually reinventing its or in the supply chain) Kanban tnemeganaM snoitarepO 5 products. This can lead to improved sales and brand loyalty. a system of messages (written or electronic) to help Student workpoint 5.11 manage production ows and JIT delivery Be knowledgeable Read the Mattel Mattel such text in has below and answer the questions that follow. Andon a system of signals and China recalled recall in two more than 18 million toys worldwide, the second aler ts informing workers of a problem that requires weeks. immediate attention Chinese-made recalled because containing Batman Sarge small Magna, die-cast their paint magnets Doggie toys from contains that can Daycare the lead. come and Pixar Mattel loose, One Piece lm has Cars also including playsets. have been recalled Polly toys Pocket, Cradle-to-cradle design and manufacturing Previously a recent approach to design the company had recalled Dora The Explorer dolls’ houses. and manufacturing based The Consumer reports of any Products injuries Safety from Commission the recalled (CPSC) said it had no products. on principles of sustainable development, especially recycling 1. Outline the 2. Explain what 3. To what this 362 type possible may extent of costs be the would problem a in to Mattel costs of system future? of not of recalling recalling TQM help its the toys. toys. Mattel (2 marks) (4 marks) overcome (8 marks) 5 . 3 Lean production and TQM L E A N are P R O D U C T I O N closely linked. A N D Lean Q U A L I T Y M A N A G E M E N T production ( H L O N LY ) focuses Key terms on less and waste quality and greater efciency, enhancement. For a TQM focuses company, on quality implementing assurance lean Quality circle production and TQM has many advantages: a formal group of volunteers It ● can create closer working relationships with all stakeholders (employees from dierent (including suppliers and customers). departments and from all ● It can motivate ● It can reduce ● It can improve ● It can enhance the levels of hierarchy) who workers. meet regularly to discuss and costs (especially long-term costs). suggest ways of improving the design the and production reputation of the of quality products. quality in their organization company. Benchmarking However, implementing disadvantages lean production and TQM has some a tool for businesses to too: compare themselves to their competitors in order to identify ● It is costly ● Staff ● It may ● It can ● It is (especially in the short term). how they can improve their own may need signicant training. operations and practices take time to change a corporate culture. TQM create a lot of stress on formal relationships in the business. an approach to quality difcult to maintain over a long period of enhancement that permeates time. the whole organization (as TQM and lean production are more commonly used by businesses a wide framework, TQM can that are new or looking to make signicant changes to retain their include quality circles and competitive advantage. However, many long-established businesses benchmarking, as well as now also understand that their traditional approaches to operations kaizen, kanban, and andon) they need production to make and quality